Design Manual
Design Manual
Volume
MammutDesignManual
Design Manual
MBS-QMS-P12F03
Revision 00
Date 20-Jul-2009
Table of Contents
CHAPT ER
C H A P T ER5
Introduction
Wind Loads
MBMA 1996
Value Engineering
MBMA 2002
20
MBMA 2006
85
CHAPT ER
Design Codes
C H A P T ER6
For Loads
Seismic Loads
Definition
MBMA 1986
For Welding
MBMA 1996
15
UBC 1997
18
27
51
C H A P T ER
Dead Loads
Collateral Loads
5
C H A P T ER7
C H A P T ER4
Live Loads
12
14
15
16
Impact Loads
17
18
Snow Loads
Definition
C H A P T ER8
Crane Loads
C H AP T ER1 4
C H A P T ER9
Load Combinations
C H AP T ER1 5
MBMA 1996
UBC 1997
ASCE 7-98
10
C H AP T ER1 6
IBC 2000
12
MBMA 2002
13
ASCE 7-02
15
C H AP T ER1 7
IBC 2003
17
Mezzanine
ASCE 7-05
19
IBC 2006
21
C H AP T ER1 8
BS 5950
23
Bracing
AP P EN D IX
C H AP T ER1 0
Serviceability
Material Specification
C H AP T ER1 3
Welds
A
1
AP P EN D IX
C H AP T ER1 2
Reference
AP P EN D IX
C H AP T ER1 1
Chapter
I N T R O D U C T I O N
Introduction
I N T R O D U C T I O N
9. During the process of analysis and design, the designer should keep in
mind the use of standard inventory sections, standard connection details,
factory limitations, erection facility with an eye on most optimized design.
10. Upon completion of design conveys his design information in the most
efficient manner using design sketches and notes as required, in order to
transfer all necessary information to the design checker, draftsman,
detailing and checking engineers.
11. Checks his final design against the estimates and if there are any major
variations in the material weights, should inform the supervisor
immediately.
12. If required for special projects the designer may be required to attend
meeting with consultants, local authorities and area office etc. for design
clarifications and explanation.
13. Checks the approval drawings, erection drawings and if required shop
drawings in order to ensure that his design has been translated as it was
conceptualized.
14. Performs design checks on jobs designed by colleagues, if assigned by
supervisor.
15. Leads a design team, coordinates and guides other designers and
colleagues on big projects multi-tasking.
16. Participates in Design review meetings and provides comments, valuable
suggestions on improvements on design engineering process,
standardization and practices.
I N T R O D U C T I O N
Value Engineering
Designers who regularly practice value engineering consistently create the
best value for the client. There are things which the client can do for himself
such as picking right consultants for his project, clearly stating his goals and
requirements, not changing his mind, and allowing ample time for design and
construction. There are also things which a manufacturer / erector can do to
cut construction costs. But the party with the greatest impact on the economic
success of the project is the designer. Not only are the interests of the client
directly in his hands but he also has a tremendous influence on the caliber of
performance and monetary rewards of the other number of things which a
designer can do to enhance his design posture and assure that all parties
concerned benefit from the construction project.
First, any designer who works in steel industry should take advantage of
steels many strong points:
1. Good weight-to-strength ratio.
2. The efficiency of off site assembly.
3. Speed of delivery and assembly.
4. Steel is readily available, can be stock piled and stored.
5. Steel has strength in three directions.
6. Steel is elastic, versatile, and durable.
7. Maintains its strength after heating and yielding.
8. Steel is easily worked.
9. Steel structures can be added to, subtracted from, altered, and re-in
forced to adapt to use changes.
10. Steel is compatible with other building materials.
11. Steel is easily inspected.
12. Steel design is user friendly.
A designer/ estimator should be aware of the current steel and material prices
he prescribes in his project. He should be aware of the where the money is
spent on steel construction, material, design, drawings, fabrication, painting,
shipping and erection.
The designer should take advantage of all allowable increases in stresses
wherever applicable in order to achieve least price for a project.
Consideration should be given to use of partial composite design of floor
beams, something in the range 50% to 75%, fully composite action is in
efficient.
Take advantage of the live load reductions if the governing codes permit.
I N T R O D U C T I O N
Select proper mix of high strength steels. High strength steels are
advantageous when strength is the major design criteria. High strength steel
(A572 Gr. 50) is about 13% more costly than A36 steel but over 35% stronger.
When deflection, stiffness, or some other serviceability criteria governs, the
nod will often go to A36 steel because the heavier the sections required will
generally have a higher moment of inertia and less cost as compared to high
grade steel.
I N T R O D U C T I O N
I N T R O D U C T I O N
Select optimum bay spacing. An exhaustive study by John Ruddy (PE) (AISC
Engineering Journal Vol. 20 # 3 1983) indicated that a rectangular bay with a
length to width ratio of approximately 1.25 to 1.50 was the most efficient.
I N T R O D U C T I O N
I N T R O D U C T I O N
Do not call for more weld than is necessary. Over welding creates excessive
heat which may contribute warping and shrinkage of the members resulting in
costly straightening expense.
Avoid locating column or rafter splices at mid span.
For heavy bracing, where ever possible, translate the bracing working points
so that they lie on the intersection of the flange faces rather than the centerline
of members. Generally this will result in more compact and efficient
connection (See article by William Thornton in the AISC Engineering Journal
Vol. 21 3rd Quarter 1984)
Allow the prudent use of oversized holes and slots to facilitate fit up and
erection. They may eliminate or reduce the need for costly site reaming of
holes or re-fabrication.
Avoid odd sections that may not be readily available or which are seldom
produced. These could be costly delays.
Avoid overly restrictive specifications. The more restrictions listed in the steel
specifications the greater the chances that no one will be able to meet them all.
This will eliminate some of the competition and often result in higher bids.
When value engineering is performed by the designer the cost savings benefits
go mainly to the client in the form of lower bids. When the value engineering
is done by the manufacturer/erector the cost savings is shared with the clients,
sometimes!
D E S I G N
Chapter
C O D E S
Design Codes
Following Loading and Design Codes should be used as a standard, unless
specified otherwise in the Project information form or customer specification.
1. Loads,
MBMA 2006 Metal Buildings Manufacturers Association Metal
Building Systems Manual, 2006 Edition
OR
MBMA 2002 Metal Buildings Manufacturers Association Low
Rise Building Systems Manual, 2002 Edition.
D E S I G N
C O D E S
OR
AISC American Institute of Steel Construction Manual of Steel
Construction - Allowable Stress Design, 1989-9th Edition.
D E S I G N
C O D E S
OR
AISI American Iron and Steel Institute Cold Formed Steel Design
Manual, 1996 Edition.
D E S I G N
C O D E S
4. Welding,
AWS D1.1/D1.1M:2004 American Welding Society Structural
Welding Code - Steel Manual, 2004 Edition.
D E A D
Chapter
L O A D S
Dead Loads
ASCE 7-05
Section 3.1
efinition
D E A D
L O A D S
D E A D
L O A D S
100
0.091
0.112
0.160
0.069
0.079
0.116
0.137
0.196
0.093
0.104
0.119
0.140
0.200
0.097
0.107
0.134
0.154
0.220
0.111
0.122
0.107
0.128
0.183
0.084
0.095
0.113
0.134
0.192
0.090
0.101
D E A D
L O A D S
Floors
Material
Terrazzo tile
Ceramic or quarry tile
Linoleum or vinyl
Mastic
Hardwood
Softwood
Clay tile
Partitions
Gypsum board
Built-up
Shingles
Roofs
Sheathing
Insulation
(per 25 mm thickness)
Bricks
Walls
Clay tile
Load Bearing
Plastering
(25 mm thick)
Stone
Structural glass
Corrugated asbestos
25 mm thick
20 mm thick
6 mm thick
20 mm thick
20 mm thick
20 mm thick
75 mm thick
100 mm thick
150 mm thick
200 mm thick
250 mm thick
50 mm thick
75 mm thick
100 mm thick
125 mm thick
150 mm thick
3-ply ready roofing
3-ply felt and gravel
5-ply felt and gravel
Wood
Asphalt
Clay tile
Slate(6 mm thick)
Wood(20 mm thick)
Gypsum(25 mm thick)
Loose
Poured-in-place
Rigid
100 mm thick
200 mm thick
300 mm thick
100 mm thick
150 mm thick
200 mm thick
300 mm thick
100 mm thick
150 mm thick
200 mm thick
300 mm thick
100 mm thick
150 mm thick
200 mm thick
300 mm thick
Cement
Gypsum
(100 mm thick)
25 mm thick
(6 mm thick)
Weight
(kg/m2)
65
50
5
45
18
12.5
85
90
140
170
200
47.5
52.5
62.5
70
92.5
5
27.5
30
10
15
45 70
50
15
20
2.5
10
7.5
200
400
600
150
215
275
400
105
150
190
275
125
150
165
225
50
25
275
75
15
Weight
(kN/m2)
0.65
0.50
0.05
0.45
0.18
0.125
0.85
0.90
1.40
1.70
2.00
0.475
0.525
0.625
0.70
0.925
0.05
0.275
0.30
0.10
0.15
0.45 0.70
0.50
0.15
0.20
0.025
0.10
0.075
2.00
4.00
6.00
1.50
2.15
2.75
4.00
1.05
1.50
1.90
2.75
1.25
1.50
1.65
2.25
0.50
0.25
2.75
0.75
0.15
D E A D
L O A D S
Collateral Loads
Table 3.4 Weights of Fixed Service Equipments
Material
False Ceilings
Suspended Acoustical Fiber Tile
Suspended Gypsum Board (Up to 12 mm thk.)
Suspended Gypsum Board (Up to 15 mm thk.)
0.05
0.10
0.15
Insulation
50 mm thk. Glass Fiber Blanket
100 mm thk. Glass Fiber Blanket
Cellular Plastic, per 25 mm thickness of Insulation
Lighting
HVAC Ducts, Office & Commercial
Sprinkler
Dry
Wet
HVAC Denotes Heating, Ventilation, Air Conditioning
For more details see MBMA-2006, IBC 2006
0.007
0.014
0.010
0.005 to 0.05
0.05
0.08
0.15
D E A D
L O A D S
Examples
Example :- 3.1
Given Data:Panel Type
Insulation
Purlin Spacing
Therefore,
UDL on purlins
Since the self weight of frames is calculated and applied by the analysis and
design software, the dead load on frames is taken as the same value of the
purlins = 0.083 kN/m2
D E A D
L O A D S
Example :- 3.2
Given Data:Panel Type
Exterior Skin
Interior Skin
Purlin spacing
Sprinkler System
Therefore,
UDL on purlins
Since the self weight of frames is calculated and applied by the analysis and
design software, the dead load on frames is taken as the same value of the
purlins = 0.272 kN/m2
L I V E
Chapter
L O A D S
Live Loads
ASCE 7-05
Section 4.1
efinition
L I V E
L O A D S
Occupancy OR Use
Office with computers
Assembly areas and theaters with fixed seats
Assembly areas and theaters other areas
Assembly areas and theaters stage floors
Balconies
Catwalks for maintenance floors
Dining Rooms and Restaurants
Elevator Machine Room grating
(On a area = 2580 mm2)
Finish light floor plate construction
(On a area = 645 mm2)
Fire Escapes
Garages (Light)
Garages (Heavy)
Gymnasiums
Hospitals
Libraries
Libraries (Stack Rooms)
Manufacturing (Light)
Manufacturing (Heavy)
Residential (Private)
Residential (Public)
Schools
Corridors
Skylights
Sidewalks, vehicular driveways
Skating rinks
Stadiums and arenas
Stairs and exits
Storage warehouses (Light)
Storage warehouses (Heavy)
Stores (Retails)
Stores (Wholesale)
Walkways & Elevated Platforms
Yards, terraces, pedestrians
Concentrated (kN)*
8.90
1.33
-
1.33
0.89
4.79
1.92
2.40
4.79
3.84
3.84
7.19
6.00
11.97
1.92
4.79
1.92
4.79
11.97
4.79
4.79
4.79
6.00
11.97
4.79
6.00
2.87
4.79
0.89
35.6
4.50
4.50
-
* - Concentrated loads may be assumed to be uniformly distributed on an area of 0.58 m2 unless noted otherwise.
L I V E
L O A D S
Industrial Application
Uniform (kN/m2)
24.0
48.0
9.60
7.19
14.4
12.0
7.19
9.60
24.0
28.8
9.60
9.60
14.4
14.4
14.4
7.19
9.60
9.60
14.4
48.0
9.60
4.79
3.60
3.60
2.40
1.20
11.97
4.79
L I V E
L O A D S
Element
ASCE 7-05
Section 4.9.1
Minimum
Roof Live
Loads
(kN/m2)
Remarks
0.96
At < or = 18.58 m2
0.58
At > or = 55.74 m2
Rafters.
0.58
2.87
4.79
Landscaped Roof
0.96
0.25
Non Accessible
Above values may be used up to and including 18 roof slope, for steeper slopes it may be reduced further.
For more details see IBC-2006, section 1607.11.2.1 or ASCE 7-05 Section 4.9
L I V E
L O A D S
This section does not apply to Roof uniform live loads, all other minimum
uniformly distributed live loads, Lo may be reduced as below,
Members for which the value KLL AT is 37.16 m2 or more are permitted to be
designed for a reduced live load in accordance with the following formula:
Notes:1. L should not be less than 0.5 Lo for members supporting one floor.
2. L should not be less than 0.4 Lo for members supporting two or more floors.
3. Live Loads more than 4.79 kN/m2 shall not be reduced. Except for members
supporting 2 or more floors, Live Load may be reduced by 20 %.
4. Live Load shall not be reduced for Passenger car garages. Except for members
supporting 2 or more floors, Live Load may be reduced by 20 %.
5. Live loads of 4.79 kN/m2 or less shall not be reduced in public assembly
occupancies.
ASCE 7-05
Section 4.9.1
Where,
L
= reduced design live load per m2 of area supported by the member.
Lo
= unreduced design live load per m2 of area supported by the member.
AT
= tributary area in m2
KLL
= Live load element factor as per table 4.4,
Table 4.4 Live Load Element Factor, KLL
Sr. No.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Element
Interior Columns
Exterior Columns with out Cantilever Slabs
Edge Columns with Cantilever Slabs
Corner Columns with Cantilever Slabs
Edge Beams without Cantilever Slabs
Interior Beams
All Other members not identified above including,
a) Edge beams with cantilever slabs
b) Cantilever beams
c) One-way slabs
d) Two-way slabs
e) Members without provisions for continuous shear transfer
normal to their span
KLL
4
4
3
2
2
2
L I V E
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 4.1
Given Data:Floor Live Load
Joist Spacing
Beam Spacing
Length of Beam
= 3.50 kN/m2
= 1.85 m
= 7.67 m
= 9.00 m
Should not be less than 0.50 Lo , Since the beam is supporting one floor.
1.75 kN/m2 Hence OK.
0.50 Lo =
L I V E
L O A D S
Example :- 4.2
Given Data:Floor Live Load
Joist Spacing
Beam Spacing
Length of Beam
= 5.00 kN/m2
= 1.85 m
= 7.67 m
= 9.00 m
= 5.00 x 0.80
= 4.00 kN/m2
L I V E
L O A D S
Lr
Lo R1 R2
R1
=
=
=
1.00
1.2 0.11 At
0.60
R2
=
=
=
1.00
1.2 0.05 F
0.60
for F <= 4 m2
for 4 < F < 12
for F >= 12
12 / x
Lr
At
x
x
=
=
=
=
ASCE 7-05
Section 4.9.1
Where,
* - The calculation of tributary area for live load is NOT similar to the
tributary area calculation for wind co-efficient.
Section C3.1 of MBMA 1986 and 1996 allows use of,
Roof Live Load = 0.58 kN/m2 for Category I Buildings
Category I buildings are buildings that represent low hazard to human life in
the event of failure, including but not limited to,
1. Agricultural Buildings
2. Temporary Facilities
3. Minor Storage Facilities
Section 1.3.3.1 MBMA 2006 states, Where uniform roof live loads are reduced
to less than 0.96 kN/m2, and are involved in design of structural members
arranged so as to create continuity, the minimum applied loads shall be the
full dead loads on all spans in combination with roof live loads on adjacent
spans or on alternate spans whichever produces the greatest effect.
L I V E
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 4.3
Given Data:Roof Live Load
Purlin Spacing
Rafter Spacing
Rafter Span
Roof Slope
= 0.96 kN/m2
= 1.50 m
= 7.90 m
=24.00 m
= 0.5:10
R1
= 12 / 0.50
= 24
R2
Lr
= Lo R1 R2
= 0.96 x 1.00 x 0.60
= 0.576
Reduced Roof Live Load (Lr) should not be less than 0.58 kN/m2
Hence, use live load = 0.58 kN/m2 for design of panels
From example 3.1
Dead Load on Panels
Live Load on Panels
Total Load on Panels
= 0.040 kN/m2
= 0.580 kN/m2
= 0.620 kN/m2
L I V E
L O A D S
Roof Purlins
Purlin Tributary area (At)
R1
= 12 / 0.50
= 24
R2
Lr
= Lo R1 R2
= 0.96 x 1.00 x 0.60
= 0.576
Reduced Roof Live Load (Lr) should not be less than 0.58 kN/m2
Hence, use live load
UDL due to live load
= 0.125 kN/m
= 0.870 kN/m
= 0.995 kN/m
Note:- Since the Uniform Live Load on Purlin is less than 0.96 kN/m2, pattern
loading on purlins should be applied.
(Example continued on next page)
10
L I V E
L O A D S
Frame Rafter
Rafter Tributary area (At)
R1
= 12 / 0.50
= 24
R2
Lr
= Lo R1 R2
= 0.96 x 0.60 x 0.60
= 0.346
Reduced Roof Live Load (Lr) should not be less than 0.58 kN/m2
Hence, use live load = 0.58 kN/m2 for design of rafters
UDL due to live load
= 7.90 x 0.58
= 4.582 kN/m
Referring to example 3.1 ,
Dead Load on Rafter
UDL due to dead load
Therefore,
UDL due to dead load
UDL due to live load
Total UDL
= 0.083 kN/m2
= 0.083 x 7.9
= 0.656
= 0.656 kN/m
= 4.582 kN/m
= 5.238 kN/m
11
L I V E
L O A D S
12
L I V E
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 4.4
Given Data:Floor Live Load
= 3.50 kN/m2
Since the Live Load is less than 3.83 kN/ m2, Partition loads should be included
in the Live Load.
Therefore Floor Live Load
= 3.50 + 0.73
= 4.23 kN/m2
Example :- 4.5
Given Data:Floor Live Load
= 5.00 kN/m2
Since the Live Load is more than 3.83 kN/m2, Partition loads need not be
included in the Live Load.
Therefore use the specified Floor Live Load
13
= 5.00 kN/ m2
L I V E
L O A D S
A single concentrated load of 0.89 kN applied in any direction, and all assemblies
shall be designed to resist a load of 0.73 kN/m applied in any direction. The two
loads 0.89 kN and 0.73 kN/m need not be assumed to act concurrently. And the
load of 0.73 kN/m need not be considered for followings occupancies,
a) One and two family dwellings.
b) Factory, industrial and storage occupancies not open to public and serve for
occupants less than 50 numbers.
Example
Example :- 4.6
14
L I V E
L O A D S
Grab bar systems (a bent pipe or a rod provided at specific locations to support
body weight in residential or industrial applications, see picture below) shall be
designed to resist a single concentrated load of 1.11 kN, applied in any direction
at any point.
These are often used in residential and industrial buildings for support or access
to low height walkways and platforms.
Example
Example :- 4.7
15
L I V E
L O A D S
The minimum design live load for fixed ladders with rungs shall be a single
concentrated load of 1.33 kN, and shall be applied at any point to produce
maximum load effect. This load should be applied for a minimum of 1 unit of
1.33 kN for every 3.048 m.
For handrail support of such ladders extending on a roof or a floor, a single
concentrated load of 0.445 kN shall be applied in any direction at any height.
Example
Example :- 4.8
16
L I V E
L O A D S
Impact Loads
ASCE 7-05
Section 4.7
17
Impact
100 %
100 %
20 %
50 %
33 %
L I V E
L O A D S
Description
Minimum imposed loads on roof with access
UDL in
( kN/m2 )
1.5
Concentrated
Loads ( kN )
1.8*
Minimum imposed loads on roof with no access, except for cleaning and maintenance
2
0.6
0.9*
0.6 [ ( 60 - a ) / 30 ] kN/m2
0
0
Note:- It is assumed that spreader boards are used during cleaning and maintenance operation
* - Denotes on a square area of 125 mm
Shopping Areas
F/G -
18
L I V E
L O A D S
UDL
( kN/m2 )
Concentrated
Loads ( kN )
1.5
1.4
1.5
1.8
2.0
1.8
1.5
1.4
Guest houses
3.0
1.5 / m*
4.0
1.5 / m*
Billard Rooms
A
Community Kitchens
Balconies
2.0
4.5
2.5
1.8
2.5
2.7
Banking halls
3.0
2.7
3.0
4.5
3.5
4.5
4.0
4.5
Projection rooms
5.0
Actual
5.0
4.5
Foundries
20.0
Actual
Catwalks
1 @ 1 m c/c
Balconies
4 min.
1.5 / m*
Fly galleries
4.5 kN/m
Ladders
19
1.5 at rung
L I V E
L O A D S
2.0
Class rooms
4.5
2.7
4.0
3.6
Places of worship
3.0
2.7
3.0
4.5
3.0
4.0
4.0
4.5
5.0
4.5
4.0
4.0
3.0
2.0
5.0
3.6
7.5
4.5
4.0
4.5
Balconies
4.0
1.5 / m*
4.5 kN/m
5.0
3.6
5.0
9.0
5.0
3.6
7.5
4.5
7.5
4.5
4.0
3.6
2.0
1.8
4.0
4.5
2.4 / m#
7.0
5.0
4.5
7.0
4.0 / m#
9.0
7.0
4.8 / m# min 15
7.0
Cold storage
5.0 / m# min 15
9.0
7.5
4.5
1.5 rung
2.5
3.0
Fly galleries
2.7
2.5
9.0
Actual
Actual
20
L I V E
L O A D S
Reduction in %
0
10
20
30
40
50 max.
Reduction in %
0
5
10
15
20
25 max.
21
L I V E
L O A D S
D) Partition Loads
1) For permanent partitions the loads should be included in the dead loads
2) For proposed partitions, the uniformly distributed partition load shall not be
less than 1/3 of the load per meter run of the finished partition
3) For floors of offices, the additional uniformly distributed partition load should
not be less than 1.0 kN/m2
E) Ceiling Supports
1) without access: -
no imposed loads
2) with access:-
22
L I V E
L O A D S
5) The horizontal force 'F' (kN) normal to and uniformly distributed over any
length of 1.5 m of a barrier for a car park is required to withstand the impact of a
vehicle is given by
F
= 0.5 mv2 / ( dc + db ) kN
where,
m = the gross mass of the vehicle in kgs.
may be taken as 1500 kgs for vehicles less than or equal to 2500 kgs.)
If mass is more than 2500 kgs, than use the actual weight.
v = the velocity of the vehicle in ( m/sec ) normal to the barrier
( = 4.5 m/sec )
dc = is the deformation of the vehicle in (mm)
( = 100 mm unless better evidence is available)
db = is the deformation of the barrier in (mm)
( = 0 for a rigid barrier )
a) The force is assumed to act at bumper height or 375 mm above floor level for
cars less than 2500 kgs.
b) Barriers for access ramps of car parks shall be designed for half the force (F) at
a height of 610 mm.
c) If the travel distance for downward travel is more than 20 m, barriers shall be
designed for (2F) at a height of 610 mm.
23
L I V E
L O A D S
Table 4.10 Minimum Horizontal Imposed Loads for Parapets, Barriers and balustrades etc.
Occupancy
Type
B and E
Horizontal
UD Line Load
(kN/m)
UDL
(kN/m2)
Concentrated
Load in (kN)
0.36
0.50
0.25
0.74
1.00
0.50
0.22
N/A
N/A
0.36
0.50
0.25
0.74
1.00
0.50
1.50
1.50
1.50
1.50
1.50
1.50
0.74
1.00
0.50
0.74
1.00
0.50
1.50
1.50
1.50
3.00
1.50
1.50
F/G
1.50
1.50
1.50
1.50
1.50
1.50
24
W I N D
Chapter
L O A D S
MBMA 96
Section 5.0
Wind Loads
MBMA 1996
General:- The procedures are prescribed for assessing wind loads to be used in
the design of buildings and structural components and cladding thereof. The
procedures are limited to buildings with flat, single sloped roofs up to 30, and
gable shaped roofs whose mean roof heights do not exceed 18.29 meters and
which have eave heights less than or equal to their least horizontal dimension.
The procedures are intended for completed buildings and may not be
appropriate for structures during erection. (For other structures latest ASCE 7-05
should be referred)
where,
q = the velocity pressure in kN/m2
V = Fastest wind speed in km/hr
H =mean height (m) of roof above ground or 4.57 m, whichever is less.
Eave height may be used in lieu of mean height if the roof slope is less than or
equal to 10. For single sloped roofs, the lower eave height may be used if the
roof slope is less than or equal to 10
A single values of q is used for the entire building
W I N D
L O A D S
P
where,
Iw
q
GC p
I w q (GC p )
Openings: Those areas in the building envelope (wall, roof surfaces) which do
not have a permanently attached means for effective closure. (Such as Doors,
Windows etc.)
Enclosed Building: A structure that encloses a space and does not have openings
that qualify under the definitions of a partially enclosed or open building.
Windows, doors and other buildings accessories, designed to resist the wind
pressures need not be considered as openings.
Partially Enclosed Building: A building in which the total area of openings in a
wall that receives positive external pressure exceeds the sum of the areas of
openings for the balance of the building envelope (walls and roof) and exceeds
5% of the area of that wall; and the density of the openings in the balance of the
building envelope does not exceed 20% as expressed by the following equations:
(In order for a building to qualify as a Partially Enclosed Building all the 3
conditions below should be satisfied, if not the building is either classified as an
Enclosed or Open Building )
Eqn. 5.2
1) A o
2) A o
3) A oi / A gi
> 0.05 A g
> A oi
<= 0.20
Where,
A o = total area (m2) of opening in a wall that receives positive external pressure.
A g = the gross area (m2) of that wall in which A o is identified.
A oi =the sum of areas (m2) of openings in the building envelope, not including
Ao.
A gi = the sum of the gross surface areas of the building envelope (walls and
roofs) not including A g (m2).
Open Building: Structures having all walls at least 80% open. This condition is
expressed for each wall by the equation,
Ao
>= 0.8 A g
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 5.1
Given Data:Building Width
Building Length
Building Height
Open for access
Roof Slope
Peak Height
= 45000 mm
= 10500 mm
= 7550 mm
= 3200 mm (All walls)
= 0.5:10 ( = 2.862 )
= 8675 mm
= 79.28 m2
= 33.60 m2
= 42.38%
W I N D
L O A D S
= 79.28 m2
The sum of all openings in the building envelope A oi not including the near
sidewall opening A o ,
= 33.60 + (2 x 144.00)
= 321.60 m2
The sum of the gross surface areas of the building envelope A gi (Far Sidewall,
Left & Right Endwall and Roof) not including A g calculated above (m2).
= 79.28 + (2 x 365.06) + 2 x [45 x 10.5/(2 x Cos )]
= 1282.49 m2
Checks,
> 0.05 A g
1. A o
33.60 > 0.05 x 79.28 = 3.964 True
2. A o
> A oi
33.60 > 321.60
False
3. A oi / A gi <= 0.20
321.60 / 1282.49 = 0.25 < 0.20 False
Since Equation 2 & 3 are not satisfied, the building cannot be classified as
Partially Enclosed Building
Hence the building is classified as an Enclosed Building
REW
FSW
HEIGHT
SLOPE
TH
NG
LE
LEW
NSW
WIDTH
NSW-NEAR SIDEWALL
FSW-FAR SIDEWALL
LEW-LEFT ENDWALL
REW-RIGHT ENDWALL
3D VIEW SHOWING ALL WALLS
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 5.2
Given Data:Building Width
Building Length
Building Height
= 28000 mm
= 79500 mm
= 8450 mm
= 2800 mm
= 3380 mm
Therefore End Zone Z = 2800 mm, but this should not be less than any of the
following,
= 0.04 x 28000
= 1120 mm
= 914
= 914 mm
Hence use Z = 2800 mm from Eave and Gable
W I N D
L O A D S
OR
(L / 3)
Notes:
1. Effective Wind Load Area is to be used for determination of pressure
coefficient only and NOT for design loads.
2. For Cladding and other Panel type members, without definitive width; use
W=L/3
3. For Fasteners, the effective Wind Load Area is the area of the building
surface contributing to the force being considered.
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 5.3
Given Data:Frame Type
= Clear Span
Building Width
= 28000 mm
Bay Spacing
= 7950 mm
Eave Height
= 8450 mm
Roof Slope
= 1:10 ( = 5.71)
Purlin Spacing
= 1650 mm
Spacing of Fasteners = 250 mm
Fastest Wind Speed = 160 km/hr
Building Use Category = II
(Importance Factor I w = 1.00)
Calculate Velocity Pressure (q)
q
= 2.45 x 10-5 V2 H2/7
= 2.45 x 10-5 x 1602 x 8.452/7
(Since the roof slope is less than 10, eave height is used instead of mean height)
q
= 1.15 kN/m2
= I w q (GC p )
= 1.00 x 1.15 x (GC p )
= 1.15 x (GC p )
W I N D
L O A D S
= 13.12 m2
= 21.07 m2
= -1.32 kN/m2
= -1.61 kN/m2
= 0.10 kN/m2
Then,
Total Wind load on purlins is given as,
= Spacing x ( DL + WL)
= 1.65 x [0.10 + (-1.32)]
= 1.65 x [0.10 + (-1.61)]
= -2.01 kN/m
= -2.49 kN/m
W I N D
L O A D S
= 1.65 m2
= 17.7 ft2
Referring to Table 5.5 (b), the wind coefficients are given as below,
Corners
Edge
Interior
The wind load
Corners
Edge
Interior
= -2.90 kN/m2
= -1.96 kN/m2
= -1.45 kN/m2
Corners
Edge
Interior
= DL + WL
= 0.04 + (-2.90)
= 0.04 + (-1.95)
= 0.04 + (-1.45)
= -2.86 kN/m2
= -1.91 kN/m2
= -1.41 kN/m2
W I N D
L O A D S
=
=
=
= -2.90
= -1.70
= -1.30
= 1.15 x -2.90
= 1.15 x -1.70
= 1.15 x -1.30
= -3.34 kN/m2
= -1.96 kN/m2
= -1.50 kN/m2
= -1.35 kN
= -0.78 kN
= -0.60 kN
1.2
1.5
0.83
1.04
0.5
0.7
2.12
2.96
Carbon Steel
4.8
5.5
1.94
4.52
1.8
2.0
1.25
1.39
1.0
4.23
Stainless Steel
4.8
5.5
1.88
3.70
1.64
1.64
3.05
2.52
2.5
1.74
-
The values for Pull-Out and Pull-Over needs to be checked, the value for 1.5 and
1.8 mm thk. Purlin is less than required in the corners; hence the spacing of
screws in the corners may be reduced if the purlins are 1.5 or 1.8 mm thk.
Pull over value is generally more than required because of the 19mm washer
bearing on panel.
10
W I N D
L O A D S
11
W I N D
L O A D S
12
W I N D
L O A D S
13
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 5.4
Using the same Data as in Example 5.3,
Calculating the wind coefficient and loads in the transverse direction
[Refer Table 5.7(a)]
Design Wind Load in kN/m on Column 1 in End Zone (1E), GCp = 0.50
= Wind Pressure x Coefficient x Tributary Width (Bay Spacing/2)
= 1.15 x 0.50 x 7.95 / 2
= 2.29 kN/m
Design Wind Load in kN/m on Rafter 1 in End Zone (2E), GCp = -1.40
= 1.15 x -1.40 x 7.95 / 2
= -6.40 kN/m
= -3.65 kN/m
Design Wind Load in kN/m on Column 2 in End Zone (4E), GCp = -0.70
= 1.15 x -0.70 x 7.95 / 2
= -3.20 kN/m
= -9.14 kN/m
Design Wind Load in kN/m on Rafter 2 in Interior Zone (3),, GCp = -0.65
= 1.15 x -0.65 x 7.95
= -5.94 kN/m
= -5.03 kN/m
14
W I N D
L O A D S
Gcp = -1.40
RAFTER-1
GCp =+0.50
Gcp = -0.80
RAFTER-2
COLUMN-1
COLUMN-2
Gcp = -0.70
Gcp = -1.00
RAFTER-1
Gcp = +0.25
Gcp = -0.65
RAFTER-2
COLUMN-1
COLUMN-2
Gcp = -0.55
-6.40
RAFTER-1
+2.29
-3.66
RAFTER-2
COLUMN-1
COLUMN-2
-3.20
-9.14
RAFTER-1
+2.29
-5.94
RAFTER-2
COLUMN-1
COLUMN-2
15
-5.03
W I N D
L O A D S
= 2800 mm
Since the building is symmetrical about the ridge, area (5E, 6E) is given as,
Eave Height
= 8450
= 8450 mm
Height at distance Z = 8450 + 2800/10
= 8730 mm
Area 5E, 6E
= (Sum of Parallel sides)/2 x Z
= (8450 + 8730)/2 x 2800 / 10002
= 24.05 m2
Total Area of Endwall = [(Width x Eave Ht) + (Width2 x Tan / 4)]
= [(28000 x 8450) + (280002 x tan 5.710 / 4)] / 10002
= 256.19 m2
Hence, Area 5, 6
-0.30
-0.15
6E
-0.30
6
6E
5E
0.90
z
0.65
0.90
5E
Taking into consideration only half the end wall for one sidewall bracing.
Design Wind Load in kN on area 5E in End Zone, GC p = 0.90
= Wind Pressure x (Area 5E)
= 1.15 x 0.90 x 24.05
16
= 24.89 kN
W I N D
L O A D S
= 77.78 kN
Similarly,
Design Wind Load in kN on area 6E in End Zone, GC p = -0.30
= Wind Pressure x (Area 6E)
= 1.15 x (-0.30) x 24.05
= -8.29 kN
= -17.94 kN
= 128.90 kN
(Note that in case of unsymmetrical building the load should divided as per the
ridge location and bracing pattern, also note, minus sign only denotes the
direction of force away from the surface and should not be used for calculation,
summation is done on the direction of forces)
Assuming half of the total load on half end wall portion is transferred to the base
of the end wall columns.
= 128.90 / 2
= 64.45 kN
Hence, the total load along the eave of one sidewall
= 64.45 kN
This force should be divided by the number of braced bays in the building,
assuming 3 braced bays, the force per bay
= 64.45 / 3
= 21.48 kN
FORCE FROM
AREA 5 & 5E
FORCE FROM
AREA 6 & 6E
SIDEWALL ELEVATION
17
W I N D
L O A D S
Alternatively, the coefficients in the end and interior zone may be averaged as
below,
Average of coefficients of (5 & 5E)
Average of coefficients of (6 & 6E)
Sum of average coefficients
= (0.65 + 0.90) / 2
= (0.15 + 0.30) / 2
= 0.775 + 0.225
= 0.775
= 0.225
= 1.00
= 147.31 kN
Assuming half of the above load transferred to the end wall column base, and
dividing by the number of braced bays
= 147.31 / (2 x 3)
= 24.55 kN
The eave strut, bracing members and connections should be designed for this
force.
P1
P2
P3
P1
P2
P3
The roof bracing should be designed for the amount of force, that is transferred
at location where it is broken, (See sketch above) so the first bracing from ridge
will be designed for load P1 and second bracing for P2 and sidewall bracing and
eave strut member for P3.
Detailed bracing section and connection is not within the scope of this chapter.
18
W I N D
L O A D S
Assuming, the end wall column spacing as 4 @ 7000 mm, the load distribution to
P1, P2, & P3 is as below,
Tributary area for P1 = Endwall Spacing / 2 x average height
= (7000/2) x 9675 / 10002
= 33.86 m2
Therefore, the load
= 1.15 x 1.00 x 33.86
= 38.94 kN
Assuming half the load transferred to the base of end wall column,
The Load P1
= 38.94 / 2
= 19.47 kN
Similarly,
Tributary area for P2 = End wall Spacing x average height
= 64.05 m2
= 7000 x 9150 / 10002
Therefore, the load
= 1.15 x 1.00 x 64.05
= 73.66 kN
Assuming half the load transferred to the base of end wall column,
The Load P1
= 73.66 / 2
= 36.83 kN
Tributary area for P3 = End wall Spacing / 2 x eave height
= 30.19 m2
= (7000/2) x 8625 / 10002
Therefore, the load
= 1.15 x 1.00 x 30.19
= 34.71 kN
Assuming half the load transferred to the base of end wall column,
The Load P1
= 34.71 / 2
= 17.35 kN
Total force at eave
= P1 + P2 + P3
= 19.47 + 36.83 + 17.35
19
= 73.65 kN
= 24.55 kN
W I N D
L O A D S
MBMA 2002
ASCE 7-98
Section 6.2
efinitions
OR
V 3s = 1.05 V fm + 16.9
Where,
-
V fm
V 3s
V 3s
100
110
120
130
140
150
160
170
180
190
200
210
220
230
240
250
V fm
79
89
98
108
117
127
136
146
155
165
174
184
193
203
212
222
20
W I N D
L O A D S
E
WIND VOLUME
LENGTH =1 MILE
LENGTH =1 MILE
10 M
WIND VOLUME
EXPOSURE 'C'
Time
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
50
Average
Speed
75
78
80
83
84
83
86
90
86
90
83.5
40
45
50
T im e v /s W in d S p e e d
95
90
85
80
75
70
65
5
10
15
20
25
30
T im e in S e c o n d s
21
35
W I N D
L O A D S
So the time required for this volume of wind 1 mile long to move across the
anemometer is calculated as,
We know, Speed
Therefore, Time
= Distance / Time
= Distance / Speed
= 1 mile / 83.5 mph
= 0.01197 hour
= 0.01197 x 60 x 60
= 43.11 sec.
So the time required to measure the Fastest Mile wind speed is 43.11 sec and it
may vary with the wind speed.
Hence we say that the Fastest Mile Wind Speed = 83.5 mph = 52.19 kmph
What is 3 Second Gust wind speed?
A 3 Second gust wind speed is defined as the maximum average speed of the
wind averaged over 3 seconds passing through a wind speed measuring
instrument at a certain height, above the terrain roughness over a specified
period of time.
The height is usually 10 meters, the terrain is Exposure C and specified period
of time is 50 years
The transition was made from fastest mile wind speed to 3-Second gust for the
following reasons.
1. Fastest mile oriented anemometers have been replaced with modern
equipment with graphic strip chart readouts.
2. The peak gust is the easiest and most reliable wind speed to read from the
newer graphs.
3. 3-Second gust speeds are closer to the speeds quoted in news media.
4. Structural members are designed by gust speeds. If another type wind speed
is used, large corrections must be made by use of the gust effect factor.
22
W I N D
L O A D S
= 79.28 m2
Considering near sidewall, the total area (m2) of opening in a wall that receives
= 33.60 m2
positive external pressure A o is,
The sum of all openings in the building envelope A oi not including the near
sidewall opening A o ,
= 33.60 + (2 x 144.00)
= 321.60 m2
23
W I N D
L O A D S
The sum of the gross surface areas of the building envelope A gi (walls and roofs)
not including A g (m2).
= 79.28 + (2 x 365.06) + 2 x [45 x 10.5/(2 x Cos )]
= 1282.49 m2
Checks,
> 1.10 A oi
1. A o
33.60 > 1.10 x 321.60 = 353.76
> 0.37 m2 OR 0.01 A g
2. A o
33.60 > 0.37 m2 OR 0.01 x 79.28 = 0.7928
3. A oi / A gi <= 0.20
321.60 / 1282.49 = 0.25 < 0.20
False
True
False
Since Equation 1 & 2 are not satisfied, the building cannot be classified as
Partially Enclosed Building
Hence the building is classified as an Enclosed Building
Comparing the equation in MBMA 1996 and MBMA 2002 as below
MBMA 1996
1)
2)
3)
MBMA 2002
1)
2)
3)
Ao
Ao
A oi / A gi
> 0.05 A g
> A oi
<= 0.20
Ao
Ao
A oi / A gi
> 1.10 A oi
> 0.37 m2 or > 0.01 A g , whichever is smaller.
<= 0.20
24
W I N D
L O A D S
Enclosed Building:
A building that does not comply with the requirements for Open or Partially
enclosed buildings are classified as Enclosed Building.
Eave Height (h):
The distance from the ground surface adjacent to the building to the roof eave
line at a particular wall. If the height of the eave varies along the wall, the
average height shall be used.
Mean Roof Height (h):
The average of the eave height and the highest point on the roof surface, except
that for roof angles of less than or equal to 10, the mean roof height shall be the
roof eave height. For Single slope buildings the lower eave height may be used
for roof slopes less than or equal to 10., and mean roof height for roof slopes
more than 10.
Escarpment:
Also known as Scarp, with respect to topographic effects is a cliff or steep slope
generally separating two levels or gently sloping areas.
Minimum Wind Load:
(MWFRS - Main Wind Force Resisting System) - The design wind pressure (p)
on any main wind resisting structure on an enclosed or partially enclosed
building should not be less than 0.48 kN/m2 multiplied by the area of the
building or structure projected on to a vertical plane normal to the assumed
wind direction.
Note: - This minimum load is the sum of wind load on the windward and
leeward wall of a main frame or a building (See following sketch)
25
W I N D
L O A D S
26
W I N D
L O A D S
Description
Large city centers with at least 50% of the buildings having a
height in excess of 21.3 meters.
Urban and suburban areas, wooded areas, or other terrain
with numerous closely spaced obstructions having the size of
single-family dwellings or larger.
Open terrain with scattered obstructions.
Flat, unobstructed areas exposed to wind flowing over open
water (excluding shorelines in hurricane prone regions for a
distance of at least 1 mile)
MBMA 2002 states "Note that IBC 2000 specifies that Exposure B shall be
assumed unless the site meets the definition of another exposure."
Unless specified in PIF Exposure B should be considered, but if we know
for sure by location of building, appropriate Exposure Category should be
considered and the same should be conveyed to all concerned for the project.
27
W I N D
L O A D S
L
W
= Span
= Spacing of element (A+B)/2.
= [greater of (W or L / 3)] x L
Note: - This area should be used ONLY for determination of GC p and NOT
for design loads.
28
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 5.5
Given Data:Frame Type
Building Width
Bay Spacing
Purlin Spacing
Spacing of Fasteners
= Clear Span
= 28000 mm
= 7950 mm
= 1650 mm
= 250 mm
= 13.12 m2
= 21.07 m2
= 21.07 m2
= 1.65 m2
3. And, Effective wind load area for Fasteners (Screws) is the actual tributary
area,
= Purlin Spacing x Spacing of fasteners
= 0.41 m2
= 1650 x 250 / 10002
Further load calculation is similar to as shown in Example 5.3
29
W I N D
L O A D S
= 28000 mm
= 79500 mm
= 8450 mm
= 2800 mm
= 3380 mm
Therefore End Zone a = 2800 mm, but this should not be less than any of the
following,
= 0.04 x 28000
= 1120 mm
= 915
= 915 mm
Hence use a = 2800 mm from Eave and Gable (See sketch below for location of
dimension a on roof plan, side walls and end walls. The roof panels, purlins,
wall panels, girts and sheeting screws, trims etc. at these locations should be
designed for coefficients given for Edge and corners, other areas are designed for
interior zone coefficients)
Note: - The sketch below applies only for slopes less than 10 for other slopes
see MBMA 2002.
30
W I N D
L O A D S
5
5
1-31
2
1
3
1
2
2
2
1-32
31
W I N D
MBMA 02
Section 1.4.1
L O A D S
Velocity Pressure
Data Required
1) Basic Wind Speed (V) (3 Second gust) in (m/sec)
(km/hr = mph x 1.61 = 3.6 x m/sec)
2) Select Importance Factor (I w )
(Default 1.00 for Standard Buildings, unless specified)
3) Select Exposure Category (A,B,C or D)
(Default B unless specified, see MBMA 2002)
4) Compute the Velocity Pressure (q h ) based on the mean height or eave height
if <= 10
Eqn. 7.2.1-2
Eqn. 7.2.1-3
Velocity Pressure
q z = q h = 0.613 x 10-3 K z K zt K d V2 I w
Where,
= 2.01 (h/365.76) 2/7 for Exposure B and with h >= 9.14 m
Kz
Use h = 9.14, if eave or mean height is less than 9.14 m
= 2.01 (h/274.32) 2/9.5 for Exposure C and with h >= 4.57 m
Kz
Use h = 4.57, if eave or mean height is less than 4.57 m
K zt
= 1.00
Topographic factor
Kd
= 0.85
Directionality factor
Iw
= 1.00
Importance factor
= Height
32
kN/m2
W I N D
L O A D S
130
140
150
160
0-9
10
12
14
16
18
0.47
0.49
0.51
0.54
0.56
0.58
0.55
0.57
0.60
0.62
0.65
0.67
0.63
0.65
0.68
0.72
0.74
0.77
0.72
0.74
0.78
0.81
0.85
0.88
4.57
6
7.62
9
10
12
14
16
18
0.58
0.61
0.64
0.67
0.68
0.71
0.73
0.75
0.77
0.67
0.71
0.74
0.77
0.79
0.82
0.85
0.87
0.89
0.77
0.81
0.86
0.89
0.91
0.94
0.97
1.00
1.02
0.87
0.93
0.97
1.01
1.03
1.07
1.11
1.14
1.17
170
180
Exposure B
0.81
0.91
0.84
0.94
0.88
0.99
0.92
1.03
0.96
1.07
0.99
1.11
Exposure C
0.99
1.11
1.04
1.17
1.10
1.23
1.14
1.28
1.16
1.30
1.21
1.35
1.25
1.40
1.28
1.44
1.32
1.48
33
190
200
210
220
230
1.01
1.04
1.10
1.15
1.19
1.23
1.12
1.16
1.22
1.27
1.32
1.37
1.24
1.27
1.34
1.40
1.46
1.51
1.36
1.40
1.47
1.54
1.60
1.65
1.48
1.53
1.61
1.68
1.75
1.81
1.23
1.30
1.37
1.42
1.45
1.51
1.56
1.60
1.64
1.37
1.45
1.52
1.57
1.61
1.67
1.73
1.78
1.82
1.50
1.59
1.68
1.74
1.77
1.84
1.90
1.96
2.01
1.65
1.75
1.84
1.90
1.95
2.02
2.09
2.15
2.20
1.81
1.91
2.01
2.08
2.13
2.21
2.29
2.35
2.41
W I N D
L O A D S
q h [(GC pf ) - (GC pi )]
kN/m2
q G C p q i (GC pi )
kN/m2
where,
q h = velocity pressure evaluated at mean roof height (h) for a given exposure.
GC pf = external pressure coefficients from Figure 6-4 ASCE 7-98
GC pi = internal pressure coefficients from Table. 6-7 ASCE 7-98
q = q z for windward walls evaluated at height z above the ground for a given
exposure.
q = q h for leeward walls, side walls, and roofs evaluated at height (h).
q i = q h for windward walls, side walls, leeward walls, and roofs of enclosed
buildings and for negative internal pressure evaluation in partially enclosed
buildings.
q i = q z for positive internal pressure evaluation in partially enclosed buildings
where height (z) is defined as the level of the highest opening in the building that
could effect the positive internal pressure. For positive internal pressure
evaluation, (q i ) may conservatively be evaluated at height (h) (q i = q h )
G = Gust effect factor (G = 0.85 for rigid structures) Sect. 6.5.8 ASCE 7-98
C p = external pressure coefficients from Fig. 6-3 or Table 6-8 ASCE 7-98.
The external co-efficient and internal coefficients are combined and tabulated in
MBMA 2002 [Table 1.4.5(a) and 1.45(b)] for use in Equation 1.4.2 above (Low Rise
Buildings, for other buildings refer ASCE 7-98). Coefficients depend on the
location relative to the geometric discontinuities in the surfaces of the building.
The building surfaces are zoned and the pressure coefficients are assumed to be
constant within each zone. When a member lies within two or more zones, the
design loads for that member can be determined using several approaches (step
functions, weighted averages, or another rational approach). For lateral loads on
framed buildings in which the end bays are not less than the width (2a) of the
end zone, common industry practice is to apply the entire extra load in the end
bay to the end bay purlins and end frames.
34
W I N D
L O A D S
Roof Angle
0 5
= 5.71
2:12
Enclosed
3:12
= 20
30 45
= 90
0 5
= 5.71
2:12
Partially
Enclosed
3:12
= 20
30 45
= 90
0 10
Open
10 < 25
25 < 45
Notes:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
End Zone
Load Case
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
A(+i)
A(-i)
Abal
Aunbal
Abal
Aunbal
Aunbal
Abal
Aunbal
1E
0.43
0.79
0.44
0.80
0.49
0.85
0.54
0.90
0.62
0.98
0.51
0.87
0.51
0.87
0.06
1.16
0.07
1.17
0.12
1.22
0.17
1.27
0.25
1.35
0.14
1.24
0.14
1.24
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
2E
-1.25
-0.89
-1.25
-0.89
-1.25
-0.89
-1.25
-0.89
-1.25
-0.89
0.09
0.45
0.51
0.87
-1.62
-0.52
-1.62
-0.52
-1.62
-0.52
-1.62
-0.52
-1.62
-0.52
-0.28
0.82
0.14
1.24
-0.50
-0.20
-0.50
0.50
0.15
-0.50
1.40
3E
-0.71
-0.35
-0.72
-0.36
-0.76
-0.40
-0.81
-0.45
-0.87
-0.51
-0.71
-0.35
-0.66
-0.30
-1.08
0.02
-1.09
0.01
-1.13
-0.03
-1.20
-0.10
-1.24
-0.14
-1.08
0.02
-1.03
0.07
-0.50
-0.60
-0.50
-0.50
-0.65
-0.50
0.20
Interior Zone
4E
-0.61
-0.25
-0.62
-0.26
-0.67
-0.31
-0.74
-0.38
-0.82
-0.46
-0.66
-0.30
-0.66
-0.30
-0.98
0.12
-0.99
0.11
-1.04
0.06
-1.11
-0.01
-1.19
-0.09
-1.03
0.07
-1.03
0.07
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
1
0.22
0.58
0.23
0.59
0.26
0.62
0.30
0.66
0.35
0.71
0.38
0.74
0.38
0.74
-0.15
0.95
-0.14
0.96
-0.11
0.99
0.07
1.03
-0.02
1.08
0.01
1.11
0.01
1.11
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
2
-0.87
-0.51
-0.87
-0.51
-0.87
-0.51
-0.87
-0.51
-0.87
-0.51
0.03
0.39
0.38
0.74
-1.24
-0.14
-1.24
-0.14
-1.24
-0.14
-1.24
-0.14
-1.24
-0.14
-0.34
0.76
0.01
1.11
-0.50
-0.20
-0.50
0.50
0.15
-0.50
1.40
3
-0.55
-0.19
-0.55
-0.19
-0.58
-0.22
-0.62
-0.26
-0.66
-0.30
-0.61
-0.25
-0.55
-0.19
-0.92
0.18
-0.92
0.18
-0.95
0.15
-0.99
0.11
-1.03
0.07
-0.98
0.12
-0.92
0.18
-0.50
-0.60
-0.50
-0.50
-0.65
-0.50
0.20
4
-0.47
-0.11
-0.48
-0.12
-0.51
-0.15
-0.55
-0.19
-0.61
-0.25
-0.55
-0.19
-0.55
-0.19
-0.84
0.26
-0.85
0.25
-0.88
0.22
-0.92
0.18
-0.98
0.12
-0.92
0.18
-0.92
0.18
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
End
walls
5&6
-0.63
-0.27
-0.63
-0.27
-0.63
-0.27
-0.63
-0.27
-0.63
-0.27
-0.63
-0.27
-0.63
-0.27
-1.00
0.10
-1.00
0.10
-1.00
0.10
-1.00
0.10
-1.00
0.10
-1.00
0.10
-1.00
0.10
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
Load case subscripts refer to negative internal pressure (-i) and positive internal pressure (+i).
Plus and minus signs signify pressures acting toward and away from the surfaces, respectively.
For values of other than those shown, linear interpolation is permitted. Note that this interpolation must be done on the external
pressure coefficient and then combined with the appropriate internal pressure coefficient. This has been done for standard slopes
of 2:12 and 3:12.
When the roof pressure coefficient in zone 2 is negative, it shall be applied in zone 2 for a distance from the edge of the roof equal
to 0.5 times the horizontal dimension of the remainder of zone 2 extending to the ridge line shall use the pressure coefficient from
zone 3.
* - Denotes coefficient for sheeted portion of the wall only. [See figure 1.4.5 (e)]
35
W I N D
L O A D S
6
4
4E
3
3E
2E
1E
B
5
2a
Figure 1.4.5(a)
Load Case A-MWFRS Coefficients in Transverse Direction (Gable Roof)
4
6
3
4E
3E
2E
h
B/2
1E
B
B/2
2a
Figure 1.4.5(b)
Load Case A-MWFRS Coefficients in Transverse Direction (Single Slope)
36
W I N D
L O A D S
Interior Zone
Sidewalls
Building
Type
Load
Case
1E
2E
3E
4E
5&6
Enclosed
B(+i)
0.43
-1.25
-0.71
-0.61
0.22
-0.87
-0.55
-0.47
-0.63
B(-i)
0.79
-0.89
-0.35
-0.25
0.58
-0.51
-0.19
-0.11
-0.27
Partially
Open
B(+i)
0.06
-1.62
-1.08
-0.98
-0.15
-1.24
-0.92
-0.84
-1.00
B(-i)
1.16
-0.52
0.02
0.02
0.95
-0.14
0.18
0.26
0.10
Open
4
6
3
6
2
3E
4E
3
2
5
2E
L/2
5
1E
L/2
B
a
6
6
3
4E
3E
5
1
2E
L/2
B/2
1E
L/2
B
a
37
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 5.7
Given Data:Frame Type
= Clear Span
Building Width
= 35000 mm
Bay Spacing
= 9 @ 8550 mm
Length
= 76950 mm
Eave Height
= 7500 mm
Roof Slope
= 1:10 ( = 5.71)
Wind Speed
= 150 kmph (3 Second Gust) = 41.67 m/sec
Importance Factor
= 1.00
Exposure Category
=B
All walls are fully sheeted.
Solution:1. Check if the building classifies under Low Rise Building,
The 2 conditions are,
a) Mean Roof Height h less than or equal to 18.28 m
b) Mean Roof Height h does not exceed least horizontal dimension
(Minimum of Width or Length)
h
= 7500 mm
Hence the building can be classified as a Low Rise Building
2. Check if the building is classifies as Enclosed, Partially Enclosed or
Open Building based on the given information about openings. Since all
walls are fully sheeted, the building is classified as an Enclosed Building.
3. Since the roof slope is less than 10, eave height may be used in lieu of mean
roof height. Therefore, h = 7500 mm for all further calculations.
4. Find the end zone dimensions for walls and roofs, the end zone dimension a
is given as the least of
10 % (0.10 B or L) of least horizontal dimension
= 0.10 x 35000
= 3500 mm
0.4 h (Mean roof or eave height)
= 0.40 x 7500
= 3000 mm
But not less than either
4 % (0.04 B or L) of least horizontal dimension OR 915 mm
= 0.04 x 35000
= 1400 mm
Hence the End Zone dimension a
= 3000 mm
38
W I N D
L O A D S
= 0.613 x 10-3 K z K zt K d V2 I w
kN/m2
Kz
= 2.01 (h/365.76) 2/7
Since the eave height is less than 9.14 m (30 ft) use h
= 2.01 (9.14/365.76) 2/7
= 9.14 m
= 0.70
K zt
Kd
=
=
= 1.00
= 0.85
qh
Therefore,
Alternatively, the same value can be directly referred from table 5.2, see under
column Exposure B, value corresponding to column 150 basic wind speed and
eave height row, 0-9 meters, = 0.63 kN/m2
6. Calculate the Design Wind Pressure (p) for MWFRS
= q h [(GC pf ) - (GC pi )] kN/m2
Note that [(GC pf ) - (GC pi )] may either be calculated individual or may be referred
from Table 1.4.5 (a) of MBMA 2002 for low rise buildings only. Referring to Table
1.4.5 (a) for = 5.71 for enclosed building.
There are 2 case A(+i) and A(-i) for positive and negative internal pressures
respectively.
Building Type
Enclosed
Roof Angle
Load Case
= 5.71
A(+i)
A(-i)
End Zone
1E
0.44
0.80
2E
-1.25
-0.89
3E
-0.72
-0.36
Interior Zone
4E
-0.62
-0.26
1
0.23
0.59
2
-0.87
-0.51
3
-0.55
-0.19
4
-0.48
-0.12
End
walls
5&6
-0.63
-0.27
The above values are represented below in sketch for better understanding.
39
W I N D
L O A D S
6 = -0.63
4 = -0.48
4E = -0.62
3 = -0.55
3E = -0.72
2 = -0.87
2E = -1.25
1 = 0.23
1E = 0.44
B
WI
ND
5 = -0.63
2a
DI
RE
CT
IO
N
6 = -0.27
4 = -0.12
4E = -0.26
3 = -0.19
3E = -0.36
2 = -0.51
2E = -0.89
1 = 0.59
1E = 0.80
B
WI
ND
5 = -0.27
a
DI
2a
40
RE
CT
IO
N
W I N D
L O A D S
Therefore, the applicable Design Wind Pressure on various zones are calculated
as below,
Note that the sign is only for direction indication, +ve sign denotes towards
surface and ve sign denotes away from surface.
Case -1 A(+i)
End zones
1E
2E
3E
4E
= 0.63 x +0.44
= 0.63 x -1.25
= 0.63 x -0.72
= 0.63 x -0.62
= +0.277
= -0.787
= -0.454
= -0.397
Interior zones
1
2
3
4
= 0.63 x +0.23
= 0.63 x -0.87
= 0.63 x -0.55
= 0.63 x -0.48
= +0.145
= -0.550
= -0.347
= -0.303
= 0.63 x -0.63
= -0.397
End zones
1E
2E
3E
4E
= 0.63 x +0.80
= 0.63 x -0.89
= 0.63 x -0.36
= 0.63 x -0.26
= +0.504
= -0.561
= -0.227
= -0.164
Interior zones
1
2
3
4
= 0.63 x +0.59
= 0.63 x -0.51
= 0.63 x -0.19
= 0.63 x -0.12
= +0.372
= -0.321
= -0.120
= -0.076
= 0.63 x -0.27
= -0.170
5&6
Case -2 A(-i)
5&6
41
W I N D
L O A D S
Hence the Design wind loads kN/m on the main framing members may be
calculated by multiplying the Design Wind Pressure and Tributary width of the
member as below,
End Zone Pressure will apply to end frame, the tributary width of the end frame
is half the bay spacing,
= 8550 / 2
= 4275 mm
Case -1 A(+i)
End zones
1E
2E
3E
4E
= 0.277 x 4.275
= 0.787 x 4.275
= 0.454 x 4.275
= 0.397 x 4.275
= 1.184 kN/m
= 3.364 kN/m
= 1.941 kN/m
= 1.680 kN/m
Interior zones
1
2
3
4
= 0.145 x 4.275
= 0.550 x 4.275
= 0.347 x 4.275
= 0.303 x4.275
= 0.619 kN/m
= 2.351 kN/m
= 1.483 kN/m
= 1.295 kN/m
= 0.397 x 4.275
= 1.697 kN/m
End zones
1E
2E
3E
4E
= 0.504 x 4.275
= 0.561 x 4.275
= 0.227 x 4.275
= 0.164 x 4.275
= 2.155 kN/m
= 2.399 kN/m
= 0.971 kN/m
= 0.701 kN/m
Interior zones
1
2
3
4
= 0.372 x 4.275
= 0.321 x 4.275
= 0.120 x 4.275
= 0.076 x 4.275
= 1.591 kN/m
= 1.372 kN/m
= 0.513 kN/m
= 0.325 kN/m
= 0.170x 4.275
= 0.727 kN/m
5&6
Case -2 A(-i)
5&6
42
W I N D
L O A D S
w = -3.364
w = -2.399
w = -1.941
w = -0.971
w =1.184
w =2.155
w = -1.680
w = -0.701
w = -2.351
w = -1.372
w = -1.483
w = -0.513
w =0.619
w =1.591
w = -1.295
w = -0.325
Similarly the [(GC pf ) - (GC pi )] for Longitudinal Direction is can be referred from
Table 1.4.5 (b) of MBMA 2002 for low rise buildings only. Hence referring to
Table 1.4.5 (b) for enclosed building.
End Zone
Interior Zone
Sidewalls
Building
Type
Load
Case
1E
2E
3E
4E
5&6
Enclosed
B(+i)
0.43
-1.25
-0.71
-0.61
0.22
-0.87
-0.55
-0.47
-0.63
B(-i)
0.79
-0.89
-0.35
-0.25
0.58
-0.51
-0.19
-0.11
-0.27
43
W I N D
L O A D S
4 = -0.47
6 = -0.63
4E = -0.61
3 = -0.55
6 = -0.63
3 = -0.55
3E = -0.71
2 = -0.87
2 = -0.87
5 = -0.63
2E = -1.25
1 = 0.22
L/2
5 = -0.63
1E =0.43
L/2
WI N
E
D IR
IO N
CT
4 = -0.11
6 = -0.27
4E = -0.25
3 = -0.19
6 = -0.27
3 = -0.19
3E = -0.35
2 = -0.51
2 = -0.51
5 = -0.27
2E = -0.89
1 = 0.58
L/2
5 = -0.27
1E =0.79
L/2
WI N
E
D IR
IO N
CT
44
W I N D
L O A D S
= 0.63 x +0.43
= 0.63 x -1.25
= 0.63 x -0.71
= 0.63 x -0.61
= +0.271
= -0.787
= -0.447
= -0.384
Interior zones
1
2
3
4
= 0.63 x +0.22
= 0.63 x -0.87
= 0.63 x -0.55
= 0.63 x -0.47
= +0.139
= -0.550
= -0.347
= -0.296
= 0.63 x -0.63
= -0.397
End zones
1E
2E
3E
4E
= 0.63 x +0.79
= 0.63 x -0.89
= 0.63 x -0.35
= 0.63 x -0.25
= +0.498
= -0.561
= -0.221
= -0.158
Interior zones
1
2
3
4
= 0.63 x +0.58
= 0.63 x -0.51
= 0.63 x -0.19
= 0.63 x -0.11
= +0.365
= -0.321
= -0.120
= -0.069
= 0.63 x -0.27
= -0.170
5&6
Case -2 B(-i)
5&6
45
W I N D
L O A D S
Hence the Design wind loads kN/m on the main framing members may be
calculated by multiplying the Design Wind Pressure and Tributary width of the
member as below,
= (7.8 + 7.5) / 2 x 3
= (7.5 + 9.25) / 2 x 35 /2 x 2 -2 x (22.95)
= 22.95 m2
= 247.22 m2
= 0.271 x 22.95
= 0.384 x 22.95
= 6.219 kN
= 8.813 kN
Interior zones
1
4
= 0.139 x 247.22 /2
= 0.296 x 247.22 / 2
= 17.181 kN
= 36.589 kN
Therefore total load on the sidewall wind force resisting system (Bracings) is
given as,
= (1E + 4E + 1 + 4) / 2
= (6.219 + 8.813 + 17.181 + 36.589) / 2
= 34.401 kN
If the number of braced bay
Force to be resisted per bay
=3
= 11.467 kN
46
W I N D
L O A D S
Case -2 B(-i)
End zones
1E
4E
= 0.498 x 22.95
= 0.158 x 22.95
= 11.429 kN
= 3.626 kN
Interior zones
1
4
= 0.365 x 247.22 / 2
= 0.069 x 247.22 / 2
= 45.117 kN
= 8.529 kN
Therefore total load on the sidewall wind force resisting system (Bracings) is
given as,
= (1E + 4E + 1 + 4) / 2
= (11.429 + 3.626 + 45.117 + 8.529) / 2
= 34.35 kN
If the number of braced bay
Force to be resisted per bay
=3
= 11.45 kN
47
W I N D
L O A D S
4 = -0.48
PSEUDO RIDGE LINE
6 = -0.63
4E = -0.62
3 = -0.55
3E = -0.72
2 = -0.87
2E = -1.25
1 = 0.23
h
B/2
1E = 0.44
WI
5 = -0.63
B/2
ND
2a
DI
RE
CT
IO
4 = -0.12
PSEUDO RIDGE LINE
6 = -0.27
4E = -0.26
3 = -0.19
3E = -0.36
2 = -0.51
2E = -0.89
1 = 0.59
h
B/2
1E = 0.80
WI
B
B/2
5 = -0.27
ND
2a
48
DI
RE
CT
IO
W I N D
L O A D S
-0.50
-0.75
-0.50
-0.75
-0.75
+1.3N
+0.75
Figure 1.4.5(e)
MBMA Recommendation for Open Building in Longitudianl Direction
49
W I N D
L O A D S
Consider the building in example 5.7 as an Open Building, the opening is walls
is as shown in Figure 1.4.5 (e) above, the coefficients on the sheeted area will be
as shown in Figure 1.4.5 (e).
The coefficients on the main frame are as shown in the sketch below,
Gcp = -0.50
Gcp = -0.50
GCp =+0.75
GCp =+0.75
Wind Coefficients for Main Framing for all zones in an Open Building
The total force on the wind bracing system at the side walls will depend on the
value of 1.3N.
Assuming the solid area of the end frame
= 45.00 m2
(Solid area is the area of main frame steel profile including the purlin depth and
sheeting depth at sidewalls and roof)
Gross area of Endwall
= 293.12 m2
Therefore,
= 0.154
b) 1/6 <= h/B <= 6
h/b
= 0.214
OK
c) S/B <= 0.5
s/b
= 0.244
OK
Hence force per sidewall is given as,
= 1.3 x N x Solid Area / (2 x 2)
= 1.3 x 10 x 45 / 4
If the number of braced bays are 4,
Force per braced bay = 146.25 / 4
50
OK
= 146.25 kN
= 36.563 kN
W I N D
L O A D S
Eqn. 7.3.3-1
kN
Where,
F D N () = normal peak drag force on open frame assemblage for an angle of
attack of the wind, () is measured from the normal to the frame outline
GC P(0) = peak drag coefficient on a single frame at ( = 0)
= effective solid area of a single frame,
As
q
= velocity pressure evaluated at mean roof height (h) for a given
exposure.
n N() = directional shielding coefficients, the maximum values of which are
given in figure 7.3.3(c) as a function of n 2 , the shielding coefficient for two
frames which is given in figure 7.3.3(b).
The design force F D N () represents the net force to be resisted by the longitudinal
framing system, including that portion transmitted directly to foundation
(ground).
51
W I N D
L O A D S
0.00
0.10
0.20
0.30
0.40
0.50
0.60
0.70
0.80
0.90
1.00
GC P(0)
1.71
1.30
1.28
1.25
1.22
1.19
1.15
1.12
1.09
1.06
0.00
0.00
0.10
0.20
0.30
0.40
0.50
0.60
0.70
0.80
0.90
1.00
S/B
n2
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.92
0.96
0.93
0.93
0.98
0.99
0.78
0.80
0.82
0.85
0.90
0.98
0.62
0.69
0.71
0.76
0.85
0.97
0.52
0.58
0.62
0.68
0.82
0.95
0.42
0.46
0.54
0.61
0.79
0.93
0.32
0.36
0.48
0.55
0.77
0.91
0.23
0.27
0.43
0.51
0.74
0.88
0.16
0.21
0.39
0.48
0.70
0.84
0.08
0.20
0.38
0.44
0.67
0.79
0.00
0.22
0.38
0.42
0.62
0.71
0.25
0.50
0.75
1.00
1.50
2.00
52
W I N D
L O A D S
53
W I N D
0.00
L O A D S
0.10
0.20
0.30
0.40
0.50
0.60
0.70
0.80
0.90
1.00
0.74
0.66
0.61
0.56
0.55
0.70
0.67
0.63
0.59
0.58
0.68
0.69
0.68
0.68
0.68
0.67
0.71
0.80
0.90
1.00
0.72
1.10
1.30
1.35
1.55
12.00
18.90
19.40
17.90
21.00
0.82
0.82
0.82
0.82
0.82
1.00
1.10
1.15
1.20
1.25
1.32
1.36
1.45
1.55
1.60
1.36
1.39
1.47
1.59
1.70
1.31
1.35
1.42
1.50
1.60
1.27
1.30
1.38
1.40
1.48
0.92
0.95
0.92
0.92
0.92
0.97
1.01
1.02
1.03
1.04
1.01
1.10
1.10
1.12
1.14
1.07
1.17
1.17
1.22
1.28
1.10
1.25
1.28
1.34
1.40
1.12
1.31
1.39
1.48
1.53
1.03
1.01
1.03
1.03
1.05
1.04
1.07
1.08
1.06
1.08
1.11
1.13
1.07
1.12
1.16
1.20
1.10
1.20
1.28
1.35
1.22
1.38
1.45
1.60
S / B = 0.25
3.00
4.00
5.00
7.00
10.00
nn / n2
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.97
0.91
0.85
0.80
0.71
0.91
0.80
0.75
0.69
0.65
0.85
0.71
0.67
0.62
0.60
nn / n2
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.98
0.91
0.88
0.85
0.82
0.92
0.81
0.78
0.77
0.73
0.85
0.76
0.75
0.73
0.70
nn / n2
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.98
0.93
0.91
0.86
0.82
0.93
0.88
0.86
0.80
0.77
0.90
0.86
0.85
0.81
0.77
nn / n2
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.96
0.95
0.94
0.86
0.93
0.90
0.89
0.83
0.93
0.92
0.91
0.89
0.79
0.68
0.64
0.58
0.57
S / B = 0.50
3.00
4.00
5.00
7.00
10.00
0.80
0.75
0.76
0.75
0.70
S / B = 0.75
3.00
4.00
5.00
7.00
10.00
0.90
0.90
0.87
0.87
0.84
S / B = 1.00
3.00
4.00
5.00
7.00
0.97
0.97
0.97
0.96
Where,
Solidity ratio = As / Ae
As
Solid area of the frame profile
Ae
total projected area outlined by frame
(for a typical low-rise building this would be (width x eave height) + gable
area
H
mean height of frames
B
width of frame
S
spacing of frames
N
number of frames
n2
two frames
n number of frames
nn
54
W I N D
L O A D S
Solving the same problem of Example 5.7, we know from previous example on
open building,
= 0.578
55
= 14.176 kN
W I N D
ASCE 7-05
Section 6.5.13
L O A D S
qh G CN
kN/m2
Where,
q h = velocity pressure evaluated at mean roof height.
G = Gust effect factor (G = 0.85 for rigid structures) Sect. 6.5.8 ASCE 7-05
C N = net pressure coefficient determined from Figures 6-18A through 6-18D of
ASCE 7-05, For roof slope <= 7.5 use C N as below,
Case A
CN
= +1.20
= -1.10
Case B
CN
Checking the same example 5.7, by applying the above equation, we know
= 0.63 kN/m2
qh
G
= 0.85
Since the slope is less than 7.5
CN
= +1.20 or -1.10
P
= 0.63 x 0.85 x 1.20
Therefore total load
= As x P x N
= 45 x 0.643 x 10
= 0.643 kN/m2
= 289.35 kN
= 72.337 kN
If there are 4 braced bays, then load per braced bay is given as,
= 72.337 / 4
= 18.084 kN
56
W I N D
L O A D S
MBMA 02
Section 1.4.5.3
Pp
q p G C pn
kN/m2
Where,
P p = combined net pressure on the parapet due to the combination of the net
pressures from the front and back parapet surfaces. Plus (and minus) signs
signify net pressure acting toward (and away from) the front exterior side of the
parapet.
qp
GC pn
Again, taking the same example 5.7, and assuming other details as below,
Top of Parapet
Bay Spacing
= 9500 mm
= 8550 mm
kN/m2
Kz
K zt
Kd
= 0.71
= 1.00
= 0.85
qp
Velocity Pressure q p
Therefore,
57
W I N D
L O A D S
= 0.963 kN/m2
= 0.642 kN/m2
= 1.156 kN/m2
= 0.706 kN/m2
= 13.723 kN/m
= 15.920 kN/m
58
W I N D
L O A D S
Design Wind loads on Solid Free Standing walls and Solid Signs
The design wind force for a solid free standing walls and solid signs shall be
determined by the following formula,
Pp
ASCE 7-05
Section 6.5.14
qz G Cf As
kN
Where,
q z = the velocity pressure evaluated at height h for a given exposure. Where h
is the top of sign above ground.
G = Gust effect factor (G = 0.85 for rigid structures) Sect. 6.5.8 ASCE 7-05
A s = the gross area of the solid free standing wall or sign in m2
C f = net force coefficient from figure 6-20 ASCE 7-05, C f depend on the shape
aspect ratio and clearance ratio above ground, may be conservatively assumed =
1.80 for more precise value see figure 6-20 of ASCE 7-05.
Say we have a Solid Sign with following details as below,
Width (B)
Height (s)
Top of Sign (h)
Wind Speed
= 4000 mm
= 2000 mm
= 8000 mm
= 150 kmph
= 41.67 m/sec
= 0.613 x 10-3 K z K zt K d V2 I w
kN/m2
= 9.14 m
= 0.70
K zt
Kd
=
=
qz
Pp
= 1.00
= 0.85
Therefore,
59
= 7.71 kN
W I N D
L O A D S
Checking the above value with more precise calculation as per Figure 6-20 of
ASCE 7-05,
B/s
=4/2
= 2.00
s/h
=2/8
= 0.25
Referring to Figure 6-20 on page 73 we find,
60
Cf
= 1.80
W I N D
L O A D S
AXIAL LOAD
DUE TO
LONGITUDINAL
LOADING
AS PER MBMA 02
FIGURE 1.4.5(c) OR
1.4.5(d)
STRUT PURLIN
SUPPORTS
61
W I N D
L O A D S
MBMA 02
Section 1.4.2
q h [(GC p ) - (GC pi )]
kN/m2
The external and internal coefficients have been combined and tabulated in
MBMA 2002 Table 1.4.6(a) through 1.4.6(h). Coefficients depend on the effective
wind load area of the component or cladding and its location relative to the
geometric discontinuities in the surfaces of the building. The building surfaces
are zoned and the pressure coefficients are assumed to be constant within each
zone. When a member lies within two or more zones, the design loads for that
member can be determined using several rational approaches. Coefficients for
wall may be reduced by 10% when the roof angle () is less than or equal to 10.
The reduced values for roof angle less than 10 is tabulated in Table 1.4.6(a) of
MBMA 2002.
Components and Claddings include all members other than the main framing
members, for example, Eave struts, purlins, girts, clips, sheeting, trims &
fasteners.
where,
q h = velocity pressure evaluated at mean roof height (h) for a given exposure.
GC p = external pressure coefficients from Figures 6-5 to 6-7 ASCE 7-98
GC pi = internal pressure coefficients from Table 6-7 ASCE 7-98
62
W I N D
L O A D S
5
5
1-31
Table 1.4.6(a)
Wall Coefficients Equations [(GC p ) - (GC pi )] w / internal pressure included
Outward pressure for C & C
Eff. Wind Load
Partially Enclosed
Zone
Enclosed Buildings
2
Area=A (m )
Buildings
A <= 0.93
-1.58
-1.95
Corner (5)
0.93 < A < 46.5
0.353 Log A - 1.57
0.353 Log A 1.94
A >= 46.5
-0.98
-1.35
A <= 0.93
-1.28
-1.65
Interior (4)
0.93 < A < 46.5
0.176 Log A - 1.27
0.176 Log A - 1.64
A >= 46.5
-0.98
-1.35
Inward pressure for C & C
A <= 0.93
1.18
1.55
All Zones
0.93 < A < 46.5
-0.176 Log A + 1.17
-0.176 Log A + 1.54
A >= 46.5
0.88
1.25
Values tabulated below are above values reduced by 10% for <=10
Outward pressure for C & C
A <= 0.93
-1.44
-1.81
Corner (5)
0.93 < A < 46.5
0.318 Log A - 1.43
0.318 Log A 1.80
A >= 46.5
-0.90
-1.27
A <= 0.93
-1.17
-1.54
Interior (4)
0.93 < A < 46.5
0.159 Log A - 1.16
0.159 Log A - 1.54
A >= 46.5
-0.90
-1.27
Inward pressure for C & C
A <= 0.93
1.08
1.45
All Zones
0.93 < A < 46.5
-0.159 Log A + 1.08
-0.159 Log A + 1.45
A >= 46.5
0.81
1.18
63
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Using the same Example 5.7, we know the following,
Velocity Pressure qh
End Zone a
= 0.63 kN/m2
= 3000 mm
First, we need to check the wall panel in all zones, how much can the selected
panel span in order to decide the spacing of girts and then design the girt.
Let us assume the following wall panel details,
Profile
= M45-250
Thickness
= 0.50 mm
Material
= Aluzinc
The effective covering width of these panel = 1000 mm, let us try using 1800 mm
girt spacing, then the effective width clause as per MBMA 2002 page I-18 applies,
which states that the width should be greater of,
Tributary width
= 1000 mm
Span / 3
= 1800 / 3
= 600 mm
Hence effective width = 1000 mm
The tributary area for coefficient calculation is given as,
= 1.800 m2
= 1000 x 1800 / 10002
Referring Table 1.4.6(a) above, considering an enclosed building, since the slope
is less than 10 use the 10% reduced values from the lower portion of the table
1.4.6 (a)
Outward Pressure (Suction)
Corners
= 0.318 Log A - 1.43
= 0.318 (Log 1.8) 1.43
Interiors
= 0.159 Log A - 1.16
= 0.159 (Log 1.8) 1.16
Inward Pressure (Pressure)
All Zones
= -0.159 Log A + 1.08
= -0.159 (Log 1.8) + 1.08
Therefore,
The loads at various zones are given by,
= q h [(GC p ) - (GC pi )]
64
= -1.349~ - 1.35
= -1.119~ -1.12
= 1.039 ~1.04
W I N D
L O A D S
= 0.85 kN/m2
Interiors
= 0.63 x 1.12
= 0.71 kN/m2
= 0.66 kN/m2
Refer the Panel Chart below to check the allowable load kN/m2 for above profile
and thickness, referring for span = 2.0 meters,
1- Span
1-Span
2- Span
2-Span
3- Span
3-Span
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
= 1.48 kN/m2
= 1.76 kN/m2
= 1.99 kN/m2
= 1.48 kN/m2
= 2.31 kN/m2
= 1.85 kN/m2
Since all loads calculated are less than the allowable loads for any number of
spans, no further checks are required. It is important to note that at locations
adjacent to wall lights and other wall openings etc. the panel spans should be
checked for the number of spans the panel is spanning and accordingly check
the appropriate allowable loads.
Since the loads are very less than the allowable let us use girt spacing of 2000
mm, it will be required to re-calculate the coefficients as above for revised
tributary area of 2.0 m2.
Outward Pressure (Suction)
Corners
= 0.318 Log A - 1.43
= 0.318 (Log 2.0) 1.43
= 0.63 x 1.33
Interiors
= -1.334 ~ - 1.33
= 0.84 kN/m2
= -1.112~ -1.12
= 0.71 kN/m2
= 1.032~ 1.03
= 0.65 kN/m2
Since the loads less than the allowable, we use girt spacing of 2000 mm.
65
W I N D
L O A D S
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
E
(kN / cm
2)
It x
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
Ibx
S xTop
S xBot
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
(mm)
0.50
1000.00
4.315
5.18
15.60
20000.00
11.49
3.58
8.53
0.74
10.99
4.84
4.81
0.99
4.02
0.70
1000.00
6.228
7.62
22.92
20000.00
20.28
6.80
12.72
1.40
17.71
7.34
8.19
1.52
12.80
1.00
1000.00
9.095
11.27
33.87
20000.00
33.53
11.75
19.13
2.43
28.54
11.16
13.93
2.30
33.33
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
Va
(mm)
0.70
1.00
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
5.92
3.79
2.63
1.93
1.48
1.17
0.95
0.78
0.66
0.56
0.48
WP
5.92
3.79
2.63
1.93
1.48
1.17
0.94
0.71
0.54
0.43
0.34
WS
7.94
5.08
3.53
2.59
1.76
1.24
0.90
0.68
0.52
0.41
0.33
D+L
6.43
5.08
3.53
2.59
1.99
1.57
1.27
1.05
0.88
0.75
0.65
WP
6.43
5.08
3.53
2.59
1.99
1.57
1.27
1.05
0.88
0.75
0.65
WS
5.92
3.79
2.63
1.93
1.48
1.17
0.95
0.78
0.66
0.56
0.48
D+L
7.31
5.85
4.11
3.02
2.31
1.83
1.48
1.22
1.03
0.88
0.76
WP
7.31
5.85
4.11
3.02
2.31
1.83
1.48
1.22
1.03
0.81
0.65
WS
7.31
4.74
3.29
2.42
1.85
1.46
1.18
0.98
0.82
0.70
0.60
D+L
11.23
7.19
4.99
3.67
2.81
2.22
1.80
1.49
1.25
1.06
0.92
WP
11.23
7.19
4.99
3.67
2.81
2.22
1.66
1.25
0.96
0.76
0.61
WS
12.12
7.76
5.39
3.96
2.83
1.99
1.45
1.09
0.84
0.66
0.53
D+L
12.12
7.76
5.39
3.96
3.03
2.39
1.94
1.60
1.35
1.15
0.99
WP
12.12
7.76
5.39
3.96
3.03
2.39
1.94
1.60
1.35
1.15
0.99
WS
11.23
7.19
4.99
3.67
2.81
2.22
1.80
1.49
1.25
1.06
0.92
D+L
15.15
9.70
6.73
4.95
3.79
2.99
2.42
2.00
1.68
1.43
1.24
WP
15.15
9.70
6.73
4.95
3.79
2.99
2.42
2.00
1.68
1.43
1.14
WS
14.04
8.99
6.24
4.58
3.51
2.77
2.25
1.86
1.56
1.25
1.00
D+L
19.40
12.42
8.62
6.33
4.85
3.83
3.10
2.57
2.16
1.84
1.58
WP
19.40
12.42
8.62
6.33
4.85
3.77
2.75
2.06
1.59
1.25
1.00
WS
18.42
11.79
8.19
6.02
4.57
3.21
2.34
1.76
1.35
1.06
0.85
D+L
18.42
11.79
8.19
6.02
4.61
3.64
2.95
2.44
2.05
1.74
1.50
WP
18.42
11.79
8.19
6.02
4.61
3.64
2.95
2.44
2.05
1.74
1.50
WS
19.40
12.42
8.62
6.33
4.85
3.83
3.10
2.57
2.16
1.84
1.58
D+L
23.03
14.74
10.24
7.52
5.76
4.55
3.68
3.05
2.56
2.18
1.88
WP
23.03
14.74
10.24
7.52
5.76
4.55
3.68
3.05
2.56
2.18
1.88
WS
24.25
15.52
10.78
7.92
6.06
4.79
3.88
3.21
2.55
2.01
1.61
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
WS
66
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
(kN )
W I N D
L O A D S
Check wall panel fasteners, for 45-250 panel profile, the fasteners are usually
spaced 250 mm c/c, hence the tributary area for fasteners is,
= Spacing of girts x spacing of fasteners
= 2.00 x 0.25
= 0.50 m2
Referring Table 1.4.6(a) above, considering an enclosed building, since the slope
is less than 10 use the 10% reduced values from the lower portion of the table
1.4.6 (a)
Outward Pressure (Suction)
Corners
= -1.44
Interiors
= -1.17
Inward Pressure (Pressure)
All Zones
= +1.08
Therefore,
The total load in kN in various zones are given by,
= q h [(GC p ) - (GC pi )] x Tributary area
Outward Pressure (Suction)
Corners
= 0.63 x 1.44 x 0.50
Interiors
= 0.63 x 1.17 x 0.50
Inward Pressure (Pressure)
All Zones
= 0.63 x 1.08 x 0.50
= 0.45 kN
= 0.37 kN
= 0.34 kN
1.2
1.5
0.83
1.04
0.5
0.7
2.12
2.96
Carbon Steel
4.8
5.5
1.94
4.52
1.8
2.0
1.25
1.39
1.0
4.23
Stainless Steel
4.8
5.5
1.88
3.70
1.64
1.64
3.05
2.52
2.5
1.74
-
The values for Pull-Out and Pull-Over needs to be checked, Pull over value is
generally more than required because of the 19mm washer bearing on panel.
67
W I N D
L O A D S
Tributary width
= Span of panels
= 2000 mm
= spacing of girts
Applying the effective width clause of MBMA 02, effective width is greater of,
Tributary width
= 2000 mm
Span / 3
= 8550 / 3
= 2850 mm
Hence effective width = 2850 mm
Therefore, tributary area
= 24.37 m2
= 8550 x 2850 / 10002
Referring Table 1.4.6(a) above, considering an enclosed building, since the slope
is less than 10 use the 10% reduced values from the lower portion of the table
1.4.6 (a)
Outward Pressure (Suction)
Corners
= 0.318 Log A - 1.43
= 0.318 (Log 24.37) 1.43
Interiors
= 0.159 Log A - 1.16
= 0.159 (Log 24.37) 1.16
Inward Pressure (Pressure)
All Zones
= -0.159 Log A + 1.08
= -0.159 (Log 24.37) + 1.08
= -0.988 ~ - 0.99
= -0.939 ~ -0.94
= 0.859 ~ 0.86
Therefore,
The loads in kN/m at various zones are given by,
= q h [(GC p ) - (GC pi )] x spacing of girts
Outward Pressure (Suction)
Corners
= 0.63 x 0.99 x 2
= 1.25 kN/m
Interiors
= 0.63 x 0.94 x 2
= 1.18 kN/m
= 1.08 kN/m
Hence the girts should be designed for all the above loads.
68
W I N D
L O A D S
2
1
3
1
2
2
2
69
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Using the same Example 5.7, we know the following,
Velocity Pressure qh
End Zone a
= 0.63 kN/m2
= 3000 mm
First, we need to check the Roof panel in all zones, how much can the selected
panel span in order to decide the spacing of purlins and then design the purlins.
Let us assume the following Roof panel details,
Profile
= M45-250
Thickness
= 0.50 mm
Material
= Aluzinc
The effective covering width of these panel = 1000 mm, let us try using 2000 mm
purlin spacing, then the effective width clause as per MBMA 2002 page I-18
applies, which states that the width should be greater of,
Tributary width
= 1000 mm
Span / 3
= 2000 / 3
= 666.67 mm
Hence effective width = 1000 mm
The tributary area for coefficient calculation is given as,
= 2.00 m2
= 1000 x 2000 / 10002
Referring Table 1.4.6(b) above, considering an enclosed building. [If the roof
slope is more than 10 use Table 1.4.6(c), if the roof slope is more than 30 use
Table 1.4.6(d)]
Uplift (Suction)
Corners
70
W I N D
L O A D S
Uplift (Suction)
Corners
= 0.63 x 2.42
Edge
= 0.63 x 1.75
Interiors
= 0.63 x 1.15
Downward Pressure (Pressure)
All Zones
= 0.63 x 0.45
= 1.53 kN/m2
= 1.10 kN/m2
= 0.73 kN/m2
= 0.28 kN/m2
Refer the Panel Chart to check the allowable load kN/m2 for above profile and
thickness, referring for span = 2.0 meters,
1- Span
1-Span
2- Span
2-Span
3- Span
3-Span
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
= 1.48 kN/m2
= 1.76 kN/m2
= 1.99 kN/m2
= 1.48 kN/m2
= 2.31 kN/m2
= 1.85 kN/m2
So we see that the allowable load for 2-Span (Suction) is less than the
calculated load at the corners, apart from this all loads calculated are less than
the allowable loads for any number of spans, no further checks are required. It
is important to note that at locations adjacent to skylights and other roof
openings etc. the panel spans should be checked for the number of spans the
panel is spanning and accordingly check the appropriate allowable loads.
71
W I N D
L O A D S
Check roof panel fasteners, for 45-250 panel profile, the fasteners are usually
spaced 250 mm c/c, hence the tributary area for fasteners is,
= Spacing of purlins x spacing of fasteners
= 2.00 x 0.25
= 0.50 m2
= 0.94 kN
= 0.62 kN
= 0.37 kN
1.2
1.5
0.83
1.04
0.5
0.7
2.12
2.96
Carbon Steel
4.8
5.5
1.94
4.52
1.8
2.0
1.25
1.39
1.0
4.23
Stainless Steel
4.8
5.5
1.88
3.70
1.64
1.64
3.05
2.52
2.5
1.74
-
The values for Pull-Out and Pull-Over needs to be checked, the calculated load at
the corners is more than the allowable for 1.2 mm thk. But generally the end bay
purlins are thicker sections, otherwise spacing of screws should be reduced. Pull
over value is generally more than required because of the 19mm washer bearing
on panel.
72
W I N D
L O A D S
Tributary width
= Span of panels
= 2000 mm
= spacing of purlins
Applying the effective width clause of MBMA 02, effective width is greater of,
Tributary width
= 2000 mm
Span / 3
= 8550 / 3
= 2850 mm
Hence effective width = 2850 mm
Therefore, tributary area
= 24.37 m2
= 8550 x 2850 / 10002
Referring Table 1.4.6(b) above, considering an enclosed building. [If the roof
slope is more than 10 use Table 1.4.6(c), if the roof slope is more than 30 use
Table 1.4.6(d)]
Uplift (Suction)
Corners
= -1.28
Edge
= -1.28
Interiors
= -1.08
Downward Pressure (Pressure)
All Zones
= 0.38
Therefore,
The loads in kN/m at various zones are given by,
= {DL - q h [(GC p ) - (GC pi )]] x spacing of purlins
If the panel and purlin self weight from Table 3.1 chapter 3 = (0.04+0.056)
= 0.096 kN/m2
Uplift (Suction)
Corners & Edge
= (0.096 - 0.63 x 1.28) x 2
= -1.42 kN/m
Interiors
= -1.17 kN/m
= 0.67 kN/m
Hence the purlins should be designed for all the above loads. The pressure
load of 0.67 kN/m may be ignored, since the combined dead and live load will
usually exceed the above value.
73
W I N D
L O A D S
3
2
2
3
2
3
a
2
3
a
3
a
1
2
-2.20
74
W I N D
L O A D S
3
2
2
1
a
2
3
2
3
a
75
W I N D
L O A D S
76
W I N D
2
4a
L O A D S
2a
a
h
2
4a
3
2
2a
2a
3
2a
A
77
W I N D
L O A D S
2
4a
A
4a
3
a
2
2a
A
78
W I N D
L O A D S
2
2a
h
a
2
A
2a
2a
A
Table 1.4.6(h)
Saw Tooth Roof Coefficients Equations [(GC p ) - (GC pi )] w / internal pressure included
Uplift for C & C
Eff. Wind Load Area A
Partially Enclosed
Zone
Enclosed Buildings
2
(m )
Buildings
A <= 0.93
-4.28
-4.65
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.40 Log A - 4.26
0.40 Log A - 4.63
Span A Corner (3)
9.30 < A < 46.5
2.289 Log A - 6.10
2.289 Log A - 6.47
A >= 46.5
-2.28
-2.65
A <= 0.93
-2.78
-3.15
Spans
9.30 < A < 46.5
1.001 Log A - 3.75
1.001 Log A - 4.12
B,C & D Corner(3)
A >= 46.5
-2.08
-2.45
A <= 0.93
-3.38
-3.75
Edge (2)
0.93 < A < 46.5
0.942 Log A - 3.35
0.942 Log A - 3.72
A >= 46.5
-1.78
-2.15
A <= 0.93
-2.38
-2.75
Interior (1)
0.93 < A < 46.5
0.647 Log A - 2.36
0.647 Log A - 2.73
A >= 46.5
-1.28
-1.65
Downward C & C
A <= 0.93
0.98
1.35
Corner (3)
0.93 < A < 9.30
-0.10 Log A - 0.98
-0.10 Log A - 1.35
A >= 9.30
0.88
1.25
A <= 0.93
1.28
1.65
Edge (2)
0.93 < A < 9.30
-0.30 Log A - 1.27
-0.30 Log A - 1.64
A >= 9.30
0.98
1.35
A <= 0.93
0.88
1.25
Interior (1)
0.93 < A < 46.5
-0.177 Log A - 0.88
-0.177 Log A - 1.25
A >= 46.5
0.58
0.95
79
W I N D
L O A D S
Members
Roof
Purlins
A >= 9.3
m2
Roof
Members
Roof
Panels &
Fasteners
A >= 0.93
m2
Wall Girts
A = 9.3 m2
Wall
Members
Roof
Overhang
Wall
Panels &
Fasteners
A <= 0.93
m2
Purlins &
Beams
A = 9.3 m2
Panels &
Fasteners
A <= 0.93
m2
Columns
A = 18.75
m2
End
Frames
Zone
Interior
Edge
Corner
Interior
Edge
Corner
Interior
Corner
Interior
Corner
Enclosed
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
0.38
-1.08
0.38
-1.28
0.38
-1.28
0.48
-1.18
0.48
-1.98
0.48
-2.98
0.93
-1.10
0.93
-1.12
1.08
-1.17
1.08
Partially
Enclosed
0.75
-1.45
0.75
-1.65
0.75
-1.65
0.85
-1.55
0.85
-2.35
0.85
-3.35
1.30
-1.40
1.30
-1.40
1.45
-1.54
1.45
Suction
-1.44
-1.81
-1.60
-1.60
-0.80
-1.70
-1.70
-1.60
-1.60
-0.80
-1.70
-1.70
-2.80
-2.80
0.88
-0.96
0.88
-1.03
0.38
-1.08
0.38
-1.28
0.38
-1.28
1.25
-1.34
1.25
-1.40
0.75
-1.45
0.75
-1.65
0.75
-1.65
Interior
Edge
Corner
Interior
Edge
Uplift
Corner
Interior
Corner
Interior
Rafters
A >= 9.3
m2
Load Type
Edge
Corner
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
80
W I N D
L O A D S
qz G Cf Af
kN
where,
MBMA 02
Section 1.4.6.1
q z = velocity pressure evaluated at height z of the centroid of the area Af for the
appropriate exposure.
G = gust effect factor which shall be taken as 0.85 for rigid structures.
C f = net force coefficient from tables 6-9 to 6-12.
A f = projected area normal to the wind, except where C f is specified for the actual
surface area. (m2)
The information provided in ASCE 7-98 for determining C f for roofs only
specifically applies to single sloped roofs. Therefore MBMA recommendations
for determining the pressure coefficients for components and cladding of open
buildings are as follows;
Walls: Use the pressure from Table 1.4.5(a)
Roofs: Use the greater of,
1) Pressure coefficient from Table 1.4.5(a) multiplied 1.25 times, or
2) The appropriate overhang coefficient from Tables 1.4.6(b) through 1.4.6(d).
Example
Using the Example 5.7 values,
The wall coefficients are referred from Table 1.4.5(a), for slope 0 <=<=10
= 0.75 for all walls
Therefore, the coefficients for wall panel is given as,
Loads
All Zones
= 0.63 x -0.75
= -0.47 kN/m2
Similarly, for Fasteners,
Tributary area
= 0.50 m2
Loads
All Zones
= 0.63 x -0.75 x 0.50
= -0.24 kN
= -0.94 kN/m
81
W I N D
L O A D S
82
W I N D
L O A D S
MBMA 02
Section 1.4.6.2
p
where,
qp
=
GC p =
GC pi =
q p (GC p - GC pi )
kN/m2
The external and internal coefficients have been combined and tabulated in
MBMA 2002 (Table 1.4.6(a) through 1.4.6(h).
Internal pressure only needs to be considered if the construction detail permits
the buildings internal pressure to propagate into the parapet cavity. If the
internal pressure is present, both load cases should be evaluated under positive
and negative internal pressure.
Example
Again, taking the same example 5.7, and assuming other details as below,
Top of Parapet
Bay Spacing
= 9500 mm
= 8550 mm
= 0.642 kN/m2
Referring to Table 1.4.6(a), since the roof slope is less than 10, 10% reduced
coefficients will apply, generally the girts in the parapet framing are simply
supported hence the spacing is considerably reduced. Let us assume a girt
spacing of 900 mm, and then the tributary area of panels is given as,
Tributary area
Coefficients
Corners
Interior
Loads
Corners
Interior
= 0.90 m2
= -1.44
= -1.17
= 0.642 x -1.44
= 0.642 x -1.17
= -0.93 kN/m2
= -0.75 kN/m2
83
W I N D
L O A D S
84
= -0.99
= -0.94
= -0.57 kN/m
= -0.54 kN/m
W I N D
L O A D S
85
W I N D
L O A D S
MBMA 2006
ASCE 7-05
Section 6.2
efinitions
OR
V 3s = 1.05 V fm + 16.9
Where,
-
V fm
V 3s
V 3s
100
110
120
130
140
150
160
170
180
190
200
210
220
230
240
250
V fm
79
89
98
108
117
127
136
146
155
165
174
184
193
203
212
222
85
W I N D
L O A D S
E
WIND VOLUME
LENGTH =1 MILE
LENGTH =1 MILE
10 M
WIND VOLUME
EXPOSURE 'C'
Time
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
50
Average
Speed
75
78
80
83
84
83
86
90
86
90
83.5
40
45
50
T im e v /s W in d S p e e d
95
90
85
80
75
70
65
5
10
15
20
25
30
T im e in S e c o n d s
86
35
W I N D
L O A D S
So the time required for this volume of wind 1 mile long to move across the
anemometer is calculated as,
We know, Speed
Therefore, Time
= Distance / Time
= Distance / Speed
= 1 mile / 83.5 mph
= 0.01197 hour
= 0.01197 x 60 x 60
= 43.11 sec.
So the time required to measure the Fastest Mile wind speed is 43.11 sec and it
may vary with the wind speed.
Hence we say that the Fastest Mile Wind Speed = 83.5 mph = 52.19 kmph
What is 3 Second Gust wind speed?
A 3 Second gust wind speed is defined as the maximum average speed of the
wind averaged over 3 seconds passing through a wind speed measuring
instrument at a certain height, above the terrain roughness over a specified
period of time.
The height is usually 10 meters, the terrain is Exposure C and specified period
of time is 50 years
The transition was made from fastest mile wind speed to 3-Second gust for the
following reasons.
1. Fastest mile oriented anemometers have been replaced with modern
equipment with graphic strip chart readouts.
2. The peak gust is the easiest and most reliable wind speed to read from the
newer graphs.
3. 3-Second gust speeds are closer to the speeds quoted in news media.
4. Structural members are designed by gust speeds. If another type wind speed
is used, large corrections must be made by use of the gust effect factor.
87
W I N D
L O A D S
= 79.28 m2
Considering near sidewall, the total area (m2) of opening in a wall that receives
= 33.60 m2
positive external pressure A o is,
The sum of all openings in the building envelope A oi not including the near
sidewall opening A o ,
= 33.60 + (2 x 144.00)
= 321.60 m2
88
W I N D
L O A D S
The sum of the gross surface areas of the building envelope A gi (walls and roofs)
not including A g (m2).
= 79.28 + (2 x 365.06) + 2 x [45 x 10.5/(2 x Cos )]
= 1282.49 m2
Checks,
> 1.10 A oi
1. A o
33.60 > 1.10 x 321.60 = 353.76
> 0.37 m2 OR 0.01 A g
2. A o
33.60 > 0.37 m2 OR 0.01 x 79.28 = 0.7928
3. A oi / A gi <= 0.20
321.60 / 1282.49 = 0.25 < 0.20
False
True
False
Since Equation 1 & 2 are not satisfied, the building cannot be classified as
Partially Enclosed Building
Hence the building is classified as an Enclosed Building
Comparing the equation in MBMA 1996 and MBMA 2002 & 2006 as below
MBMA 1996
1) A o
2) A o
3) A oi / A gi
> 0.05 A g
> A oi
<= 0.20
> 1.10 A oi
> 0.37 m2 or > 0.01 A g , whichever is smaller.
<= 0.20
89
W I N D
L O A D S
Enclosed Building:
A building that does not comply with the requirements for Open or Partially
enclosed buildings are classified as Enclosed Building.
Eave Height (h):
The distance from the ground surface adjacent to the building to the roof eave
line at a particular wall. If the height of the eave varies along the wall, the
average height shall be used.
Mean Roof Height (h):
The average of the eave height and the highest point on the roof surface, except
that for roof angles of less than or equal to 10, the mean roof height shall be the
roof eave height. For Single slope buildings the lower eave height may be used
for roof slopes less than or equal to 10., and mean roof height for roof slopes
more than 10.
Escarpment:
Also known as Scarp, with respect to topographic effects is a cliff or steep slope
generally separating two levels or gently sloping areas.
Minimum Wind Load: (Same as in MBMA 2002)
(MWFRS - Main Wind Force Resisting System) - The design wind pressure (p)
on any main wind resisting structure on an enclosed or partially enclosed
building should not be less than 0.48 kN/m2 multiplied by the area of the
building or structure projected on to a vertical plane normal to the assumed
wind direction.
Note: - This minimum load is the sum of wind load on the windward and
leeward wall of a main frame or a building (See following sketch)
90
W I N D
L O A D S
91
W I N D
L O A D S
Description
92
W I N D
L O A D S
93
W I N D
L O A D S
94
W I N D
L O A D S
95
W I N D
L O A D S
L
W
= Span
= Spacing of element (A+B)/2.
= [greater of (W or L / 3)] x L
Note: - This area should be used ONLY for determination of GC p and NOT
for calculating design loads.
96
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 5.5
Given Data:Frame Type
Building Width
Bay Spacing
Purlin Spacing
Spacing of Fasteners
= Clear Span
= 28000 mm
= 7950 mm
= 1650 mm
= 250 mm
= 13.12 m2
= 21.07 m2
= 21.07 m2
= 1.65 m2
3. And, Effective wind load area for Fasteners (Screws) is the actual tributary
area,
= Purlin Spacing x Spacing of fasteners
= 0.41 m2
= 1650 x 250 / 10002
Further load calculation is similar to as shown in Example 5.3
97
W I N D
L O A D S
= 28000 mm
= 79500 mm
= 8450 mm
= 2800 mm
= 3380 mm
Therefore End Zone a = 2800 mm, but this should not be less than any of the
following,
= 0.04 x 28000
= 1120 mm
= 915
= 915 mm
Hence use a = 2800 mm from Eave and Gable (See sketch below for location of
dimension a on roof plan, side walls and end walls. The roof panels, purlins,
wall panels, girts and sheeting screws, trims etc. at these locations should be
designed for coefficients given for Edge and corners, other areas are designed for
interior zone coefficients)
Note: - The sketch below applies only for slopes less than 10 for other slopes
see MBMA 2006.
98
W I N D
L O A D S
5
5
1-31
2
1
3
1
2
2
2
1-32
99
W I N D
MBMA 06
Section 1.3.4.1
L O A D S
Velocity Pressure
Data Required
1) Basic Wind Speed (V) (3 Second gust) in (m/sec)
(km/hr = mph x 1.61 = 3.6 x m/sec)
2) Select Importance Factor (I w )
(Default 1.00 for Standard Buildings, unless specified)
3) Select Exposure Category (B,C or D)
(Default B unless specified in PIF)
4) Compute the Velocity Pressure (q h ) based on the mean height or eave height
if <= 10
Velocity Pressure
q z = q h = 0.613 x 10-3 K z K zt K d V2 I w
Where,
Kz
= 2.01 (h/365.76) 2/7
MBMA 06 Page 16
OR
Table 6-3 ASCE 7-05
Use h = 9.144,
Kz
Use h = 4.572,
K zt
Kd
Iw
h
= 1.00
= 0.85
= 1.00
= Height
100
kN/m2
W I N D
L O A D S
130
140
150
160
0-9
10
12
14
16
18
0.47
0.49
0.51
0.54
0.56
0.58
0.55
0.57
0.60
0.62
0.65
0.67
0.63
0.65
0.68
0.72
0.74
0.77
0.72
0.74
0.78
0.81
0.85
0.88
4.57
6
7.62
9
10
12
14
16
18
0.58
0.61
0.64
0.67
0.68
0.71
0.73
0.75
0.77
0.67
0.71
0.74
0.77
0.79
0.82
0.85
0.87
0.89
0.77
0.81
0.86
0.89
0.91
0.94
0.97
1.00
1.02
0.87
0.93
0.97
1.01
1.03
1.07
1.11
1.14
1.17
170
180
Exposure B
0.81
0.91
0.84
0.94
0.88
0.99
0.92
1.03
0.96
1.07
0.99
1.11
Exposure C
0.99
1.11
1.04
1.17
1.10
1.23
1.14
1.28
1.16
1.30
1.21
1.35
1.25
1.40
1.28
1.44
1.32
1.48
101
190
200
210
220
230
1.01
1.04
1.10
1.15
1.19
1.23
1.12
1.16
1.22
1.27
1.32
1.37
1.24
1.27
1.34
1.40
1.46
1.51
1.36
1.40
1.47
1.54
1.60
1.65
1.48
1.53
1.61
1.68
1.75
1.81
1.23
1.30
1.37
1.42
1.45
1.51
1.56
1.60
1.64
1.37
1.45
1.52
1.57
1.61
1.67
1.73
1.78
1.82
1.50
1.59
1.68
1.74
1.77
1.84
1.90
1.96
2.01
1.65
1.75
1.84
1.90
1.95
2.02
2.09
2.15
2.20
1.81
1.91
2.01
2.08
2.13
2.21
2.29
2.35
2.41
W I N D
L O A D S
q h [(GC pf ) - (GC pi )]
kN/m2
q G C p q i (GC pi )
kN/m2
where,
q h = velocity pressure evaluated at mean roof height (h) for a given exposure.
GC pf = external pressure coefficients from Figure 6-10 ASCE 7-05
GC pi = internal pressure coefficients from Table. 6-5 ASCE 7-05
q = q z for windward walls evaluated at height z above the ground for a given
exposure.
q = q h for leeward walls, side walls, and roofs evaluated at height (h).
q i = q h for windward walls, side walls, leeward walls, and roofs of enclosed
buildings and for negative internal pressure evaluation in partially enclosed
buildings.
q i = q z for positive internal pressure evaluation in partially enclosed buildings
where height (z) is defined as the level of the highest opening in the building that
could effect the positive internal pressure. For positive internal pressure
evaluation, (q i ) may conservatively be evaluated at height (h) (q i = q h )
G = Gust effect factor (G = 0.85 for rigid structures) Sect. 6.5.8 ASCE 7-05
C p = external pressure coefficients from Fig. 6-6 or Table 6-8 ASCE 7-05
The external co-efficient and internal coefficients are combined and tabulated in
MBMA 2006 [Table 1.3.4.5(a) and 1.3.4.5(b)] for use in Equation 6-18 above (Low
Rise Buildings, for other buildings refer ASCE 7-05). Coefficients depend on the
location relative to the geometric discontinuities in the surfaces of the building.
The building surfaces are zoned and the pressure coefficients are assumed to be
constant within each zone. When a member lies within two or more zones, the
design loads for that member can be determined using several approaches (step
functions, weighted averages, or another rational approach). For lateral loads on
framed buildings in which the end bays are not less than the width (2a) of the
end zone, common industry practice is to apply the entire extra load in the end
bay to the end bay purlins and end frames.
102
W I N D
L O A D S
Table 1.3.4.5(a) Refer Figure 1.3.4.5(a) or (b) with this table (Same as MBMA 2002)
Main Framing Coefficients [(GC pf ) - (GC pi )] for Transverse Direction
Building Type
Roof Angle
0 5
= 5.71
2:12
Enclosed
3:12
= 20
30 45
= 90
0 5
= 5.71
2:12
Partially
Enclosed
3:12
= 20
30 45
= 90
0 10
Open
10 < 25
25 < 45
Notes:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
End Zone
Load Case
+i
-i
+i
-i
+i
-i
+i
-i
+i
-i
+i
-i
+i
-i
+i
-i
+i
-i
+i
-i
+i
-i
+i
-i
+i
-i
+i
-i
1
2
1
2
3
1
2
1E
0.43
0.79
0.44
0.80
0.49
0.85
0.54
0.90
0.62
0.98
0.51
0.87
0.51
0.87
0.06
1.16
0.07
1.17
0.12
1.22
0.17
1.27
0.25
1.35
0.14
1.24
0.14
1.24
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
2E
-1.25
-0.89
-1.25
-0.89
-1.25
-0.89
-1.25
-0.89
-1.25
-0.89
0.09
0.45
0.51
0.87
-1.62
-0.52
-1.62
-0.52
-1.62
-0.52
-1.62
-0.52
-1.62
-0.52
-0.28
0.82
0.14
1.24
-0.50
-0.20
-0.50
0.50
0.15
-0.50
1.40
3E
-0.71
-0.35
-0.72
-0.36
-0.76
-0.40
-0.81
-0.45
-0.87
-0.51
-0.71
-0.35
-0.66
-0.30
-1.08
0.02
-1.09
0.01
-1.13
-0.03
-1.20
-0.10
-1.24
-0.14
-1.08
0.02
-1.03
0.07
-0.50
-0.60
-0.50
-0.50
-0.65
-0.50
0.20
Interior Zone
4E
-0.61
-0.25
-0.62
-0.26
-0.67
-0.31
-0.74
-0.38
-0.82
-0.46
-0.66
-0.30
-0.66
-0.30
-0.98
0.12
-0.99
0.11
-1.04
0.06
-1.11
-0.01
-1.19
-0.09
-1.03
0.07
-1.03
0.07
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
1
0.22
0.58
0.23
0.59
0.26
0.62
0.30
0.66
0.35
0.71
0.38
0.74
0.38
0.74
-0.15
0.95
-0.14
0.96
-0.11
0.99
0.07
1.03
-0.02
1.08
0.01
1.11
0.01
1.11
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
0.75*
2
-0.87
-0.51
-0.87
-0.51
-0.87
-0.51
-0.87
-0.51
-0.87
-0.51
0.03
0.39
0.38
0.74
-1.24
-0.14
-1.24
-0.14
-1.24
-0.14
-1.24
-0.14
-1.24
-0.14
-0.34
0.76
0.01
1.11
-0.50
-0.20
-0.50
0.50
0.15
-0.50
1.40
3
-0.55
-0.19
-0.55
-0.19
-0.58
-0.22
-0.62
-0.26
-0.66
-0.30
-0.61
-0.25
-0.55
-0.19
-0.92
0.18
-0.92
0.18
-0.95
0.15
-0.99
0.11
-1.03
0.07
-0.98
0.12
-0.92
0.18
-0.50
-0.60
-0.50
-0.50
-0.65
-0.50
0.20
4
-0.47
-0.11
-0.48
-0.12
-0.51
-0.15
-0.55
-0.19
-0.61
-0.25
-0.55
-0.19
-0.55
-0.19
-0.84
0.26
-0.85
0.25
-0.88
0.22
-0.92
0.18
-0.98
0.12
-0.92
0.18
-0.92
0.18
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
End
walls
5&6
-0.63
-0.27
-0.63
-0.27
-0.63
-0.27
-0.63
-0.27
-0.63
-0.27
-0.63
-0.27
-0.63
-0.27
-1.00
0.10
-1.00
0.10
-1.00
0.10
-1.00
0.10
-1.00
0.10
-1.00
0.10
-1.00
0.10
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
-0.75*
Load case subscripts refer to negative internal pressure (-i) and positive internal pressure (+i).
Plus and minus signs signify pressures acting toward and away from the surfaces, respectively.
For values of other than those shown, linear interpolation is permitted. Note that this interpolation must be done on the external
pressure coefficient and then combined with the appropriate internal pressure coefficient. This has been done for standard slopes
of 2:12 and 3:12.
When the roof pressure coefficient in zone 2 or 2E is negative, it shall be applied in zone 2 or 2E for a distance from the edge of the
roof equal to 0.5 times the horizontal dimension of the remainder of zone 2 or 2E extending to the ridge line shall use the pressure
coefficient from zone 3 or 3E.
* - Denotes coefficient for sheeted portion of the wall only. [See figure 1.4.5 (e)]
103
W I N D
L O A D S
6
4
4E
3
3E
2E
1E
B
5
2a
2a
4E
3E
2E
h
B/2
1E
B
B/2
2a
104
W I N D
L O A D S
Table 1.3.4.5(b) Refer figure 1.3.4.5(c) or (d) with this table (Same as MBMA 2002)
Main Framing Coefficients [(GC pf ) - (GC pi )] for Longitudinal Direction (All roof angles)
End Zone
Interior Zone
Sidewalls
Building
Type
Load
Case
1E
2E
3E
4E
5&6
Enclosed
+i
0.43
-1.25
-0.71
-0.61
0.22
-0.87
-0.55
-0.47
-0.63
-i
0.79
-0.89
-0.35
-0.25
0.58
-0.51
-0.19
-0.11
-0.27
Partially
Open
+i
0.06
-1.62
-1.08
-0.98
-0.15
-1.24
-0.92
-0.84
-1.00
-i
1.16
-0.52
0.02
0.02
0.95
-0.14
0.18
0.26
0.10
Open
4
6
3
6
2
3E
4E
3
2
5
2E
L/2
5
1E
L/2
B
2a
6
6
3
4E
3E
5
1
2E
L/2
B/2
1E
L/2
B
2a
105
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 5.7
Given Data:Frame Type
= Clear Span
Building Width
= 35000 mm
Bay Spacing
= 9 @ 8550 mm
Length
= 76950 mm
Eave Height
= 7500 mm
Roof Slope
= 1:10 ( = 5.71)
Wind Speed
= 150 kmph (3 Second Gust) = 41.67 m/sec
Importance Factor
= 1.00
Exposure Category
=B
All walls are fully sheeted.
Solution:1. Check if the building classifies under Low Rise Building,
The 2 conditions are,
a) Mean Roof Height h less than or equal to 18.28 m
b) Mean Roof Height h does not exceed least horizontal dimension
(Minimum of Width or Length)
h
= 7500 mm
Hence the building can be classified as a Low Rise Building
2. Check if the building is classifies as Enclosed, Partially Enclosed or
Open Building based on the given information about openings. Since all
walls are fully sheeted, the building is classified as an Enclosed Building.
3. Since the roof slope is less than 10, eave height may be used in lieu of mean
roof height. Therefore, h = 7500 mm for all further calculations.
4. Find the end zone dimensions for walls and roofs, the end zone dimension a
is given as the least of
10 % (0.10 B or L) of least horizontal dimension
= 0.10 x 35000
= 3500 mm
0.4 h (Mean roof or eave height)
= 0.40 x 7500
= 3000 mm
But not less than either
4 % (0.04 B or L) of least horizontal dimension OR 915 mm
= 0.04 x 35000
= 1400 mm
Hence the End Zone dimension a
= 3000 mm
Therefore, ( 2a )
= 6000 mm
106
W I N D
L O A D S
= 0.613 x 10-3 K z K zt K d V2 I w
kN/m2
= 9.14 m
= 0.70
K zt
Kd
=
=
qh
= 1.00
= 0.85
Therefore,
Alternatively, the same value can be directly referred from table 5.2, see under
column Exposure B, value corresponding to column 150 basic wind speed and
eave height row, 0-9 meters, = 0.63 kN/m2
6. Calculate the Design Wind Pressure (p) for MWFRS
= q h [(GC pf ) - (GC pi )] kN/m2
Note that [(GC pf ) - (GC pi )] may either be calculated individual or may be referred
from Table 1.3.4.5 (a) of MBMA 2006 for low rise buildings only. Referring to
Table 1.3.4.5 (a) for = 5.71 for enclosed building.
There are 2 case + i and - i for positive and negative internal pressures
respectively.
Building Type
Enclosed
Roof Angle
Load Case
= 5.71
+i
-i
End Zone
1E
0.44
0.80
2E
-1.25
-0.89
3E
-0.72
-0.36
Interior Zone
4E
-0.62
-0.26
1
0.23
0.59
2
-0.87
-0.51
3
-0.55
-0.19
4
-0.48
-0.12
End
walls
5&6
-0.63
-0.27
The above values are represented below in sketch for better understanding.
107
W I N D
L O A D S
6 = -0.63
4 = -0.48
4E = -0.62
3 = -0.55
3E = -0.72
2 = -0.87
2E = -1.25
1 = 0.23
1E = 0.44
B
5 = -0.63
2a
6 = -0.27
4 = -0.12
4E = -0.26
3 = -0.19
3E = -0.36
2 = -0.51
2E = -0.89
1 = 0.59
1E = 0.80
B
5 = -0.27
2a
108
W I N D
L O A D S
Therefore, the applicable Design Wind Pressure on various zones are calculated
as below,
Note that the sign is only for direction indication, +ve sign denotes towards
surface and ve sign denotes away from surface.
Case -1 ( + i )
End zones
1E
2E
3E
4E
= 0.63 x +0.44
= 0.63 x -1.25
= 0.63 x -0.72
= 0.63 x -0.62
= +0.277
= -0.787
= -0.454
= -0.397
Interior zones
1
2
3
4
= 0.63 x +0.23
= 0.63 x -0.87
= 0.63 x -0.55
= 0.63 x -0.48
= +0.145
= -0.550
= -0.347
= -0.303
= 0.63 x -0.63
= -0.397
End zones
1E
2E
3E
4E
= 0.63 x +0.80
= 0.63 x -0.89
= 0.63 x -0.36
= 0.63 x -0.26
= +0.504
= -0.561
= -0.227
= -0.164
Interior zones
1
2
3
4
= 0.63 x +0.59
= 0.63 x -0.51
= 0.63 x -0.19
= 0.63 x -0.12
= +0.372
= -0.321
= -0.120
= -0.076
= 0.63 x -0.27
= -0.170
5&6
Case -2 ( - i )
5&6
109
W I N D
L O A D S
Hence the Design wind loads kN/m on the main framing members may be
calculated by multiplying the Design Wind Pressure and Tributary width of the
member as below,
End Zone Pressure will apply to end frame, the tributary width of the end frame
is half the bay spacing,
= 8550 / 2
= 4275 mm
Case -1 ( + i )
End zones
1E
2E
3E
4E
= 0.277 x 4.275
= 0.787 x 4.275
= 0.454 x 4.275
= 0.397 x 4.275
= 1.184 kN/m
= 3.364 kN/m
= 1.941 kN/m
= 1.680 kN/m
Interior zones
1
2
3
4
= 0.145 x 4.275
= 0.550 x 4.275
= 0.347 x 4.275
= 0.303 x4.275
= 0.619 kN/m
= 2.351 kN/m
= 1.483 kN/m
= 1.295 kN/m
= 0.397 x 4.275
= 1.697 kN/m
End zones
1E
2E
3E
4E
= 0.504 x 4.275
= 0.561 x 4.275
= 0.227 x 4.275
= 0.164 x 4.275
= 2.155 kN/m
= 2.399 kN/m
= 0.971 kN/m
= 0.701 kN/m
Interior zones
1
2
3
4
= 0.372 x 4.275
= 0.321 x 4.275
= 0.120 x 4.275
= 0.076 x 4.275
= 1.591 kN/m
= 1.372 kN/m
= 0.513 kN/m
= 0.325 kN/m
= 0.170 x 4.275
= 0.727 kN/m
5&6
Case -2 - i
5&6
110
W I N D
L O A D S
w = -3.364
w = -2.399
w = -1.941
w = -0.971
w =1.184
w =2.155
w = -1.680
w = -0.701
w = -2.351
w = -1.372
w = -1.483
w = -0.513
w =0.619
w =1.591
w = -1.295
w = -0.325
Similarly the [(GC pf ) - (GC pi )] for Longitudinal Direction is can be referred from
Table 1.3.4.5 (b) of MBMA 2006 for low rise buildings only. Hence referring to
Table 1.3.4.5 (b) for enclosed building.
End Zone
Interior Zone
Sidewalls
Building
Type
Load
Case
1E
2E
3E
4E
5&6
Enclosed
+i
0.43
-1.25
-0.71
-0.61
0.22
-0.87
-0.55
-0.47
-0.63
-i
0.79
-0.89
-0.35
-0.25
0.58
-0.51
-0.19
-0.11
-0.27
111
W I N D
L O A D S
4 = -0.47
6 = -0.63
4E = -0.61
3 = -0.55
6 = -0.63
3 = -0.55
3E = -0.71
2 = -0.87
2 = -0.87
5 = -0.63
2E = -1.25
1 = 0.22
L/2
5 = -0.63
1E =0.43
L/2
WIN
EC
DIR
2a
N
TIO
4 = -0.11
6 = -0.27
4E = -0.25
3 = -0.19
6 = -0.27
3 = -0.19
3E = -0.35
2 = -0.51
2 = -0.51
5 = -0.27
2E = -0.89
1 = 0.58
L/2
5 = -0.27
1E =0.79
L/2
WIN
EC
DIR
N
TIO
2a
112
W I N D
L O A D S
= 0.63 x +0.43
= 0.63 x -1.25
= 0.63 x -0.71
= 0.63 x -0.61
= +0.271
= -0.787
= -0.447
= -0.384
Interior zones
1
2
3
4
= 0.63 x +0.22
= 0.63 x -0.87
= 0.63 x -0.55
= 0.63 x -0.47
= +0.139
= -0.550
= -0.347
= -0.296
= 0.63 x -0.63
= -0.397
End zones
1E
2E
3E
4E
= 0.63 x +0.79
= 0.63 x -0.89
= 0.63 x -0.35
= 0.63 x -0.25
= +0.498
= -0.561
= -0.221
= -0.158
Interior zones
1
2
3
4
= 0.63 x +0.58
= 0.63 x -0.51
= 0.63 x -0.19
= 0.63 x -0.11
= +0.365
= -0.321
= -0.120
= -0.069
= 0.63 x -0.27
= -0.170
5&6
Case -2 B(-i)
5&6
113
W I N D
L O A D S
1E
7500
8100
1E
8100
7500
9250
Hence the Design wind loads kN/m on the main framing members may be
calculated by multiplying the Design Wind Pressure and Tributary width of the
member as below,
6000
35000
= (8.1 + 7.5) / 2 x 6
= (7.5 + 9.25) / 2 x 35 /2 x 2 -2 x (46.8)
= 46.8 m2
= 199.5 m2
= 0.271 x 46.8
= 0.384 x 46.8
= 12.68 kN
= 17.97 kN
Interior zones
1
4
= 0.139 x 199.5 /2
= 0.296 x 199.5 / 2
= 13.86 kN
= 29.53 kN
Therefore total load on the sidewall wind force resisting system (Bracings) is
given as,
= (1E + 4E + 1 + 4) / 2
= (12.68 + 17.97 + 13.86 + 29.53) / 2
= 37.02 kN
If the number of braced bay
Force to be resisted per bay
=3
= 12.34 kN
114
W I N D
L O A D S
Case -2 ( - i )
End zones
1E
4E
= 0.498 x 46.8
= 0.158 x 46.8
= 23.31 kN
= 7.394 kN
Interior zones
1
4
= 0.365 x 199.5 / 2
= 0.069 x 199.5 / 2
= 36.41 kN
= 6.883 kN
Therefore total load on the sidewall wind force resisting system (Bracings) is
given as,
= (1E + 4E + 1 + 4) / 2
= (23.31 + 7.394 + 36.41 + 6.883) / 2
= 36.99 kN
If the number of braced bay
Force to be resisted per bay
=3
= 12.33 kN
115
W I N D
L O A D S
4 = -0.48
PSEUDO RIDGE LINE
6 = -0.63
4E = -0.62
3 = -0.55
3E = -0.72
2 = -0.87
2E = -1.25
1 = 0.23
h
B/2
1E = 0.44
WI
5 = -0.63
B/2
ND
2a
DI
RE
CT
IO
4 = -0.12
PSEUDO RIDGE LINE
6 = -0.27
4E = -0.26
3 = -0.19
3E = -0.36
2 = -0.51
2E = -0.89
1 = 0.59
h
B/2
1E = 0.80
WI
B
B/2
5 = -0.27
ND
2a
116
DI
RE
CT
IO
W I N D
L O A D S
= qh G CN
Where,
qh
G
CN
For winds perpendicular to the ridge, ASCE 7-05 Figures 6-18A, 6-18B, 6- 18C are
for monosloped roofs, gable roofs, and troughed roofs, respectively. Net pressure
coefficients are given for two cases: (1) where there is clear wind flow through
the building, and (2) where there is obstructed wind flow. Obstructed wind flow
occurs when objects below the roof produce greater than a 50% blockage of the
wind flow through the building. Also, note that for gable roofs with a slope less
than 7.5 , the coefficients for a monoslope roof (Figure 6-18A) with = 0 are to
be used.
It is important to note that the ASCE 7-05 provisions in Figure 6-18 have lower
and upper limits on the ratio (h/L) i.e. the mean roof height to the horizontal
dimension of roof measured in the along wind direction. Therefore the MBMA
recommendation for building aspect ratios that fall outside the h/L limits, are to
use the pressure coefficients provided in Table 1.3.4.5(a). This is consistent with
previous editions of MBMA Low-Rise Building Systems Manual.
Also, the ASCE 7-05 provisions only apply to the roof surfaces. Therefore the
MBMA recommendation for wall surfaces that might be clad, is to use the wall
pressure coefficients provided in Table 1.3.4.5(a) and Figure 1.3.4.5(e). This is
consistent with previous editions of MBMA Low-Rise Building Systems Manual.
For winds parallel to the ridge, net pressure coefficients are given in ASCE 7- 05
Figure 6-18D. However, this only covers pressures and suctions on the roof
surfaces, which do not contribute to the longitudinal wind brace requirements.
For wind pressures on the bare frames, or on clad surfaces on the endwalls,
MBMA has its own recommendation. Since the values given in these references
are based on mean pressure coefficients (C p ) referenced to mean-hourly wind
speeds, the peak coefficients shown on Figure 1.3.4.5(e) were obtained by
amplifying the values as follows:
Eqn. 1.3.4.5
MBMA 2006
GC p
117
W I N D
L O A D S
Where the gust factor is assumed to be 2.0, the 3 second gust speeds are taken as
1.53 times mean hourly speeds, and the 1.25 factor accounts for uncertainty in the
database as the coefficients were generated from experiments in a uniform flow
wind tunnel (turbulence not properly modeled).
The coefficient GC p = 1.3N where, N = the number of frames, to be used in the
design of main framing in the longitudinal direction for open buildings is based
on some research work in the US, and is a bit on conservative.
****
-0.75
****
-0.75
-0.75
+1.3N
+0.75
The 0.75 pressure coefficients apply to any covered areas of the building surfaces.
The 1.3N pressure coefficients shall be applied to the solid area of the largest frame projected onto a plane normal to the ridge; this
coefficient is based on the following limits:
a.
0.1 <= <= 0.3
b. 1/6 <= h/B <= 6
c.
S/B <= 0.5
Where is the ratio of solid area of to frame to gross area of the end wall and N is the number of transverse frames. See MBMA 2006 Design
example 1.3.4.9(b)-3a for parameters outside this limits.
118
W I N D
L O A D S
119
W I N D
L O A D S
120
W I N D
L O A D S
121
W I N D
L O A D S
Consider the building in example 5.7 as an Open Building, the opening is walls
is as shown in Figure 1.3.4.5 (e) above, the coefficients on the sheeted area will be
as shown in Figure 1.3.4.5 (e).
1) Wind Left and Wind Right Case
For all Frames, Interior and End frames
The Wall Pressure tabulated below are as per Figure 1.3.4.5(e) MBMA 2006
Walls
Windward Wall
-0.75
Leeward Wall
-0.75
Refer to Figure 1.3.4.5(e) in MBMA 2006
Load (kN/m)
q h [(GC pf ) (Gc pi )]x Bay
Spacing
0.63 x -0.75 x 8.55 = -4.03
0.63 x -0.75 x 8.55 = -4.03
= qh G CN
where,
G
= 0.85
Referring to Figure 16-18B pitched roof
Roof Slope
= 5.71
< 7.50
Referring to note 3 in above Figure 16-18B, states that for slope less than 7.50,
Monoslope coefficients given in Figure 16-18A should be referred.
g = 0 and g = 180 Case A
Net Pressure Coefficient C N
Roof
(Figure 16-18A ASCE 7-05)
Windward Roof
-0.50
Leeward Roof
-1.20
Assuming Obstructed Wind Flow Case
Load (kN/m)
q h x G x C N x Bay Spacing
0.63 x 0.85 x -0.50 x 8.55 = -2.29
0.63 x 0.85 x -1.20 x 8.55 = -5.49
Load (kN/m)
q h x G x C N x Bay Spacing
0.63 x 0.85 x -1.10 x 8.55 = -5.04
0.63 x 0.85 x -0.60 x 8.55 = -2.75
122
W I N D
L O A D S
-0.50
-1.10
-1.20
-0.60
GCp =+0.75
GCp =+0.75
Walls
Windward Wall
-0.75
Leeward Wall
-0.75
Refer to Figure 1.3.4.5(e) in MBMA 2006
Load (kN/m)
q h [(GC pf ) (Gc pi )]x Bay
Spacing
0.63 x -0.75 x 8.55 = -4.03
0.63 x -0.75 x 8.55 = -4.03
123
Load (kN/m)
q h x G x C N x Bay Spacing
0.63 x 0.85 x -0.90 x 8.55 = -4.12
0.63 x 0.85 x 0.50 x 8.55 = 2.29
W I N D
L O A D S
<= h
-0.90
0.50
Load (kN/m)
q h x G x C N x Bay Spacing
0.63 x 0.85 x -1.20 x 8.55 = -5.49
0.63 x 0.85 x 0.50 x 8.55 = 2.29
-0.90
0.50
GCp =+0.75
GCp =+0.75
-1.20
0.50
-1.20
0.50
GCp =+0.75
GCp =+0.75
124
W I N D
L O A D S
= 0.154
= 0.214
= 0.244
125
OK
OK
OK
= 146.25 kN
= 36.563 kN
W I N D
L O A D S
Eqn. 7.3.3-1
kN
Where,
F D N () = normal peak drag force on open frame assemblage for an angle of
attack of the wind, () is measured from the normal to the frame outline
GC P(0) = peak drag coefficient on a single frame at ( = 0)
= effective solid area of a single frame,
As
q
= velocity pressure evaluated at mean roof height (h) for a given
exposure.
n N() = directional shielding coefficients, the maximum values of which are
given in figure 7.3.3(c) as a function of n 2 , the shielding coefficient for two
frames which is given in figure 7.3.3(b).
The design force F D N () represents the net force to be resisted by the longitudinal
framing system, including that portion transmitted directly to foundation
(ground).
126
W I N D
L O A D S
0.00
0.10
0.20
0.30
0.40
0.50
0.60
0.70
0.80
0.90
1.00
GC P(0)
1.71
1.30
1.28
1.25
1.22
1.19
1.15
1.12
1.09
1.06
0.00
0.00
0.10
0.20
0.30
0.40
0.50
0.60
0.70
0.80
0.90
1.00
S/B
n2
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.92
0.96
0.93
0.93
0.98
0.99
0.78
0.80
0.82
0.85
0.90
0.98
0.62
0.69
0.71
0.76
0.85
0.97
0.52
0.58
0.62
0.68
0.82
0.95
0.42
0.46
0.54
0.61
0.79
0.93
0.32
0.36
0.48
0.55
0.77
0.91
0.23
0.27
0.43
0.51
0.74
0.88
0.16
0.21
0.39
0.48
0.70
0.84
0.08
0.20
0.38
0.44
0.67
0.79
0.00
0.22
0.38
0.42
0.62
0.71
0.25
0.50
0.75
1.00
1.50
2.00
127
W I N D
L O A D S
128
W I N D
0.00
L O A D S
0.10
0.20
0.30
0.40
0.50
0.60
0.70
0.80
0.90
1.00
0.74
0.66
0.61
0.56
0.55
0.70
0.67
0.63
0.59
0.58
0.68
0.69
0.68
0.68
0.68
0.67
0.71
0.80
0.90
1.00
0.72
1.10
1.30
1.35
1.55
12.00
18.90
19.40
17.90
21.00
0.82
0.82
0.82
0.82
0.82
1.00
1.10
1.15
1.20
1.25
1.32
1.36
1.45
1.55
1.60
1.36
1.39
1.47
1.59
1.70
1.31
1.35
1.42
1.50
1.60
1.27
1.30
1.38
1.40
1.48
0.92
0.95
0.92
0.92
0.92
0.97
1.01
1.02
1.03
1.04
1.01
1.10
1.10
1.12
1.14
1.07
1.17
1.17
1.22
1.28
1.10
1.25
1.28
1.34
1.40
1.12
1.31
1.39
1.48
1.53
1.03
1.01
1.03
1.03
1.05
1.04
1.07
1.08
1.06
1.08
1.11
1.13
1.07
1.12
1.16
1.20
1.10
1.20
1.28
1.35
1.22
1.38
1.45
1.60
S / B = 0.25
3.00
4.00
5.00
7.00
10.00
nn / n2
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.97
0.91
0.85
0.80
0.71
0.91
0.80
0.75
0.69
0.65
0.85
0.71
0.67
0.62
0.60
nn / n2
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.98
0.91
0.88
0.85
0.82
0.92
0.81
0.78
0.77
0.73
0.85
0.76
0.75
0.73
0.70
nn / n2
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.98
0.93
0.91
0.86
0.82
0.93
0.88
0.86
0.80
0.77
0.90
0.86
0.85
0.81
0.77
nn / n2
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.96
0.95
0.94
0.86
0.93
0.90
0.89
0.83
0.93
0.92
0.91
0.89
0.79
0.68
0.64
0.58
0.57
S / B = 0.50
3.00
4.00
5.00
7.00
10.00
0.80
0.75
0.76
0.75
0.70
S / B = 0.75
3.00
4.00
5.00
7.00
10.00
0.90
0.90
0.87
0.87
0.84
S / B = 1.00
3.00
4.00
5.00
7.00
0.97
0.97
0.97
0.96
Where,
Solidity ratio = As / Ae
As
Solid area of the frame profile
Ae
total projected area outlined by frame
(for a typical low-rise building this would be (width x eave height) + gable
area
H
mean height of frames
B
width of frame
S
spacing of frames
N
number of frames
n2
two frames
n number of frames
nn
129
W I N D
L O A D S
Solving the same problem of Example 5.7, we know from previous example on
open building,
= 0.578
130
= 14.176 kN
W I N D
L O A D S
MBMA 06
Section
1.3.4.5.1
Pp
q p G C pn
kN/m2
Where,
P p = combined net pressure on the parapet due to the combination of the net
pressures from the front and back parapet surfaces. Plus (and minus) signs
signify net pressure acting toward (and away from) the front exterior side of the
parapet.
qp
GC pn
Again, taking the same example 5.7, and assuming other details as below,
Top of Parapet
Bay Spacing
= 9500 mm
= 8550 mm
kN/m2
Kz
K zt
Kd
= 0.71
= 1.00
= 0.85
qp
Velocity Pressure q p
Therefore,
131
= 0.963 kN/m2
= 0.642 kN/m2
= 13.723 kN/m
W I N D
L O A D S
132
W I N D
L O A D S
Design Wind loads on Solid Free Standing walls and Solid Signs
The design wind force for a solid free standing walls and solid signs shall be
determined by the following formula,
Pp
ASCE 7-05
Section 6.5.14
qz G Cf As
kN
Where,
q z = the velocity pressure evaluated at height h for a given exposure. Where h
is the top of sign above ground.
G = Gust effect factor (G = 0.85 for rigid structures) Sect. 6.5.8 ASCE 7-05
A s = the gross area of the solid free standing wall or sign in m2
C f = net force coefficient from figure 6-20 ASCE 7-05, C f depend on the shape
aspect ratio and clearance ratio above ground, may be conservatively assumed =
1.80 for more precise value see figure 6-20 of ASCE 7-05.
Say we have a Solid Sign with following details as below,
Width (B)
Height (s)
Top of Sign (h)
Wind Speed
= 4000 mm
= 2000 mm
= 8000 mm
= 150 kmph
= 41.67 m/sec
= 0.613 x 10-3 K z K zt K d V2 I w
kN/m2
= 9.14 m
= 0.70
K zt
Kd
=
=
qz
Pp
= 1.00
= 0.85
Therefore,
133
= 7.71 kN
W I N D
L O A D S
Checking the above value with more precise calculation as per Figure 6-20 of
ASCE 7-05,
B/s
=4/2
= 2.00
s/h
=2/8
= 0.25
Referring to Figure 6-20 on page 73 we find,
134
Cf
= 1.80
W I N D
L O A D S
AXIAL LOAD
DUE TO
LONGITUDINAL
LOADING
AS PER MBMA 02
FIGURE 1.4.5(c) OR
1.4.5(d)
STRUT PURLIN
SUPPORTS
Columns and rafters, which are designed with simple connections, may be
considered as main wind force resisting members when they participate in frame
action to resist wind loads or are designed for wind loads from two building
surfaces.
This would include endwall columns and rafters acting as members in a braced
frame to resist transverse wind loads, simply framed sidewall and endwall
columns designed for wind loads perpendicular to the wall in which they occur
combined with wind loads from the roof surface, and rafters designed for wind
loads from wall and roof surfaces combined
135
W I N D
L O A D S
MBMA 06
Section 1.3.4.6
q h [(GC p ) - (GC pi )]
kN/m2
The external and internal coefficients have been combined and tabulated in
MBMA 2006 Table 1.3.4.6(a) through 1.3.4.6(h). Coefficients depend on the
effective wind load area of the component or cladding and its location relative to
the geometric discontinuities in the surfaces of the building. The building
surfaces are zoned and the pressure coefficients are assumed to be constant
within each zone. When a member lies within two or more zones, the design
loads for that member can be determined using several rational approaches.
Coefficients for wall may be reduced by 10% when the roof angle () is less than
or equal to 10. The reduced values for roof angle less than 10 is tabulated in
Table 1.3.4.6(a) of MBMA 2006.
Components and Claddings include all members other than the main framing
members, for example, Eave struts, purlins, girts, clips, sheeting, trims &
fasteners.
where,
q h = velocity pressure evaluated at mean roof height (h) for a given exposure.
GC p = external pressure coefficients from Figures 6-11 to 6-17 ASCE 7-05
GC pi = internal pressure coefficients from Table 6-5 ASCE 7-05
136
W I N D
L O A D S
5
5
1-31
137
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Using the same Example 5.7, we know the following,
Velocity Pressure qh
End Zone a
= 0.63 kN/m2
= 3000 mm
First, we need to check the wall panel in all zones, how much can the selected
panel span in order to decide the spacing of girts and then design the girt.
Let us assume the following wall panel details,
Profile
= M45-250
Thickness
= 0.50 mm
Material
= Aluzinc
The effective covering width of these panel = 1000 mm, let us try using 1800 mm
girt spacing, then the effective width clause as per MBMA 2006 page 19 applies,
which states that the width should be greater of,
Tributary width
= 1000 mm
Span / 3
= 1800 / 3
= 600 mm
Hence effective width = 1000 mm
The tributary area for coefficient calculation is given as,
= 1.800 m2
= 1000 x 1800 / 10002
Referring Table 1.4.6(a) above, considering an enclosed building, since the slope
is less than 10 use the 10% reduced values from the lower portion of the table
1.4.6 (a)
Outward Pressure (Suction)
Corners
= 0.318 Log A - 1.43
= 0.318 (Log 1.8) 1.43
Interiors
= 0.159 Log A - 1.16
= 0.159 (Log 1.8) 1.16
Inward Pressure (Pressure)
All Zones
= -0.159 Log A + 1.08
= -0.159 (Log 1.8) + 1.08
Therefore,
The loads at various zones are given by,
= q h [(GC p ) - (GC pi )]
138
= -1.349~ - 1.35
= -1.119~ -1.12
= 1.039 ~1.04
W I N D
L O A D S
= 0.85 kN/m2
Interiors
= 0.63 x 1.12
= 0.71 kN/m2
= 0.66 kN/m2
Refer the Panel Chart below to check the allowable load kN/m2 for above profile
and thickness, referring for span = 2.0 meters,
1- Span
1-Span
2- Span
2-Span
3- Span
3-Span
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
= 1.48 kN/m2
= 1.76 kN/m2
= 1.99 kN/m2
= 1.48 kN/m2
= 2.31 kN/m2
= 1.85 kN/m2
Since all loads calculated are less than the allowable loads for any number of
spans, no further checks are required. It is important to note that at locations
adjacent to wall lights and other wall openings etc. the panel spans should be
checked for the number of spans the panel is spanning and accordingly check
the appropriate allowable loads.
Since the loads are very less than the allowable let us use girt spacing of 2000
mm, it will be required to re-calculate the coefficients as above for revised
tributary area of 2.0 m2.
Outward Pressure (Suction)
Corners
= 0.318 Log A - 1.43
= 0.318 (Log 2.0) 1.43
= 0.63 x 1.33
Interiors
= -1.334 ~ - 1.33
= 0.84 kN/m2
= -1.112~ -1.12
= 0.71 kN/m2
= 1.032~ 1.03
= 0.65 kN/m2
Since the loads less than the allowable, we use girt spacing of 2000 mm.
139
W I N D
L O A D S
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
(mm)
(mm)
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
E
(kN / cm
2)
It x
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
Ibx
S xTop
S xBot
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
0.50
1000.00
4.315
5.18
15.60
20000.00
11.49
3.58
8.53
0.74
10.99
4.84
4.81
0.99
4.02
0.70
1000.00
6.228
7.62
22.92
20000.00
20.28
6.80
12.72
1.40
17.71
7.34
8.19
1.52
12.80
1.00
1000.00
9.095
11.27
33.87
20000.00
33.53
11.75
19.13
2.43
28.54
11.16
13.93
2.30
33.33
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
Va
(kN )
0.70
1.00
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
5.92
3.79
2.63
1.93
1.48
1.17
0.95
0.78
0.66
0.56
0.48
WP
5.92
3.79
2.63
1.93
1.48
1.17
0.94
0.71
0.54
0.43
0.34
WS
7.94
5.08
3.53
2.59
1.76
1.24
0.90
0.68
0.52
0.41
0.33
D+L
6.43
5.08
3.53
2.59
1.99
1.57
1.27
1.05
0.88
0.75
0.65
WP
6.43
5.08
3.53
2.59
1.99
1.57
1.27
1.05
0.88
0.75
0.65
WS
5.92
3.79
2.63
1.93
1.48
1.17
0.95
0.78
0.66
0.56
0.48
D+L
7.31
5.85
4.11
3.02
2.31
1.83
1.48
1.22
1.03
0.88
0.76
WP
7.31
5.85
4.11
3.02
2.31
1.83
1.48
1.22
1.03
0.81
0.65
WS
7.31
4.74
3.29
2.42
1.85
1.46
1.18
0.98
0.82
0.70
0.60
D+L
11.23
7.19
4.99
3.67
2.81
2.22
1.80
1.49
1.25
1.06
0.92
WP
11.23
7.19
4.99
3.67
2.81
2.22
1.66
1.25
0.96
0.76
0.61
WS
12.12
7.76
5.39
3.96
2.83
1.99
1.45
1.09
0.84
0.66
0.53
D+L
12.12
7.76
5.39
3.96
3.03
2.39
1.94
1.60
1.35
1.15
0.99
WP
12.12
7.76
5.39
3.96
3.03
2.39
1.94
1.60
1.35
1.15
0.99
WS
11.23
7.19
4.99
3.67
2.81
2.22
1.80
1.49
1.25
1.06
0.92
D+L
15.15
9.70
6.73
4.95
3.79
2.99
2.42
2.00
1.68
1.43
1.24
WP
15.15
9.70
6.73
4.95
3.79
2.99
2.42
2.00
1.68
1.43
1.14
WS
14.04
8.99
6.24
4.58
3.51
2.77
2.25
1.86
1.56
1.25
1.00
D+L
19.40
12.42
8.62
6.33
4.85
3.83
3.10
2.57
2.16
1.84
1.58
WP
19.40
12.42
8.62
6.33
4.85
3.77
2.75
2.06
1.59
1.25
1.00
WS
18.42
11.79
8.19
6.02
4.57
3.21
2.34
1.76
1.35
1.06
0.85
D+L
18.42
11.79
8.19
6.02
4.61
3.64
2.95
2.44
2.05
1.74
1.50
WP
18.42
11.79
8.19
6.02
4.61
3.64
2.95
2.44
2.05
1.74
1.50
WS
19.40
12.42
8.62
6.33
4.85
3.83
3.10
2.57
2.16
1.84
1.58
D+L
23.03
14.74
10.24
7.52
5.76
4.55
3.68
3.05
2.56
2.18
1.88
WP
23.03
14.74
10.24
7.52
5.76
4.55
3.68
3.05
2.56
2.18
1.88
WS
24.25
15.52
10.78
7.92
6.06
4.79
3.88
3.21
2.55
2.01
1.61
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
WS
140
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
W I N D
L O A D S
Check wall panel fasteners, for 45-250 panel profile, the fasteners are usually
spaced 250 mm c/c, hence the tributary area for fasteners is,
= Spacing of girts x spacing of fasteners
= 2.00 x 0.25
= 0.50 m2
Referring Table 1.4.6(a) above, considering an enclosed building, since the slope
is less than 10 use the 10% reduced values from the lower portion of the table
1.4.6 (a)
Outward Pressure (Suction)
Corners
= -1.44
Interiors
= -1.17
Inward Pressure (Pressure)
All Zones
= +1.08
Therefore,
The total load in kN in various zones are given by,
= q h [(GC p ) - (GC pi )] x Tributary area
Outward Pressure (Suction)
Corners
= 0.63 x 1.44 x 0.50
Interiors
= 0.63 x 1.17 x 0.50
Inward Pressure (Pressure)
All Zones
= 0.63 x 1.08 x 0.50
= 0.45 kN
= 0.37 kN
= 0.34 kN
1.2
1.5
0.83
1.04
0.5
0.7
2.12
2.96
Carbon Steel
4.8
5.5
1.94
4.52
1.8
2.0
1.25
1.39
1.0
4.23
Stainless Steel
4.8
5.5
1.88
3.70
1.64
1.64
3.05
2.52
2.5
1.74
-
The values for Pull-Out and Pull-Over needs to be checked, Pull over value is
generally more than required because of the 19mm washer bearing on panel.
141
W I N D
L O A D S
Tributary width
= Span of panels
= 2000 mm
= spacing of girts
Applying the effective width clause of MBMA 02, effective width is greater of,
Tributary width
= 2000 mm
Span / 3
= 8550 / 3
= 2850 mm
Hence effective width = 2850 mm
Therefore, tributary area
= 24.37 m2
= 8550 x 2850 / 10002
Referring Table 1.4.6(a) above, considering an enclosed building, since the slope
is less than 10 use the 10% reduced values from the lower portion of the table
1.4.6 (a)
Outward Pressure (Suction)
Corners
= 0.318 Log A - 1.43
= 0.318 (Log 24.37) 1.43
Interiors
= 0.159 Log A - 1.16
= 0.159 (Log 24.37) 1.16
Inward Pressure (Pressure)
All Zones
= -0.159 Log A + 1.08
= -0.159 (Log 24.37) + 1.08
= -0.988 ~ - 0.99
= -0.939 ~ -0.94
= 0.859 ~ 0.86
Therefore,
The loads in kN/m at various zones are given by,
= q h [(GC p ) - (GC pi )] x spacing of girts
Outward Pressure (Suction)
Corners
= 0.63 x 0.99 x 2
= 1.25 kN/m
Interiors
= 0.63 x 0.94 x 2
= 1.18 kN/m
= 1.08 kN/m
Hence the girts should be designed for all the above loads.
142
W I N D
L O A D S
2
1
3
1
2
2
2
Table 1.4.6(b) (0 <= < 7 ) (Same as in MBMA 2002, except angle limit from 10 to 7)
Roof and Overhang Coefficients Equations [(GC p ) - (GC pi )] w / internal pressure included
Uplift for C & C
Eff. Wind Load
Partially Enclosed
Zone
Enclosed Buildings
Area A (m2)
Buildings
A <= 0.93
-2.98
-3.35
Corner (3)
0.93 < A < 9.30
1.70 Log A 2.93
1.70 Log A 3.30
A >= 9.30
-1.28
-1.65
A <= 0.93
-1.98
-2.35
Edge (2)
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.70 Log A 1.96
0.70 Log A 2.33
A >= 9.30
-1.28
-1.65
A <= 0.93
-1.18
-1.55
Interior (1)
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.10 Log A - 1.18
0.10 Log A - 1.55
A >= 9.30
-1.08
-1.45
Downward pressure for C & C
A <= 0.93
0.48
0.85
All Zones
0.93 < A < 9.30
-0.10 Log A + 0.48
-0.10 Log A + 0.85
A >= 9.30
0.38
0.75
Overhang Coefficients, Uplift for C & C
A <= 0.93
-2.80
Corner (3)
0.93 < A < 9.30
2.00 Log A 2.74
A >= 9.30
-0.8
A <= 0.93
-1.70
Edge (2)
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.10 Log A 1.70
and
9.30
<
A
<
46.5
0.715
Log A 2.29
Interior (1)
A >= 46.5
-1.10
143
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Using the same Example 5.7, we know the following,
Velocity Pressure qh
End Zone a
= 0.63 kN/m2
= 3000 mm
First, we need to check the Roof panel in all zones, how much can the selected
panel span in order to decide the spacing of purlins and then design the purlins.
Let us assume the following Roof panel details,
Profile
= M45-250
Thickness
= 0.50 mm
Material
= Aluzinc
The effective covering width of these panel = 1000 mm, let us try using 2000 mm
purlin spacing, then the effective width clause as per MBMA 2006 page 19
applies, which states that the width should be greater of,
Tributary width
= 1000 mm
Span / 3
= 2000 / 3
= 666.67 mm
Hence effective width = 1000 mm
The tributary area for coefficient calculation is given as,
= 2.00 m2
= 1000 x 2000 / 10002
Referring Table 1.4.6(b) above, considering an enclosed building. [If the roof
slope is more than 10 use Table 1.4.6(c), if the roof slope is more than 30 use
Table 1.4.6(d)]
Uplift (Suction)
Corners
144
W I N D
L O A D S
Uplift (Suction)
Corners
= 0.63 x 2.42
Edge
= 0.63 x 1.75
Interiors
= 0.63 x 1.15
Downward Pressure (Pressure)
All Zones
= 0.63 x 0.45
= 1.53 kN/m2
= 1.10 kN/m2
= 0.73 kN/m2
= 0.28 kN/m2
Refer the Panel Chart to check the allowable load kN/m2 for above profile and
thickness, referring for span = 2.0 meters,
1- Span
1-Span
2- Span
2-Span
3- Span
3-Span
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
= 1.48 kN/m2
= 1.76 kN/m2
= 1.99 kN/m2
= 1.48 kN/m2
= 2.31 kN/m2
= 1.85 kN/m2
So we see that the allowable load for 2-Span (Suction) is less than the
calculated load at the corners, apart from this all loads calculated are less than
the allowable loads for any number of spans, no further checks are required. It
is important to note that at locations adjacent to skylights and other roof
openings etc. the panel spans should be checked for the number of spans the
panel is spanning and accordingly check the appropriate allowable loads.
145
W I N D
L O A D S
Check roof panel fasteners, for 45-250 panel profile, the fasteners are usually
spaced 250 mm c/c, hence the tributary area for fasteners is,
= Spacing of purlins x spacing of fasteners
= 2.00 x 0.25
= 0.50 m2
= 0.94 kN
= 0.62 kN
= 0.37 kN
1.2
1.5
0.83
1.04
0.5
0.7
2.12
2.96
Carbon Steel
4.8
5.5
1.94
4.52
1.8
2.0
1.25
1.39
1.0
4.23
Stainless Steel
4.8
5.5
1.88
3.70
1.64
1.64
3.05
2.52
2.5
1.74
-
The values for Pull-Out and Pull-Over needs to be checked, the calculated load at
the corners is more than the allowable for 1.2 mm thk. But generally the end bay
purlins are thicker sections, otherwise spacing of screws should be reduced. Pull
over value is generally more than required because of the 19mm washer bearing
on panel.
146
W I N D
L O A D S
Tributary width
= Span of panels
= 2000 mm
= spacing of purlins
Applying the effective width clause of MBMA 02, effective width is greater of,
Tributary width
= 2000 mm
Span / 3
= 8550 / 3
= 2850 mm
Hence effective width = 2850 mm
Therefore, tributary area
= 24.37 m2
= 8550 x 2850 / 10002
Referring Table 1.4.6(b) above, considering an enclosed building. [If the roof
slope is more than 10 use Table 1.4.6(c), if the roof slope is more than 30 use
Table 1.4.6(d)]
Uplift (Suction)
Corners
= -1.28
Edge
= -1.28
Interiors
= -1.08
Downward Pressure (Pressure)
All Zones
= 0.38
Therefore,
The loads in kN/m at various zones are given by,
= {DL - q h [(GC p ) - (GC pi )]] x spacing of purlins
If the panel and purlin self weight from Table 3.1 chapter 3 = (0.04+0.056)
= 0.096 kN/m2
Uplift (Suction)
Corners & Edge
= (0.096 - 0.63 x 1.28) x 2
= -1.42 kN/m
Interiors
= -1.17 kN/m
= 0.67 kN/m
Hence the purlins should be designed for all the above loads. The pressure
load of 0.67 kN/m may be ignored, since the combined dead and live load will
usually exceed the above value.
147
W I N D
L O A D S
3
2
2
3
2
3
a
2
3
a
3
a
1
2
Table 1.4.6(c) (7 <= < 27 ) (Same as in MBMA 2002, except angle limit from 10 to 7 & 30 to 27)
Roof and Overhang Coefficients Equations [(GC p ) - (GC pi )] w / internal pressure included
Uplift for C & C
Eff. Wind Load
Zone
Enclosed Buildings
Partially Enclosed Buildings
Area A (m2)
A <= 0.93
-2.28
-2.65
Corner (3)
and
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.70 Log A - 2.26
0.70 Log A - 2.63
Edge (2)
A >= 9.30
-1.58
-1.95
A <= 0.93
-1.08
-1.45
Interior (1)
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.10 Log A - 1.08
0.10 Log A - 1.44
A >= 9.30
-0.98
-1.35
Downward pressure for C & C
A <= 0.93
0.68
1.05
All Zones
0.93 < A < 9.30
-0.20 Log A + 0.67
-0.20 Log A + 1.04
A >= 9.30
0.48
0.85
Overhang Coefficients, Uplift for C & C
A <= 0.93
-3.70
Corner (3)
0.93 < A < 9.30
1.20 Log A - 3.66
A >= 9.30
-2.50
Edge (2)
and
Interior (1)
-2.20
148
W I N D
L O A D S
3
2
2
1
a
2
3
2
3
a
Table 1.4.6(d) (27 <= < 45 ) (Same as in MBMA 2002, except angle limit from 30 to 27)
Roof and Overhang Coefficients Equations [(GC p ) - (GC pi )] w / internal pressure included
Uplift for C & C
Eff. Wind Load
Zone
Enclosed Buildings
Partially Enclosed Buildings
Area A (m2)
A <= 0.93
-1.38
-1.75
Corner (3) and
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.20 Log A 1.37
0.20 Log A - 1.74
Edge (2)
A >= 9.30
-1.18
-1.55
A <= 0.93
-1.18
-1.55
Interior (1)
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.20 Log A 1.17
0.20 Log A - 1.54
A >= 9.30
-0.98
-1.35
Downward pressure for C & C
A <= 0.93
1.08
1.45
All Zones
0.93 < A < 9.30
-0.10 Log A + 1.08
-0.10 Log A + 1.45
A >= 9.30
0.98
1.35
Overhang Coefficients, Uplift for C & C
A <= 0.93
-2.00
Corner (3)
and
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.20 Log A - 1.99
Edge (2)
A >= 9.30
-1.80
149
W I N D
L O A D S
Table 1.4.6(e) (10 <= < 30 ) Multi Span Gable (Same as in MBMA 2002)
Roof Coefficients Equations [(GC p ) - (GC pi )] w / internal pressure included
Uplift for C & C
Eff. Wind Load
Zone
Enclosed Buildings
Partially Enclosed Buildings
Area A (m2)
A <= 0.93
-2.88
-3.25
Corner (3)
0.93 < A < 9.30
1.00 Log A 2.85
1.00 Log A 3.22
A >= 9.30
-1.88
-2.25
A <= 0.93
-2.38
-2.75
Edge (2)
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.50 Log A - 2.36
0.50 Log A 2.73
A >= 9.30
-1.88
-2.25
A <= 0.93
-1.78
-2.15
Interior (1)
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.20 Log A - 1.77
0.20 Log A - 2.14
A >= 9.30
-1.58
-1.95
Downward pressure for C & C
A <= 0.93
0.78
1.15
All Zones
0.93 < A < 9.30
-0.20 Log A + 0.77
-0.20 Log A + 1.14
A >= 9.30
0.58
0.95
(30 <= < 45 )
Uplift for C & C
A <= 0.93
-2.78
-3.15
Corner (3)
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.9 Log A - 2.75
0.90 Log A - 3.12
A >= 9.30
-1.88
-2.25
A <= 0.93
-2.68
-3.05
Edge (2)
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.80 Log A - 2.65
0.80 Log A - 3.03
A >= 9.30
-1.88
-2.25
A <= 0.93
-2.18
-2.25
Interior (1)
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.90 Log A - 2.15
0.90 Log A - 2.52
A >= 9.30
-1.28
-1.65
Downward pressure for C & C
A <= 0.93
1.18
1.55
All Zones
0.93 < A < 9.30
-0.20 Log A + 1.58
-0.20 Log A + 1.95
A >= 9.30
0.98
1.35
150
W I N D
2
4a
L O A D S
2a
a
h
2
4a
3
2
2a
2a
3
2a
A
Table 1.4.6(f) (3 <= < 10 ) for less than 3 refer 1.4.6(b) (Same as in MBMA 2002)
Single Slope Roof Coefficients Equations [(GC p ) - (GC pi )] w / internal pressure included
Uplift for C & C
Eff. Wind Load Area A
Partially Enclosed
Zone
Enclosed Buildings
(m2)
Buildings
A <= 0.93
-2.78
-3.15
High Side Corner
0.93 < A < 9.30
1.00 Log A - 2.75
1.00 Log A - 3.12
(3')
A >= 9.30
-1.78
-2.15
A <= 0.93
-1.98
-2.35
Low Side Corner
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.60 Log A - 1.96
0.60 Log A - 2.33
(3)
A >= 9.30
-1.38
-1.75
A <= 0.93
-1.78
-2.15
High Side Edge
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.10 Log A - 1.78
0.10 Log A - 2.15
(2')
A >= 9.30
-1.68
-2.05
A <= 0.93
-1.48
-1.85
Low Side Edge (2)
0.93 < A < 9.30
0.10 Log A - 1.48
0.10 Log A - 1.85
A >= 9.30
-1.38
-1.75
Interior (1)
All
-1.28
-1.65
Downward pressure for C & C
A <= 0.93
0.48
0.85
All Zones
0.93 < A < 9.30
-0.10 Log A + 0.68
-0.10 Log A + 1.05
A >= 9.30
0.38
0.75
151
W I N D
L O A D S
2
4a
A
4a
3
a
2
2a
A
152
W I N D
L O A D S
2
2a
h
a
2
A
2a
2a
A
153
W I N D
L O A D S
Members
Roof
Purlins
A >= 9.3
m2
Roof
Members
Roof
Panels &
Fasteners
A >= 0.93
m2
Wall Girts
A = 9.3 m2
Wall
Members
Roof
Overhang
Wall
Panels &
Fasteners
A <= 0.93
m2
Purlins &
Beams
A = 9.3 m2
Panels &
Fasteners
A <= 0.93
m2
Columns
A = 18.75
m2
End
Frames
Zone
Interior
Edge
Corner
Interior
Edge
Corner
Interior
Corner
Interior
Corner
Enclosed
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
0.38
-1.08
0.38
-1.28
0.38
-1.28
0.48
-1.18
0.48
-1.98
0.48
-2.98
0.93
-1.10
0.93
-1.12
1.08
-1.17
1.08
Partially
Enclosed
0.75
-1.45
0.75
-1.65
0.75
-1.65
0.85
-1.55
0.85
-2.35
0.85
-3.35
1.30
-1.40
1.30
-1.40
1.45
-1.54
1.45
Suction
-1.44
-1.81
-1.60
-1.60
-0.80
-1.70
-1.70
-1.60
-1.60
-0.80
-1.70
-1.70
-2.80
-2.80
0.88
-0.96
0.88
-1.03
0.38
-1.08
0.38
-1.28
0.38
-1.28
1.25
-1.34
1.25
-1.40
0.75
-1.45
0.75
-1.65
0.75
-1.65
Interior
Edge
Corner
Interior
Edge
Uplift
Corner
Interior
Corner
Interior
Rafters
A >= 9.3
m2
Load Type
Edge
Corner
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
Pressure
Suction
154
W I N D
L O A D S
qh G CN
kN/m2
where,
MBMA 06
Section
1.3.4.6.1
q h = velocity pressure.
G = gust effect factor which shall be taken as 0.85 for rigid structures.
C N = Net pressure coefficient from ASCE 7-05 Figures 6-19A to 6-19C.
The above figures in ASCE 7-05 are for monosloped roofs, gable, roofs, and
troughed roofs. Net pressure coefficients are given for two cases,
1) Where there is clear wind flow through the building.
2) Where there is obstructed wind flow.
Obstructed wind flow occurs when objects below the roof produce greater than
50% blockage of the wind flow through the building.
However, the ASCE 7-05 provisions only apply to the roof surfaces. Some open
buildings might have partially clad walls which should be factored into the total
wind loads. Figure 1.3.4.5(e) has the MBMA recommendations for wall surfaces
for open metal buildings.
It is important to note that the ASCE 7-05 provisions in Figure 6-19 have lower
and upper limits on the ratio (h/L) i.e. the mean roof height to the horizontal
dimension of roof measured in the along wind direction. Therefore the MBMA
recommendation for determinng pressure coefficients for components and
cladding for building aspect ratios that fall outside the (h/L) limits are as follows:
Walls: Use the pressure from Tables 1.3.4.5(a)
Roofs: Use the greater of,
1) Pressure coefficient from Tables 1.3.4.5(a) multiplied 1.25 times, or
2) The appropriate overhang coefficient from Tables 1.3.4.6(b) through
1.3.4.6(d).
This is consistent with previous editions of MBMA Low-Rise Building Systems
Manual.
155
W I N D
L O A D S
156
W I N D
L O A D S
157
W I N D
L O A D S
158
W I N D
L O A D S
Example
Using the Example 5.7 values,
h/L
= 7500 / 76950
= 0.0975
< 0.25
= -0.47 kN/m2
= -0.24 kN
= -0.94 kN/m
159
W I N D
L O A D S
160
W I N D
L O A D S
MBMA 02
Section 1.4.6.2
p
where,
qp
=
GC p =
GC pi =
q p (GC p - GC pi )
kN/m2
The external and internal coefficients have been combined and tabulated in
MBMA 2006 [Table 1.3.4.6(a) through 1.3.4.6(h) ].
Internal pressure only needs to be considered if the construction detail permits
the buildings internal pressure to propagate into the parapet cavity. If the
internal pressure is present, both load cases should be evaluated under positive
and negative internal pressure.
Example
Again, taking the same example 5.7, and assuming other details as below,
Top of Parapet
Bay Spacing
= 9500 mm
= 8550 mm
= 0.642 kN/m2
Referring to Table 1.3.4.6(a), since the roof slope is less than 10, 10% reduced
coefficients will apply, generally the girts in the parapet framing are simply
supported hence the spacing is considerably reduced. Let us assume a girt
spacing of 900 mm, and then the tributary area of panels is given as,
Tributary area
Coefficients
Corners
Interior
Loads
Corners
Interior
= 0.90 m2
= -1.44
= -1.17
= 0.642 x -1.44
= 0.642 x -1.17
= -0.93 kN/m2
= -0.75 kN/m2
161
W I N D
L O A D S
162
= -0.99
= -0.94
= -0.57 kN/m
= -0.54 kN/m
W I N D
L O A D S
163
W I N D LO A D S
BS 6399 - 2: 1997
Definition
Section 1.8
1) Design Method
Standard method which uses a simplified procedure to obtain a standard
effective wind speed which is used with standard pressure co-efficient to
determined the wind loads for orthogonal design cases.
(This procedure is virtually the same as in CP3 : Chapter V: part 2)
Section 1.6.1
Kb
2
1
0.5
This Part of BS 6399 does not apply when the value of dynamic augmentation
factor exceeds the limits shown in figure 3 below. Buildings falling outside these
limits should be assessed using established dynamic methods.
164
W I N D LO A D S
The dynamic augmentation factor (Cr) is given for typical buildings in figure
below,
Section 1.7
3) Site exposure
The site wind speed (Vs) refers to a standard open country exposure at a height of
10 m above ground. To obtain the effective wind speed the effects of varying
ground roughness, the height and distance of obstructions upwind of the site and
the effects of topography should be taken into account.
Section 1.7.2
165
W I N D LO A D S
Section 1.7.3
5) Reference height ( Hr )
The reference height (Hr) ( m ) is defined for the building form in the appropriate
pressure coefficient tables and definition figures, but can conservatively be taken
as the maximum height of the building above ground level.
Section 1.7.3
6) Effective height ( He )
The effective height (He) ( m ) may be conservatively taken as the reference height
( Hr )
166
W I N D LO A D S
Section 1.7.3
7) Average height ( Ho )
The average height ( Ho ) ( m ) is the average level of roof tops of the buildings or
height of other permanent obstructions upwind of the site.
Section 1.7.3
8) Upwind Spacing ( Xo )
This is the distance ( Xo ) ( m ) of the structure from the nearest obstructing
building.
Section 1.7.3
a) Hd = 0.8 Ho
for Xo <= 2 Ho
for Xo >= 6 Ho
167
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.2.1
= 160 x 0.65
= 104 kmph.
= 28.89 m/sec
Similarly,
If the wind speed is given as fastest mile
Mean Hourly Wind Speed
= 160 kmph.
= 160 x 0.77
= 123 kmph.
= 34.17 m/sec
168
W I N D LO A D S
169
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.2.2.2
Eqn. 9
Sa = 1 + 0.001Ds
When topography is considered significant, Sa taken as the greater of,
Eqn. 10
Sa = 1 + 0.001Ds,
Eqn. 11
Sa = 1 + 0.001DT + 1.2 ye s
where,
Ds
DT
ye
170
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.2.2.3
Section 2.2.2.4
171
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.2.2.5
Section 2.2.2
Eqn. 8
Vs = Vb Sa Sd Ss Sp
Table 4 Terrain Factor Sb for standard method
Site in country or upto 2 km into
Site in town, extending >= 2
Effective
town
km upwind from the site
Height
Closest distance to sea upwind in kms
He
<= 0.1
2
10
>= 100
2
10
>= 100
<= 2
1.48
1.40
1.35
1.26
1.18
1.15
1.07
1.65
1.62
1.57
1.45
1.50
1.45
1.36
10
1.78
1.78
1.73
1.62
1.73
1.69
1.58
15
1.85
1.85
1.82
1.71
1.85
1.82
1.71
20
1.90
1.90
1.89
1.77
1.90
1.89
1.77
30
1.96
1.96
1.96
1.85
1.96
1.96
1.85
50
2.04
2.04
2.04
1.95
2.04
2.04
1.95
100
2.12
2.12
2.12
2.07
2.12
2.12
2.07
172
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.2.3
Eqn. 12
Section 2.1.2
Ve = Vb Sa Sd Ss Sp Sb = Vs Sb
17) Dynamic Wind Pressure ( qs )
The value of the dynamic pressure (qs) (N/m2 or Pa) of the standard method is
given by,
Eqn. 1
Section 2.1.3.4
qs = 0.613 Ve 2
18) Size effect factor ( Ca )
The size effect factor (Ca) of the standard method accounts for the nonsimultaneous action of gusts across an external surface and for the response of
internal pressures. Values of size effect factor are given in figure 4 below,
dependent on the site exposure (see site exposure category) and the diagonal
dimension a.
173
W I N D LO A D S
1.000
1.000
1.000
1.000
1.000
0.988
0.980
0.970
0.965
0.958
0.915
0.888
0.870
0.855
0.845
0.835
0.828
0.820
0.815
0.770
0.745
0.728
0.713
0.703
0.693
0.685
0.678
0.673
1.000
1.000
1.000
1.000
1.000
0.985
0.975
0.965
0.958
0.950
0.895
0.865
0.845
0.825
0.815
0.803
0.793
0.785
0.775
0.725
0.695
0.670
0.655
0.640
0.630
0.620
0.610
0.605
1.000
1.000
1.000
1.000
1.000
0.985
0.970
0.960
0.948
0.940
0.875
0.838
0.813
0.790
0.775
0.760
0.750
0.740
0.730
0.668
0.630
0.605
0.585
0.568
0.555
0.540
0.530
0.525
For external pressures the diagonal dimension (a) is the largest diagonal of the
area over which load sharing takes place, as illustrated in figure 5.
This manual is using (Cae) and (Cai) for External and Internal Size Effect Factor
respectively.
174
W I N D LO A D S
Eqn. 2
Section 2.1.3.2
pe = qs Cpe Ca
20) Internal surface pressure ( pi )
The pressure acting on the external surface of a building is given by,
Eqn. 3
Section 2.1.3.3
pi = qs Cpi Ca
21) Net surface pressure ( p )
The pressure acting on the external surface of a building is given by,
Eqn. 4
p = pe - pi
175
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.4.1.3
Example
Given:Metal Building (Portal Sheds and Similar Light Structures)
Eave Height
= 8500 mm
= 8.5 m
Building location
= Country
Site Altitude Ds
= 20 meters above sea level.
3 Second gust wind = 160 kmph = 44.44 m/sec
Calculate the dynamic wind pressure (qs)
Referring to table 1, building type factor (Kb) = 2 and referring figure 3 the
Dynamic augmentation factor (Cr) = 0.055 approximately.
Assuming, topography is not significant, hence altitude factor
(Sa)
= 1 + 0.001Ds = 1 + 0.001 x 20 = 1.02
Direction Factor (Sd) = 1.00, since the wind direction is unknown
= 1.00
Seasonal Factor (Ss)
Probability Factor (Sp) = 1.00
Basic wind speed (Vb) (Mean hourly wind speed)
= 44.44 x 0.65 = 28.89 m/sec
Site wind speed (Vs)
= Vb Sa Sd Ss Sp
= 28.89 x 1.02 x 1.00 x 1.00 x 1.00
= 29.47
= 0.613 x 48.092
176
= 1417 N/m2
= 1.418 kN/m2
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.4
Windward (front)
Leeward (rear)
D/H >= 4
0.85
-0.50
0.60
-0.50
Side
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Exposure Case
Isolated
Funnelling
-1.30
-0.80
-0.50
-1.60
-0.90
-0.90
Interpolation may be used in the range 1<D/H<4, for funnelling interpolation, see funnelling section
177
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.4.1.4
Funnelling
Where walls of two adjacent buildings face each other and the gap between them
is less than the scaling length ( b ) , funnelling will occur and accelerate the flow
and make the pressure coefficient more negative. The values for Isolated and
Funnelling are given in Table 5 above and are to be applied as follows,
a) Where the gap between the buildings is less than (b/4) or greater than scaling
length b, the isolated values should be used.
b) Where the gap between buildings is greater than (b/4) and less than (b)
1) either use the funnelling values, conservatively
Or
2) take the funnelling values to apply at a gap width of (b/2) and the
isolated values to apply at gap widths of (b/4) and at (b), and interpolate
linearly between these values for the actual gap width in the range from
(b/4) to (b/2) or the range from (b/2) to (b).
c) Where the two buildings are sheltered by upwind buildings such that the
effective height for the lower of the two buildings is (0.4Hr) funnelling may be
disregarded.
d) The values of table 5 are valid for non-vertical walls within 15 of the vertical.
For buildings with re-entrant corners, recessed bays or internal walls, see BS-6399
section 2.4.3.
178
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.5
Section 2.5.1
179
W I N D LO A D S
180
C
-0.70
-0.70
-0.70
-0.70
-0.40
-0.30
-0.30
-0.30
-0.40
-0.60
D
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.5.2
b) Mono-pitch and Duo-pitch roofs:These are roofs of buildings with gable ends.
Loaded zones for Mono-pitch and Duo-pitch :- Zones over which the external
pressure coefficient is assumed to be constant for both mono-pitch and duo-pitch
roofs are shown in figures 19 and 20. These zones are strips parallel to the eaves
and verge (gable) and are defined in terms of the scaling lengths bL and bw
Where,
(bw) = L
OR
(bw) = W
OR
181
W I N D LO A D S
wind angle = 0
wind angle = 90
AU
AL
-1.80
-1.20
-0.60
-2.20
-2.10
-1.10
-0.70
-0.70
-2.40
-1.10
-0.80
-1.10
-0.80
-0.40
-2.60
-1.60
-1.10
-0.80
-0.80
-2.60
-1.00
-0.90
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.20
-0.50
-0.50
-0.20
-1.70
-1.30
-1.20
-1.00
-0.80
-1.70
-1.00
-0.90
0.80
0.50
0.40
0.50
0.50
0.40
0.30
0.20
-1.50
-1.30
-1.20
-1.00
-0.90
-0.90
-0.80
-0.90
0.80
0.60
0.70
0.60
0.60
0.50
0.40
0.30
-1.20
-1.20
-1.20
-0.40
-0.20
-1.00
-0.70
-0.70
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.70
0.70
0.70
0.50
0.50
-1.20
-1.20
-1.20
-0.40
-0.20
-1.10
-0.70
-0.70
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.70
0.60
Interpolation for intermediate pitch angles may be used between values with the same sign
182
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.5.2.4
c) Duo-pitch roofs
183
W I N D LO A D S
wind angle = 0
wind angle = 90
-0.90
-0.80
-0.90
-1.10
-0.70
-0.70
-1.50
-1.30
-1.00
-0.90
-1.70
-1.00
-0.90
-0.80
-0.70
-0.70
-1.70
-1.30
-1.00
-0.80
-2.60
-1.00
-0.90
-0.70
-0.50
-0.50
-2.60
-1.40
-0.80
-0.80
-2.40
-1.20
-0.80
-0.50
-0.30
-0.50
-2.20
-1.50
-0.70
-0.70
-1.80
-1.20
-0.60
-0.90
-0.30
-0.40
-2.00
-1.10
-0.60
-0.50
-0.90
-0.30
-0.40
-1.10
-0.80
-0.40
-1.30
-0.90
-0.50
-1.60
-1.50
-0.60
-0.40
0.20
0.20
0.20
-1.30
-0.90
-0.50
-0.50
-0.50
-0.20
-0.90
-0.50
-0.50
-1.20
-1.10
-0.60
-0.50
0.80
0.50
0.40
-0.90
-0.50
-0.50
-0.40
-0.30
-0.30
-1.20
-1.20
-0.60
-0.40
0.80
0.60
0.70
-0.40
-0.30
-0.30
0.80
0.80
0.80
-0.80
-0.70
-0.60
-1.20
-1.20
-0.70
-0.60
0.80
0.80
0.80
-0.90
-0.60
-0.80
-1.20
-1.20
-1.15
-0.60
Interpolation for intermediate pitch angles may be used between values with the same sign
Interpolation is not permitted between angles +5 and -5, data for flat roof should be used
184
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.5.3
d) Hipped roofs
185
W I N D LO A D S
-1.40
-1.00
-1.00
-0.70
-0.40
-0.70
-1.10
-1.00
-0.90
-2.30
-1.20
-1.00
-1.30
-0.80
-0.70
-1.00
-1.00
-0.80
-2.60
-1.00
-0.90
-1.40
-1.30
-0.60
-0.90
-0.90
-0.80
-2.30
-1.10
-0.80
-0.80
-0.60
-0.60
-1.10
-0.80
-0.80
-1.80
-1.20
-0.60
-0.80
-0.60
-0.60
-1.10
-0.60
-0.60
-1.30
-0.80
-0.50
-1.40
-1.30
-0.60
-0.90
-0.60
-0.40
0.20
0.20
0.20
-1.40
-1.30
-0.60
-0.50
-0.50
-0.20
-1.30
-0.80
-0.60
-1.00
-0.60
-0.50
0.80
0.50
0.40
-1.30
-0.80
-0.60
-0.70
-0.40
-0.40
-1.10
-1.15
-0.40
0.80
0.60
0.70
-0.70
-0.40
-0.40
-0.60
-0.30
-0.70
-1.20
-0.70
-0.60
0.80
0.80
0.80
-0.60
-0.30
-1.20
-1.20
-0.50
-0.60
0.80
0.80
0.80
Interpolation for intermediate pitch angles may be used between values with the same sign
Interpolation is not permitted between angles +5 and -5, data for flat roof should be used
186
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.5.4
e) Mansard roofs
Mansard roofs
External pressure coefficients for mansard roofs and other multi-pitch roofs
should be derived for each plane face by the procedure similar to mono-pitch or
duo-pitch given in table 9 and 10 or the procedure for hipped roof given in table
11 using the pitch angle for each plane face. The key in figure 22 indicates where
edge zones should be omitted.
187
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.5.5
f) Multi-bay roofs
External pressure coefficients on downwind bays of mono-pitch and duo-pitch
multi-bay roofs as defined in figure 23 may conservatively be taken to be the same
as for a single-bay roof.
However, reduced values of external pressure coefficients may be derived from
table 9 or table 10, as appropriate, as follows:
a) For mono-pitch roofs as shown in figure 23a), any positive pressure coefficient
obtained from table 9 should be replaced on the second and any subsequent
downwind bays by Cpe = -0.4.
b) For unequal-pitch duo-pitch roofs, all roof slopes downwind of the first ridge
should be treated as being troughed (negative pitch angle), even when the upwind
slope is ridged as shown in figure 23(b), so that the local coefficients behind each
ridge are given by the more onerous A and B eave zones for negative pitch angles.
c) For equal-pitch duo-pitch roofs, all roof slopes downwind of the upward slope
should be treated as alternatively downwind ridged (positive pitch angle) and
troughed (negative pitch angle) as shown in figures 23(c) and (d), so that the local
coefficients behind each ridge are given by the less onerous E and F ridge zones for
positive pitch angles.
NOTE. The provisions of c) above may be applied to unequal-pitch duo-pitch roofs
when the pitch angles differ by less than 10.
For winds from =0 and =180, in all the above cases, a further reduction in
external pressure may be obtained by applying the reduction factors of table 12 to
the second and subsequent downwind bays.
Table 12 - Reduction factor for multi-bay roofs
Bay
Upwind bay
Second bay
Reduction factor
1.00
0.80
188
All remaining
bays
0.60
W I N D LO A D S
189
W I N D LO A D S
Section 2.7
190
W I N D LO A D S
191
W I N D LO A D S
=1.30
Cp
= 0.60
Free-standing walls and parapets:- Values of net pressure coefficients (Cp) for freestanding walls and parapets, with or without return corners, are given in table 21
appropriate to the zones shown in figure 26 for two values of solidity (z = 1) refers
to solid walls, while (z = 0.8) refers to walls which are 80% solid and 20% open.
Where (h) is the height of the wall or parapets.
Table 21 Net pressure coefficients Cp for free standing walls and parapets
Zones
Solidity
Walls
A
B
C
D
2.1
1.7
1.2
z = 1.00
With return corners
3.4
With return corners >= 1h
2.1
1.8 1.4 1.2
1.2 1.2 1.2
z = 0.80
All
1.2
Note:- Interpolation may be used for return corner lengths between zero and h
The high values near the free end or return corners of solid walls (zones A and B)
occur when the wind is blowing at =45 onto that end. Moderate porosity in this
region, i.e. solidity (z = 0.8) reduces these high loads to the values in zone D.
Interpolation for solidity may be used in the range (0.8 < z < 1). For porous walls
and fences with solidity less than 0.8, coefficients should be derived as for plane
lattice frames (unclad framing).
The net pressure coefficients (Cp) in zones A,B and C can be reduced when the wall
or parapet length (L) is less than (15h). A reduction factor (k) given in Table 21a
may be applied to these zones. The value of (Cpk) should not be taken as less than
1.2. Where free standing wall abut other structures such that there is no free end, a
value of (Cp) = 1.2
L/h
<= 3
5
10
>= 15
Effect of parapets on pitched roofs:- Parapets reduce the high suction in the edge
zones around the periphery of the roof and neglecting these effects will give a
192
W I N D LO A D S
conservative result for roof pitches less than (a = 30). For steeper roofs, the effects
of parapets should be taken into account by using the procedure given in section
3.3.3.7 of the code.
Frictional drag force
Walls:- Friction forces should be calculated for long walls with D>b when the
wind is parallel to the wall. The frictional drag coefficient should be assumed to act
over all zone C of such walls, with values as given in table 6. The resulting
frictional forces should be added to the normal forces.
Roofs:- Frictional forces should be considered on long roofs away from the upwind
edges. The resulting frictional drag coefficient should be assumed to act over zone
D on flat roofs (see figure 16) for all wind directions; and over zone D for monopitch or duo-pitch roofs (see figures 19 and 20 and zone J for hipped roofs in figure
21) only when the wind is parallel to the ridge. Values of frictional drag coefficient
should be obtained from table 6 and the resulting frictional forces shall be
combined with the normal pressure forces.
Type of Surface
Smooth surfaces without corrugations or ribs across the wind
direction
Surfaces with corrugations across the wind direction
Surfaces with ribs across the wind direction
0.01
0.02
0.04
= qs Cf As Ca
Where,
qs
Cf
As
Ca
193
W I N D LO A D S
Cpi
0.75 Cpe
0.90 Cpe
The relevant diagonal dimension a for size effect factor Ca can be taken as,
a = diagonal dimension of dominant opening,
OR
a = 0.2 x (internal volume)1/3
where the internal volume is the volume of the storey or room containing the
dominant opening.
Say if,
Ado is the area of dominant opening, and
Aso is the sum of openings in other walls,
the opening will be considered dominant if, Ado => 2Aso
194
W I N D LO A D S
Longer
Two adjacent
open faces
Three open
facesa
0.85
0.80
0.77
0.60
-0.60
-0.46
-0.57
-0.63
0.52
0.67
0.77
0.40
-0.39
-0.43
-0.60
-0.56
For single wall, use pressure coefficients for walls given in table 5
b
- where two sets of values are given they should be treated as separate load cases
d) Partition Walls:- The maximum net pressure coefficient Cp = (Cpe - Cpi) across
internal walls should be taken as 0.5.
The relevant diagonal dimension a for size effect factor Ca can be taken as,
a = 10 x (internal volume of the room)1/3
Example 1
Given:Frame Profile
Building width
Building Length
Bay Spacing
Endwall col. Spacing
Eave Height
Roof slope
Sliding doors
Job site
Wind pressure qs
Calculate the External wind pressure on all faces, walls and roofs.
Solution:-
195
W I N D LO A D S
= 24828.75 m3
= 10 x (24828.75)1/3
= 291.73 m
Referring to Figure 4 the building can be classified in category B and hence the
Size effect factor Cai for internal pressure = 0.697 (after interpolation)
Step 3:- Refer the external pressure coefficient
a) Wind left and wind right case
D = Width = 35.5 m
i)
B = Length = 78.2 m
H = 8.5 m
Walls coefficients
or
2H = 2 x 8.5 = 17.0 m
Therefore the zones along the end wall of the building for wind left and right case
are,
A= 0.2 b= 3.4 m,
B = b-A =13.6 m,
196
C = WAB=35.53.413.6=18.5 m
W I N D LO A D S
WALL
ARD
LEEW
B
A
LL
WA
ARD
W
D
WIN
L=B
WIND DIRECTION
W=D
LOADED ZONES ALONG END WALL FOR WIND LEFT OR RIGHT CASE
Since, D / H = 35.5 / 8.5 = 4.176 > 4.00 and assuming isolated case, the external
pressure coefficients (Cpe ) are as below, (Refer Table 5)
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
= 0.675
= -0.563
= -1.464
= -0.900
= -0.563
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
197
W I N D LO A D S
p = pe - pi
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.675 (0.30)
= -0.563 (0.30)
= -1.464 (0.30)
= -0.900 (0.30)
= -0.563 (0.30)
= 0.97
= -0.27
= -1.17
= -0.60
= -0.27
Note that the Zones A,B,C are along the end walls, hence the end wall columns
shall be designed for the maximum of above and the values that will be obtained
for wind end case.
ii)
Roof coefficients
Since the roof slope is less than 5, roof is considered as flat roof and external
pressure coefficients are referred from (Table 8)
a) If the building is with eave trim / eave gutter detail then the coefficients are as
below,
Zone A (Roof)
= -2.00
Zone B (Roof)
= -1.40
Zone C (Roof)
= -0.70
Zone D (Roof)
= 0.20
b) If the building is with parapet detail, assuming height of parapet = 1.25 m,
therefore, h / b = 1.25/17 = 0.074, then by interpolation the coefficients are as
below,
Zone A (Roof)
= -1.88
Zone B (Roof)
= -1.30
Zone C (Roof)
= -0.70
Zone D (Roof)
= 0.20
c) If the building is with curved eave detail, assuming radius of curved eave = 0.5
m, therefore r/b = 0.029 then by interpolation the coefficients are as below,
Zone A (Roof)
Zone B (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone D (Roof)
= -1.05
= -1.20
= -0.40
= 0.20
d) If the building is with mansard eave detail, assuming angle = 35, therefore by
interpolation the coefficients are as below,
Zone A (Roof)
Zone B (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone D (Roof)
= -1.03
= -1.10
= -0.33
= 0.20
198
W I N D LO A D S
In further calculations we will assume the building with eave trim / eave gutter
detail and hence use the coefficients for sharp eave detail.
Width of loaded zone A & B = b / 10
= 17 / 10
= 1.70 m
= 17 / 4
= 17 / 2
= 4.25 m
= 8.00 m
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
199
= -2.234
= -1.576
= -0.788
= 0.225
W I N D LO A D S
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all roof
= -2.234 ( -0.30)
= -1.576 ( -0.30)
= -0.788 ( -0.30)
= 0.225 ( 0.30)
= -0.225 ( 0.30)
= -1.94
= -1.28
= -0.49
= 0.52
= -0.07
Multiplying the wall and roof net pressures with the tributary area (bay spacing)
to get the load UDL in kN/m
Calculating the loads on the interior frames, for wind left case,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone B (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone D +ve (Roof)
Zone D ve (Roof)
10.0
3.85
= 0.97 x 7.82
= -0.27 x 7.82
= -1.28 x 7.82
= -0.49 x 7.82
= 0.52 x 7.82
= -0.07 x 7.82
4.07
4.07
7.59
2.11
10.0
7.59
3.85
= 7.59
= -2.11
= -10.0
= -3.85
= 4.07
= -0.55
10.0
7.59
0.55
3.85
2.11
0.55
2.11
case 1
case 2
3.85
2.11
10.0
7.59
(Note that wind right case will be mirror image of wind left case)
200
W I N D LO A D S
Calculating the loads on the end wall rafter or end frame if end is a main frame,
for wind left case and considering half bay loads.
Zone A (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone D +ve (Roof)
Zone D ve (Roof)
7.58
1.86
3.96
= -1.94 x 7.82/2
= -0.49 x 7.82/2
= 0.52 x 7.82/2
= -0.07 x 7.82/2
= 7.58
= -1.86
= 2.03
= -0.27
3.96
3.96
1.86
3.96
4.26
4.26
7.58
3.96
7.58
1.86
2.03
2.03
4.26
case 1
case 2
1.86
0.27
0.27
3.96
3.96
4.26
7.58
3.96
Loads on the end wall columns for wind left case, note that the size effect factor
Ca may be conservatively taken = 1.00 since the diagonal dimension for end wall
column is small, that is = sqrt (5.0712 + 8.52) = 9.898, referring figure 4, Ca = 0.96
Therefore, the net pressure for end wall columns needs to be recalculated with Cae
= 1.00
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C need not be evaluated, since it will be under Zone B for wind right case.
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= -1.843 (0.30)
201
= -1.55
W I N D LO A D S
Zone B (Walls)
= -1.134 (0.30)
= -0.84
The UDL on end wall columns are obtained by multiplying with tributary area,
Corner columns
Zone A (Walls)
= -1.55 x 5.071/2
= 3.93 kN/m
Interior columns
Zone B (Walls)
= -0.84 x 5.071
= 4.26 kN/m
Loads on end wall diaphragm or braced bays
DRAG FORCE
1.76
DRAG FORCE
1.76
3.79
1.06
Windward wall
Leeward wall
= 0.97 x 7.82/2
= -0.27 x 7.82/2
= 3.79
= -1.06
Additional loads due to horizontal drag force should be added to the total
bracing or diaphragm design force. The horizontal drag force for wind left
or wind right case is calculated as below,
Width D
= 35.5 m
Width of Zone C
= D b = 35.5 17.0 = 18.5 m
Area of drag force
= (D b) H
= 18.5 x 8.5
= 157.25 m2
Frictional Drag coefficient Cf for corrugated sheets as per (Table 6)
= 0.02
Hence total frictional drag force is given as
= qs Cf As Cae
= 1.418 x 0.02 x 157.25 x 0.792 = 3.53 kN
Dividing the force on both sides we get,
= 3.52 / 2
= 1.76 kN
b) Wind end case
D = Width = 78.2 m
i)
B = Length = 35.5 m
H = 8.5 m
Walls coefficients
202
or 2H = 2 x 8.5 = 17.0 m
W I N D LO A D S
Therefore the zones along the end wall of the building for wind left and right case
are,
A = 0.2 b = 3.4 m,
B = b = 17 m,
Since, D / H = 78.2 / 8.5 = 9.20 > 4.00 and assuming isolated case, the external
pressure coefficients are as below,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
LEEW
ARD W
ALL
C
B
H
WI
ND
WA
RD
N
IO
ECT
DIR
D
WIN
WA
LL
L=D
W= B
203
= 0.725
= -0.604
= -1.570
= -0.966
= -0.604
W I N D LO A D S
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.725 (0.30)
= -0.604 (0.30)
= -1.570 (0.30)
= -0.966 (0.30)
= -0.604 (0.30)
= 1.02
= -0.31
= -1.27
= -0.67
= -0.31
Note that the Zones A,B,C are along the side walls, hence the side wall columns
shall be designed for the maximum of above and the values that will be obtained
for wind left / right case.
Load on the bracing system
Windward wall
= 1.02 kN/m2
Leeward wall
= -0.31 kN/m2
Total coefficient for bracing design = 1.02 + 0.31 = 1.33 kN/m2
Total end wall area
= 317.512 m2
Therefore, total load = 317.512 x 1.33
Dividing the force top and bottom
Dividing the force along the 2 sidewalls
Dividing the force by the nos. of braced bays
= 422.29 kN
= 422.29 / 2
= 211.45 / 2
= 105.57 /3
= 211.45 kN
= 105.57 kN
= 35.19 kN
35.19
35.19
24.61+36.125
80.96+36.125
WIND DIRECTION
In addition to above we need to add the frictional drag force on the roof and
sidewalls for Zone D, it is calculated as below,
Roof,
Length of Zone D
= L bw / 2
Area of Zone D (As) = (L bw / 2) x W
Drag coefficients (Cf) = 0.02
204
= 78.2 17 / 2 = 69.7 m
= 69.7 x 35.5 = 2474.35 m2
W I N D LO A D S
= qs Cf As Cae
Wall,
Length of Zone C
Area of Zone C (As)
Drag coefficients (Cf)
Total drag force
=Lb
= (L b) x H
= 0.02
= qs Cf As Cae
= 78.2 17.0
= 61.2 x 8.5
= 61.2 m
= 520.2 m2
= 35.19 + 36.17 /3
= 47.25 kN
The end wall columns will be governed by the wind ward coefficient, but as
before the size effect factor may be conservatively taken as 1.00, hence we need to
recalculate the net pressure using Cae = 1.00
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
= 0.850
= -0.709
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.850 (0.30)
= -0.709 (0.30)
= 1.15
= -0.41 (Will not control)
Corner columns
All interior columns
= 1.15 x 5.071/2
= 1.15 x 5.071
We see that the load on the end wall corner columns is more in wind left or wind
right where as it more on interior columns in wind end case.
ii)
Roof coefficients
Since the roof slope is less than 5 , roof is considered as flat roof and external
pressure coefficients are referred from (Table 8)
205
W I N D LO A D S
The roof coefficients for a flat roof will remain the same for all directions, namely,
wind left, wind right and wind end, only the location of loaded zone is as shown
in each cases.
D
C
LEEW
ARD W
ALL
B
W
IN
DW
AR
D
N
O
I
ECT
DIR
D
WIN
A
W
AL
L
L=D
W=B
= 17 / 10
= 17 / 4
= 17 / 2
= 1.70 m
= 4.25 m
= 8.50 m
Now we need to calculate the loads on the interior frames for wind end case,
Zone B (Walls)
= -0.67 x 7.82 = -5.24
Zone D +ve (Roof)
= 0.52 x 7.82 = 4.07
case 1
Zone D ve (Roof)
= -0.07 x 7.82 = -0.55
case 2
Wind load on end wall rafter or end frame in case main frame end for wind end
case.
Taking average of the pressure in zones as below,
(Zone A +Zone C)/2 = (1.94 + 0.49)/2
= -1.215
(Zone B + Zone C)/2 = (1.28 + 0.49)/2
= -0.885
Therefore, UDL on rafter in kN/m is given by multiplying with tributary area,
= -1.215 x 7.82/2
= -4.75 kN/m
= -0.885 x 7.82/2
= -3.46 kN/m
206
W I N D LO A D S
4.07
4.07
5.24
5.24
4.97
0.55
4.97
4.75
0.55
5.24
5.24
2.92
3.46
3.46
5.83
4.75
2.92
The end wall diaphragm or braced bays shall be designed for the side wall force
in Zone A,
Zone A (Walls)
= -1.27 x 7.82/2
Using the same example above except that the roof slope is 1:10.
Solution:Step 1:- Check building open condition.
The building condition remains the same as above that is Enclosed Building
Step 2:- Refer the internal pressure coefficient
The internal pressure for enclosed building is as per Table 16 and can be taken as
Cpi = -0.30 for case Four walls equally permeable and roof impermeable
Calculate the internal volume of the building
= cross section area x length
= 333.25 x 78.2 = 26060.15 m3
Hence diagonal dimension a
= 10 x (26060.15)1/3
= 296.48 m
Referring to Figure 4 the building can be classified in category B and hence the
Size effect factor Cai for internal pressure = 0.696 (after interpolation)
207
W I N D LO A D S
B = Length = 78.2 m
H = 8.5 m
Walls coefficients
or 2H = 2 x 8.5 = 17.0 m
Therefore the zones along the end wall of the building for wind left and right case
are,
A = 0.2 b = 3.4 m,
B = b-A=13.6 m,
LEE W
ARD
W AL
C = WAB = 35.53.413.6=18.5 m
B
A
W
IN D
AR
DW
A LL
L=B
WIND DIRECTION
W=D
LOADED ZONES ALONG END WALL FOR WIND LEFT OR RIGHT CASE
Since, D / H = 35.5 / 8.5 = 4.176 > 4.00 and assuming isolated case, the external
pressure coefficients are as below,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
208
W I N D LO A D S
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= -0.563
= -1.464
= -0.900
= -0.563
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.675 (0.30)
= -0.563 (0.30)
= -1.464 (0.30)
= -0.900 (0.30)
= -0.563 (0.30)
= 0.97
= -0.27
= -1.17
= -0.60
= -0.27
Note that the Zones A,B,C are along the end walls, hence the end wall columns
shall be designed for the maximum of above and the values that will be obtained
for wind end case.
ii)
Roof coefficients
Referring table 10 since roof slope = 5.71 and considering the building with sharp
eaves.
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone E
Zone F
Zone G
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.75
= -1.17
= -0.58
= -0.93
= -0.34
= -0.41
209
W I N D LO A D S
= b / 10
=b/2
= 17 / 10
= 17 / 4
= 1.70 m
= 8.50 m
Note:
If the slope is greater than 5, a scaling length can be computed as:
a = sqrt [ (0.5W)2 + (0.5W x Tan )2 + L2 ]
a = sqrt [ (0.5 x 35.5)2 + (0.5 x 35.5 x Tan 5.71)2 + 78.22 ]
= 80.20 m
Therefore the size effect factor Ca = 0.792 (Refer figure 4)
Therefore the external pressure ( pe ) on roof are given as below, using equation,
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone E
Zone F
Zone G
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.966
= -1.316
= -0.650
= -1.043
= -0.385
= -0.457
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all roof
210
W I N D LO A D S
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.966 ( -0.30)
= -1.316 ( -0.30)
= -0.650 ( -0.30)
= 1.043 ( 0.30)
= -0.385 ( 0.30)
= -0.457 ( 0.30)
= -1.67
= -1.02
= -0.35
= -0.75
= -0.09
= -0.16
Multiplying the wall and roof net pressures with the tributary area (bay spacing)
to get the load UDL in kN/m
Calculating the loads on the interior frames, for wind left case,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone B (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone F (Roof)
Zone G (Roof)
7.98
2.74
= 0.97 x 7.82
= -0.27 x 7.82
= -1.02 x 7.82
= -0.35 x 7.82
= -0.09 x 7.82
= -0.16 x 7.82
= 7.59
= -2.11
= -7.96
= -2.74
= -0.70 (Using higher of F and G)
= -1.25
1.25
7.59
1.25
2.11
7.98
2.11
7.59
(Note that wind right case will be mirror image of wind left case)
Similarly, loads on the penultimate frame will be calculated as below,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone E (Roof)
Zone G (Roof)
2.74
= 0.97 x 7.82
= -0.27 x 7.82
= -1.67 x 7.82
= -0.35 x 7.82
= -0.75 x 7.82
= -0.16 x 7.82
= 7.59
= -2.11
= -13.1
= -2.74
= -5.87
= -1.25
211
W I N D LO A D S
5.87
13.1
5.87
2.74
1.25
2.74
1.25
7.59
2.11
13.1
2.11
7.59
Calculating the loads on the end wall rafter or end frame if end is a main frame,
for wind left case and considering half bay loads.
Zone A (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone E (Roof)
Zone G (Roof)
= -1.67 x 7.82/2
= -0.35 x 7.82/2
= -0.75 x 7.82/2
= -0.16 x 7.82/2
= -6.53
= -1.37
= -2.94
= -0.62
2.94
6.53
1.37
3.96
4.26
2.94
0.62
0.62
3.96
3.96
1.37
6.53
4.26
3.96
Loads on the end wall columns for wind left case, note that the size effect factor
Ca may be conservatively taken = 1.00 since the diagonal dimension for end wall
column is small, that is = sqrt (5.0712 + 8.52) = 9.898, referring Figure 4, Ca = 0.96
Therefore, the net pressure for end wall columns needs to be recalculated with Cae
= 1.00
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C need not be evaluated, since it will be under Zone B for wind right case.
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
212
W I N D LO A D S
p = pe - pi
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
= -1.843 (0.30)
= -1.134 (0.30)
= -1.55
= -0.84
The UDL on end wall columns are obtained by multiplying with tributary area,
Corner columns
Zone A (Walls)
= -1.55 x 5.071/2
= 3.96 kN/m
Interior columns
Zone B (Walls)
= -0.84 x 5.071
= 4.26 kN/m
Additional loads due to horizontal drag force should be added to the total
bracing or diaphragm design force. The horizontal drag force for wind left
or wind right case is calculated as below,
Width D
= 35.5 m
Width of Zone C
= D b = 35.5 17.0 = 18.5 m
Area of drag force
= (D b) H
= 18.5 x 8.5
= 157.25 m2
Frictional Drag coefficient Cf for corrugated sheets as per Table 6
= 0.02
Hence total frictional drag force is given as
= qs Cf As Cae
= 1.418 x 0.02 x 157.25 x 0.792 = 3.53 kN
Dividing the force on both sides we get,
= 3.52 / 2
= 1.76 kN
d) Wind end case
D = Width = 78.2 m
B = Length = 35.5 m
213
H = 8.5 m
W I N D LO A D S
i)
Walls coefficients
or 2H = 2 x 8.5 = 17.0 m
Therefore the zones along the end wall of the building for wind left and right case
are,
A = 0.2 b = 3.4 m,
B = b-A = 13.6 m,
C = WAB = 35.53.413.6=18.5 m
Since, D / H = 78.2 / 8.5 = 9.20 > 4.00 and assuming isolated case, the external
pressure coefficients are as below,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
LEEW
ARD W
ALL
C
B
H
W
IN
DW
AR
N
D
O
I
CT
IRE
DD
N
I
W
W
AL
L
B
A
L=D
W=B
214
= 0.725
= -0.604
= -1.570
= -0.966
= -0.604
W I N D LO A D S
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.725 (0.30)
= -0.604 (0.30)
= -1.570 (0.30)
= -0.966 (0.30)
= -0.604 (0.30)
= 1.02
= -0.31
= -1.27
= -0.67
= -0.31
Note that the Zones A,B,C are along the side walls, hence the side wall columns
shall be designed for the maximum of above and the values that will be obtained
for wind left / right case.
Load on the bracing system
Windward wall
= 1.02 kN/m2
Leeward wall
= -0.31 kN/m2
Total coefficient for bracing design = 1.02 + 0.31 = 1.33 kN/m2
Total end wall area
= 333.25 m2
Therefore, total load = 333.25 x 1.33
Dividing the force top and bottom
Dividing the force along the 2 sidewalls
Dividing the force by the nos. of braced bays
= 443.22 kN
= 443.22 / 2
= 221.61 / 2
= 110.805 /3
= 221.61 kN
= 110.805 kN
= 36.94 kN
In addition to above we need to add the frictional drag force on the roof and
sidewalls for Zone D, it is calculated as below,
Roof,
Length of Zone D
Area of Zone D (As)
Drag coefficients (Cf)
Total drag force
= L bw / 2
= (L bw / 2) x W
= 0.02
= qs Cf As Cae
Wall,
Length of Zone C
=Lb
Area of Zone C (As) = (L b) x H
Drag coefficients (Cf) = 0.02
= 78.2 17 / 2 = 69.7 m
= 69.7 x 35.5 = 2474.35 m2
= 1.418 x 0.02 x 2474.35 x 0.852
= 59.78 kN
= 78.2 17.0
= 61.2 x 8.5
215
= 61.2 m
= 520.2 m2
W I N D LO A D S
= qs Cf As Cae
= 36.17 kN
= 36.94 + 36.17/3
= 49.00 kN
The end wall columns will be governed by the wind ward coefficient, but as
before the size effect factor may be conservatively taken as 1.00, hence we need to
recalculate the net pressure using Cae = 1.00
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
= 0.850
= -0.709
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.850 (0.30)
= -0.709 (0.30)
= 1.15
= -0.41 (Will not control)
Corner columns
All interior columns
= 1.15 x 5.071/2
= 1.15 x 5.071
216
W I N D LO A D S
We see that the load on the end wall corner columns is more in wind left or wind
right where as it more on interior columns in wind end case.
ii)
Roof coefficients
Since the roof slope is greater than 5 external pressure coefficients are referred
from table 10
D
C
LEEW
ARD W
ALL
B
W
IN
DW
AR
D
ION
CT
IRE
DD
N
I
W
A
W
AL
L
L=D
W=B
= 17 / 10
= 35.5 / 4
= 17 / 2
= 1.70 m
= 8.88 m
= 8.50 m
217
W I N D LO A D S
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone D
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -2.212
= -1.268
= -0.674
= -0.554
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all roof
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -2.212 ( -0.30)
= -1.268 ( -0.30)
= -0.674 ( -0.30)
= -0.554 ( 0.30)
= -1.92
= -0.97
= -0.38
= -0.26
Multiplying the wall and roof net pressures with the tributary area (bay spacing)
to get the load UDL in kN/m
Now we need to calculate the loads on the interior frames for wind end case,
Zone B (Walls)
= -0.67 x 7.82
= -5.24
Zone D (Roof)
= -0.26 x 7.82
= -2.03
Wind load on end wall rafter or end frame in case main frame end for wind end
case. Taking average of end zones and zone C
Zone A + C (Roof)
= (-1.97 - 0.38)/2
= -1.18
Zone B + C (Roof)
= (-0.97 0.38)/2
= -0.68
Therefore, UDL on rafter in kN/m is given by multiplying with tributary area,
= -1.18 x 7.82/2
= -4.61 kN/m
= -0.68 x 7.82/2
= -2.66 kN/m
Now we need to calculate wind loads for the Secondaries Panels, Purlins and
Girts.
Wall Panels
The sidewall and endwall panels should be designed for the maximum load that
they may be subjected to in their zone. The zone A, B , C on sidewall and endwall
will have the same loading.
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of girts, the diagonal dimension is less than 5
meters, hence a = 5 m.
218
W I N D LO A D S
Therefore,
Cae
= 1.00
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.850
= -0.709
= -1.843
= -1.134
= -0.709
= 0.850 (0.30)
= -0.709 (0.30)
= -1.843 (0.30)
= -1.134 (0.30)
= -0.709 (0.30)
= 1.15
= -0.41
= -1.55
= -0.83
= -0.41
Wall Girts
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of girts, the diagonal dimension (a)
= sqrt ( Girt Spacing2 + Bay Spacing2 )
= 8.01 m.
= sqrt ( 1.752 + 7.822 )
Therefore,
Cae
= 0.965
The interior size effect factor, is the same as calculated earlier,
= 0.697
Cai
External Wall coefficients (pe) are all the same as calculated in earlier,
219
W I N D LO A D S
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.821
= -0.684
= -1.779
= -1.095
= -0.684
= 0.821 (0.30)
= -0.684 (0.30)
= -1.779 (0.30)
= -1.095 (0.30)
= -0.684 (0.30)
= 1.12
= -0.38
= -1.48
= -0.80
= -0.38
Roof Panels
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of girts, the diagonal dimension is less than 5
meters, hence a = 5 m.
= 1.00
Therefore,
Cae
The interior size effect factor, is the same as calculated earlier,
Cai
= 0.697
External Wall coefficients (pe) are all the same as calculated in earlier for Slope
1:10.
For Wind Left / Right Case
Zone A (Roof)
= -1.75
Zone B (Roof)
= -1.17
Zone C (Roof)
= -0.58
Zone E (Roof)
= -0.93
Corner
Eave
Interior
Ridge
220
W I N D LO A D S
Zone F (Roof)
Zone G (Roof)
= -0.34
= -0.41
= -1.97
= -1.13
= -0.60
= -0.49
Corner
Gable
End Bay
Interior (Not Governing)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.75
= -1.17
= -0.58
= -1.29
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Corners
Eave
Interior
End Bay
= -2.48
= -1.66
= -0.82
= -1.83
= -2.48 (0.30)
= -1.66 (0.30)
= -0.82 (0.30)
= -1.83 (0.30)
= -2.18
= -1.36
= -0.52
= -1.53
Roof Purlins
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of purlins, the diagonal dimension (a)
= sqrt ( Purlin Spacing2 + Bay Spacing2 )
= sqrt ( 1.752 + 7.822 )
= 8.01 m.
221
W I N D LO A D S
Therefore,
Cae
= 0.965
Corner
Eave Purlins
Interior Purlins
Ridge Purlins
Interior Ridge Purlins (Not Governing)
Interior Purlins (Not Governing)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.97
= -1.13
= -0.60
= -0.49
End Bay Purlins may be taken as maximum of average of either A+C or B+C
(A+C) / 2
= -(1.97 + 0.60)/2
= -1.29 (Governs)
(B+C) / 2
= -(1.13 + 0.60)/2
= -0.87 (Not Governing)
Summarize above results,
Corner
Eave Purlins
Interior Purlins
End Bay Purlins
= -1.75
= -1.17
= -0.58
= -1.29
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Corners
Eave Purlins
Interior Purlins
End Bay Purlins
= -2.395
= -1.601
= -0.794
= -1.765
222
W I N D LO A D S
= -2.395 (0.30)
= -1.601 (0.30)
= -0.794 (0.30)
= -1.765 (0.30)
= -2.09
= -1.30
= -0.49
= -1.47
Example 2
Given:Frame Profile
Building width
Building Length
Bay Spacing
Endwall col. Spacing
Eave Height
Roof slope
Sliding doors
Sliding doors
Wall Opening
Job site
Wind pressure qs
223
W I N D LO A D S
Calculate the External wind pressure on all faces, walls and roofs.
Solution:Step 1:- Check building open condition.
Check if the building is classified under Buildings with dominant wall
openings the condition is that area of any one opening is greater than the twice
sum of area of openings in other walls Ado => 2Aso
Ado = 20 x 5 = 100.00 m2
Aso = 2 x [ 4 ( 3 x 3 ) ] = 72.00 m2
We see that Ado > 2Aso , hence the building classify under Buildings with
dominant wall openings
Step 2:- Refer the internal pressure coefficient
Calculate the internal volume of the building
= cross section area x length
= 333.25 x 78.2 = 26060.15 m3
Area of Opening in one Wall
Sum of Area of Opening in other walls
Ratio of Opening
= 100.00 m2
= 72.00 m2
= 100.00/72.00 = 1.39
The internal pressure for building with dominant opening is as per Table 17 and
Since the value of Ratio of Opening (1.39 < 2) it can be taken as Cpi = -0.30.
Referring to Figure 4 the building can be classified in category B and hence the
Size effect factor Cai for internal pressure = 0.986 (after interpolation)
Step 3:- Refer the external pressure coefficient
a)
D = Width = 35.5 m
i)
B = Length = 78.2 m
H = 8.5 m
Walls coefficients
224
or 2H = 2 x 8.5 = 17.0 m
W I N D LO A D S
Therefore the zones along the end wall of the building for wind left and right
cases are,
A= 0.2 b= 3.4 m, B = b-A = 17.0 -3.4= 13.6 m,C = WAB=35.53.413.6=18.5m
Since, D / H = 35.5 / 8.5 = 4.176 > 4.00 and assuming isolated case, the external
pressure coefficients are as below, (Refer Table 5)
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
= 0.675
= -0.563
= -1.464
= -0.901
= -0.563
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
225
W I N D LO A D S
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.675 - (-0.419)
= -0.563 - (-0.419)
= -1.464 - (-0.419)
= -0.901 - (-0.419)
= -0.563 - (-0.419)
= 1.09
= -0.14
= -1.05
= -0.48
= -0.14
Note that the Zones A, B, C are along the end walls; hence the end wall columns
shall be designed for the maximum of above and the values that will be obtained
for wind end case.
ii.)
Roof coefficients
Referring ( Table 10) since roof slope = 5.71 and considering the building with
sharp eaves.
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone E
Zone F
Zone G
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.75
= -1.17
= -0.59
= -0.93
= -0.34
= -0.41
226
W I N D LO A D S
= b / 10
=b/2
= 17 / 10
= 17 / 4
= 1.70 m
= 8.50 m
Note:
If the slope is greater than 5, a scaling length can be computed as:
a = sqrt [ (0.5W)2 + (0.5W x Tan )2 + L2 ]
a = sqrt [ (0.5 x 35.5)2 + (0.5 x 35.5 x Tan 5.71)2 + 78.22 ]
= 80.20 m
Therefore the size effect factor Ca = 0.792 (Refer Figure 4)
Therefore the external pressure ( pe ) on roof are given as below, using equation,
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone E
Zone F
Zone G
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.966
= -1.316
= -0.663
= -1.042
= -0.382
= -0.460
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all roof
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.966 ( -0.419)
= -1.314 ( -0.419)
= -0.663 ( -0.419)
= -1.043 (-0.419)
= -0.385 (-0.419)
= -0.457 (-0.419)
= -1.55
= -0.89
= -0.24
= -0.62
= 0.034
= -0.038
Multiplying the wall and roof net pressures with the tributary area (bay spacing)
to get the load UDL in kN/m
Calculating the loads on the interior frames, for wind left case,
Windward wall
= 1.09 x 7.82
= 8.52
Leeward wall
= -0.14 x 7.82
= -1.09
Zone B (Roof)
= -0.89 x 7.82
= -6.95
Zone C (Roof)
= -0.24 x 7.82
= -1.88
227
W I N D LO A D S
Zone F (Roof)
Zone G (Roof)
= 0.038 x 7.82
= -0.040 x 7.82
Note: that wind right case will be mirror image of wind left case
Similarly, loads on the penultimate frame will be calculated as below,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone E (Roof)
Zone G (Roof)
= 1.09 x 7.82
= -0.14 x 7.82
= - 0.89x7.82
= -0.24 x 7.82
= -0.62x 7.82
= -0.034 x 7.82
= 8.52
= -1.09
= -6.95
= -1.88
= -4.84
= -0.30
228
W I N D LO A D S
Note: that wind right case will be mirror image of wind left case
Calculating the loads on the end wall rafter or end frame if end is a main frame,
for wind left case and considering half bay loads.
Zone A (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone E (Roof)
Zone G (Roof)
= -1.55 x 7.82/2
= -0.24 x 7.82/2
= -0.62 x 7.82/2
= -0.038 x 7.82/2
= -6.04
= -0.95
= -2.43
= -0.17
Loads on the end wall columns for wind left case, note that the size effect factor
Ca may be conservatively taken = 1.00 since the diagonal dimension for end wall
column is small, that is = sqrt (5.0712 + 8.52) = 9.898, referring Figure 4, Ca = 0.96
Therefore, the net pressure for end wall columns needs to be recalculated with
Cae = 1.00
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= -1.843 (0.419)
= -1.134 (0.419)
= -1.423
= -0.714
The UDL on end wall columns are obtained by multiplying with tributary area,
Corner columns
Zone A (Walls)
= -1.423 x 5.071/2
= 3.61 kN/m
Interior columns
Zone B (Walls)
= -0.714 x 5.071
= 3.62 kN/m
229
W I N D LO A D S
230
W I N D LO A D S
= 1.77 kN
B = Length = 35.5 m
H = 8.5 m
Walls coefficients
B = b-A = 13.6 m,
C = WAB = 35.53.413.6=18.5 m
Since, D / H = 78.2 / 8.5 = 9.20 > 4.00 and assuming isolated case, the external
pressure coefficients are as below,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
231
W I N D LO A D S
= 0.725
= -0.604
= -1.571
= -0.967
= -0.604
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.725
= -0.604
= -1.571
= -0.967
= -0.604
(0.419)
(0.419)
(0.419)
(0.419)
(0.419)
= 1.415
= -0.184
= -1.151
= -0.547
= -0.184
Note: that the Zones A, B, C are along the side walls, hence the side wall columns
shall be designed for the maximum of above and the values that will be obtained
for wind left / right case.
Load on the bracing system
Windward wall
= 1.415kN/m2
Leeward wall
= -0.184 kN/m2
Total coefficient for bracing design = 1.415 + 0.184 = 1.6 kN/m2
Total end wall area
= 333.25 m2
Therefore, total load = 333.25 x 1.6
Dividing the force top and bottom
Dividing the force along the 2 sidewalls
Dividing the force by the nos. of braced bays
232
= 533.2 kN
= 533.2 / 2
= 266.6 / 2
= 133.3 /3
= 266.6 kN
= 133.3 kN
= 44.4 kN
W I N D LO A D S
In addition to above we need to add the frictional drag force on the roof and
sidewalls for Zone D, it is calculated as below,
Roof,
Length of Zone D
Area of Zone D (As)
Drag coefficients (Cf)
Total drag force
= L bw / 2
= (L bw / 2) x W
= 0.02
= qs Cf As Cae
= 78.2 17 / 2 = 69.7 m
= 69.7 x 35.5 = 2474.35 m2
Wall,
Length of Zone C
Area of Zone C (As)
Drag coefficients (Cf)
Total drag force
=Lb
= (L b) x H
= 0.02
= qs Cf As Cae
= 78.2 17.0
= 61.2 x 8.5
= 59.78 + 12.56
= 36.17 kN
= 72.34 kN
T O T A L L O A D = 1 3 3 .3
T O T A L D R A G F O R C E = 7 2 .3 4
4 4 .4
4 4 .4
4 4 .4
1 5 .3 3 + 1 8 .0 9
1 1 7 .8 9 + 1 8 .0 9
W IN D D IR E C T IO N
S ID E W A L L E L E V A T IO N S H O W IN G B R A C IN G L O A D S
= 44.4 + 36.17/3
= 56.45 kN
The end wall columns will be governed by the wind ward coefficient, but as before
the size effect factor may be conservatively taken as 1.00, hence we need to
recalculate the net pressure using Cae = 1.00
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
= 0.850
= -0.709
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
233
W I N D LO A D S
all walls
= 0.850 (0.420)
= -0.709 (0.420)
= 1.27
= -0.289 (Will not control)
Corner columns
All interior columns
= 1.27 x 5.071/2
= 1.27 x 5.071
We see that the load on the end wall corner columns is more in wind left or wind
right where as it more on interior columns in wind end case.
iii)
Roof coefficients
Since the roof slope is greater than 5 external pressure coefficients are referred
from (Table 10)
= 17 / 10
= 1.70 m
= 17 / 4
= 17 / 2
= 4.25 m
= 8.50 m
W I N D LO A D S
Zone C (Roof)
Zone D (Roof)
= -0.60
= -0.49
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -2.212
= -1.268
= -0.674
= -0.554
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all roof
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -2.212 ( -0.419 )
= -1.268 ( -0.419)
= -0.674 ( -0.419)
= -0.554 (0.419)
= -1.792
= -0.848
= -0.254
= -0.134
Multiplying the wall and roof net pressures with the tributary area (bay spacing)
to get the load UDL in kN/m
Now we need to calculate the loads on the interior frames for wind end case,
Zone B (Walls)
= -0.547 x 7.82
= -4.28
Zone D (Roof)
= -0. 134 x 7.82
= -1.05
Wind load on end wall rafter or end frame in case main frame end for wind end
case. Taking average of end zones A and zone C
Zone A + C (Roof)
= (-1.792 - 0.254)/2
= -1.023
Zone B + C (Roof)
= (-0.848 -0.254)/2
= -0.551
Therefore, UDL on rafter in kN/m is given by multiplying with tributary area,
= -1.023 x 7.82/2
= -4.00 kN/m
= -0.551 x 7.82/2
= -2.15 kN/m
235
W I N D LO A D S
Now we need to calculate wind loads for the Secondary Panels, Purlins and Girts.
Wall Panels
The sidewall and endwall panels should be designed for the maximum load that
they may be subjected to in their zone. The zone A, B, C on sidewall and endwall
will have the same loading.
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of girts, the diagonal dimension is less than 5
meters, hence a = 5 m.
= 1.00
Therefore,
Cae
The interior size effect factor, is the same as calculated earlier,
= 0.986
Cai
External Wall coefficients (pe) are all the same as calculated in earlier,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
236
= 0.850
W I N D LO A D S
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= -0.709
= -1.843
= -1.134
= -0.709
= 0.850 (0.419)
= -0.709 (0.419)
= -1.843 (0.419)
= -1.134 (0.419)
= -0.709 (0.419)
= 1.271
= -0.289
= -1.42
= -0.92
= -0.289
Wall Girts
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of girts, the diagonal dimension (a)
= sqrt ( Girt Spacing2 + Bay Spacing2 )
= 8.01 m.
= sqrt ( 1.752 + 7.822 )
= 0.965
Therefore,
Cae
The interior size effect factor, is the same as calculated earlier,
Cai
= 0.986
External Wall coefficients (pe) are all the same as calculated in earlier,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.821
= -0.684
= -1.779
= -1.095
= -0.684
237
W I N D LO A D S
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.821 (0.419)
= -0.684 (0.419)
= -1.779 (0.419)
= -1.095 (0.419)
= -0.684 (0.419)
= 1.241
= -0.264
= -1.359
= -0.675
= -0.264
Roof Panels
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of girts, the diagonal dimension is less than 5
meters, hence a = 5 m.
= 1.00
Therefore,
Cae
The interior size effect factor, is the same as calculated earlier,
= 0.986
Cai
External Wall coefficients (pe) are all the same as calculated in earlier for Slope
1:10.
For Wind Left / Right Case
Zone A (Roof)
= -1.75
Zone B (Roof)
= -1.17
Zone C (Roof)
= -0.58
Zone E (Roof)
= -0.93
Zone F (Roof)
= -0.34
Zone G (Roof)
= -0.41
For Wind End Case
Corner
Eave
Interior
Ridge
Interior Ridge (Not Governing)
Interior (Not Governing)
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone D
Corner
Gable
End Bay
Interior (Not Governing)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.97
= -1.13
= -0.60
= -0.49
= -1.75
= -1.17
238
W I N D LO A D S
Interior
End Bay
= -0.59
= -1.29
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Corners
Eave
Interior
End Bay
= -2.48
= -1.66
= -0.84
= -1.83
= -2.48 (-0.419)
= -1.66 (-0.419)
= -0.82 (-0.419)
= -1.83 (-0.419)
= -0.172
= -1.24
= -0.42
= -1.41
Roof Purlins
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of purlins, the diagonal dimension (a)
= sqrt ( Purlin Spacing2 + Bay Spacing2 )
= 8.01 m.
= sqrt ( 1.752 + 7.822 )
Therefore,
Cae
= 0.965
The interior size effect factor, is the same as calculated earlier,
= 0.986
Cai
External Wall coefficients (pe) are all the same as calculated in earlier for Slope
1:10.
For Wind Left / Right Case
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone E
Zone F
Zone G
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.75
= -1.17
= -0.58
= -0.93
= -0.34
= -0.41
Corner
Eave Purlins
Interior Purlins
Ridge Purlins
Interior Ridge Purlins (Not Governing)
Interior Purlins (Not Governing)
239
W I N D LO A D S
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.97
= -1.13
= -0.60
= -0.49
End Bay Purlins may be taken as maximum of average of either A+C or B+C
(A+C) / 2
= -(1.97 + 0.60)/2
= -1.29 (Governs)
(B+C) / 2
= -(1.13 + 0.60)/2
= -0.87 (Not Governing)
Summarize above results,
Corner
Eave Purlins
Interior Purlins
End Bay Purlins
= -1.75
= -1.17
= -0.58
= -1.29
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Corners
Eave Purlins
Interior Purlins
End Bay Purlins
= -2.395
= -1.601
= -0.794
= -1.765
= -2.395 (0.419)
= -1.601 (0.419)
= -0.794 (0.419)
= -1.765 (0.419)
240
= -1.975
= -1.181
= -0.374
= -1.375
W I N D LO A D S
Example 3
Given:Frame Profile
Building width
Building Length
Bay Spacing
Endwall col. Spacing
Eave Height
Roof slope
Sliding doors
Sliding doors
Wall Opening
Job site
Wind pressure qs
Calculate the External wind pressure on all faces, walls and roofs.
Solution:Step 1:- Check building open condition.
Check if the building is classified under Buildings with dominant wall
openings the condition is that area of any one opening is greater than the twice
sum of area of openings in other walls Ado => 2Aso
241
W I N D LO A D S
Ado = 20 x 5 = 100.00 m2
Aso = 2 x [ 2 ( 3 x 3 ) + (2 x 2 ) ] = 44.00 m2
We see that Ado > 2Aso , hence the building classify under Buildings with
dominant wall openings
Step 2:- Refer the internal pressure coefficient
Calculate the internal volume of the building
= cross section area x length
= 333.25 x 78.2 = 26060.15 m3
Area of Opening in one Wall
Sum of Area of Opening in other walls
Ratio of Opening
Hence diagonal dimension a
= 100.00 m2
= 44.00 m2
= 100.00/44.00 = 2.27
= 0.20 x (26060.15)1/3 = 5.93 m
The internal pressure for building with dominant opening is as per Table 17 and
Since the value of Ratio of Opening (2.27 > 2 and < 3 ). It can be taken as:
Lets assume opening on windward and Cpe = 0.60 as per Table 5.
Cpi = Cpe [ ( Ratio of Opening 2) x 0.15 + 0.75 ] ( after interpolation )
Cpi = 0.60 [ ( 2.27 2.0 ) x 0.15 + 0.75 ] = 0.47
Referring to Figure 4 the building can be classified in category B and hence the
Size effect factor Cai for internal pressure = 0.986 (after interpolation)
Step 3:- Refer the external pressure coefficient
b)
D = Width = 35.5 m
j)
B = Length = 78.2 m
H = 8.5 m
Walls coefficients
or 2H = 2 x 8.5 = 17.0 m
Therefore the zones along the end wall of the building for wind left and right
cases are,
A= 0.2 b= 3.4 m, B = b-A = 17.0 -3.4= 13.6 m, C = WAB=35.53.413.6=18.5 m
242
W I N D LO A D S
Since, D / H = 35.5 / 8.5 = 4.176 > 4.00 and assuming isolated case, the external
pressure coefficients are as below, (Refer Table 5)
Windward wall
= 0.60
Leeward wall
= -0.50
Zone A (Walls)
= -1.30
Zone B (Walls)
= -0.80
Zone C (Walls)
= -0.50
Diagonal dimension a for sidewalls
= sqrt ( H2 + L2 ) = sqrt ( 8.52 + 78.22)
= 78.66 m
Therefore the size effect factor Cae = 0.794 (Refer figure 4)
Therefore the external pressure ( pe ) on walls are given as below, using equation,
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.675
= -0.563
= -1.464
= -0.901
= -0.563
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
243
W I N D LO A D S
Note that the Zones A, B, C are along the end walls; hence the end wall columns
shall be designed for the maximum of above and the values that will be obtained
for wind end case.
ii.)
Roof coefficients
Referring ( Table 10) since roof slope = 5.71 and considering the building with
sharp eaves.
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone E
Zone F
Zone G
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.75
= -1.17
= -0.59
= -0.93
= -0.34
= -0.41
244
W I N D LO A D S
= b / 10
=b/2
= 17 / 10
= 17 / 4
= 1.70 m
= 8.50 m
Note:
If the slope is greater than 5, a scaling length can be computed as:
a = sqrt [ (0.5W)2 + (0.5W x Tan )2 + L2 ]
a = sqrt [ (0.5 x 35.5)2 + (0.5 x 35.5 x Tan 5.71)2 + 78.22 ]
= 80.20 m
Therefore the size effect factor Ca = 0.792 (Refer Figure 4)
Therefore the external pressure ( pe ) on roof are given as below, using equation,
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone E
Zone F
Zone G
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.966
= -1.316
= -0.663
= -1.043
= -0.382
= -0.460
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all roof
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.966 0.657
= -1.314 0.657
= -0.663 0.657)
= -1.043 0.657
= -0.385 0.657
= -0.457 0.657
= -2.623
= -1.971
= -1.32
= -1.77
= -1.042
= -1.11
Multiplying the wall and roof net pressures with the tributary area (bay spacing)
to get the load UDL in kN/m
Calculating the loads on the interior frames, for wind left case,
Windward wall
= 0.018 x 7.82
= 0.63
Leeward wall
= -1.13 x 7.82
= -8.84
Zone B (Roof)
= -1.971 x 7.82
= -15.41
Zone C (Roof)
= -1.32 x 7.82
= -10.32
Zone F (Roof)
= -1.042 x 7.82
= -8.15 (Using higher of F and G)
Zone G (Roof)
= -1.11 x 7.82
= -8.68
245
W I N D LO A D S
Note: that wind right case will be mirror image of wind left case
Similarly, loads on the penultimate frame will be calculated as below,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone E (Roof)
Zone G (Roof)
= 0.18 x 7.82
= -1.13 x 7.82
= -2.623x 7.82
= -1.32 x 7.82
= -1.77x 7.82
= -1.11 x 7.82
= 1.4
= -8.84
= -20.51
= -10.32
= -13.29
= -8.68
246
W I N D LO A D S
Note: that wind right case will be mirror image of wind left case
Calculating the loads on the end wall rafter or end frame if end is a main frame,
for wind left case and considering half bay loads.
Zone A (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone E (Roof)
Zone G (Roof)
= -2.623 x 7.82/2
= -1.32 x 7.82/2
= -1.17 x 7.82/2
= -1.11 x 7.82/2
= -10.26
= -5.16
= -4.57
= -4.34
Loads on the end wall columns for wind left case, note that the size effect factor
Ca may be conservatively taken = 1.00 since the diagonal dimension for end wall
column is small, that is = sqrt (5.0712 + 8.52) = 9.898, referring Figure 4, Ca = 0.96
Therefore, the net pressure for end wall columns needs to be recalculated with
Cae = 1.00
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= -1.843 0.657
= -1.134 0.657
= -2.5
= -1.791
The UDL on end wall columns are obtained by multiplying with tributary area,
Corner columns
Zone A (Walls)
= -2.5 x 5.071/2
= 6.34 kN/m
Interior columns
Zone B (Walls)
= -1.791 x 5.071
= 9.08 kN/m
247
W I N D LO A D S
248
W I N D LO A D S
B = Length = 35.5 m
H = 8.5 m
Walls coefficients
or 2H = 2 x 8.5 = 17.0 m
Therefore the zones along the end wall of the building for wind left and right case
are,
A = 0.2 b = 3.4 m,
B = b-A = 13.6 m,
C = WAB = 35.53.413.6=18.5 m
Since, D / H = 78.2 / 8.5 = 9.20 > 4.00 and assuming isolated case, the external
pressure coefficients are as below,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
249
W I N D LO A D S
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls
= 0.725
= -0.604
= -1.571
= -0.967
= -0.604
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.725
= -0.604
= -1.571
= -0.967
= -0.604
0.657
0.657
0.657
0.657
0.657
= 0.068
= -1.26
= -2.23
= -1.62
= -1.26
Note: that the Zones A, B, C are along the side walls, hence the side wall columns
shall be designed for the maximum of above and the values that will be obtained
for wind left / right case.
Load on the bracing system
Windward wall
= 0.068
Leeward wall
= -1.26
Total coefficient for bracing design = 0.068 + 1.26 = 1.43
Total end wall area
= 333.25
kN/m2
kN/m2
kN/m2
m2
= 238.27 kN
= 119.14 kN
= 39.71 kN
= 476.55 kN
= 476.55 / 2
= 238.27 / 2
= 119.14 /3
In addition to above we need to add the frictional drag force on the roof and
sidewalls for Zone D, it is calculated as below,
Roof,
Length of Zone D
Area of Zone D (As)
Drag coefficients (Cf)
Total drag force
= L bw / 2
= (L bw / 2) x W
= 0.02
= qs Cf As Cae
= 78.2 17 / 2 = 69.7 m
= 69.7 x 35.5 = 2474.35 m2
Wall,
Length of Zone C
=Lb
= 78.2 17.0
250
W I N D LO A D S
= 61.2 x 8.5
= 59.78 + 12.56
= 36.17 kN
= 520.2 m2
44.4
44.4
105.06+18.09
5.67+18.09
WIND DIRECTION
= 39.71 + 36.17/3
= 51.77 kN
The end wall columns will be governed by the wind ward coefficient, but as
before the size effect factor may be conservatively taken as 1.00, hence we
need to recalculate the net pressure using Cae = 1.00
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
= 0.850
= -0.709
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.850 0.657
= -0.709 0.657
Corner columns
All interior columns
= 1.37 x 5.071/2
= 1.37 x 5.071
We see that the load on the end wall corner columns is more in wind left or wind
right where as it more on interior columns in wind end case.
iiii)
Roof coefficients
251
W I N D LO A D S
Since the roof slope is greater than 5 external pressure coefficients are referred
from (Table 10)
= 17 / 10
= 17 / 4
= 17 / 2
= 1.70 m
= 4.25 m
= 8.50 m
W I N D LO A D S
Zone B (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone D (Roof)
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all roof
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -2.212 0.657
= -1.268 0.657
= -0.674 0.657
= -0.554 0.657
= -2.87
= -1.93
= -1.33
= -1.211
Multiplying the wall and roof net pressures with the tributary area (bay spacing)
to get the load UDL in kN/m
Now we need to calculate the loads on the interior frames for wind end case,
Zone B (Walls)
= -1.62 x 7.82
= -12.67
Zone D (Roof)
= -0. 134 x 7.82
= -9.47
Wind load on end wall rafter or end frame in case main frame end for wind end
case. Taking average of end zones A and zone C
Zone A + C (Roof)
= (-2.87 1.33)/2
= -2.1
Zone B + C (Roof)
= (-1.93 -1.33)/2
= -1.63
Therefore, UDL on rafter in kN/m is given by multiplying with tributary area,
= -2.1 x 7.82/2
= -8.21 kN/m
= -1.63 x 7.82/2
= -6.37 kN/m
253
W I N D LO A D S
Now we need to calculate wind loads for the Secondary Panels, Purlins and Girts.
Wall Panels
The sidewall and endwall panels should be designed for the maximum load that
they may be subjected to in their zone. The zone A, B, C on sidewall and endwall
will have the same loading.
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of girts, the diagonal dimension is less than 5
meters, hence a = 5 m.
= 1.00
Therefore,
Cae
The interior size effect factor, is the same as calculated earlier,
= 0.986
Cai
External Wall coefficients (pe) are all the same as calculated in earlier,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
254
= 0.850
W I N D LO A D S
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= -0.709
= -1.843
= -1.134
= -0.709
Wall Girts
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of girts, the diagonal dimension (a)
= sqrt ( Girt Spacing2 + Bay Spacing2 )
= 8.01 m.
= sqrt ( 1.752 + 7.822 )
= 0.965
Therefore,
Cae
The interior size effect factor, is the same as calculated earlier,
Cai
= 0.986
External Wall coefficients (pe) are all the same as calculated in earlier,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.821
= -0.684
= -1.779
= -1.095
= -0.684
255
W I N D LO A D S
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.821 - 0.657
= -0.684 - 0.657
= -1.779 - 0.657
= -1.095 - 0.657
= -0.684 - 0.657
= 0.16
= -1.34
= -2.44
= -1.75
= -1.34
Roof Panels
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of girts, the diagonal dimension is less than 5
meters, hence a = 5 m.
= 1.00
Therefore,
Cae
The interior size effect factor, is the same as calculated earlier,
= 0.986
Cai
External Wall coefficients (pe) are all the same as calculated in earlier for Slope
1:10.
For Wind Left / Right Case
Zone A (Roof)
= -1.75
Zone B (Roof)
= -1.17
Zone C (Roof)
= -0.58
Zone E (Roof)
= -0.93
Zone F (Roof)
= -0.34
Zone G (Roof)
= -0.41
For Wind End Case
Corner
Eave
Interior
Ridge
Interior Ridge (Not Governing)
Interior (Not Governing)
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone D
Corner
Gable
End Bay
Interior (Not Governing)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.97
= -1.13
= -0.60
= -0.49
= -1.75
= -1.17
256
W I N D LO A D S
Interior
End Bay
= -0.59
= -1.29
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Corners
Eave
Interior
End Bay
= -2.48
= -1.66
= -0.84
= -1.83
= -2.48 0.657
= -1.66 0.657
= -0.82 0.657
= -1.83 0.657
= -3.14
= -2.32
= -1.42
= -2.49
Roof Purlins
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of purlins, the diagonal dimension (a)
= sqrt ( Purlin Spacing2 + Bay Spacing2 )
= 8.01 m.
= sqrt ( 1.752 + 7.822 )
Therefore,
Cae
= 0.965
The interior size effect factor, is the same as calculated earlier,
= 0.986
Cai
External Wall coefficients (pe) are all the same as calculated in earlier for Slope
1:10.
For Wind Left / Right Case
Zone A (Roof)
= -1.75
Zone B (Roof)
= -1.17
Zone C (Roof)
= -0.58
Zone E (Roof)
= -0.93
Zone F (Roof)
= -0.34
Zone G (Roof)
= -0.41
Corner
Eave Purlins
Interior Purlins
Ridge Purlins
Interior Ridge Purlins (Not Governing)
Interior Purlins (Not Governing)
= -1.97
= -1.13
257
W I N D LO A D S
Zone C (Roof)
Zone D (Roof)
= -0.60
= -0.49
End Bay Purlins may be taken as maximum of average of either A+C or B+C
(A+C) / 2
= -(1.97 + 0.60)/2
= -1.29 (Governs)
(B+C) / 2
= -(1.13 + 0.60)/2
= -0.87 (Not Governing)
Summarize above results,
Corner
Eave Purlins
Interior Purlins
End Bay Purlins
= -1.75
= -1.17
= -0.58
= -1.29
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Corners
Eave Purlins
Interior Purlins
End Bay Purlins
= -2.395
= -1.601
= -0.794
= -1.765
= -2.395 0.657
= -1.601 0.657
= -0.794 0.657
= -1.765 0.657
= -3.05
= -2.23
= -1.45
= -2.42
Continuation:
Now lets assume opening on Leeward and Cpe = -0.50 as per Table 5.
Cpi = Cpe [ ( Ratio of Opening 2) x 0.15 + 0.75 ] ( after interpolation )
Cpi = -0.50 [ ( 2.27 2.0 ) x 0.15 + 0.75 ] = -0.39
Referring to Figure 4 the building can be classified in category B and hence the
Size effect factor Cai for internal pressure = 0.986 (after interpolation)
Step 3:- Refer the external pressure coefficient
258
W I N D LO A D S
B = Length = 78.2 m
H = 8.5 m
B. Walls coefficients
Scaling length b = minimum of B=W=78.2 m
or 2H = 2 x 8.5 = 17.0 m
Therefore the zones along the end wall of the building for wind left and right
cases are,
A= 0.2 b= 3.4 m, B = b-A = 17.0 -3.4= 13.6 m, C = WAB=35.53.413.6=18.5 m
Since, D / H = 35.5 / 8.5 = 4.176 > 4.00 and assuming isolated case, the external
pressure coefficients are as below, (Refer Table 5)
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
W I N D LO A D S
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.675
= -0.563
= -1.464
= -0.901
= -0.563
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.675 (-0.545)
= -0.563 (-0.545)
= -1.464 (-0.545)
= -0.901 (-0.545)
= -0.563 (-0.545)
= 1.22
= -0.018
= -0.919
= -0.356
= -0.018
Note that the Zones A, B, C are along the end walls; hence the end wall columns
shall be designed for the maximum of above and the values that will be obtained
for wind end case.
C.)
Roof coefficients
Referring ( Table 10) since roof slope = 5.71 and considering the building with
sharp eaves.
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone E
Zone F
Zone G
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.75
= -1.17
= -0.59
= -0.93
= -0.34
= -0.41
260
W I N D LO A D S
= b / 10
=b/2
= 17 / 10
= 17 / 4
= 1.70 m
= 8.50 m
Note:
If the slope is greater than 5, a scaling length can be computed as:
a = sqrt [ (0.5W)2 + (0.5W x Tan )2 + L2 ]
a = sqrt [ (0.5 x 35.5)2 + (0.5 x 35.5 x Tan 5.71)2 + 78.22 ]
= 80.20 m
Therefore the size effect factor Ca = 0.792 (Refer Figure 4)
Therefore the external pressure ( pe ) on roof are given as below, using equation,
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone E
Zone F
Zone G
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.966
= -1.316
= -0.663
= -1.042
= -0.382
= -0.460
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all roof
W I N D LO A D S
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone E
Zone F
Zone G
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.966 (-0.545)
= -1.314 (-0.545)
= -0.663 (-0.545)
= 1.043 (-0.545)
= -0.385 (-0.545)
= -0.457 (-0.545)
= -1.421
= -0.769
= -0.118
= -0.498
= 0.16
= 0.88
Multiplying the wall and roof net pressures with the tributary area (bay spacing)
to get the load UDL in kN/m
Calculating the loads on the interior frames, for wind left case,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone B (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone F (Roof)
Zone G (Roof)
= 1.22 x 7.82
= -0.018 x 7.82
= -0.769 x 7.82
= -0.118 x 7.82
= 0.16 x 7.82
= 0.088x 7.82
= 9.54
= -0.14
= -6.01
= -0.92
= 1.25 (Using higher of F and G)
= 0.69
Note: that wind right case will be mirror image of wind left case
Similarly, loads on the penultimate frame will be calculated as below,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone E (Roof)
Zone G (Roof)
= 1.22 x 7.82
= -0.018 x 7.82
= -1.421x 7.82
= -1.118 x 7.82
= -0.498 x 7.82
= 0.088 x 7.82
= 9.54
= -0.14
= -11.11
= -0.92
= -3.89
= 0.69
262
W I N D LO A D S
Note: that wind right case will be mirror image of wind left case
Calculating the loads on the end wall rafter or end frame if end is a main frame,
for wind left case and considering half bay loads.
Zone A (Roof)
Zone C (Roof)
Zone E (Roof)
Zone G (Roof)
= -1.421 x 7.82/2
= -0.118 x 7.82/2
= -0.498 x 7.82/2
= -0.88 x 7.82/2
= -5.56
= -0.46
= -1.95
= -0.344
Loads on the end wall columns for wind left case, note that the size effect factor
Ca may be conservatively taken = 1.00 since the diagonal dimension for end wall
column is small, that is = sqrt (5.0712 + 8.52) = 9.898, referring Figure 4, Ca = 0.96
Therefore, the net pressure for end wall columns needs to be recalculated with Cae =
1.00
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
263
W I N D LO A D S
all walls
= -1.843 (-0.545)
= -1.134 (-0.545)
= -1.298
= -0.589
The UDL on end wall columns are obtained by multiplying with tributary area,
Corner columns
Zone A (Walls)
= -1.298 x 5.071/2
= -3.29 kN/m
Interior columns
Zone B (Walls)
= -0.589 x 5.071
= -2.98 kN/m
264
W I N D LO A D S
= 1.77 kN
B = Length = 35.5 m
H = 8.5 m
Walls coefficients
or 2H = 2 x 8.5 = 17.0 m
Therefore the zones along the end wall of the building for wind left and right case
are,
A = 0.2 b = 3.4 m,
B = b-A = 13.6 m,
C = WAB = 35.53.413.6=18.5 m
Since, D / H = 78.2 / 8.5 = 9.20 > 4.00 and assuming isolated case, the external
pressure coefficients are as below,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
265
W I N D LO A D S
= 0.725
= -0.604
= -1.571
= -0.967
= -0.604
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.725 (-0.545)
266
= 1.27
W I N D LO A D S
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= -0.604
= -1.571
= -0.967
= -0.604
(-0.545)
(-0.545)
(-0.545)
(-0.545)
= -0.059
= -1.026
= -0.42
= -0.059
Note: that the Zones A, B, C are along the side walls, hence the side wall columns
shall be designed for the maximum of above and the values that will be obtained
for wind left / right case.
Load on the bracing system
Windward wall
= 1.27
Leeward wall
= -0.059
Total coefficient for bracing design = 1.27 + 0.059 = 1.33
Total end wall area
= 333.25
kN/m2
kN/m2
kN/m2
m2
= 221.61 kN
= 110.81 kN
= 36.93 kN
= 443.22 kN
= 443.22 / 2
= 221.61 / 2
= 110.81 /3
In addition to above we need to add the frictional drag force on the roof and
sidewalls for Zone D, it is calculated as below,
Roof,
Length of Zone D
Area of Zone D (As)
Drag coefficients (Cf)
Total drag force
= L bw / 2
= (L bw / 2) x W
= 0.02
= qs Cf As Cae
= 78.2 17 / 2 = 69.7 m
= 69.7 x 35.5 = 2474.35 m2
Wall,
Length of Zone C
Area of Zone C (As)
Drag coefficients (Cf)
Total drag force
=Lb
= (L b) x H
= 0.02
= qs Cf As Cae
= 78.2 17.0
= 61.2 x 8.5
= 59.78 + 12.56
= 72.34 kN
= 36.17 kN
= 36.93 + 36.17/3
= 48.99 Kn
267
W I N D LO A D S
44.4
44.4
4.92+18.09
105.81+18.09
WIND DIRECTION
The end wall columns will be governed by the wind ward coefficient, but as before
the size effect factor may be conservatively taken as 1.00, hence we need to
recalculate the net pressure using Cae = 1.00
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
= 0.850
= -0.709
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all walls
= 0.850 (-0.545)
= -0.709 (-0.545)
= 1.395
= -0.164 (Will not control)
Corner columns
All interior columns
= 1.395 x 5.071/2
= 1.395 x 5.071
We see that the load on the end wall corner columns is more in wind left or wind
right where as it more on interior columns in wind end case.
ivi)
Roof coefficients
Since the roof slope is greater than 5 external pressure coefficients are referred
from (Table 10)
268
W I N D LO A D S
= 17 / 10
= 17 / 4
= 17 / 2
= 1.70 m
= 4.25 m
= 8.50 m
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -2.212
= -1.268
= -0.674
= -0.554
Similarly, the internal pressure ( pi ) on all walls is given as below, using equation,
269
W I N D LO A D S
pi = qs Cpi Cai
all roof
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -2.212 (-0.545)
= -1.268 (-0.545)
= -0.674 (-0.545)
= -0.554 (-0.545)
= -1.67
= -0.72
= -0.129
= -0.009
Multiplying the wall and roof net pressures with the tributary area (bay spacing)
to get the load UDL in kN/m
Now we need to calculate the loads on the interior frames for wind end case,
Zone B (Walls)
= -0.42 x 7.82
= -3.28
Zone D (Roof)
= -0. 009 x 7.82
= -0.70
Wind load on end wall rafter or end frame in case main frame end for wind end
case. Taking average of end zones A and zone C
Zone A + C (Roof)
Zone B + C (Roof)
= (-1.67 0 .129)/2
= (-0.72 -0.129)/2
= -0.90
= -0.42
= -3.52 kN/m
= -1.64 kN/m
270
W I N D LO A D S
Now we need to calculate wind loads for the Secondary Panels, Purlins and Girts.
Wall Panels
The sidewall and endwall panels should be designed for the maximum load that
they may be subjected to in their zone. The zone A, B, C on sidewall and endwall
will have the same loading.
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of girts, the diagonal dimension is less than 5
meters, hence a = 5 m.
= 1.00
Therefore,
Cae
The interior size effect factor, is the same as calculated earlier,
Cai
= 0.986
External Wall coefficients (pe) are all the same as calculated in earlier,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.850
= -0.709
= -1.843
= -1.134
= -0.709
= 0.850 (-0.545)
= -0.709 (-0.545)
= -1.843 (-0.545)
= -1.134 (-0.545)
= -0.709 (-0.545)
271
= 1.395
= -0.164
= -1.298
= -0.589
= -1.164
W I N D LO A D S
Wall Girts
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of girts, the diagonal dimension (a)
= sqrt ( Girt Spacing2 + Bay Spacing2 )
= 8.01 m.
= sqrt ( 1.752 + 7.822 )
= 0.965
Therefore,
Cae
The interior size effect factor, is the same as calculated earlier,
Cai
= 0.986
External Wall coefficients (pe) are all the same as calculated in earlier,
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.60
= -0.50
= -1.30
= -0.80
= -0.50
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Windward wall
Leeward wall
Zone A (Walls)
Zone B (Walls)
Zone C (Walls)
= 0.821
= -0.684
= -1.779
= -1.095
= -0.684
= 0.821 (-0.545)
= -0.684 - (-0.545)
= -1.779 - (-0.545)
= -1.095 - (-0.545)
= -0.684 - (-0.545)
= -1.366
= -0.139
= -1.234
= -0.55
= -0.139
Roof Panels
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of girts, the diagonal dimension is less than 5
meters, hence a = 5 m.
= 1.00
Therefore,
Cae
272
W I N D LO A D S
Corner
Eave
Interior
Ridge
Interior Ridge (Not Governing)
Interior (Not Governing)
Zone A
Zone B
Zone C
Zone D
Corner
Gable
End Bay
Interior (Not Governing)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.97
= -1.13
= -0.60
= -0.49
= -1.75
= -1.17
= -0.59
= -1.29
pe = qs Cpe Cae
Corners
Eave
Interior
End Bay
= -2.48
= -1.66
= -0.84
= -1.83
273
W I N D LO A D S
Corner
Eave
Interior
End Bay
= -2.48 (-0.545)
= -1.66 (-0.545)
= -0.82 (-0.545)
= -1.83 (-0.545)
= -1.94
= -1.12
= -0.285
= -1.29
Roof Purlins
Assuming 1.75 meter spacing of purlins, the diagonal dimension (a)
= sqrt ( Purlin Spacing2 + Bay Spacing2 )
= 8.01 m.
= sqrt ( 1.752 + 7.822 )
Therefore,
Cae
= 0.965
Corner
Eave Purlins
Interior Purlins
Ridge Purlins
Interior Ridge Purlins (Not Governing)
Interior Purlins (Not Governing)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
(Roof)
= -1.97
= -1.13
= -0.60
= -0.49
End Bay Purlins may be taken as maximum of average of either A+C or B+C
(A+C) / 2
= -(1.97 + 0.60)/2
= -1.29 (Governs)
(B+C) / 2
= -(1.13 + 0.60)/2
= -0.87 (Not Governing)
Summarize above results,
Corner
Eave Purlins
Interior Purlins
End Bay Purlins
= -1.75
= -1.17
= -0.58
= -1.29
pe = qs Cpe Cae
274
W I N D LO A D S
Corners
Eave Purlins
Interior Purlins
End Bay Purlins
= -2.395
= -1.601
= -0.794
= -1.765
= -2.395 (-0.545)
= -1.601 (-0.545)
= -0.794 (-0.545)
= -1.765 (-0.545)
275
= -1.85
= -1.056
= -0.249
= -1.22
S E I S M I C
Chapter
L O A D S
Seismic Loads
AISC 2005
Seismic Design
Manual
efinition
Generally, seismic force resisting systems are classified into three levels of
performance, designated as, Ordinary, Intermediate or Special,
depending on the level of ductility that the system is expected to provide.
Also, structures not specifically designed or detailed for seismic resistance by the
Seismic Provisions are referred to as Low Seismic Structures
It is important to note, however that even low seismic steel structures possess some
inherent amount of seismic resistance, which may be adequate to resist a limited
amount of seismic demand. Structures with Response Modification Factor (R) <= 3
may be classified as low seismic structures.
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Acceleration
The figure below (Typical Acceleration Spectrum) shows that most of the
earthquake accelerations (and hence the energy imparted to the structure) fall in
a natural period range of 0.2 seconds to 1.0 second, thus structures with natural
periods in this range will collect more energy than structures with periods
outside this range. A typical 2 storey building has a period near 0.2 seconds, and
the period for a 10-storey building is approximately 10 seconds. Since these
frequencies are in the portion of the spectrum that contains most of the
earthquake energy, buildings with 10 stories and less tend to feel the earthquake
more than taller structures. Low rise buildings also tend to be stiff and tall
structures tend to be flexible. A short (generally less than 10 stories) stiff structure
tends to attract a larger percentage of a displacement induced force than a
flexible structure. For these two reasons, earthquake induced forces in stiff
structures tend to be a larger percentage of the structures weight than those in
flexible taller structures. Tall flexible structures generally experience a greater
total deflection (drift).
Ground motion
0.2 Sec
1.0 Sec
Period, T
Ground motion
Stiff structure
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Groundmotion
Groundmotion
Flexiblestructure
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Seismic Force on the structure result from the lateral acceleration due to the
earthquake ground motion, essentially as a function of,
F=ma. (Force = Mass x acceleration), The seismic force resisting system is
designed to resist the induced forces and dissipate the energy causing the
acceleration of the structure.
ASCE 7 describes six procedures for determining the distortions and forces in
structures subject to earthquake ground motion. These are listed below in order
of increasing calculation difficulty and expected accuracy.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
The index force and simplified analysis procedures are alternate methods that
have limited application and must be approved by the authority having
jurisdiction. The remaining methods account for dissipation of earthquake input
energy by inelastic distortion of the structure.
The Equivalent Lateral Force (ELF) procedure and the modal analysis procedure
involve linear elastic analysis that use earthquake effects adjusted to account for
expected inelastic behavior of the structure. Both are approximate methods of
analysis useful within the limitations on their applicability (see FEMA 369). The
last two methods Pushover analysis & inelastic response history analysis are
generally not required except in high seismic risk situations.
According to ASCE 7, the Equivalent Lateral Force method is permitted for all
structures, except those subjected to the most severe earthquake conditions, and
the modal analysis is permitted for all structures. Both analysis use four
important seismic parameters,
1. Response modification factors (R)
2. The over strength factor (W o )
3. The deflection amplification factor (C d )
4. The reliability / redundancy factor ()
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Bucking
Yielding
Nominal Elastic
Elements
Nominal Elastic
Elements
Yielding
Yielding
Ductile EBF
Nominal
Elastic
Elements
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
S E I S M I C
MBMA 86
Section 7.0
L O A D S
MBMA 1986
Required Design Data
1. Seismic Zone
a. Range
b. Default
= 0,1, 2, 3 & 4
= 2 (unless specified in the PIF)
Eqn. 7.1
(V)
0.14 Z K W
Where,
K
W
=
=
=
Note:- Allowable stresses may be increased 33% for wind and seismic.
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 6.1
Given Data:Building Use
Roof Dead Load
Roof Collateral Load
Wall Dead Load
Eave Height
Frame Type
Width
Bay Spacing
Length
Roof Slope
Peak Height
Symmetry
Frame weight
Endwall Weight
Seismic Zone
= Warehouse
= 0.10 kN/m2
= 0.20 kN/m2
= 0.10 kN/m2
= 7550 mm
= Clear Span
= 32500 mm
= 8 @ 7660 mm
= 61280 mm
= 0.5:10 ( = 2.862 )
= 8362 mm
= about ridge
= 25 kN (approx.)
= 18 kN (approx.)
=3
Solution:The two Seismic Force Resisting System in Metal buildings are, Main Rigid
Frames in the transverse direction and the Cross Bracing or Portal Frames in
the longitudinal direction.
1) Calculate the total weight W of structure in transverse direction,
Roof Dead weight
Collateral weight
Wall Dead weight
Frame weight
Total Weight W
10
= 11.08 kN
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
The total base shear is applied on the frame at left and right side eave points, and
two cases are checked, as shown below. For a multi-span the loads are
distributed depending upon interior column top and bottom connection.
V
2
V
2
CLEAR SPAN
CASE-1 (AS SHOWN)
CASE-2 (FORCES IN OPPOSITE DIRECTION)
V
PINNED TOP
PINNED BASE
V
2
V
2
MULTI-SPAN
CASE-1 (AS SHOWN)
CASE-2 (FORCES IN OPPOSITE DIRECTION)
V
FIXED TOP
V
3
PINNED OR FIXED
BASE
V
3
MULTI-SPAN
CASE-1 (AS SHOWN)
CASE-2 (FORCES IN OPPOSITE DIRECTION)
11
V
3
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 747 kN
= 312 kN
= 1059 kN
= 1164.5 kN
Therefore,
V
= 122 kN
V1
= (W 1 h 1 / W h ) x V
= [ 1059 x 3.5 / ( 1059 x 3.5 + 105.5 x 7.55 )] x 122
= 100.4 kN
V2
= (W 2 h 2 / W h ) x V
= [ 105.5 x 7.55 / ( 1059 x 3.5 + 105.5 x 7.55 )] x 122
= 21.6 kN
Now to calculate the Longitudinal Base shear, we need to calculate the total
building weight, assuming the structure with mezzanine,
Total roof dead weight,
= unit weight x width x length
= 0.10 x 32.5 x 61.28
= 199.16 kN
Total roof collateral weight,
= 0.20 x 32.5 x 61.28
= 398.32 kN
Total sidewall dead weight,
= unit weight x length x eave height x 2 / 2
= 0.10 x 61.28 x 7.55 x 2 / 2
= 46.27 kN
Total end wall weight = unit weight x width x (eave height + peak height) / 2
= 0.10 x 32.5 x (7.55 + 8.36) / 2
= 25.85 kN
12
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
V2
V1
V1+V2
2
V1+V2
2
CLEAR SPAN
CASE-1 (AS SHOWN)
CASE-2 (FORCES IN OPPOSITE DIRECTION)
V2
PINNED
V1
PINNED BASE
V1+V2
2
V1+V2
2
CLEAR SPAN
CASE-1 (AS SHOWN)
CASE-2 (FORCES IN OPPOSITE DIRECTION)
V2
FIXED TOP
V1
PINNED BASE
V1 V2
+
4
2
V1
4
V1
4
V1
4
CLEAR SPAN
CASE-1 (AS SHOWN)
CASE-2 (FORCES IN OPPOSITE DIRECTION)
13
V1 V2
+
4
2
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 175.0 kN
= 36.00 kN
= 880.60 kN
= 5974.8 kN
= 2489.5 kN
= 8464.3 kN
= 9344.9 kN
= 981 kN
= 490 kN
Now distributing this force along the sidewall to mezzanine and eave level
V1
= (W 1 h 1 / W h ) x V
= [ 8464.3 x 3.5 / ( 8464.3 x 3.5 + 880.6 x 7.55 )] x 490
= 400 kN
V2
= (W 2 h 2 / W h ) x V
= [ 880.6 x 7.55 / ( 8464.3 x 3.5 + 880.6 x 7.55)] x 490
= 90 kN
V2
V1
V1+V2
3
V1+V2
3
SIDEWALL ELEVATION
V1+V2
3
14
S E I S M I C
MBMA 96
Section 7.0
L O A D S
MBMA 1996
Required Design Data
1. Peak Velocity Acceleration Coefficient (A v )
a. Range
= A v < 0.05 to 0.40
b. Default
= 0.20 (Unless specified in PIF)
2. Peak Acceleration (A a )
a. Range
b. Default
Aa
Ca
0.049
= Aa
0.05
0.08
0.10
0.16
0.20
0.28
0.30
0.36
0.40
0.44
2.5 C a / R
Eqn. 7.1
Cs W
Where,
W
=
(V)
(R=4.5)
(R=4.5)
(R=5.0)
Total dead load including collateral loads and partition etc. (kN)
25% of the floor live load in storage occupancies.
20% of snow load, if greater than 1.44 kN/m2.
33% increase in stresses is not allowed for seismic.
15
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Example :- 6.2
Using the building data from Example 6.1, other seismic data as below,
Peak Velocity Acceleration Coefficient (A v ) = 0.15
= 0.15
Peak Acceleration (A a )
= 0.22 (Interpolated)
Therefore from Table 7.4.1.1, C a
Building use category
= II
Importance Factor
= 1.00
Calculating the base shear in transverse direction, from example 6.1, without
considering mezzanine we know the total weight W,
= 105.5 kN
Seismic Design Coefficient ( C s )
= 2.5 C a / R
= 2.5 x 0.222 / 4.5
(R=4.5 for Rigid Frames)
= 0.123
Seismic Base Shear ( V )
= Cs W
= 0.123 x 105.5
= 13.01 kN
Now if we consider the mezzanine, we know that,
Total weight W 1 at mezzanine level h 1 = 3.5 m,
= 747 + 312
= 1059 kN
= 105.5 + 1059
= 1164 kN
= 0.123 x 1164
= 144 kN
V1
= (W 1 h 1 / W h ) x V
= [ 1059 x 3.5 / ( 1059 x 3.5 + 105.5 x 7.55 )] x 144
= 119 kN
V2
= (W 2 h 2 / W h ) x V
= [ 105.5 x 7.55 / ( 1059 x 3.5 + 105.5 x 7.55 )] x 144
= 25 kN
Therefore,
16
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 8464.3 kN
= 880.60 kN
= 9345 kN
= 1037 kN
= 519 kN
Now distributing this force along the sidewall to mezzanine and eave level
V1
= (W 1 h 1 / W h ) x V
= [ 8464.3 x 3.5 / ( 8464.3 x 3.5 + 880.60 x 7.55 )] x 519
= 424 kN
V2
= (W 2 h 2 / W h ) x V
= [ 880.60 x 7.55 / ( 8464.3 x 3.5 + 880.60 x 7.55)] x 519
= 95 kN
17
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
UBC 1997
UBC 1997
Section 1626
= 1, 2A, 2B, 3, 4
= 2B
Soil Profile
A
B
C
D
E
F
= 0.28
18
Z=4
0.32 N a
0.40 N a
0.40 N a
0.44 N a
0.36 N a
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
3 Ca W / R
Where,
W
= Total dead load including collateral loads and partition etc. (kN)
25% of the floor live load in storage and warehouses occupancies.
25% of snow load, if greater than 1.44 kN/m2.
Minimum of 0.48 kN/m2 if partitions are present.
Note:- 33% increase in stresses is not allowed for seismic.
(For other methods of calculating Seismic Base Shear see UBC 1997)
Structures shall be designed for seismic ground motion and forces in any
horizontal direction, the following Seismic load shall be used in the load
combinations,
Eqn. 30.1
= r Eh + Ev
Eqn. 30.2
Em
= o Eh
Where,
E
= the earthquake load on an element of the structure resulting from the
combination of horizontal component E h and vertical component E v .
= the earthquake load due to base shear, V.
Eh
= may be taken as zero (0) for ASD.
Ev
o
= the seismic force amplification factor, required for structural over
strength. (Default = 2.8, minimum = 2, see UBC 97 Table 16-N)
r
= Reliability / Redundancy factor. (Min. = 1.0, Max. =1.5)
19
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Example :- 6.3
Using the building data from Example 6.1, other seismic data as below,
Seismic Zone
= 2A
Therefore, Seismic Zone Factor Z
= 0.15 (Refer Table 16-I)
Soil Profile type
=C
Therefore, Seismic Coefficient C a
= 0.18 (Refer Table 16-Q)
Considering the building without mezzanine, we know W = 105.5 kN
Seismic Base Shear ( V )
= 3 Ca W / R
= 3 x 0.18 x 105.5 / 4.5 (R=4.5 for Rigid Frames)
= 12.66 kN
In order to use these load in combination with other loads, we need to consider
E as in equation 30.1 above, say the load combination as per UBC 97 is as below
0.9D E / 1.4
Eqn. 12-10
E
E
E
= r Eh + Ev
= 1.00 x V + 0
=V
= o Eh
= 2.8 V
o = 2.80
So when we are designing the frames we should use E=V for all load
combinations with seismic loads, and for the connection design for any load
combination with seismic loads, use E = E m = 2.8 V in the same combination.
Therefore the above load combination for frame design will be,
0.9D ( V / 1.4 )
Therefore the above load combination for connection design will be,
0.9D (2.8 V / 1.4 )
= 0.9D 2 V
20
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 1059 kN
= 1165 kN
Therefore,
V
= 140 kN
V1
= (W 1 h 1 / W h ) x V
= [ 1059 x 3.5 / ( 1059 x 3.5 + 105.5 x 7.55 )] x 140
= 115 kN
V2
= (W 2 h 2 / W h ) x V
= [ 105.5 x 7.55 / ( 1059 x 3.5 + 105.5 x 7.55 )] x 140
= 25 kN
In order to use these load in combination with other loads, we need to consider
E as in equation 30.1 above, say the load combination as per UBC 97 is as below
0.9D E / 1.4
E
E
E
Eqn. 12-10
= r Eh + Ev
= 1.50 x V + 0
= 1.5 V
Therefore the above load combination for frame design will be,
0.9D ( 1.5 V / 1.4 )
= 0.9D 1.07 V
= 0.9D 2 V
21
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 8464.3 kN
= 880.60 kN
= 9345 kN
= 3 Ca W / R
= 3 x 0.18 x 9345 / 5.6
= 901 kN
= 450 kN
Now distributing this force along the sidewall to mezzanine and eave level
V1
= (W 1 h 1 / W h ) x V
= [ 8464.3 x 3.5 / ( 8464.3 x 3.5 + 880.60 x 7.55 )] x 450
= 367.52 kN
V2
= (W 2 h 2 / W h ) x V
= [ 880.60 x 7.55 / ( 8464.3 x 3.5 + 880.60 x 7.55)] x 450
= 82.48 kN
The load combination for bracing member design with mezzanine will be,
0.9D ( V / 1.4 )
= 0.9D V
The load combination for bracing member design without mezzanine will be,
0.9D ( 1.5 V / 1.4 )
= 0.9D 1.07 V
The load combination for bracing connection design with or without mezzanine
will be,
0.9D (2.8 V / 1.4 )
= 0.9D 2 V
22
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Eqn. 30-8
= C t h n 3/4
Eqn. 30-4
= CV I W / R T
Eqn. 30-5
Eqn. 30-6
Eqn. 30-7
Soil Profile
A
B
C
D
E
F
23
Z=4
0.32 N a
0.40 N a
0.56 N a
0.64 N a
0.96 N a
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Example :- 6.4
Using the building data from Example 6.1, other seismic data as below,
Seismic Zone
= 2A
Therefore, Seismic Zone Factor Z
= 0.15 (Refer Table 16-I)
Soil Profile type
=C
Therefore, Seismic Coefficient C a
= 0.18 (Refer Table 16-Q)
= 0.25 (Refer Table 16-R)
Therefore, Seismic Coefficient C v
Considering the building without mezzanine, we know W = 105.5 kN
Calculate Structure Period (T) = C t h n 3/4
= 0.387
= 0.085 x 7.553/4
(R=4.5 for Rigid Frames)
Seismic Base Shear ( V )
= CV I W / R T
= 0.25 x 1.00 x 105.5 / (4.5 x 0.387)
= 15.15 kN
Maximum Base Shear (V max ) = 2.5 C a I W / R
= 2.5 x 0.18 x 1.00 x 105.5 / 4.5
= 10.55 kN
Minimum Base Shear (V min ) = 0.11 C a I W
= 0.11 x 0.18 x 1.00 x 105.5
= 2.09 kN
Therefore Seismic Base Shear = 10.55 kN
In order to use these load in combination with other loads, we need to consider
E as in equation 30.1 above, say the load combination as per UBC 97 is as below
0.9D E / 1.4
Eqn. 12-10
E
E
E
= r Eh + Ev
= 1.00 x V + 0
=V
= o Eh
= 2.8 V
o = 2.80
So when we are designing the frames we should use E=V for all load
combinations with seismic loads, and for the connection design for any load
combination with seismic loads, use E = E m = 2.8 V in the same combination.
Therefore the above load combination for frame design will be,
0.9D ( V / 1.4 )
Therefore the above load combination for connection design will be,
0.9D (2.8 V / 1.4 )
= 0.9D 2 V
24
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 1059 kN
= 1165 kN
Therefore,
V
= CV I W / R T
(R=4.5 for Rigid Frames)
= 0.25 x 1.00 x 1165 / (4.5 x 0.387)
= 167.2 kN
Maximum Base Shear (V max ) = 2.5 C a I W / R
= 2.5 x 0.18 x 1.00 x 1165 / 4.5
= 116.5 kN
Minimum Base Shear (V min ) = 0.11 C a I W
= 0.11 x 0.18 x 1.00 x 1165
= 23.06 kN
Therefore Seismic Base Shear = 116.5 kN
V1
= (W 1 h 1 / W h ) x V
= [ 1059 x 3.5 / ( 1059 x 3.5 + 105.5 x 7.55 )] x 117
= 96 kN
V2
= (W 2 h 2 / W h ) x V
= [ 105.5 x 7.55 / ( 1059 x 3.5 + 105.5 x 7.55 )] x 117
= 21 kN
In order to use these load in combination with other loads, we need to consider
E as in equation 30.1 above, say the load combination as per UBC 97 is as below
0.9D E / 1.4
E
E
E
Eqn. 12-10
= r Eh + Ev
= 1.50 x V + 0
= 1.5 V
Therefore the above load combination for frame design will be,
0.9D ( 1.5 V / 1.4 ) = 0.9D 1.07 V
For connection design it is the same as above,
0.9D (2.8 V / 1.4 )
= 0.9D 2 V
25
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 8464.3 kN
= 9345 kN
= 1078 kN
= 751 kN
= 185 kN
= (W 1 h 1 / W h ) x V
= [ 8464.3 x 3.5/( 8464.3 x 3.5+880.60 x 7.55 )] x 376
= 310 kN
V2
= (W 2 h 2 / W h ) x V
= [ 880.60 x 7.55/( 8464.3 x 3.5+880.60 x 7.55)] x 376
= 66 kN
The load combination for bracing member design without mezzanine will be,
0.9D ( V / 1.4 )
= 0.9D V
The load combination for bracing member design without mezzanine will be,
0.9D ( 1.5 V / 1.4 ) = 0.9D 1.07 V
The load combination for bracing connection design with or without mezzanine
will be,
0.9D (2.8 V / 1.4 )
= 0.9D 2 V
26
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
7-98
Table 9.4.1.2
7-98
3. Site Class
a. Range
b. Default
= A, B, C, D, E & F
= D (as per IBC 1615.1.1 Unless specified in PIF)
Site Class Definitions Table 1615.1.1 IBC 2000, Table 9.4.1.2 ASCE 7-98
Site Class
Soil Profile Name
A
Hard rock
B
Rock
C
Very dense soil and soft rock
D
Stiff soil profile
E
Soil (see ASCE 7-98)
F
(see ASCE 7-98)
4. Mapped Spectral Response Short (S s )
a. Range
= 0.15 to 2.50
b. Default
= 0.50 (Unless specified in PIF)
5. Mapped Spectral Response 1 Second (S 1 )
a. Range
= 0.04 to 1.00
b. Default
= 0.13 (Unless specified in PIF)
Sec. 1616.6.3 IBC 2000
Sec 9.5.2.5.3 7-98
Note:For Regular Buildings less than 5 stories in SDC (D, E, F) with T =< 0.5
S S need not exceed 1.5
S 1 need not exceed 0.60
(S s =1.50 Maximum)
(S 1 =0.60 Maximum)
27
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
(R=4.00)
(R=5.00)
(R=5.00)
(R=1.50)
7. Over-Strength Factor
a. Rigid / Portal Frames
b. Endwalls w/bracing
c. Sidewalls bracing
d. Blockwall
( o =3.00)
( o =2.00)
( o =2.00)
( o =2.50)
Maximum of o = 3.00
( o =2.50)
( o =2.00)
( o =2.00)
( o =2.50)
( o =3.50)
( o =4.50)
( o =4.50)
( o =1.25)
Note:If the Response Modification Factor R is less than or equal to 3 for Seismic
Design Category SDC (A, B, C) the use of Over-Strength Factor with Special
Seismic Load Combinations 8 & 9 in LRFD and 11 & 12 in ASD (See chapter 9)
need not be applied.
28
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Site Class
A
B
C
D
E
F
Site Class
A
B
C
D
E
F
a Seismic Use Group I and II structures located on sites with mapped maximum considered earthquake spectral
response acceleration at 1-second period, S 1 , equal to or greater than 0.75g shall be assigned to Seismic Design Category
E and Seismic Use Group III structures located on such sites shall be assigned to Seismic Design Category F
29
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 0.01 w x
Where,
w x = portion of the total gravity load of the structure, W, located or assigned to
level x.
Example
Example :- 6.4
Using the same data as in Example 6.1, and considering that the SDC (Seismic
Design Category) is A
The total weight of building in transverse direction is
= 105.5 kN
= wx
V
Fx
= Fx
= 0.01 x w x
= 0.01 x 105.5
Therefore,
= 1.06 kN
30
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
2. Simplified Procedure
(This procedure has limited application; see section 9.5.3.8 of ASCE 7-98)
Eqn. 9.4.1.2.4-1
Eqn. 9.4.1.2.4-2
Eqn. 9.4.1.2.5-1
2/3 x S MS
Eqn. 9.4.1.2.5-2
2/3 x S M1
1.2 S DS W / R
Eqn. 9.5.3.8.1
(V)
Fa SS
=
Fv S1
Where,
R = as per table 9.5.2.2 of ASCE 7-98
W = effective seismic weight of the structure, including the total dead load and
other loads listed below,
1. In areas used for storage, a minimum of 25% of the reduced floor live load
(floor live load in public garages and open parking structures need not be
included).
2. Where an allowance for partition load is included in the floor load design, the
actual partition weight or a minimum of 0.48 kN/m2 of floor area, whichever
is greater.
3. Total weight of permanent operating equipment.
4. 20% of flat roof snow load where flat snow load exceeds 1.44 kN/m2.
Section 9.5.2.5
7-98
31
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Vertical Distribution
The forces at each level shall be calculated using the following formula:
Fx
Eqn. 9.5.3.8.2
1.2 S DS w x / R
Where,
w x = portion of the seismic weight of the structure, W, at level x
Example :- 6.5
Assuming the same building data as in Example 6.1, and other seismic data as
below,
Occupancy Category
= II
Hence, Importance factor I
= 1.00
Site Class
=C
Mapped Spectral Response Short (S s ) = 0.50
Mapped Spectral Response 1 Sec. (S 1 ) = 0.30
From Table 9.4.1.2.4a for Site Class C and S s = 0.50
Fa
= 1.20
From Table 9.4.1.2.4b for Site Class C and S 1 = 0.30
= 1.50
Fv
Maximum Spectral Response Short (S MS )
= Fa SS
= 1.20 x 0.50
= 0.60
= 0.45
=0.40
= 0.30
32
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Therefore,
Seismic Design Category as per Short (S DS )
Seismic Design Category as per 1 Second (S D1 )
Seismic Base Shear
(V)
Where R = 4.00 for rigid frames
= C (Table 9.4.2.1a)
= D (Table 9.4.2.1b)
= 1.20 S DS W / R
= 1.20 x 0.40 x 105.5 / 4.00
= 12.66 kN
= 1.20 S DS W / R
= 1.20 x 0.40 x 1164 / 4.00
= 139.69 kN
F x1
At roof level
F x2
= 1.2 S DS w x / R
= 1.2 x 0.40 x 1059 / 4.00
= 127 kN
= 1.2 S DS w x / R
= 1.2 x 0.40 x 105.5 / 4.00
= 12.66 kN
(V)
= 1.20 S DS W / R
F x1
= 1.2 S DS w x / R
= 1.2 x 0.40 x 8464 / 5.00
= 813 kN
At roof level
F x2
= 1.2 S DS w x / R
= 1.2 x 0.40 x 880.6 / 5.00
= 84.5 kN
33
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
C T h n 3/4
Eqn. 9.5.3.2.1-1
S DS I / R
Eqn. 9.5.3.2.1-2
S D1 I / T R
Eqn. 9.5.3.2.1-3
0.044 I S DS
0.50 S 1 I / R
Cs W
Eqn. 9.5.3.2.1-4
Eqn. 9.5.3.2-1
(V)
Where,
CT
hn
I
W
1.
2.
3.
4.
34
S E I S M I C
Sect.9.5.3.4 7-98
L O A D S
Eqn. 9.5.3.4-1
Fx
= C vx V
Eqn. 9.5.3.4-2
C vx
= wx hxk / wi hik
Where,
V
= total design lateral force or base shear
C vx
= Vertical distribution factor
w i , w x = the portion of seismic weight of structure located at level i or x
h i , h x = the height from the base at level i or x
k
= an exponent related to the structure period as per table below,
Ta
T a <= 0.5
0.5 < T a < 2.5
T a >= 2.5
k
1
Interpolated between 1 & 2
2
Example :- 6.6
Using the building data in example 6.1 and other seismic parameters as in
example 6.5 are recalled below,
Design Spectral Response Short (S DS )
= 0.40
= 0.30
Therefore,
Seismic Design Category as per Short (S DS )
Seismic Design Category as per 1 Second (S D1 )
= C (Table 9.4.2.1a)
= D (Table 9.4.2.1b)
35
= 0.390
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 0.19
= 0.018
= 0.038
(Without mezzanine)
Seismic Base Shear (V) = C s W
= 0.10 x 105.5
= 10.55 kN
= 116.4 kN
(With mezzanine)
= 1059 kN
= 105.5 kN
Wi hi
36
= 4503.03
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= (w 1 h 1 k / W i h i k ) x V
= [1059 x 3.5/( 4503 )] x 132.7
= 109.2 kN
V2
= (w 2 h 2 k / W i h i k) x V
= [105.5 x 7.55/( 4503)] x 132.7
= 23.5 kN
Now, calculating the seismic force in the longitudinal direction, we know the
following,
Design Spectral Response Short (S DS )
Design Spectral Response 1 Second (S D1 )
Seismic Design Category as per Short (S DS )
Seismic Design Category as per 1 Second (S D1 )
= 0.40
= 0.30
= C (Table 9.4.2.1a)
= D (Table 9.4.2.1b)
= 0.22
= 0.27
= 0.018
= 0.03
37
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 748 kN
= 374 kN
Distributing this force along the sidewall to mezzanine and eave level
Calculating the vertical distribution factor C vx
Vertical Distribution Factor C vx
= wx hxk / wi hik
The total weight w 1 at mezzanine level h 1 = 3.5 m,
= 8464 kN
= 880.6 kN
Wi hi
= (w 1 h 1 k / W i h i k ) x V
= [8464 x 3.5/( 36272 )] x 575
= 470 kN
V2
= (w 2 h 2 k / W i h i k) x V
= [880.6 x 7.55/( 36272)] x 575
= 105 kN
38
= 36272.53
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
=
=
=
=
=
=
r QE
0.20 S DS D
V (Seismic Base Shear)
Reliability factor (Minimum = 1.00, Maximum = 1.50)
1.00
for SDC (A, B, C)
1.50
for SDC (D, E, F)
Conservatively
Note:- The vertical seismic effect E v need not be included if S DS =< 0.125
Substituting the value of E h and E v in load combinations (8, 9 & 10),
Equation 8)
= D + C o + 0.7 r Q E 0.7 (0.20 S DS D)
= (1 + 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 r Q E
*
= (1 - 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 r Q E
Equation 9)
= D + C o + 0.75 L f + 0.75 ( L r or S ) + 0.525 r Q E 0.525 (0.20 S DS D)
= (1 + 0.105 S DS ) D + C o + 0.75 L f + 0.75 ( L r or S ) + 0.525 r Q E
*
= (1 - 0.105 S DS ) D + C o + 0.75 L f + 0.75 ( L r or S ) + 0.525 r Q E
Equation 10)
= 0.6 D + 0.7 r Q E 0.7 (0.20 S DS D)
*
= (0.6 + 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 r Q E
= (0.6 - 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 r Q E
*
39
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Applying the calculated Seismic Base Shear in example 6.6 using Load
Combinations described above,
Using the values of Base Shear (Q E ) from Equivalent Lateral Force Method
Transverse Direction
= 12.03 kN
(without mezzanine)
= 1.50
0.7 r Q E
= 0.7 x 1.50 x 12.03
(1+0.14 S DS ) D = (1+0.14 x 0.40) D
r
= 12.63 kN
= 1.056 D
(Ignoring C o )
12.63 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
40
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 9.47 kN
= 1.042 D
9.47 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
41
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 12.63 kN
= 0.656 D
= 0.544 D
(Ignoring C o )
(Ignoring C o ) (Will govern)
12.63 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
42
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
r
0.7 r Q E
0.7 r Q E
(1+0.14 S DS ) D
= 1.50
= 0.7 x 1.50 x 109.2
= 0.7 x 1.50 x 23.50
= (1+0.14 x 0.40) D
= 114.6 kN
= 24.68 kN
= 1.056 D
(Ignoring C o )
24.7 kN
114.6 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
43
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 85.99 kN
= 18.51 kN
(1 + 0.105 S DS )D
= (1+0.105 x 0.40) D
= 1.042 D
18.5 kN
0.75 FLOOR LIVE LOAD
86 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
44
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 0.656 D
= 0.544 D
(Ignoring C o )
(Ignoring C o ) (Will govern)
0.54 DEAD LO AD
24.7 kN
115 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
45
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
=
=
=
=
=
o QE
0.20 S DS D
V (Seismic Base Shear)
2.50 for Main Frames
2.00 for bracings
Note:- The vertical seismic effect E v need not be included if S DS =< 0.125
Substituting the value of E mh and E v in load combinations (8, 9 & 10),
Equation 11)
= D + C o + 0.7 o Q E 0.7 (0.20 S DS D)
= (1 + 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 o Q E
*
= (1 - 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 o Q E
Equation 12)
= 0.6 D + 0.7 o Q E 0.7 (0.20 S DS D)
*
= (0.6 + 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 o Q E
= (0.6 - 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 o Q E
*
46
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Applying the calculated Seismic Base Shear in example 6.6 using Load
Combinations described above,
Using the values of Base Shear (Q E ) from Equivalent Lateral Force Method
Transverse Direction
= 12.03 kN
(without mezzanine)
or
= 21.05 kN
= 1.056 D
(Ignoring C o )
21.05 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
47
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 21.05 kN
= 0.544 D
(Ignoring C o )
21.05 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
48
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
c)
III
Hb / 40
H / 50
H / 66
H / 100
H / 142
H / 76
H / 50
H / 100
H / 142
H / 76
H / 66
H / 100
H / 142
H / 100
H / 100
49
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
50
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
MBMA 2006
Several exceptions are listed where seismic loads are not required to be
evaluated, and the only one that would be applicable to metal building
applications is agricultural storage structures intended only for incidental
human occupancy.
It should be noted that the 2006 IBC references ASCE 7-05 for its seismic criteria
requirements and the 2005 AISC Seismic Provisions for its steel seismic detailing
requirements. The 2006 IBC, ASCE 7-05 and 2005 AISC Seismic Provisions are
fully compatible through a significant coordination that took place between the
various code and standard writing committees.
A Design Guide for applying seismic loads to metal buildings was jointly
published by the International Code Council (ICC) and MBMA. It has recently
been updated to the IBC 2006 and ASCE 7-05. Some excerpts from this Guide,
which will be referred to as the 2006 Design Guide, as well as the first complete
example are provided in the following sections.
Basic Concept of Seismic Code Reduced Forces
The 2006 IBC requires that all structures, in most parts of the United States, be
designed to resist design earthquake ground motions. As currently defined,
these design earthquake motions have average return periods of between 300
and 800 years and are quite severe. In the higher seismic regions of the United
States it would be economically prohibitive to design structures to remain elastic
for these motions (as is done for wind loads).
Based on this, earthquake engineering has evolved to allow for inelastic yielding
to accommodate seismic loadings as long as such yielding does not impair the
vertical load capacity of the structure. To reconcile with the allowance of damage
from inelastic response, forces determined by linear analysis are reduced to a
design earthquake force level through the introduction of the seismic force
reduction factor, (R) .
51
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
52
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Due to the flexibility of metal building structures, typical code limits on drift
(sidesway) can be exceeded when it can be demonstrated that non-structural
components attached to the framing can accommodate the excess movement or
that special detailing allows for differential movement.
Typically, the engineer for the metal building manufacturer designs only the
steel building structure. Another engineer normally performs the design of the
remainder of the structure, including foundations and concrete or masonry
walls. This is further discussed in the Common Industry Practices section of the
Manual.
Approach to Metal Building Roof Diaphragm Rigidity (Flexible vs Rigid) and
Accidental Torsion.
1. Diaphragm Flexibility
Applied forces are distributed within any building in a direct relationship to the
rigidity of the structural elements of that building. A significant factor is the
rigidity of structural elements that transfer forces horizontally, relative to
elements that transfer force vertically. For either extreme of this relative rigidity
between horizontal and vertical elements, engineers have developed simplified
design approaches to determine force distributions.
The two extremes are defined as follows:
(a) Flexible Diaphragm: The rigidity of the horizontal diaphragm is very
small relative to the rigidity of the vertical systems.
(b) Rigid Diaphragm: The rigidity of the horizontal diaphragm is very
large compared to the rigidity of the vertical systems.
Analysis using either of these bounding assumptions produces results that vary
in accuracy depending upon how closely the actual structure matches the
simplifying assumptions. Although many (perhaps most) structures fall
somewhere between these extremes, more accurate analysis can only be done by
using complex finite-element models that are generally not practical to use for
ordinary building designs.
2006 IBC Section 1602.1 defines a flexible diaphragm as having a lateral
deflection of more than two times the average story drift of the vertical elements
supporting the diaphragm, and a rigid diaphragm as everything else. This
definition requires calculation of diaphragm deflection, which is complex and
imprecise for many types of diaphragm construction. Therefore, it is important to
be able to select and use appropriate simplified assumptions to obtain rapid
structural design solutions.
53
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Diaphragm deflection varies, depending upon the materials used, the type and
spacing of fasteners used in the construction, the depth of the diaphragm in the
direction of deformation, and the width or span of the diaphragm transverse to
the direction of deformation. Horizontal diaphragm systems in metal buildings
might consist of either the metal cladding of the roof itself or horizontal bracing
systems installed beneath the roof alone. Examples of horizontal bracing systems
used include rods, angles, cables, or other structural members and are often
tension-only bracing.
Metal Roof Systems
Metal roof cladding typically consists of either standing seam metal panels or
through-fastened roof panels. In standing seam roof (SSR) systems, the formed
roof sheets are restrained against uplift but are free to slide against each other
(float) along the length of the joining seams. Side seam resistance to slip varies.
The panel clips allow for relative movement between the panels and their
supporting structure to accommodate thermal expansion. The resulting roof
systems vary in the strength and stiffness required to transfer horizontal forces,
and in general they are considered to be flexible for any type of construction.
Therefore, separate horizontal bracing systems that are designed to resist the full
wind and earthquake demands usually need to be provided. Friction caused by
sliding of panels at the attachments along seams probably provides energy
dissipation (damping) to the structure that is beneficial to earthquake response,
but is usually ignored in the design. There are exceptions to this typical
presumed behavior. Standing seam roof systems with documented diaphragm
strength and stiffness values may be sufficient to act as sub diaphragms for the
distribution of portions of the lateral forces to the main diaphragm cross-ties, i.e.
strut purlins.
Through-fastened roof (TFR) systems come in many types. Some systems use
screws that fasten through only one sheet of adjoining roof panels, while an
overlapping rib holds down the adjacent sheet. This roofing type, like a standing
seam roof, is considered to be flexible for all types of construction. Other TFR
systems use concealed or exposed screws that fasten through both metal sheets
along an overlapping edge. The rigidity of these systems varies depending upon
the type and spacing of fasteners, the profile and thickness of the joining metal
roofing sheets, and the overall depth and width of the diaphragm.
It has been a traditional metal building design practice to assume that
diaphragms of all types are flexible, regardless of the size or shape of the
building or the type and relative rigidity of the vertical structural elements. For
the most part, this assumption is reasonably correct and appropriate.
54
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
A typical metal building that is relatively square in plan view, with either an
SSR or TFR roof system, a series of moment frames in the transverse
directions, and several bays of tension-rod bracing in the longitudinal
direction, would be expected to meet the deflection check as a flexible
diaphragm system. However, the design engineer should be aware that some
structural geometries might be better classified as having rigid diaphragms:
As an example, a warehouse building with a TFR roof system that has a series of
moment (portal) frames instead of bracing along the walls of the longitudinal
axis, in order to provide a continuous line of loading docks along the walls of the
building. The relatively flexible moment frames are likely to experience
deflections equal to or greater than the TFR system. Note that an SSR roof system
would still be considered flexible for this building.
Structures using relatively flexible cable bracing systems as vertical bracing, in
conjunction with relatively more rigid tension-rod horizontal bracing or a TFR
roof system might be considered as having rigid diaphragms.
In a recent development, ASCE 7-05 has adopted a new provision found in
Section 12.3.1.1 which states that un-topped steel decking is permitted to be
considered as a flexible diaphragm in structures in which the vertical elements
are structural steel braced frames or concrete, masonry, steel or composite shear
frames.
Inherent and Accidental Torsion
ASCE 7-05 Section 12.8.4.1 requires, for diaphragms which are rigid (i.e. not
flexible), that the distribution of base shear forces should consider the inherent
torsional moment caused by the difference in location between the center of mass
and center of stiffness of the structure. In addition, ASCE 7-05, Section 12.8.4.2
requires, for rigid diaphragms, that an additional accidental torsional moment be
added to the inherent torsion defined by ASCE 7-05, Section 12.8.4.1. Further,
ASCE 7-05, Section 12.8.4.3 requires that in some instances the combined inherent
and accidental torsional moment must be multiplied by a dynamic amplification
factor.
55
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
56
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
There are several special requirements embedded in the 2006 IBC. These are
discussed in Section 4d of the Example that begins in Section 1.3.6.9 of this
Manual. The advantage of the (R=3) option might be that other loads (such as
wind) may govern the design.
The (R=3) option may perhaps result in a much simpler design and analysis
for such cases without any reduction in economy. The 2006 Design Guide
provides an (R = 3) option alternate to demonstrate its use.
Advantages in Performing a Geotechnical Investigation
For many constructed metal buildings, geotechnical investigations are not
performed, and the minimum soil allowables are used for foundation design.
However, there may be advantages of performing a geotechnical investigation
for a project site, including: Determination of the site class of the soil profile of
the site. Without this determination, the default value of Site Class D must be
assumed by code, which could result in earthquake design forces being over
two times greater than that required if the site class was actually Site Class B.
A lower site class may also result in a reduction in a seismic design category for a
particular structure, which in turn may mean less restrictive detailing
requirements and height limitations. This would result in a lower cost structure
and foundation. Determination of site-specific soil bearing values. This
determination would usually result in higher allowable bearing pressures than
the default values provided in the code, resulting in more economical foundation
designs. Detection of soil or foundation problems, which could adversely affect
the construction or structural performance of the metal building. These problems
could include subsurface areas of weakness, expansive soils, corrosive soils and
water table issues. Mitigating these problems, if present, would likely result in a
building that performs better over its life. Note that according to 2006 IBC Section
1613.5.5 (ASCE 7-05 Section 20.1), the site classification is ideally based on site
specific soil data to a depth of 100 feet (30.48 m). However in lieu of data
available to that depth, IBC permits the soil properties to be estimated by the
registered design professional preparing the soil report based on known geologic
conditions. Therefore, it is important to request that borings be taken to the
necessary depth to comply with this requirement.
57
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Relationship and Issues between the Metal Building Manufacturer and the
Building Specifying Engineer
Metal building systems are designed and fabricated by manufacturers, then
typically sold through franchised builders (or dealers) who also provide erection
who has a direct relationship with the end customer and the other project
designers. This creates a line of communication that often includes
nontechnical personnel, a situation that can lead to designs that do not fully
satisfy project needs. To avoid such problems, it is vitally important that all
project requirements, including design specifications, special loading and
applicable code provisions, are clearly communicated to the metal building
design engineer. It is equally output data are communicated to the end customer,
the project architect, and the foundation engineer. Furthermore, 2006 IBC
Section 1603 requires that the construction documents clearly indicate
pertinent structural design information, including earthquake design data.
Typically, due to lack of direct contact with the end user, the metal building of
record for a project. This function must be served by a registered design
professional who prepares the design for the foundation and any other
structural components or systems and who has a direct relationship with the
lead designer or end customer. Additionally the design professional of record
has the responsibility to coordinate dimensions and the layout of grid lines,
frame lines, and building lines.
Relationship and Issues between the Metal Building Manufacturer and
Foundation/Hardwall Engineer (Blockwall)
As previously stated, it is typical practice to have the foundation and concrete or
masonry walls of metal buildings designed by a separate registered design
professional. It is very important that the loads imposed by the metal building to
a foundation or hardwall are clearly identified to the engineer responsible for
their design. Also, the interface details between the building, walls and
foundation (bolt type, size, location, spacing and connection details) need to be
clearly identified. It is also very important that the hardwall design engineer
clearly communicate all applicable design criteria to the metal building engineer.
For example if the wall engineers design assumes that hardwalls do not behave
as shear walls, then special connections need to be provided between the
hardwall and the building to accommodate the building lateral in-plane
displacement. shear wall loads imposed by the building need to be
communicated to the hardwall engineer so he or she can engineer the hardwall
and its foundation for these loads. In general, if hardwalls are being used, they
will usually have more than adequate strength to act as shear walls if designed to
do so.
58
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
59
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Table 11.5-1
7-05
Table 20.3-1
7-05
= A, B, C, D, E & F
= D (as per 1613.5.2 IBC06 Unless specified in PIF)
60
S E I S M I C
Table 12.2-1
7-05
L O A D S
(R=3.50)4*
(R=4.00)5*
(R=3.25)5*
(R=1.50)
( o =3.00)
( o =2.00)
( o =2.00)
( o =2.50)
Maximum of o = 3.00
Table 12.2-1
7-05
( o =2.50)
( o =2.00)
( o =2.00)
( o =2.50)
Note:If the Response Modification Factor R is less than or equal to 3 for Seismic
Design Category SDC (A, B, C) the use of Over-Strength Factor with Special
Seismic Load Combinations 8 & 9 in LRFD and 11 & 12 in ASD (See chapter 9)
need not be applied.
61
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Site Class
A
B
C
D
E
F
Site Class
A
B
C
D
E
F
III
A
C
D
D
III
A
C
D
D
a Seismic Use Group I and II structures located on sites with mapped maximum considered earthquake spectral
response acceleration at 1-second period, S 1 , equal to or greater than 0.75g shall be assigned to Seismic Design Category
E and Seismic Use Group III structures located on such sites shall be assigned to Seismic Design Category F
62
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 0.01 w x
Where,
w x = portion of the total gravity load of the structure, W, located or assigned to
level x.
Example
Example :- 6.4
Using the same data as in Example 6.1, and considering that the SDC (Seismic
Design Category) is A
The total weight of building in transverse direction is
= 105.5 kN
= wx
V
Fx
= Fx
= 0.01 x w x
= 0.01 x 105.5
Therefore,
= 1.06 kN
63
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
2. Simplified Procedure
(This procedure has limited application; see section 12.14 of ASCE 7-05)
Eqn. 11.4-1
Eqn. 11.4-2
Eqn. 11.4-3
2/3 x S MS
Eqn. 11.4-4
2/3 x S M1
F S DS W / R
Eqn. 12.14-11
(V)
Fa SS
=
Fv S1
Where,
R = as per table 12.2-1 of ASCE 7-05
W = effective seismic weight of the structure, including the total dead load and
other loads listed below,
1. In areas used for storage, a minimum of 25% of the reduced floor live load
(floor live load in public garages and open parking structures need not be
included).
2. Where an allowance for partition load is included in the floor load design, the
actual partition weight or a minimum of 0.48 kN/m2 of floor area, whichever
is greater.
3. Total weight of permanent operating equipment.
4. 20% of flat roof snow load where flat snow load exceeds 1.44 kN/m2.
F
Ss
64
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Vertical Distribution
The forces at each level shall be calculated using the following formula:
Fx
Eqn. 12.14-12
wx V / W
Where,
w x = portion of the seismic weight of the structure, W, at level x
Example :- 6.5
Assuming the same building data as in Example 6.1, and other seismic data as
below,
Occupancy Category
= II
Hence, Importance factor I
= 1.00
Site Class
=C
Mapped Spectral Response Short (S s ) = 0.50
Mapped Spectral Response 1 Sec. (S 1 ) = 0.30
From Table 1613.5.3(1) for Site Class C and S s = 0.50
= 1.20
Fa
From Table 1613.5.3(2) for Site Class C and S 1 = 0.30
= 1.50
Fv
Maximum Spectral Response Short (S MS )
= Fa SS
= 1.20 x 0.50
Maximum Spectral Response 1 Second (S M1 )
= Fv S1
= 1.50 x 0.30
Design Spectral Response Short (S DS ) = 2/3 x S MS
= 2 /3 x 0.60
Design Spectral Response 1 Second (S D1 )
= 2/3 x S M1
= 2/3 x 0.45
65
= 0.60
= 0.45
=0.40
= 0.30
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Therefore,
Seismic Design Category as per Short (S DS )
Seismic Design Category as per 1 Second (S D1 )
= C (Table 9.4.2.1a)
= D (Table 9.4.2.1b)
F x1
At roof level
F x2
= 1.2 S DS w x / R
= 1.2 x 0.40 x 1059 / 3.50
= 145 kN
= 1.2 S DS w x / R
= 1.2 x 0.40 x 105.5 / 3.50
= 14.4 kN
(V)
= S DS W / R
F x1
= 1.2 S DS w x / R
= 1.2 x 0.40 x 8464 / 3.25
= 1250 kN
At roof level
F x2
= 1.2 S DS w x / R
= 1.2 x 0.40 x 880.6 / 3.25
= 130 kN
66
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
CT hnx
Eqn. 12.8-2
S DS I / R
Eqn. 12.8-3
S D1 I / T R
Eqn. 12.8-4
S D1 T L I / T2 R
Eqn. 12.8-5
0.01
Eqn. 12.8-6
0.5 S 1 I / R
Eqn. 12.8-1
Cs W
(V)
Where,
C T & x = (0.0724) (0.80) for Moment Resisting frames.
= (0.0488) (0.75) for Endwalls & Sidewalls
= (0.0488) (0.75) for Blockwalls and other structures
hn
= Is the height of the building from base.
I
= Importance Factor for Seismic
= The Long-Period transition period (Should be provided for a location)
TL
ranges from 4 to 16 seconds, use 4 sec if not provided)
W
= total dead load and applicable portions of other loads listed below,
1. In areas used for storage, a minimum of 25% of the floor live load shall be
applicable. The 2.4 kN/m2 floor live load for passenger cars in parking
garages need not be considered.
2. Where an allowance for partition load is included in the floor load
design, the actual partition weight or a minimum of 0.48 kN/m2 of floor
area, whichever is greater shall be applicable.
3. Total operating weight of permanent equipment and the effective
contents of vessels.
4. Where the flat roof snow load exceeds 1.44 kN/m2, 20% of the design
snow load shall be included in W.
67
S E I S M I C
Sect.12.8.3 7-05
L O A D S
Eqn. 12.8-11
Fx
= C vx V
Eqn. 12.8-12
C vx
= wx hxk / wi hik
Where,
V
= total design lateral force or base shear
C vx
= Vertical distribution factor
w i , w x = the portion of seismic weight of structure located at level i or x
h i , h x = the height from the base at level i or x
k
= an exponent related to the structure period as per table below,
Ta
T a <= 0.5
0.5 < T a < 2.5
T a >= 2.5
k
1
Interpolated between 1 & 2
2
Example :- 6.6
Using the building data in example 6.1 and other seismic parameters as in
example 6.5 are recalled below,
Design Spectral Response Short (S DS )
= 0.40
= 0.30
Therefore,
Seismic Design Category as per Short (S DS )
Seismic Design Category as per 1 Sec (S D1 )
Approximate Fundamental Period (T a )
= CT hnx
where,
= 0.0853
CT
= 7.55 m
hn
x
= 0.80
Therefore, Approx. Fundamental Period (T a )
= 0.0853 x 7.55 0.80
68
= C (Table 9.4.2.1a)
= D (Table 9.4.2.1b)
= 0.43 Sec
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 0.20
= 1.85
= 0.01
(Without mezzanine)
Seismic Base Shear (V) = C s W
= 0.114 x 105.5
= 12.03 kN
= 132.7 kN
= 1059 kN
= 105.5 kN
Wi hi
69
= 4503.03
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= (w 1 h 1 k / W i h i k ) x V
= [1059 x 3.5/( 4503 )] x 132.7
= 109.2 kN
V2
= (w 2 h 2 k / W i h i k) x V
= [105.5 x 7.55/( 4503)] x 132.7
= 23.5 kN
Now, calculating the seismic force in the longitudinal direction, we know the
following,
Design Spectral Response Short (S DS )
Design Spectral Response 1 Second (S D1 )
Seismic Design Category as per Short (S DS )
Seismic Design Category as per 1 Second (S D1 )
= 0.40
= 0.30
= C (Table 9.4.2.1a)
= D (Table 9.4.2.1b)
= 0.22
= 0.42
= 7.62
= 0.01
70
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 1149 kN
= 575 kN
Distributing this force along the sidewall to mezzanine and eave level
Calculating the vertical distribution factor C vx
Vertical Distribution Factor C vx
= wx hxk / wi hik
The total weight w 1 at mezzanine level h 1 = 3.5 m,
= 8464 kN
= 880.6 kN
Wi hi
= (w 1 h 1 k / W i h i k ) x V
= [8464 x 3.5/( 36272 )] x 575
= 470 kN
V2
= (w 2 h 2 k / W i h i k) x V
= [880.6 x 7.55/( 36272)] x 575
= 105 kN
71
= 36272.53
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
=
=
=
=
=
=
r QE
0.20 S DS D
V (Seismic Base Shear)
Reliability factor (Minimum = 1.00, Maximum = 1.50)
1.00
for SDC (A, B, C)
1.30
for SDC (D, E, F)
Conservatively
(See ASCE 7-05 Section 12.3.4.2 for more details)
Note:- The vertical seismic effect E v need not be included if S DS =< 0.125
Substituting the value of E h and E v in load combinations (8, 9 & 10),
Equation 8)
= D + C o + 0.7 r Q E 0.7 (0.20 S DS D)
= (1 + 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 r Q E
*
= (1 - 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 r Q E
Equation 9)
= D + C o + 0.75 L f + 0.75 ( L r or f 2 S ) + 0.525 r Q E 0.525 (0.20 S DS D)
= (1 + 0.105 S DS ) D + C o + 0.75 L f + 0.75 ( L r or f 2 S ) + 0.525 r Q E
*
= (1 - 0.105 S DS ) D + C o + 0.75 L f + 0.75 ( L r or f 2 S ) + 0.525 r Q E
Equation 10)
= 0.6 D + 0.7 r Q E 0.7 (0.20 S DS D)
*
= (0.6 + 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 r Q E
= (0.6 - 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 r Q E
*
72
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Applying the calculated Seismic Base Shear in example 6.6 using Load
Combinations described above,
Using the values of Base Shear (Q E ) from Equivalent Lateral Force Method
Transverse Direction
= 12.03 kN
(without mezzanine)
= 1.30
0.7 r Q E
= 0.7 x 1.30 x 12.03
(1+0.14 S DS ) D = (1+0.14 x 0.40) D
r
= 10.95 kN
= 1.056 D
(Ignoring C o )
10.95 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
73
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 8.21 kN
= 1.042 D
8.21 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
74
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 10.95 kN
= 0.656 D
= 0.544 D
(Ignoring C o )
(Ignoring C o ) (Will govern)
10.95 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
75
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
r
0.7 r Q E
0.7 r Q E
(1+0.14 S DS ) D
= 1.30
= 0.7 x 1.30 x 109.2
= 0.7 x 1.30 x 23.50
= (1+0.14 x 0.40) D
= 99.37 kN
= 21.39 kN
= 1.056 D
(Ignoring C o )
21.39 kN
99.37 kN
Vh
Vh
SEISMIC FORCE WITH LOAD COMBINATION
Vv
76
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 74.53 kN
= 16.04 kN
(1 + 0.105 S DS )D
= (1+0.105 x 0.40) D
= 1.042 D
16.04 kN
0.75 FLOOR LIVE LOAD
74.53 kN
Vh
Vh
SEISMIC FORCE WITH LOAD COMBINATION
Vv
77
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 96.37 kN
= 21.39 kN
= (0.6+0.14 x 0.40) D
= (0.6-0.14 x 0.40) D
= 0.656 D
= 0.544 D
(Ignoring C o )
(Ignoring C o ) (Will govern)
21.39 kN
99.37 kN
Vh
Vh
SEISMIC FORCE WITH LOAD COMBINATION
Vv
78
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
=
=
=
=
=
o QE
0.20 S DS D
V (Seismic Base Shear)
2.50 for Main Frames
2.00 for bracings
Note:- The vertical seismic effect E v need not be included if S DS =< 0.125
Substituting the value of E mh and E v in load combinations (11,12),
Equation 11)
= D + C o + 0.7 o Q E 0.7 (0.20 S DS D)
= (1 + 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 o Q E
*
= (1 - 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 o Q E
Equation 12)
= D + C o + 0.75 L f + 0.75 ( L r or f 2 S ) + 0.525 o Q E 0.525 (0.20 S DS D)
= (1 + 0.105 S DS ) D + C o + 0.75 L f + 0.75 ( L r or f 2 S ) + 0.525 o Q E
*
= (1 - 0.105 S DS ) D + C o + 0.75 L f + 0.75 ( L r or f 2 S ) + 0.525 o Q E
Equation 13)
= 0.6 D + 0.7 o Q E 0.7 (0.20 S DS D)
*
= (0.6 + 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 o Q E
= (0.6 - 0.14 S DS ) D + C o + 0.7 o Q E
*
79
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Applying the calculated Seismic Base Shear in example 6.6 using Load
Combinations described above,
Using the values of Base Shear (Q E ) from Equivalent Lateral Force Method
Transverse Direction
= 12.03 kN
(without mezzanine)
or
= 21.05 kN
= 1.056 D
(Ignoring C o )
21.05 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
80
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 15.79 kN
= 1.042 D
15.79 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
81
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
= 21.05 kN
= 0.656 D
= 0.544 D
(Ignoring C o )
(Ignoring C o ) (Will govern)
21.05 kN
Vh
Vh
Vv
82
Vv
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Important Note:( S1 )
1) This comparison is based on an excersice of back calculating the values of ( Ss ) and
required in MBMA 06 in order to get the same value of Seismic Base Shear as per UBC 97, for a given
weight and other constant parameters.
2) There is no validation from any code for this comparison. It is merely a tool to facilitate the
calculation of same base shear for both UBC 97 and MBMA 06 code.
3) This comparison is valid upto a height of 13 meters. For values greater than 13 meters, the user can
calculate the value by trial and error. Values for 15 & 25 M is also given below.
4) The comparison is valid for only default values indicated below
Default Values
1
2
3
4
UBC 97
Soil Profile = D
Occupancy Categories = Standard Structures
Seismic Source type = B
Distance to Seismic Source 10 km
MBMA 06
Occupancy Category II
Site Class D
Reponse Modification Factor R = 3
2A
0.3650
0.0900
2B
0.5000
0.1300
3
0.9310
0.2600
4
1.2830
0.3000
2A
0.4000
0.1720
2B
0.6000
0.2350
3
0.8300
0.3700
4
1.2000
0.4770
2A
0.4000
0.1780
2B
0.6000
0.2431
3
0.7500
0.3850
4
0.9000
0.4950
83
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
Occupancy Category
I or II
III
IV
Hc / 40
H / 50
H / 66
H / 100
H / 142
H / 76
H / 50
H / 100
H / 142
H / 76
H / 66
H / 100
H / 142
H / 100
H / 100
84
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
85
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
86
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
87
S E I S M I C
L O A D S
88
S N O W
Chapter
L O A D S
Snow Loads
MBMA 02
Section 1.5
ASCE 7-98
Section 7.0
MBMA 06
Section 1.3.5
ASCE 7-05
Chapter 7.0
efinition
S N O W
L O A D S
Flat Roof Snow Loads (p f ) The snow load, P f on a roof with a slope equal to or
less than 5 shall be calculated as per equation 7-1 below,
p f = 0.7 C e C t I s p g
But not less than following minimum values, for monoslope roofs with slopes
less than 15, hip and gable roofs with slopes less than or equal to
(21.3/W)+0.5 and curved roofs where the vertical angle from the eaves to the
crown is less than 10
If
If
then
then
p f >= I s p g
p f >= 0.96 I s
Where,
= exposure factor from Table 7-2 ASCE 7-98 / 05
(Default C e = 0.90)
Ce
= thermal factor from Table 7-3 ASCE 7-98 / 05
(Default C t = 1.20)
Ct
= Importance Factor from Table 1.1 (a) / 1.3.1(a)
(Default II, I s = 1.00)
Is
2
pg
= Ground Snow load in kN/m
W
= is the horizontal distance from eave to ridge in meters.
Table 1.5.2 / 1.3.5.2 Typical Heated and Unheated Building Usage
C t = 1.00
C t = 1.20
Manufacturing Production
Manufacturing Equipment Service
Commercial Retail Stores
Agricultural buildings
On-Farm Structures
Commercial Warehouse / Freight Terminals1
Some recreational facilities such as ice rinks,
gyms, field houses, exhibition buildings, fair
buildings etc.
Some warehouse facilities such as raw material
storage, mini warehouses parking and vehicle
storage, etc.
Refrigerated Storage Facilities
Educational Complexes
Hospital and Treatment Facilities
Churches
Government Administration & Service
Transport Terminals
Residential
Some recreation facilities such as bowling lanes,
theaters, museums, clubs studios etc.
Some warehouse facilities such as retail
storage, parts distribution and storage, etc.
1 - C = 1.10 if the building is kept just above freezing
t
The values in the table serve as a guide to assess if a building falls in a heated or unheated category, the actual planned use and
occupancy of a given structure must be considered in determining the thermal factor of the building.
S N O W
L O A D S
Sheltered
1.30
1.20
1.10
1.00
N/A
N/A
ps = CS pf
Where,
C s = Roof slope factor (may be conservatively taken as 1.00) see MBMA 02/06
and ASCE 7-98/05 for more details and relevant equations for steep roof
slopes.
Slippery surface values shall be used only where the roofs surface is
unobstructed and sufficient space is available below the eaves to accept all the
sliding snow. A roof shall be considered unobstructed if no objects exist on it
which prevent snow on it from sliding.
Note that metal roofs are assumed as slippery surfaces unless the presence
of snow guards or other obstructions prevents snow from sliding. (See
MBMA Metal Roofing Systems Design Manual)
S N O W
L O A D S
Roof Slope Factor (C s ):- The requirements of roof slope factor are provided in
equation form below,
a) For warm roofs (C t <= 1.00), [i.e. all roofs not meeting the definitions of (b)
cold roofs or (c) cool roofs.]
1) Unobstructed slippery roofs that will allow the snow to slide off the
eaves and provided it is either a non-ventilated roof with R>= 30 ft2 h
F/Btu (5.3 C m2/W), or a ventilated roof with R>= 20 ft2 h F/Btu (3.5
C m2/W) [where, R is the thermal resistance of the roofing material in
ft2 h F/Btu (C m2/W) ,
Cs
Cs
Cs
= 1.00
= 1-(-5)/65
=0
for,
for,
for,
<= 5
5 < < 70
>= 70
Note that for a ventilated roof the exterior air under it shall be able to circulate
freely from its eaves to its ridge.
2) All other warm roofs,
Cs
Cs
Cs
= 1.00
= 1-(-30)/40
=0
for,
for,
for,
<= 30
30 < < 70
>= 70
= 1.00
= 1-(-15)/55
=0
for,
for,
for,
<= 15
15 < < 70
>= 70
for,
for,
for,
<= 30
30 < < 70
>= 70
= 1.00
= 1-(-45)/25
=0
S N O W
L O A D S
c) For cool roofs (C t = 1.10), [i.e. structures kept just above freezing and
others with cold, ventilated roofs with a thermal resistance between the
ventilated space and the heated space greater than R=25
1) Unobstructed slippery roofs that will allow the snow to slide off the
eaves,
Cs
Cs
Cs
= 1.00
= 1-(-10)/60
=0
for,
for,
for,
<= 10
10 < < 70
>= 70
for,
for,
for,
<= 37.5
37.5 < < 70
>= 70
= 1.00
= 1-(-37.5)/32.5
=0
For curved roofs, multiple folded plate roofs, saw-tooth roofs, or barrel vault
roofs see ASCE 7-98 or ASCE 7-05 for appropriate C s values.
Ice Dams and Icicles along Eaves:- Additional loads due to ice dams and
icicles along the eaves are specified in ASCE 7-98 / 05, section 7.4.5 as follows,
Two types of warm roofs that drain water over their eaves shall be capable of
sustaining a uniformly distributed load = 2 P f , on all overhanging portions:
a) Unventilated warm roofs that have an R-value less than R-30
b) Ventilated warm roofs that have an R-values less than R-20
No other loads except dead loads shall be present on the roof when this
uniformly distributed load is applied.
The intent is to consider heavy loads from ice that forms along the eaves only
for structures where such loads are likely to form. It is also not considered
necessary to analyze the entire structure for such loads, just the eaves
themselves. These may be ignored in case the building is provided with
curved eaves.
Partial Loading:- The effect of having a selected spans loaded with the
balanced snow load and remaining spans loaded with half the balanced snow
load shall be investigated as follows,
S N O W
L O A D S
Continuous Beam Systems, shall be investigated for the effects of the 3 loading
conditions as shown in figure 7-4 and explained in 3 cases below,
Case -1:- Full unbalanced snow load on either exterior span and half the
balanced snow load on all other spans.
Case-2:- Half the balanced snow load on either exterior span, and full balanced
snow load on all other spans.
Case-3:- All possible combinations of full balanced snow load on any two
adjacent spans and half the balanced snow load on all other spans. For this
case there will be (n-1) possible combinations where n equals the number of
spans in the continuous beam system.
If a cantilever is present in any of the above cases, it shall be considered to be a
span.
Partial load provisions need not be applied to the structural members which
span perpendicular to the ridge line (main frame rafters) in gable roofs with
slopes greater than (21.3/W+0.5)
S N O W
L O A D S
Unbalanced Snow Loads:- For hip and gable roofs with a slope exceeding 70
or with a slope less than (21.3/W+0.5), unbalanced snow loads are not
required to be applied. A summary of unbalanced load cases for hip and gable
roofs is given in figure below as per MBMA 2002 (Revised in MBMA 2006 see
following page),
Where,
= 0.50
= 0.33 + 0.167 L/W
= 1.00
if,
if,
if,
S N O W
L O A D S
Unbalanced Snow Loads for Gable / Hip Roof As per MBMA 2006
S N O W
L O A D S
Drifts on Lower Roofs:- Drift loads on lower roofs are specified in section 7.7
of ASCE 7-98/05, separate provisions are given for drifting at roof steps
(higher portions of the same structure) and for drifting caused by adjacent
structures and terrain features. The triangular drift loads are superimposed on
the balanced snow load.
The requirements of ASCE 7-98/05 are summarized below in a form more
suitable for programming,
Eqn. 7-9 ASCE 7-98
Eqn. 7-9 ASCE 7-05
h d <= h c
hd > hc
hd = hc
then,
then,
w = 4h d
<= 8h c
w = 4h d 2 / h c <= 8h c
Where,
= clear height from top of balanced snow load to
hc
(1) closest point on the adjacent upper roof,
(2) top of parapet
(3) top of a projection on the roof, in meters.
S N O W
L O A D S
If the drift width, w exceeds the width of the lower roof, the drift shall be
truncated at the far edge of the roof, not reduced to zero there.
The maximum intensity of the drift surcharge load, P d g equals h d g where
snow density g, is defined as below
Eqn. 7-4 ASCE 7-98
Eqn. 7-4 ASCE 7-05
g = [ 0.426 Pg + 2.2 ]
10
S N O W
L O A D S
Roof Projections:- Drift loads by roof projections are specified in ASCE 798/05 section 7.8. The drifts are calculated the same as for a roof step, figure 79 of ASCE 7-98/05, except that the drift height is taken as 0.75 h d and L u is
equal to the length of the roof upwind of the projection.
Sliding Snow:- (Revised in MBMA 2006 / ASCE 7-05)
Sliding snow is specified in ASCE 7-98 section 7.9 as follows:
The extra load caused by snow sliding off a sloped roof onto a lower roof
shall be determined assuming that all the snow that accumulates on the upper
roof under the balanced loading condition slides onto the lower roof.
Engineering judgment is also required regarding the width W of the
deposited sliding snow. The recommended approach below is based on the
information provided in ASCE 7-98 commentary.
It is the recommendation of MBMA that the following method be used to
determine the amount of sliding snow for a metal roof. The weight of sliding
snow in kN/m of length of the lower roof, S L shall be distributed as a uniform
load over a width of lower roof, W as follows,
S L = 1.25 P fu L u ( 1 - C SD )
<= g h c w
Where,
P fu
= balanced roof snow load on the upper roof
= width of the upper roof sloped in the direction of the lower roof
Lu
g
= density of snow
hc
= clear height from top of balanced snow load to
(1) closest point on the adjacent upper roof,
(2) top of parapet
(3) top of a projection on the roof, in meters.
w
= lesser of 6.096 meters or width of lower roof when, h c <= 0.914 m
w
= 18.28/h c >= 1.524 meters, h c > 0.914 m
= ( 1 - / 65)
<= 65
(See figure 1.5.11)
C SD
=0
> 65
C SD
11
S N O W
L O A D S
12
S N O W
L O A D S
Combining Snow loads:- Balanced snow loads, unbalanced snow loads, drift
loads, and sliding snow are treated as separate load cases and are not to be
combined except as noted below,
Sliding snow loads shall be superimposed on the balanced snow load as per
ASCE 7-98/05, section 7.9
Drift loads shall be superimposed on balanced snow loads as per ASCE 798/05, section 7.7 and 7.7.1 respectively
Rain-On-Snow surcharge:- Rain-on snow surcharge is specified in section 7.10
of ASCE 7-98/05. It is only applicable when p g <= 0.957 kN/m2, but not zero,
and the roof slope is less than ( < 2.386 in MBMA 02 and W/15240 in MBMA
2006, W is in mm) . The maximum surcharge is 0.239 kN/m2.
13
S N O W
L O A D S
14
S N O W
L O A D S
Example
Example :- 7.1
Given Data:Building Use
Building width
Building length
Eave height
Roof Slope
Roof Extension
Frame type
Terrain category
Adjacent Structures
Roof type
Roof Insulation
Ground Snow P g
3048
4877
12192
30480
15240
BUILDING GEOMETRY
15
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.7 C e C t I s p g
= 0.7 x 1 x 1 x 1 x 0.718
= 0.502 kN/m2
= Cs pf
= 1.00 x 0.502
(balanced load)
= 0.502 kN/m2
3) Unbalanced snow load need not be considered if the roof slope is,
> 70
OR
< [(21.3/W)+0.5]
Since the roof slope is more than 3.29 < 4.76, unbalanced snow load should be
considered.
Note:- ASCE 7-98 does not address asymmetric roofs with regard to unbalanced
load. This situation exists in this example, since the roof extension does not
extend the entire length of the building; one rational method to handle this is to
compute effective width as below,
W1
L1
W eff
W eff
= 7620 mm
W2
= 10668 mm (W 1 + Roof extension width)
= 18288 mm L 2
= 12192 mm
= (W 1 L 1 + W 2 L 2 ) / (L 1 + L 2 )
= (7620 x 18288 + 10668 x 12192) / (18288+12192)
= 8839.2 mm
16
S N O W
L O A D S
W2
L2
Ww
Weff
RIDGE LINE
he = 0.89
WIND
L1
W1
Case-1
= 7620 mm
W eff
= 8839 mm
Ww
= (30480 / 8839)
= 3.45 <= 4.00
L/W eff
We know,
= 0.50
if,
L/W <= 1.00
= 1.00
if,
L/W > 4
Therefore,
17
S N O W
L O A D S
0.99
0.60
1.15
0.15
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
0.50
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
18
S N O W
L O A D S
WL
Ww
he=0.63
WIND
Case-2
W w = W eff
= 8839 mm
WL
= 7620 mm
= (30480 / 7620)
= 4.00 <= 4.00
L/W L
We know,
= 0.50
if,
L/W <= 1.00
= 1.00
if,
L/W > 4
Therefore,
19
S N O W
L O A D S
0.60
1.20
0.15
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
0.50
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
20
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.7 C e C t I s p g
= 0.7 x 1 x 1 x 1 x 0.718
= 0.502 kN/m2
= Cs pf
= 1.00 x 0.502
(balanced load)
= 0.502 kN/m2
6) Unbalanced snow load need not be considered if the roof slope is,
Less than the larger of (21.3/W)+0.5 = 3.29 or 2.38
Since the roof slope is more than 3.29 < 4.76, unbalanced snow load should be
considered.
Note:- ASCE 7-05 does not address asymmetric roofs with regard to unbalanced
load. This situation exists in this example, since the roof extension does not
extend the entire length of the building; one rational method to handle this is to
compute effective width as below,
W1
L1
W eff
W eff
Note:- W eff
= 7620 mm
W2
= 10668 mm (W 1 + Roof extension width)
= 18288 mm L 2
= 12192 mm
= (W 1 L 1 + W 2 L 2 ) / (L 1 + L 2 )
= (7620 x 18288 + 10668 x 12192) / (18288+12192)
= 8839.2 mm
= W 2 = 10668 mm
in MBMA 2006
21
S N O W
L O A D S
W2
L2
Ww
Weff
RIDGE LINE
he = 0.89
WIND
L1
W1
Case-1
= 7620 mm
W eff
= 10668 mm
Ww
(21.3/W+0.5) = (21.3/7.62+0.5)
= 3.30 > 2.38
h d = [(0.416) (W W )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] - 0.457
= [(0.416) (7.62)1/3 (0.718 + 0.4788)1/4] - 0.457
= 0.399 m
Snow density,
g
= [0.426 p g + 2.2]
<= 4.70 kN/m3
g
= 0.426 x 0.718 + 2.2
= 2.50 kN/m3 < 4.70 kN/m3
Since the Roof slope = 4.76 is greater than the greater of (21.3/W+0.5) = 3.30
or 2.38, Unbalanced loads must be considered.
Therefore case (c) of figure 1.3.5.8 governs as shown in figure below, the load
values at various points left eave, ridge and right eave are calculated as below,
22
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.15 kN/m2
= 0.50 kN/m2
= 0.29 kN/m2
= 3.69 m
The balanced and unbalanced design snow loads are shown in the figure below,
0.29
3.69
0.50
0.15
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
0.50
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
23
S N O W
L O A D S
WL
Ww
he=0.63
WIND
Case-2
WL
= 7620 mm
Ww
= 10668 mm
= 2.50 > 2.38
(21.3/W w +0.5) = (21.3/10.668+0.5)
h d = [(0.416) (W W )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] - 0.457
= [(0.416) (10.668)1/3 (0.718 + 0.4788)1/4] - 0.457
= 0.502 m
Snow density,
<= 4.70 kN/m3
g
= [0.426 p g + 2.2]
g
= 0.426 x 0.718 + 2.2
= 2.50 kN/m3 < 4.70 kN/m3
Since the Roof slope = 4.76 is greater than the greater of (21.3/W+0.5) = 2.50
or 2.38, Unbalanced loads must be considered.
Therefore case (c) of figure 1.3.5.8 governs as shown in figure below, the load
values at various points left eave, ridge and right eave are calculated as below,
24
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.15 kN/m2
= 0.50 kN/m2
= 0.36 kN/m2
= 4.64 m
The balanced and unbalanced design snow loads are shown in the figure below,
4.632
0.36
0.50
0.15
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
0.50
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
25
S N O W
L O A D S
Ww
WL
he=0.63
WIND
Case-1
Ww
= 7620 mm
WL
= 7620 mm
L/W
= (30480 / 7620)
= 4.00 = 4.00
We know,
= 0.50
if,
L/W <= 1.00
= 1.00
if,
L/W > 4
Therefore,
26
S N O W
L O A D S
0.60
1.20
0.15
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
0.50
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
The unbalanced loading in the other direction will be mirror image of the above
pattern, if the structural sections are symmetrical there is no need of other checks,
but if not, then the sections should be checked.
27
S N O W
L O A D S
Ww
WL
he=0.63
WIND
Case-1
Ww
= 7620 mm
WL
= 7620 mm
(21.3/W+0.5) = (21.3/7.62+0.5)
= 3.30 > 2.38
h d = [(0.416) (W W )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] - 0.457
= [(0.416) (7.62)1/3 (0.718 + 0.4788)1/4] - 0.457
= 0.399 m
Snow density,
g
= [0.426 p g + 2.2]
<= 4.70 kN/m3
g
= 0.426 x 0.718 + 2.2
= 2.50 kN/m3 < 4.70 kN/m3
Since the Roof slope = 4.76 is greater than the greater of (21.3/W+0.5) = 3.30
or 2.38, Unbalanced loads must be considered.
Therefore case (c) of figure 1.3.5.8 governs as shown in figure below, the load
values at various points left eave, ridge and right eave are calculated as below,
28
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.15 kN/m2
= 0.50 kN/m2
= 0.29 kN/m2
= 3.69 m
The balanced and unbalanced design snow loads are shown in the figure below,
3.69
0.29
0.50
0.15
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
0.50
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
The unbalanced loading in the other direction will be mirror image of the above
pattern, if the structural sections are symmetrical there is no need of other checks,
but if not, then the sections should be checked.
29
S N O W
L O A D S
Partial Loading:a) Rigid Frames:-Partial Loading is not required on the members that span
perpendicular to the ridge line in gable roofs with slopes greater than
[(21.3/W+0.5) = 3.30 (As per MBMA 2002)] [Greater of (21.3/W+0.5) = 3.30
or 2.38 as per MBMA 2006]
b) Continuous Roof Purlin:- All three load cases need to be evaluated as
follows: (Same in MBMA 2002 and 2006)
Case-1: Full balance snow load on each exterior span and half the
balance snow load on all other spans
0.50
0.25
End Bay
Interior Bay
End Bay
0.50
0.25
End Bay
Interior Bay
End Bay
Case-2: Half the balance snow load on each exterior span and
full balanced snow load on all other spans
0.50
0.25
End Bay
Interior Bay
End Bay
End Bay
Interior Bay
End Bay
0.50
0.25
0.25
0.25
End Bay
Interior Bay
End Bay
End Bay
Interior Bay
End Bay
0.50
0.25
0.50
0.25
End Bay
Interior Bay
30
End Bay
S N O W
L O A D S
Note:- Purlin design may be controlled by minimum roof live loads per section
1.3.3 or the unbalanced tapered load of 0.60 kN/m2 at ridge and 1.20 kN/m2 at
the eave.
Eave Overhang Ice Loading:- This load is stipulated as a UDL = 2p f = 0.502 x 2 =
1.004 kN/m2, this needs to be combined only with dead and only the eave
members should be designed for this load. as a uniformly distributed load equal.
Note that even though the overhang is unheated, the value of 2 p f is calculated
using C t = 1.0. However for gable overhangs, p f should be calculated using C t =
1.2. No other loads except dead loads shall be present on the roof when this load
is applied.
31
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.7 C e C t I s p g
= 0.7 x 0.9 x 1 x 1.2 x 1.197
= 0.905 kN/m2
= Cs pf
= 0.86 x 0.905
32
(balanced load)
= 0.778 kN/m2
S N O W
L O A D S
3) Unbalanced snow load need not be considered if the roof slope is,
> 70
OR
< [(21.3/W)+0.5]
Since the roof slope is more than 3.29 < 14.04, unbalanced snow load should
be considered.
L/W
We know,
Therefore,
Snow density,
g
g
Since, width
WL
275 P f /gW L
Roof slope
= (30480 / 7620)
= 4.00 = 4.00
= 0.50
= 0.33 + 0.167 L/W
= 1.00
if,
if,
if,
= 1.00
= [0.426 p g + 2.2]
= 0.426 x 1.197 + 2.2
= 12.05
Therefore case (c) of figure 1.5.8 governs as shown in figure below, the load
values at various points left eave, ridge and right eave are calculated as below,
1.56
0.23
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
0.78
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
33
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.23 kN/m2
= 1.56 kN/m2
The balanced and unbalanced design snow loads are shown in the figure above.
Partial Loading:a) Rigid Frames:-Partial Loading is not required on the members that span
perpendicular to the ridge line in gable roofs with slopes greater than
(21.3/W+0.5) = 3.30
b) Continuous Roof Purlin:- All three load cases need to be evaluated as in
example 7.2
Note:- Purlin Design may be controlled by the unbalanced snow load of 1.56
kN/m2
Eave Overhang Ice Loading:- This load is stipulated as a UDL = 2p f = 0.905 x 2 =
1.81 kN/m2, this needs to be combined only with dead and only the eave
members should be designed for this load.
34
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.7 C e C t I s p g
= 0.7 x 0.9 x 1 x 1.2 x 1.197
= 0.905 kN/m2
= Cs pf
= 0.86 x 0.905
35
(balanced load)
= 0.778 kN/m2
S N O W
L O A D S
6) Unbalanced snow load need not be considered if the roof slope is,
Less than the larger of (21.3/W)+0.5 = 3.29 or 2.38
Since the roof slope is more than 3.29 < 14.04, unbalanced snow load should
be considered.
= 7620 mm
WL
= 7620 mm
Ww
(21.3/W+0.5) = (21.3/7.62+0.5)
= 3.29 > 2.38
h d = [(0.416) (W W )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] - 0.457
= [(0.416) (7.62)1/3 (1.197 + 0.4788)1/4] - 0.457
= 0.475 m
Snow density,
g
= [0.426 p g + 2.2]
<= 4.70 kN/m3
g
= 0.426 x 1.197 + 2.2
= 2.71 kN/m3 < 4.70 kN/m3
Since the Roof slope = 4.76 is greater than the greater of (21.3/W+0.5) = 3.30
or 2.38, Unbalanced loads must be considered.
Therefore case (c) of figure 1.3.5.8 governs as shown in figure below, the load
values at various points left eave, ridge and right eave are calculated as below,
Uniform windward load
Uniform leeward load
Surcharge leeward load
Surcharge leeward length
= 0.23 kN/m2
= 0.78 kN/m2
= 0.64 kN/m2
= 2.53 m
The balanced and unbalanced design snow loads are shown in the figure below,
36
S N O W
L O A D S
2.53
0.64
0.78
0.23
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
0.78
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
Partial Loading:c) Rigid Frames:-Partial Loading is not required on the members that span
perpendicular to the ridge line in gable roofs with slopes greater than
(21.3/W+0.5) = 3.30
d) Continuous Roof Purlin:- All three load cases need to be evaluated as in
example 7.2
Note:- Purlin Design may be controlled by the unbalanced snow load of 1.56
kN/m2
Eave Overhang Ice Loading:- This load is stipulated as a UDL = 2p f = 0.905 x 2 =
1.81 kN/m2, this needs to be combined only with dead and only the eave
members should be designed for this load.
Note that even though the overhang is unheated, the value of 2 p f is calculated
using C t = 1.0. However for gable overhangs, p f should be calculated using C t =
1.2. No other loads except dead loads shall be present on the roof when this load
is applied.
37
S N O W
L O A D S
Example: - 7.4
Given:Building Use
= Manufacturing (Standard Building)
Building Size
Width x Length x Eave Height
(Area 01)
= 30480 x 91440 x 9144 mm
(Area 02)
= 30480 x 53340 x 6096 mm
(Area 03)
= 30480 x 38100 x 9144 mm
(Area 04)
= 15240 x 9144 x 3658 mm (Flat Roof)
Roof Slope
= 2:12 ( = 9.46)
S = 12/2 = 6
Frame type
= Clear Span
Roof type
= Sheltered, Heated, Smooth surface, unventilated,
Roof insulation
= R-19
Terrain Category
=B
Adjacent Structures
= more than 6096 mm away
= 1.915 kN/m2
Ground Snow Load P g
Area 01
Area 03
12
2
Area 04
F
E
C2
9144
C1
B
3657
9144
A
3048
7620
38100
15240
9144
7620
53340
6096
30480
3048
4572
38
Area 02
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.7 C e C t I s p g
= 0.7 x 1.2 x 1 x 1 x 1.915
Check if minimum P f requirement is satisfied,
then p f >= 0.96 I s
If
p g > 0.96 kN/m2
Therefore
pf
= 1.609 kN/m2
= 0.96 kN/m2
= 1.609 kN/m2
Therefore,
Snow density,
g
g
Since, width
WL
275 p f /gW L
Roof slope
= 0.50
= 0.33 + 0.167 L/W
= 1.00
if,
if,
if,
= 6.00
= 1.00
= [0.426 p g + 2.2]
= 0.426 x 1.915 + 2.2
= 9.62
Therefore case (d) of figure 1.5.8 governs as shown in figure below, the load
values at various points left eave, ridge and right eave are calculated as below,
39
S N O W
L O A D S
3.22
0.48
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
1.61
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
Partial Loading:a) Rigid Frames:-Partial Loading is not required on the members that span
perpendicular to the ridge line in gable roofs with slopes greater than
(21.3/W+0.5) = 1.89
b) Continuous Roof Purlin:- All three load cases need to be evaluated as in
example 7.2
Note:- Purlin Design may be controlled by the unbalanced snow load of 3.22
kN/m2
Eave Overhang Ice Loading:- This load is stipulated as a UDL = 2p f = 2 x 1.609 =
3.22 kN/m2, this needs to be combined only with dead and only the eave
members should be designed for this load.
40
S N O W
L O A D S
Therefore,
Snow density,
g
g
Since, width
WL
275 p f /gW L
Roof slope
= 3.50
= 0.50
= 0.33 + 0.167 L/W
= 1.00
if,
if,
if,
= 0.91
= [0.426 p g + 2.2]
= 0.426 x 1.915 + 2.2
= 8.75
Therefore case (c) of figure 1.5.8 governs as shown in figure below, the load
values at various points left eave, ridge and right eave are calculated as below,
2.34
0.48
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
1.61
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
41
S N O W
L O A D S
Therefore,
Snow density,
g
g
Since, width
WL
275 p f /gW L
Roof slope
= 2.50
= 0.50
= 0.33 + 0.167 L/W
= 1.00
if,
if,
if,
= 0.75
= [0.426 p g + 2.2]
= 0.426 x 1.915 + 2.2
= 7.21
Therefore case (c) of figure 1.5.8 governs as shown in figure below, the load
values at various points left eave, ridge and right eave are calculated as below,
42
S N O W
L O A D S
2.21
0.48
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
1.61
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
Partial Loading:c) Rigid Frames:-Partial Loading is not required on the members that span
perpendicular to the ridge line in gable roofs with slopes greater than
(21.3/W+0.5) = 1.89
d) Continuous Roof Purlin:- All three load cases need to be evaluated as in
example 7.2
Note:- Purlin Design may be controlled by the unbalanced snow load of 2.21
kN/m2
43
S N O W
L O A D S
= (h 1 + h 3 )/2 h 2
= Eave height +(width/2) tan
= 9.14 + (30.48/2) x tan 9.46 = 11.68 m
= 3.65
= Eave height +(Offset/2) tan
= 9.14 + (15.24/2) x tan 9.46 = 10.41 m
= (11.68 + 10.41)/2 3.65
= 7.40 m
= Pressure / Density
= pf / g
= 1.609 /3.02 = 0.533 m
= (h r h b )
= 7.40 0.533 = 6.87 m
= 6.87 /0.533 = 12.89 > 0.20
hr (Avg.)
hd
hb
w
(average)
9144
LOWER ROOF
7.26
1.61
h1
hr h3
h2
7498
9144
44
S N O W
L O A D S
L L (windward)
h d (windward)
= 9.14 m
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (L L )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -
0.457}
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (9.14) 1/3 (1.915+0.4788) - 0.457}
= 0.469 m < h c = 6.87 m
L u (leeward)
h d (leeward)
= 91.44 m
= [(0.416) (L u )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -0.457
= [(0.416) (91.44) 1/3 (1.915+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.875 m < h c = 6.87 m
= 7.50 m
= h d g = 1.875 x 3.02
= 5.66 kN/m2
= p s + p d = 1.609 + 5.66
= 7.26 kN/m2
b. Sliding Snow
Not applicable, because from the profile of the building, we can see that no
snow will slide from the Area 01 to Area 04
2) Calculation of Snow Area B (See isometric view)
a. Drift Load
Sloped roof snow load, Ps = 1.609 kN/m2
(balanced load)
= Eave Height Area 1 Eave Height Area 2
hr
= 9.144 6.096
= 3.048 m
h b (Depth of snow) = Pressure / Density
= pf / g
= 1.609 /3.02 = 0.533 m
= (h r h b )
= 3.048 0.533 = 2.515 m
hc
= 2.515 /0.533 = 4.72 > 0.20
hc / hb
Therefore, Drift Loads should be considered.
LOWER ROOF
hr (Avg.)
hd
5.11
1.61
hb
4640
w
45
S N O W
L O A D S
= L u (leeward)
= 30.48 m
L L (windward)
Therefore, leeward drift controls,
= [(0.416) (L u )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -0.457
h d (leeward)
= [(0.416) (30.48) 1/3 (1.915+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.16 m < h c = 2.515 m
= 4.64 m
= 4h d = 4 x 1.16
Width w
Drift Surcharge load, P d
= h d g = 1.16 x 3.02
= 3.50 kN/m2
= p s + p d = 1.609 + 3.50
= 5.11 kN/m2
b. Sliding Snow
We know,
= (h r h b )
= 3.048 0.533 = 2.515 m
hc
Snow will slide from ridge to eave width of Area 01 towards Area 02
= 30.48 /2
= 15.24 m
Lu
Since roof slope of 9.46 is less than 65
C SD
= (1 /65) = (1-9.46/65) = 0.854
Since h c > 0.914 m
w
= (0.914 / h c ) x 6.096
= (0.914 / 2.515) x 6.096
= 2.215
But w should not be greater than 1.524 m, hence w
Sliding Snow Load S L
Maximum Sliding Load
Sliding Load /m2
Therefore total load
= 1.524
46
S N O W
L O A D S
= 1.609 kN/m2
(balanced load)
LOWER ROOF
hr
hd
5.48
1.61
hb
5120
w
53340
53340
L L (windward)
h d (leeward)
= 53.34 m
= 0.75 x [(0.416) (53.34) 1/3 (1.915+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.12 m < h c = 2.515 m
= 38.10 m
L u (leeward)
h d (leeward)
= [(0.416) (38.10) 1/3 (1.915+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.28 m < h c = 2.515 m
Therefore, leeward drift controls with hd = 1.28 m
= 5.12 m
Width w
= 4h d = 4 x 1.28
Drift Surcharge load, p d
= h d g = 1.28 x 3.02
= 3.86 kN/m2
= p s + p d = 1.609 + 3.86
= 5.48 kN/m2
b. Sliding Snow
Not applicable, because from the profile of the building, we can see that no
snow will slide from this Area.
47
S N O W
L O A D S
CANOPY LOWER
THAN EAVE HEIGHT
1524
3.26
4.67
1.93
3048
3048
6096
LOAD ON CANOPY
L L (windward)
h d (leeward)
= p f + p d = 1.93 + 2.67
= 4.67 kN/m2
Note: - For the below eave canopy, the minimum design live load per section
1607.11.2.5 of the IBC 2000 is 2.87 kN/m2
48
S N O W
L O A D S
b. Sliding Snow
We know,
hc
= (h r h b )
= 1.524 0.639 = 0.885 m
Snow will slide from ridge to eave width of Area 01 towards Area 02
= 30.48 /2
= 15.24 m
Lu
Since roof slope of 9.46 is less than 65
= (1 /65) = (1-9.46/65) = 0.854
C SD
Since h c < 0.914 m, w is lesser of 6.096 or the lower roof width = 3.048
w
=3.048 m
Sliding Snow Load S L
= 1.25 p fu L u (1-C SD ) <= g h c w
= 1.25x1.609x15.24x(1-0.854) = 4.48 kN/m
Maximum Sliding Load
= g h c w= 3.02 x 0.885 x3.048 = 8.15 kN/m
2
Sliding Load /m
= S L / w = 4.48/ 3.048
= 1.47 kN/m2
Therefore total load
= 1.93 + 1.47
= 3.40 kN/m2
CANOPY
TOTAL = 3.40
1.47 (Sliding Snow)
1.93 (Flat Roof Snow)
1524
3048
3048
LOAD ON CANOPY
5.48
5.11
0.53
4.62
5.15
1.61
49
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.533 m
= 0.50 p f
= 2 p f /C e
Check if calculated snow depth in valley extends above snow level at ridge:
Snow depth at valley, h dv
= 2.67 / 3.02
= 0.88 m
= 0.3 x 1.61
= 0.483
0.5 Pf
0.5 Pf
2Pf / Ce
hdv
2.67
0.48
0.80
0.80
15240
RIDGE
15240
VALLEY
50
RIDGE
S N O W
L O A D S
51
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.7 C e C t I s P g
= 0.7 x 1.2 x 1 x 1 x 1.915
Check if minimum P f requirement is satisfied,
then p f >= 0.96 I s
If
p g > 0.96 kN/m2
Therefore
pf
= 1.609 kN/m2
= 0.96 kN/m2
= 1.609 kN/m2
52
= 0.48 kN/m2
= 1.61 kN/m2
= 1.02 kN/m2
= 5.39 m
S N O W
L O A D S
The balanced and unbalanced design snow loads are shown in the figure below,
5.39
1.01
1.61
0.48
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
1.02
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
Partial Loading:a) Rigid Frames:-Partial Loading is not required on the members that span
perpendicular to the ridge line in gable roofs with slopes greater than
(21.3/W+0.5) = 1.89
b) Continuous Roof Purlin:- All three load cases need to be evaluated as in
example 7.2
Note:- Purlin Design may be controlled by the unbalanced snow load of 3.22
kN/m2
Eave Overhang Ice Loading:- This load is stipulated as a UDL = 2p f = 2 x 1.609 =
3.22 kN/m2, this needs to be combined only with dead and only the eave
members should be designed for this load.
Note that even though the overhang is unheated, the value of 2 p f is calculated
using C t = 1.0. However for gable overhangs, p f should be calculated using C t =
1.2. No other loads except dead loads shall be present on the roof when this load
is applied.
53
S N O W
L O A D S
= (h 1 + h 3 )/2 h 2
= Eave height +(width/2) tan
= 9.14 + (30.48/2) x tan 9.46 = 11.68 m
= 3.65
= Eave height +(Offset/2) tan
= 9.14 + (15.24/2) x tan 9.46 = 10.41 m
= 7.40 m
= (11.68 + 10.41)/2 3.65
= Pressure / Density
= Pf / g
= 1.609 /3.02 = 0.533 m
= (h r h b )
= 7.40 0.533 = 6.87 m
= 6.87 /0.533 = 12.89 > 0.20
hr (Avg.)
hd
hb
w
(average)
9144
LOWER ROOF
7.26
1.61
h1
hr h3
h2
7498
9144
54
S N O W
L O A D S
L L (windward)
= 9.14 m
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (L L )1/3 (P g + 0.4788)1/4] h d (windward)
0.457}
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (9.14) 1/3 (1.915+0.4788) - 0.457}
= 0.469 m < h c = 6.87 m
L u (leeward)
h d (leeward)
= 91.44 m
= [(0.416) (L u )1/3 (P g + 0.4788)1/4] -0.457
= [(0.416) (91.44) 1/3 (1.915+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.875 m < h c = 6.87 m
= 7.50 m
= h d g = 1.875 x 3.02
= 5.66 kN/m2
= P s + P d = 1.609 + 5.66
= 7.26 kN/m2
b. Sliding Snow
Not applicable, because from the profile of the building, we can see that no
snow will slide from the Area 01 to Area 04
2) Calculation of Snow Area B (See isometric view)
a. Drift Load
(balanced load)
Sloped roof snow load, p s = 1.609 kN/m2
= Eave Height Area 1 Eave Height Area 2
hr
= 3.048 m
= 9.144 6.096
h b (Depth of snow) = Pressure / Density
= 1.609 /3.02 = 0.533 m
= Pf / g
hc
= (h r h b )
= 3.048 0.533 = 2.515 m
= 2.515 /0.533 = 4.72 > 0.20
hc / hb
Therefore, Drift Loads should be considered.
LOWER ROOF
hr (Avg.)
hd
5.11
1.61
hb
4640
w
55
S N O W
L O A D S
= L u (leeward)
= 30.48 m
L L (windward)
Therefore, leeward drift controls,
h d (leeward)
= [(0.416) (L u )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -0.457
= [(0.416) (30.48) 1/3 (1.915+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.16 m < h c = 2.515 m
= 4.64 m
= 4h d = 4 x 1.16
Width w
Drift Surcharge load, p d
= h d g = 1.16 x 3.02
= 3.50 kN/m2
= p s + p d = 1.609 + 3.50
= 5.11 kN/m2
b. Sliding Snow
We know,
= (h r h b )
= 3.048 0.533 = 2.515 m
hc
Snow will slide from ridge to eave width of Area 01 towards Area 02
= 30.48 /2
Lu
= 15.24 m
Since roof slope of 9.46 is greater than 1.19 Sliding snow must be checked
Total Sliding load/m of eave = 0.4 p f W
= 0.4 x 1.609 x 15.24
= 9.808 kN/m
= 4.57 m
= 9.808 / 4.57
Since, (S d /g) = 2.15 / 3.02
hc
= (p s + S d )
hb
hr
pt
= 2.15 kN/m2
LOWER ROOF
3.76
1.61
4.57
56
S N O W
L O A D S
= 1.609 kN/m2
(balanced load)
LOWER ROOF
hr
hd
5.48
1.61
hb
5120
w
53340
53340
L L (windward)
h d (leeward)
= 53.34 m
= 0.75 x [(0.416) (53.34) 1/3 (1.915+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.12 m < h c = 2.515 m
= 38.10 m
L u (leeward)
h d (leeward)
= [(0.416) (38.10) 1/3 (1.915+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.28 m < h c = 2.515 m
Therefore, leeward drift controls with hd = 1.28 m
Width w
= 4h d = 4 x 1.28
= 5.12 m
Drift Surcharge load, p d
= h d g = 1.28 x 3.02
= 3.86 kN/m2
= p s + p d = 1.609 + 3.86
= 5.48 kN/m2
57
S N O W
L O A D S
b. Sliding Snow
Not applicable, because from the profile of the building, we can see that no
snow will slide from this Area.
4) Calculation of Area D (See isometric view)
a. Drift Load
Unheated structure due to canopy condition (C t = 1.20)
= 0.7 C e C t I s p g
Flat Roof Snow Load p f
= 0.7 x 1.2 x 1.2 x 1.0 x 1.915 = 1.93 kN/m2
= Eave Height Area 2 Canopy Height
= 1.524 m
= 6.096 4.572
h b (Depth of snow) = Pressure / Density
= 1.93 /3.02 = 0.639 m
= pf / g
hc
= (h r h b )
= 1.524 0.639 = 0.885 m
= 0.885 /0.639 = 1.38 > 0.20
hc / hb
Therefore, Drift Loads should be considered.
hr
CANOPY LOWER
THAN EAVE HEIGHT
1524
3.26
4.67
1.93
3048
3048
6096
LOAD ON CANOPY
L L (windward)
h d (leeward)
= p f + p d = 1.93 + 2.67
= 4.67 kN/m2
Note: - For the below eave canopy, the minimum design live load per section
7.4.5 of the ASCE 7-05 is 2 p f = 3.87 kN/m2
58
S N O W
L O A D S
b. Sliding Snow
We know,
= (h r h b )
= 1.524 0.639 = 0.885 m
hc
Since roof slope of 9.46 is greater than 1.19 Sliding snow must be checked
Total Sliding load/m of eave = 0.4 p f W
= 0.4 x 1.609 x 15.24
Sliding snow shall be distributed over a length of 15 ft
(Even though the canopy width is 10ft = 3.048 m)
= 9.808 / 4.57
Since, (S d /g) = 2.15 / 3.02
= 4.57 m
= 2.15 kN/m2
CANOPY
1524
pt
= 9.808 kN/m
4.08
2.15
1.93
3048
3048
5.48
5.11
0.53
4.62
5.15
1.61
59
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.533 m
At Ridge
At Valley
Check if calculated snow depth in valley extends above snow level at ridge:
Snow depth at valley, h dv
= 2.67 / 3.02
= 0.88 m
= 0.483 kN/m2
0.5 Pf
0.5 Pf
2Pf / Ce
hdv
2.67
0.48
0.80
0.80
15240
RIDGE
15240
VALLEY
60
RIDGE
S N O W
L O A D S
Example: - 7.5
This example demonstrates the calculation of drift snow loads including
unbalanced gable roof snow load and sliding snow.
Given:Building Use
= Warehouse (Standard Building)
Building Size
Width x Length x Eave Height
(Area 01)
= 36576 x 38100 x 7315 mm
(Area 02)
= 36576 x 38100 x 7315 mm
= 9144 x 3657mm (Flat Roof)
(Area 03)
= 13716 x 4267 mm (Flat Roof)
(Area 04)
S = 12/6 = 2
Roof Slope
= 6:12 ( = 26.56)
Frame type
= Multi Gable
Roof type
= Partially Exposed, Heated, Smooth surface,
Unventilated,
Roof insulation
= R-19
=B
Terrain Category
Adjacent Structures
= more than 6096 mm away
= 1.44 kN/m2
Ground Snow Load p g
Area 02
Area 01
12
6
Area 05
16459
7315
D
3048
A
4267
38100
Area 03
3657
6096
3657
18288
18288
36576
Area 04
9144
61
3353
13716
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.7 C e C t I s P g
= 0.7 x 1 x 1 x 1 x 1.44
Check if minimum P f requirement is satisfied,
then p f >= 0.96 I s
If
p g > 0.96 kN/m2
pf
Therefore
= 1.008 kN/m2
= 0.96 kN/m2
= 1.008 kN/m2
Therefore,
Snow density,
g
g
Since, width
WL
275 p f /gW L
Roof slope
= 0.50
= 0.33 + 0.167 L/W
= 1.00
if,
if,
if,
= 2.08
= [0.426 p g + 2.2]
= 0.426 x 1.44 + 2.2
= 3.65
Therefore case (c) of figure 1.5.8 governs as shown in figure below, the load
values at various points left eave, ridge and right eave are calculated as below,
62
S N O W
L O A D S
1.62
0.30
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
1.00
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
Partial Loading:a) Rigid Frames:-Partial Loading is not required on the members that span
perpendicular to the ridge line in gable roofs with slopes greater than
(21.3/W+0.5) = 1.66
b) Continuous Roof Purlin:- All three load cases need to be evaluated as in
example 7.2
Note:- Purlin Design may be controlled by the unbalanced snow load of 1.62
kN/m2
Drift Loads and Sliding Snow Loads:Note:- Unbalanced snow loads, drift loads and sliding snow load are treated as
separate load cases and are not to be combined as per section 1.5.12.
63
S N O W
L O A D S
hb
LOWER ROOF
hr
hd
4.29
1.00
hb
4670
L L (windward)
h d (windward)
= 9.14 m
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (L L )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -
0.457}
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (9.14) 1/3 (1.44+0.4788) - 0.457}
= 0.425 m < h c = 3.30 m
L u (leeward)
h d (leeward)
= 36.58 m
= [(0.416) (L u )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -0.457
= [(0.416) (36.58) 1/3 (1.44+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.16 m < h c = 3.30 m
= 4.64 m
= h d g = 1.16 x 2.81
= 3.26 kN/m2
= p f + p d = 1.008 + 3.26
= 4.26 kN/m2
64
S N O W
L O A D S
b. Sliding Snow
= (h r h b )
= 3.66 0.359 = 3.30 m
hc
Snow will slide from ridge to eave width of Area 01 towards Area 03
Lu
= 36.58 /2
= 18.29 m
Since roof slope of 26.56 is less than 65
= (1 /65) = (1-26.56/65) = 0.591
C SD
Since h c > 0.914 m
w
= (0.914 / h c ) x 6.096
= (0.914 / 3.30) x 6.096
= 1.688
Sliding Snow Load S L
Maximum Sliding Load
Sliding Load /m2
Therefore total load
hb
LOWER ROOF
hr
hd
6.59
1.00
hb
1688
65
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.50 p f
= 2 p f /C e
Check if calculated snow depth in valley extends above snow level at ridge:
Snow depth at valley, h dv
= 2.01 / 2.81
= 0.72 m
= 0.30 kN/m2
0.5 Pf
0.5 Pf
2Pf / Ce
hdv
2.01
0.30
0.50
0.50
18288
RIDGE
18288
VALLEY
66
RIDGE
S N O W
L O A D S
AREA 1
RIDGE
AREA 2
EAVE
hr (Average)
4.35
1.00
hd
AREA 4
L L (windward)
h d (windward)
hb
4754
0.457}
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (7.62) 1/3 (1.44+0.4788) - 0.457}
= 0.381 m < h c = 7.86 m
L u (leeward)
h d (leeward)
= 38.10 m
= [(0.416) (L u )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -0.457
= [(0.416) (38.10) 1/3 (1.44+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.19 m < h c = 3.30 m
= 4.76 m
= h d g = 1.19 x 2.81
= 3.34 kN/m2
= p f + p d = 1.008 + 3.34
= 4.35 kN/m2
b. Sliding Snow
We can see that no will slide from Area 2 to Area 4
67
S N O W
L O A D S
2.47
hr
4.29
AREA 5
1.00
3352
4648
3352
L L (windward)
h d (windward)
= (13.716+3.35) m
= 17.06 m
1/3
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (L L ) (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -
0.457}
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (17.06) 1/3 (1.44+0.4788) - 0.457}
= 0.602 m < h c = 7.86 m
L u (leeward)
h d (leeward)
= 36.58 m
= [(0.416) (L u )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -0.457
= [(0.416) (36.58) 1/3 (1.44+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.17 m < h c = 3.30 m
= 4.68 m
= h d g = 1.17 x 2.81
= 3.29 kN/m2
= p f + p d = 1.008 + 3.29
= 4.29 kN/m2
68
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.45
= 0.52 m
= 0.52 + 0.359
= 0.879 m
= g (h d + h b ) = 2.81 x 0.879
= 2.47 kN/m2
b. Sliding Snow
hc
C SD
Since h c > 0.914 m
w
= (h r h b )
= 3.048 0.359 = 2.689 m
= (1 /65) = (1-26.56/65) = 0.591
= (0.914 / h c ) x 6.096
= (0.914 / 2.689) x 6.096
= 2.07 m
= 1.524 m
Since the width of sliding snow w = 1.524 < gap = 3.35 m, the sliding snow
will fall in between the building.
69
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.7 C e C t I s P g
= 0.7 x 1 x 1 x 1 x 1.44
Check if minimum P f requirement is satisfied,
then p f >= 0.96 I s
If
p g > 0.96 kN/m2
Therefore
pf
= 1.008 kN/m2
= 0.96 kN/m2
= 1.008 kN/m2
70
= 0.30 kN/m2
= 1.008 kN/m2
= 1.66* kN/m2
S N O W
L O A D S
= (8/3) h d ( S ) 0.5
= (8/3) x 0.833 ( 2 ) 0.5
= 3.14 m
The balanced and unbalanced design snow loads are shown in the figure below,
3.14
1.66
1.00
0.30
UNBALANCED SNOW LOAD
1.00
BALANCED SNOW LOAD
RIDGE
LEFT
EAVE
RIGHT
EAVE
ELEVATION
Partial Loading:a) Rigid Frames:-Partial Loading is not required on the members that span
perpendicular to the ridge line in gable roofs with slopes greater than
(21.3/W+0.5) = 1.66
b) Continuous Roof Purlin:- All three load cases need to be evaluated as in
example 7.2
Note:- Purlin Design may be controlled by the unbalanced snow load of 1.62
kN/m2
Drift Loads and Sliding Snow Loads:Note:- Unbalanced snow loads, drift loads and sliding snow load are treated as
separate load cases and are not to be combined as per section 1.3.5.12.
71
S N O W
L O A D S
hb
hr
hd
LOWER ROOF
4.26
1.00
hb
4.64
L L (windward)
h d (windward)
= 9.14 m
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (L L )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -
0.457}
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (9.14) 1/3 (1.44+0.4788) - 0.457}
= 0.425 m < h c = 3.30 m
L u (leeward)
h d (leeward)
= 36.58 m
= [(0.416) (L u )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -0.457
= [(0.416) (36.58) 1/3 (1.44+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.16 m < h c = 3.30 m
= 4.64 m
= h d g = 1.16 x 2.81
= 3.26 kN/m2
= p f + p d = 1.008 + 3.26
= 4.26 kN/m2
72
S N O W
L O A D S
c. Sliding Snow
= (h r h b )
= 3.66 0.359 = 3.30 m
hc
Snow will slide from ridge to eave width of Area 01 towards Area 03
= 36.58 /2
= 18.29 m
Lu
Since roof slope of 26.56 is greater than 1.19 Sliding snow must be checked
Total Sliding load/m of eave = 0.4 p f W
= 0.4 x 1.008 x 18.29
= 7.37 kN/m
= 4.57 m
= 7.37 / 4.57
Since, (S d /g) = 1.61 / 2.81
pt
= 1.61 kN/m2
hb
= (p f + S d )
hc
LOWER ROOF
2.62
1.00
4.57
hb
hr
73
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.50 p f
= 2 p f /C e
Check if calculated snow depth in valley extends above snow level at ridge:
Snow depth at valley, h dv
= 2.01 / 2.81
= 0.72 m
= 0.30 kN/m2
0.5 Pf
0.5 Pf
2Pf / Ce
hdv
2.01
0.30
0.50
0.50
18288
RIDGE
18288
VALLEY
74
RIDGE
S N O W
L O A D S
AREA 2 RIDGE
hd
hr
hd
EAVE
4.35
1.00
AREA 4
L L (windward)
h d (windward)
1.34
hb
4.75
hb
hr (average)
AREA 1
0.457}
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (7.62) 1/3 (1.44+0.4788) - 0.457}
= 0.381 m < h c = 7.86 m
L u (leeward)
h d (leeward)
= 38.10 m
= [(0.416) (L u )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -0.457
= [(0.416) (38.10) 1/3 (1.44+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.19 m < h c = 3.30 m
= 4.75 m
= h d g = 1.19 x 2.81
= 3.34 kN/m2
= p f + p d = 1.008 + 3.34
= 4.35 kN/m2
b. Sliding Snow
We can see that no will slide from Area 2 to Area 4
75
S N O W
L O A D S
76
S N O W
L O A D S
2.47
hr
4.29
AREA 5
1.00
3352
4648
3352
L L (windward)
h d (windward)
= (13.716+3.35) m
= 17.06 m
1/3
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (L L ) (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -
0.457}
= 0.75 {[(0.416) (17.06) 1/3 (1.44+0.4788) - 0.457}
= 0.602 m < h c = 7.86 m
L u (leeward)
h d (leeward)
= 36.58 m
= [(0.416) (L u )1/3 (p g + 0.4788)1/4] -0.457
= [(0.416) (36.58) 1/3 (1.44+0.4788) - 0.457
= 1.17 m < h c = 3.30 m
= 4.68 m
= h d g = 1.17 x 2.81
= 3.29 kN/m2
= p f + p d = 1.008 + 3.29
= 4.29 kN/m2
77
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.45
= 0.52 m
= 0.52 + 0.359
= 0.879 m
= g (h d + h b ) = 2.81 x 0.879
= 2.47 kN/m2
b. Sliding Snow
Not applicable for this example, sliding snow will fall between the two
buildings. (The final resting place of any snow that slides off a higher roof onto
a lower roof will depend on the size, position, and orentation of each roof.
Reference ASCE commentary)
78
S N O W
L O A D S
Example: - 7.6
Given:Building Use
Building Size
Roof Slope
Frame type
Roof type
Roof insulation
Terrain Category
Adjacent Structures
Ground Snow Load p g
A
1828
7620
C
5486
B
30480
60960
33528
3048
22860
2438
7620
3048x2438x30480
Raised Roof
5486
33528
79
S N O W
L O A D S
= 0.7 C e C t I s p g
= 0.7 x 1 x 1 x 1.1 x 1.915
= 1.47 kN/m2
Check if minimum P f requirement is satisfied,
If
p g > 0.96 kN/m2
then p f >= 0.96 I s = 1.06 kN/m2
= 1.47 kN/m2
Therefore
pf
Snow density,
<= 4.70 kN/m3
g
= [0.426 p g + 2.2]
g
= 0.426 x 1.915 + 2.2
= 3.02 kN/m3 < 4.70 kN/m3
22860
3048
w2
7620
w1
3.76
2.74
hd
hr
1.47
hb
3030
80
1680
S N O W
L O A D S
= 22.86 m
= 0.75 x [(0.416) (L u )1/3 (P g + 0.4788)1/4] -0.457
= 0.75 x [(0.416) (22.86) 1/3 (1.915+0.4788) - 0.457
= 0.76 m < h c = 1.954 m
= 0.76 m, and
= 4h d = 4 x 0.76
= 3.03 m
= 0.76 + 0.486
= 1.246 m
= (h d - h b ) x g
= 1.246 x 3.02
= 3.76 kN/m2
R
Therefore,
Width w
hd
R
hd - hb
R
Therefore, P t
R
PR
w1
5.03
hd
hr
1.47
hb
4740
PR
81
C R A N E
Chapter
L O A D S
Crane Loads
MBMA 02
MBMA 06
Section 2.1
eneral
The recommended practices in this chapter are intended to serve as a guide for
the design of crane buildings with bridge, monorail, jib and single leg gantry
cranes of service classifications A through F.
The class of crane service can significantly affect design, and therefore, the cost
and performance of building framing used for the support of the crane system.
The six different categories of crane service classification have been established
by the CMAA as a guide for determining the service requirements of specific
applications. See table 8.1 below for details on these classification.
MBMA recommendations are normally not applicable for crane buildings with
service class E or F, however some additional guidelines have been provided. For
more detailed information see AISE Technical Report # 13.
Cranes may be manufactured to suit any of the crane classification described by
CMAA. Cranes are available with bridge, hoist, or trolley, either hand geared or
electric powered. The speed of hand geared cranes is low, and the impact forces
which the supporting structures may resist are low compared to faster electric
cranes, these are generally specified by the customer end-user in the PIF.
The different types of cranes commonly used are listed below,
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Note:- There are no major changes in MBMA 2006 compared MBMA 2002
C R A N E
L O A D S
Class B
(Light Service)
This service class covers cranes used in repair shops, light assembly operations, service buildings,
light warehousing, or similar duty, where service requirements are light and the speed is slow.
Loads may vary from no load to occasional full-rated loads, with 2 - 5 lifts per hour.
Class C
(Moderate Service)
This service class covers cranes used in machine shops or paper mill machine rooms, or similar
duty, where service requirements are moderate. The cranes will handle loads that average 50% of
the rated capacity, with 5 - 10 lifts/hour, with not over 50% of the lifts at rated capacity.
Class D
(Heavy Service)
This service class covers cranes that may be used in heavy machine shops, foundries, fabricating
plants, steel warehouses, container yards, lumber mills, or similar duty, and standard duty
bucket and magnet operations where heavy-duty production is required. Loads approaching
50% of the rated capacity are handled constantly during the working period. High speeds are
desirable for this type of service, with 10 - 20 lifts/hour, with not over 65% of the lifts at rated
capacity.
Class E
(Severe Service)
This type of service requires cranes capable of handling loads approaching the rated capacity
throughout their life. Applications may include magnet, bucket, and magnet/bucket combination
cranes for scrap yards, cement mills, lumber mills, fertilizer plants, container handling, or similar
duty, with 20 or more lifts/hour at or near the rated capacity.
Class F
(Continuous Severe Service)
This type of service requires cranes capable of handling loads approaching rated capacity
continuously under severe service conditions throughout their life. Applications may include
custom-designed specialty cranes essential to performing the critical work tasks affecting the
total production facility. These cranes must provide the highest reliability, with special attention
to ease-of-maintenance features.
(CMAA stands for Crane Manufacturers Association of America)
C R A N E
L O A D S
Underhung
MBMA 02
MBMA 06
Table 2.2
Power Source
1. Hand Geared
2. Electric
1. Hand Geared
2. Electric
3. Electric
4. Electric
Top Running
5. Electric
6. Electric
Jib Cranes
Description
Single Girder
Single Girder
Single Girder
Single Girder
Double Girder
Box Girder
Pendant Operated
4-Wheel End
Truck
Box Girder
Cab Operated
4-Wheel End
Truck
Box Girder
Cab Operated
8-Wheel End
Truck
Span or Reach
3.0 to 15.0 m
3.0 to 15.0 m
3.0 to 15.0 m
3.0 to 15.0 m
6.0 to 18.0 m
Capacity
0.5 to 10 MT
1.0 to 10 MT
0.5 to 10 MT
0.5 to 10 MT
5.0 to 25 MT
15.0 to 27.0 m
5.0 to 25 MT
15.0 to 30.0 m
Up to 60 MT
15.0 to 30.0 m
Up to 250 MT
1. Hand Geared
or Electric
Floor Mounted
280 to 360
2.4 to 6.0
0.25 to 5 MT
2. Hand Geared
or Electric
Column Mounted
180
2.4 to 6.0
0.25 to 5 MT
Crane Loads
Crane buildings must be designed for forces induced by the operation or
movement of the bridge, hoist, and trolley of the supported cranes. All elements
affected by crane loads shall be designed to resist the loads specified. Unless
otherwise specified in the PIF, the vertical impact, lateral and longitudinal forces
for cranes are calculated using the normal allowance given in MBMA for service
class A to D and AISE Report # 13 for Class E & F. These allowances depend
solely on the power source of crane, hand geared or electric, and the method of
operation, Pendant or Cab. These impact factors and may be inadequate for:
1. Special Purpose Cranes
2. Cranes with fast operating speeds
3. Top running cranes with double flange, straight tread wheels or guide
rollers.
4. Improper bridge or trolley bumpers
5. High span to wheel base ratios.
6. Poorly aligned and maintained cranes, rails and runway beams
7. Improper operating procedures.
C R A N E
L O A D S
Wheel Loads
1. Vertical Loads
The crane beams are designed for all loads transferred by the crane wheels,
Vertical, Lateral & Longitudinal. In case the crane wheel loads are not specified
in the specification from the supplier, the vertical wheel load may be
conservatively approximated as below,
Eqn. 2.4.1-1 MBMA 02
Eqn. 2.4.1-1 MBMA 06
WL
RC + HT + 0.5 CW
NW b
WL
RC
HT
CW
NW b
=
=
=
=
=
Where,
MBMA 02
MBMA 06
Section 2.4.2
ASCE 7-05
Section 4.10.2
Sr. No.
1
2
3
4
Crane Description
Monorail Cranes (Powered), (Brackets &
Connections included)
Cab or Radio operated bridge cranes (Powered)
Pendant operated bridge cranes (Powered)
Bridge cranes or monorail cranes with hand
geared bridge, trolley and hoist
Impact Factor
25
25
10
0
Vertical Impact shall not be required for Design of frames, support columns, or the building
foundation.
The maximum wheel loads used for the design of runway beams, including
monorails, their connections and support brackets, shall be increased by the
percentage given in table 8.3 to allow for the vertical impact or vibration.
Vertical Impact is not applied for the design of main frame columns,
independent crane columns and foundation.
C R A N E
2.
L O A D S
Lateral Loads
The lateral force or the horizontal load on the bridge crane runway beams with
electrically powered trolleys shall be calculated as 20% of the sum of the rated
capacity of the crane and weight of the hoist and trolley.
This force is assumed to act horizontally at the top surface of a runway rail, in
either direction perpendicular to the beam length and should be distributed with
due regard to the lateral stiffness of the crane runway beam, the runway beams
are of equal stiffness, the lateral forces shall be distributed equally between them.
Sec. 2.4.3 MBMA 02
Sec. 2.4.3 MBMA 06
Lateral Force =
0.20 x ( RC + HT )
Where,
RC
HT
=
=
Rated Capacity
Weight of hoist with trolley
3. Longitudinal Loads
Runway beams, including monorails, their connections, and the longitudinal
bracing system shall be designed to support horizontal forces calculated as 10%
of the maximum wheel loads excluding the vertical impact. Longitudinal loads
shall be assumed to act horizontally at the top of the rails and in each direction
parallel to the length of the runway beam. The runway beams, including the
monorails, their connections, and the longitudinal bracing system shall also be
designed for crane stop forces.
Sec. 2.4.4 MBMA 02
Sec. 2.4.4 MBMA 06
Longitudinal Force
Where,
WL
C R A N E
L O A D S
Table 8.4 Crane Impact, Side Thrust and Traction Forces for Crane Class E & F
Crane Type
Vertical Impact %
of maximum
wheel loads
25
25
40
40
Tractive force
(Long. Load) as %
of maximum load
on driving wheels
20
20
25
100
20
25
25
20
25
10
100
100
30
200
10
20
20
20
20
20
Mill cranes
Ladle cranes
Clamshell bucket and magnet cranes
(including slab and billet yard
cranes)
Soaking pit cranes
Stripping cranes
Motor room, maintenance cranes, etc
Stacker cranes (cab operated)
Pendant operated cranes
See AISE Technical Report # 13 Table 1 for more details
Example
Example: - 8.1
Crane Capacity (RC)
Weight of trolley (HT)
Weight of Crane
Therefore, CW
Number of end truck wheels
Class of Crane A to D
= 10 MT
= 0.74 MT
= 8.30 MT
= 8.30 0.74
=2
= 7.56 MT
= 7.26 MT
= 72.6 kN
C R A N E
L O A D S
Applying the Impact factors for different cranes from table 8.3, the vertical load
with impact will be,
Monorails
Powered
Hand Operated
= 72.6 x 1.25
= 72.6 x 1.00
= 90.75 kN
= 72.60 kN
= 90.75 kN
= 79.86 kN
= 72.60 kN
2. Lateral Loads
a. Service Class A to D
Lateral Force
= 0.20 x ( RC + HT )
= 0.20 x ( 10 + 0.74 )
= 21.5 / 4
= 2.15 MT
= 21.5 kN
= 5.38 kN
= 0.40 x ( 10 + 0.74 )
= 4.30 MT
= 43.0 kN
= 10.75 kN
3. Longitudinal Loads
a. Service Class A to D
Longitudinal Force
Dividing by 2 sides of the bridge,
Longitudinal Force /side
= 0.10 x WL
= 0.10 x 72.6
= 7.26 kN
= 7.26 / 2
= 3.63 kN
= 0.20 x 72.6
= 14.5 kN
= 14.5 / 2
= 7.25 kN
C R A N E
L O A D S
C R A N E
L O A D S
C R A N E
L O A D S
10
C R A N E
L O A D S
11
C R A N E
L O A D S
Suspension Systems
Monorail and Underhung suspension systems may be rigid or flexible as shown
in the figure below, flexible systems may result in lower effective crane loads and
reduced wear.
For flexible systems, anti-sway bracing should be provided to limit the sway of
the flexible supports to five degrees in both the lateral and longitudinal
directions.
All runway systems must be aligned and leveled before anti-sway bracing is
installed. The bracing should not be allowed to carry any of the vertical loads
imposed on the support system.
Anti-sway bracing should be installed so that it does not interfere with or restrict
the normal thermal expansion or contraction of the system. On two runway
systems, only one of the runways should be laterally braced. Lateral braces
should be installed at each suspension point. The other runway beam must be
left free to float and provide a relief for variations in runway alignment, crane
deflections and building variations.
12
C R A N E
L O A D S
13
C R A N E
L O A D S
Runway Stops
The force produced by a crane striking a runway stop is dependant on the
energy-absorbing device used in the crane bumper. The device may may be
hydraulic or spring type. The bumper forces should be obtained from the crane
manufacturer and provided by the customer. In the absence of this data, AISE
Technical Report # 13 provides guidance on computing the bumper forces for
different energy absorbing device types.
For cranes located outside enclosed buildings, consideration should be given to
the initial velocity and related bumper force that may be produced by the action
of specified wind loads on the crane.
14
C R A N E
L O A D S
Example
Example: - 8.2
Crane Capacity (RC)
Weight of trolley (HT)
Weight of Crane
Therefore, CW
Number of end truck wheels
Bridge Load Rated Speed V B
Trolley Load Rated Speed
= 10 MT
= 0.74 MT
= 8.30 MT
= 8.30 0.74
=2
= 1.5 m/sec
= 0.8 m/sec
= 7.56 MT
= 4.45 MT
= 44.5 kN
= FA S h
Where,
S
h
= 0.071 m
= 0.11 m
15
C R A N E
L O A D S
Fatigue
The effect of fatigue shall be included in the design and detailing of crane
runway beams, their connections, support brackets (Not including supporting
column in case of stepped or independent columns), and suspension systems
(For Monorail Cranes) for cranes with service classifications B through D as give
below, for crane classification E & F refer AISE Report # 13. Frames, support
columns, and longitudinal bracing need not be designed for fatigue conditions.
MBMA 02
Table 2.9
Table 8.5 Loading Condition for Parts and Connections Subject to Fatigue
AISC Loading Condition
Service Class (CMAA)
R < = 0.5
R > 0.5
B
1
C
1
2
2
3
D
MBMA 06
Table 2.9
Parts and Connections include all parts of a crane beam except the crane beam.
Table 8.5 Design Life Stress Range Fluctuations for Parts and Connections
Subject to Fatigue
Design Life Stress Range Fluctuations (N)
Service Class (CMAA)
R < = 0.5
R > 0.5
B
20,000
100,000
C
100,000
500,000
500,000
2,000,000
D
Parts and Connections include all parts of a crane beam except the crane beam.
Where,
R
=
R
=
RC
=
TW
=
16
C R A N E
L O A D S
Example
Example: - 8.3
Crane Capacity (RC)
Weight of trolley (HT)
Weight of Crane
Therefore, CW
R
= 10 MT
= 0.74 MT
= 8.30 MT
= 8.30 0.74
= 7.56 MT
= TW / (TW + RC)
= 8.30 / (8.30 + 10)
= 0.45
MBMA 02
Table 2.9.2
= N/A
= 20,000
=1
= 100,000
=2
= 500,000
AISC 89
Table A-K4.3
then
then
then
then
then
then
17
C R A N E
L O A D S
Crane Application
BS
FEM
1-2
DIN
AS
CMAA /
AISE
13
H1
B2 B3
A1
1-2
23
H1 H2
B1 B3
1-2
A2 - B
1-3
35
H2
B4
1-2
B-C
34
H2 H3
B3 B4
2-3
C-D
45
H2
B4 B5
2-3
2-3
2-3
C-D
Foundry Cranes
2-3
45
H2
B3 B4
2-3
45
B5 B6
1
2
3
10
11
H2 H3
B5 B6
12
3-4
56
H3 H4
B5 B6
45
13
3-4
56
H3 H4
B5 B6
D-E
14
56
H3 H4
B5 B6
D-E
15
H2 H3
B5 B6
16
Forging cranes
56
H4
B5 B6
17
Pig-breaking cranes
56
H3 H4
B5 B6
18
56
H3 H4
B6
19
H4
B6
18
C R A N E
L O A D S
Type
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ASCE
ARA-A
ARA-B
ASCE
ARA-A
ARA-B
1
2
3
4
5
CR 104
CR 105
CR 135
CR 171
CR 175
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
A 45
A 55
A 65
A 75
A 100
A 120
A 150
Weight
Height
(mm)
Lb/yd
Kgs/m
ASCE Profiles
20
9.09
66.68
25
11.36
69.85
30
13.64
79.38
35
15.91
84.14
40
18.18
88.90
45
20.45
93.66
50
22.73
98.43
55
25.00
103.19
60
27.27
107.95
65
29.55
112.71
70
31.82
117.48
75
34.09
122.24
80
36.36
127.00
85
38.64
131.76
90
40.91
136.53
90
40.91
142.88
90
40.91
133.75
100
45.45
146.05
100
45.45
152.40
100
45.45
143.27
ASTM Profiles
113
51.59
127.00
115
52.09
131.76
147
66.97
146.05
187
84.83
152.40
191
86.80
152.40
DIN Profiles
49
22.10
55.00
70
31.80
65.00
95
43.10
75.00
124
56.20
85.00
163
74.30
95.00
220
100.00
110.00
331
150.30
150.00
19
Width (mm)
Base
Head
66.68
69.85
79.38
84.14
88.90
93.66
98.43
103.19
107.95
112.71
117.48
122.24
127.00
131.76
136.53
130.18
121.05
146.05
139.70
130.56
34.13
38.10
42.86
44.45
47.63
50.80
53.98
57.15
60.33
61.12
61.91
62.71
63.50
65.09
66.68
65.09
65.09
69.85
69.85
67.47
127.00
131.76
131.76
152.40
152.40
63.50
65.09
87.31
109.22
107.95
130.00
150.00
180.00
200.00
200.00
220.00
220.00
45.00
55.00
65.00
75.00
100.00
120.00
150.00
C R A N E
L O A D S
Example
Example: - 8.4 (As per MBMA 2002)
Crane Capacity (RC)
Bridge Span
Weight of trolley (HT)
Weight of Bridge
Operation
Crane Service Class
Maximum wheel Load (WL)
Crane use
= 20 MT
= 25 m
= 0.94 MT
= 12.93 MT
= Pendant Operated
=C
= 136 kN
= Warehouse
=2
Allowable Stress Range in kN/cm2 for Crane Runway Beams as per Table 8.7,
1. Hot Rolled Sections
= Stress Category A
= 25.51 kN/cm2
2. Built-Up Sections
= Stress Category B
= 19.99 kN/cm2
3. All Fillet Welds
= Stress Category F
= 8.27 kN/cm2
Loading Conditions for Parts & Connections as per Table 8.5,
R
= TW / (TW + RC)
= (12.93+0.94) / (19.93+0.94+10)
Therefore AISC Loading condition for R> 0.5 and Service Class C
= 0.58
=2
Hence use same Allowable stress range as above for all sections and welds used
in parts and connections of a crane runway beam.
1. Vertical Load
Maximum wheel Load
Impact Factor
Vertical Load with Impact
= 136 kN
= 10%
= 136 x 1.1
(Table 8.3)
= 149.6 kN
2. Lateral Load
Lateral Load
= 4.18 MT
= 41.88 kN
3. Longitudinal Load
Longitudinal Load
= 0.10 (WL)
= 0.10 x 136
20
= 13.6 kN
C R A N E
L O A D S
Example
Example: - 8.4 (As per MBMA 2006)
Crane Capacity (RC)
Bridge Span
Weight of trolley (HT)
Weight of Bridge
Operation
Crane Service Class
Maximum wheel Load (WL)
Crane use
= 20 MT
= 25 m
= 0.94 MT
= 12.93 MT
= Pendant Operated
=C
= 136 kN
= Warehouse
= 100,000
= 0.58
=2
Hence use same Allowable stress range as above for all sections and welds used
in parts and connections of a crane runway beam.
1. Vertical Load
Maximum wheel Load
Impact Factor
Vertical Load with Impact
= 136 kN
= 10%
= 136 x 1.1
(Table 8.3)
= 149.6 kN
2. Lateral Load
Lateral Load
= 4.18 MT
= 41.88 kN
3. Longitudinal Load
Longitudinal Load
= 0.10 (WL)
= 0.10 x 136
21
= 13.6 kN
C R A N E
L O A D S
22
C R A N E
L O A D S
2. Lateral Loads
Lateral crane loads (side thrusts) are oriented perpendicular to the crane
runway and are applied at the top of the rails. Lateral loads are caused by:
1. acceleration and deceleration of the trolley and loads
2. non-vertical lifting
3. unbalanced drive mechanisms
4. oblique or skewed travel of the bridge
Except for the case of the trolley running into the bridge end stops, the
magnitude of lateral load due to trolley movement and non-vertical lifting is
limited by the coefficient of friction between the end truck wheels and rails.
Drive mechanisms provide either equal drive wheel torque on each side of the
crane or they are balanced to align the center of the tractive force with the
center of gravity of the crane and lifted load. If the drive mechanism is not
balanced, acceleration and deceleration of the bridge crane results in skewing
of the bridge relative to the runways. The skewing imparts lateral loads onto
the crane girder. Oblique travel refers to the fact that bridge cranes cannot
travel in a perfectly straight line down the center of the runway. Oblique travel
may be thought of as being similar to the motion of an automobile with one
tire under inflated. The tendency of the crane to wander can be minimized by
properly maintaining the end trucks and the rails. The wheels should be
parallel and they should be in similar condition of wear. The rails should be
kept aligned and the surfaces should be smooth and level. A poorly aligned
and maintained runway can result in larger lateral loads. The relatively larger
lateral loads will in turn reduce the service life of the crane girder.
The AISC Specification and most model building codes set the magnitude of
lateral loads at 20% of the sum of the weights of the trolley and the lifted load.
The AISE Technical Report No. 13 varies the magnitude of the lateral load
based on the function of the crane (see table 8.4)
a) Cab-operated cranes:
The maximum of,
(1) That specified in Table 8.4, or
(2) 20% of the combined weight of the lifted load and trolley. For
stacker cranes, this factor shall be 40% of the combined weight of the
lifted load, trolley, rigid arm and material handling device,
or
(3) 10% of the combined total weight of the lifted load and the crane
weight. For stacker cranes, this factor shall be 15% of the combined
total weight of the lifted load and the crane weight.
23
C R A N E
L O A D S
b) Pendant cranes:
10% of the total combined weight of the lifted load and the entire crane
weight including trolley, end trucks and wheels for the total side thrust.
c) Radio-operated cranes:
Radio-operated cranes shall be considered the same as cab operated cranes
for vertical impact, side thrust and traction.
The lateral loads are to be applied to each runway girder with due regard to
the relative lateral stiffness of the structures supporting the rails.
3. Longitudinal Loads
Longitudinal crane forces are due to either acceleration or deceleration of the
crane bridge or the crane impacting the bumper. The tractive forces are limited
by the coefficient of friction of the steel wheel on the rails. For pendant cranes,
the AISE Technical Report No. 13 requires 20% of the maximum load on the
driving wheels to be used for the tractive force. The force imparted by impact
with hydraulic or spring type bumpers is a function of the length of stroke of
the bumper and the velocity of the crane upon impact with the crane stop. The
owner should obtain the longitudinal forces from the crane manufacturer. If
this information is not available, the AISE Technical Report No. 13 provides
equations that can be used for determining the bumper force.
Building Classifications
To apply the requirements of AISE Load Combination Case 1 described below,
the classification of the building must be established (not to be confused with
the crane classification). The building classes are denoted A, B, C and D and
are described in AISE Technical Report No. 13 as follows:
24
C R A N E
L O A D S
25
C R A N E
L O A D S
Case 2.
All dead and live loads, including roof live loads, plus maximum side thrust of
one crane or more than one crane if specific conditions warrant, longitudinal
traction from one crane, plus all eccentric effects and one of the following
vertical crane loadings:
1 . Vertical load from one crane including full impact.
2. Vertical load induced by as many cranes as may be positioned to affect the
member under consideration, not including impact.
Full allowable stresses may be used with no reduction for fatigue. This case
applies to all classes of building construction.
Case 3.
All dead and live loads including impact from one crane plus one of the
following:
a) Full wind with no side thrust but with one crane positioned for maximum
vertical load effects.
b) Fifty percent of full wind load with maximum side thrust and vertical load
effects from one crane.
c) Full wind with no live load or crane load.
d) Bumper impact at end of runway from one crane.
e) Seismic effects resulting from dead loads of all cranes parked in each aisle
positioned for maximum seismic effects.
For Case 3 allowable stresses may be increased 33.3 %. This case applies to all
classes of building construction.
Because the standard AISE building classifications were based upon the most
frequently encountered situations, they should be used with engineering
judgment. The engineer, in consultation with the owner, should establish the
specific criteria.
Deflection
The vertical deflection of top running crane runway beams with 100 percent of
the maximum wheel loads without vertical impact shall not exceed L/1000 of
the runway beam span for cranes with CMAA classifications E or F.
Fatigue
The same recommendation for fatigue given for CMAA crane classification A,
B and C also applies to crane classifications E and F.
26
C R A N E
L O A D S
27
C R A N E
L O A D S
The tie back must also allow for vertical movement due to axial shortening of
the crane column. This vertical movement can be in the range of 6.5 mm. In
general, the tie back should be attached directly to the top flange of the girder.
Attachment to the web of the girder with a diaphragm plate should be
avoided, since the lateral load path for this detail results in bending stresses in
the girder web perpendicular to the girder cross section. The diaphragm plate
also tends to resist movement due to the axial shortening of the crane column.
c) Bearing Stiffeners
Bearing stiffeners should be provided at the ends of the girders as required by
the AISC ASD Specification Paragraphs K1 .3 and K1.4. The AISE Technical
Report No. 13 requires that full penetration welds be used to connect the top
of the bearing stiffeners to the top flange of the girder. Fillet welds are
considered to be inadequate to transfer the concentrated wheel load stresses
into the bearing stiffener because the small gap between underside of flange
and top of stiffener would result in the wheel load reactive force being
transferred through the fillet welds. The bottom of the bearing stiffeners may
be fitted (preferred) or fillet welded to the bottom flange. All stiffener to girder
welds should be continuous. Cracks have been observed in the webs of crane
girders with partial height bearing stiffeners. The cracks start in the web
between the bearing stiffener and the top flange and run longitudinally along
the web of the girder. There are many possible causes for the propagation of
these cracks. An explanation of this phenomenon may be that when the rail is
eccentric to the girder web, transverse bending is induced in the girder flange
and web. The bending in the web results in high bending stresses in the critical
section of web between the underside of the top flange and the upper ends of
the partial height stiffeners.
d) Intermediate Stiffeners
When intermediate stiffeners are used, the AISE Technical Report No. 1 3
requires that the intermediate stiffeners be welded to the top flange with full
penetration welds. The stiffeners should be stopped short of the bottom flange.
The stiffeners should be terminated in accordance with paragraph G4 of the
AISC ASD Specification. The AISE Technical Report No. 13 additionally
requires continuous welds between stiffener and web for intermediate
stiffeners.
28
C R A N E
L O A D S
e) Cap Channels
Channel caps or cap plates are frequently used atop wide flange members to
develop adequate top flange capacity for transfer of lateral loads to the
supporting columns. A common rule-of-thumb is that a wide flange reinforced
with a cap channel will be economical if the total section is 29.8 kg/m lighter
than a comparable un-reinforced wide flange member. The welds connecting
the channel cap to the top flange can be continuous or intermittent. However,
the AISC allowable stress for the base metal is reduced from that of Category B
for continuous welds to that of Category E for intermittent welds.
It should be noted that the cap channel or plate does not fit perfectly with
100% bearing on the top of the wide flange. The tolerances given in ASTM A6
allow the wide flange member to have some flange tilt along its length, or the
plate may be cupped or slightly warped, or the channel may have some twist
along its length. These conditions will leave small gaps between the top flange
of the girder and the underside of the top plate or channel. The passage of the
crane wheel over these gaps will tend to distress the channel or plate to top
flange welds. Because of this phenomenon, cap plates or channels should not
be used with class E or F cranes.
f) Column Cap Plates
The crane column cap plate should be detailed so as not to materially restrain
the end rotation of the girder. If the cap plate girder bolts are placed between
the column flanges, the girder end rotation is resisted by a force couple
between the column flange and the bolts. This detail has been known to cause
bolt failures. Preferably, the girder should be bolted to the cap plate outside of
the column flanges. The column cap plate should be extended outside of the
column flange with the bolts to the girder placed outside of the column
flanges. The column cap plate should not be made overly thick, as this detail
requires the cap plate to distort to allow for the end rotation of the girder. The
girder to cap plate bolts should be adequate to transfer the longitudinal
tractive or bumper forces to the longitudinal crane bracing. Consideration
should be given to using slotted holes perpendicular to the runway or oversize
holes to allow tolerance for aligning the girder webs with the webs of the
supporting column.
29
C R A N E
L O A D S
g) Lacing
A horizontal truss can be used to resist the crane lateral forces. The truss is
designed to span between the crane columns. Typically, the top flange of the
girder acts as one chord of the truss while a parallel back up beam acts as the
other chord. The diagonal web members are typically angles. Preferably, the
angles should be bolted rather than welded. The crane girder will deflect
downward when the crane passes, the back up beam will not. The design of
the diagonal members should account for the end moments that will be
generated by this relative movement.
Walkways can be designed and detailed as a horizontal beam to transfer
lateral loads to the crane columns. The lacing design may be incorporated in
the walkway design. As with the crane lacing, the walkway connection to the
crane girder needs to account for the vertical deflection of the crane girder. If
the walkway is not intended to act as a beam, then the designer must isolate
the walkway from the crane girder.
The AISE Technical Report No. 13 requires that crane runway girders with
spans of 36 feet and over for building classifications A, B, and C or runway
girder spans 10.97 m and over in class D buildings shall have bottom flange
bracing. This bracing is to be designed for 2.5 percent of the maximum bottom
flange force, and is not to be welded to the bottom flange. Vertical cross braces
or diaphragms should not be added to this bracing so as to allow for the
deflection of the crane beam relative to the backup beam.
h) Sidesway Web Buckling
Crane runway girders should be checked to ensure adequate capacity to resist
sidesway web buckling. Equation K1-7 contained in the AISC ASD or LRFD
Specification should be used in this check. This criteria is likely to control the
base member size for crane runway girders with cap plates, welded girders
with larger top flanges and girders with braced compression flanges. It seems
likely that the foregoing AISE limitations on the length of unbraced tension
flanges were created to address the sidesway web buckling phenomena. The
sidesway web buckling criteria was introduced into the AISC ASD
Specification in the Ninth Edition. Runway girders designed prior to this time
would not have been checked for this criteria.
At present, the AISC criteria does not address the condition of multiple wheel
loads on a single span. Therefore, engineering judgment must be used when
applying Equation K1-7 for multiple wheel loads.
30
C R A N E
L O A D S
31
C R A N E
L O A D S
l) Erection
Special fabrication and erection tolerances are recommended for crane
buildings including runway beams. Improper erection may cause excessive
forces that adversely affect the performance and durability of the crane
building. See MBMA 2002 / 2006 Common Industry Practices, Sections 4, 6,
and 9 for recommended fabrication and erection tolerances.
m) Operation and Maintenance
Improper operation of crane systems or maintenance of cranes, rails, runway
beams, runway support or suspension systems, including fasteners, can cause
excessive forces that adversely affect the performance and durability of crane
buildings. The End Customer is responsible for ensuring proper operation,
inspection and maintenance of cranes.
32
C R A N E
L O A D S
Guidelines
1. Crane runway beams may be provided with any of the 3 configuration
below,
a. Cap Channel + Top Flange + Web + Bottom Flange.
b. Cap Channel + Web + Bottom Flange.
c. Top Flange + Web + Bottom Flange. (with or with out surge girder as
required by design)
2. The default fatigue stress range is 20.70 kN/cm2. However for paper mills,
foundries and rolling mills a fatigue stress of 12.50 kN/cm2 is often
required for safety reasons. (The fatigue stresses considered in design
should be confirmed with the customer at estimation stage).
3. As a standard welding procedure,
a. For Crane beams with web thickness less than or equal to 8 mm
double side fillet welds are provided between top / bottom flange and
web.
b. For web thickness greater than 8 mm, CJP (Complete joint Penetration)
weld is provided between top flange and web only and double side
fillet weld between bottom flange and web, this should be considered
at estimate stage.
4. If crane lifting capacity is equal to or exceeds 20MT the portion of the
column below the crane runway beam should be double side weld.
5. For independent crane columns and stepped columns separate
longitudinal bracing system should be provided below the crane beam (in
the same plane as crane beam) in addition to the sidewall wind bracing.
The sidewall wind bracing may be Cable, Rod or Angle as required by
design.
6. Double side welding should be provided for stepped column below crane
beam and independent crane columns. The double side welding for crane
beams should be included in the estimate.
7. Cable or Rod bracing may be provided as crane bracing for buildings with
Crane capacity up to and including 10 MT.
8. Angle bracing should be provided as longitudinal bracing for buildings
with Crane capacity more than 10 MT.
33
C R A N E
L O A D S
34
L O A D
Chapter
C O M B I N A T I O N S
Load Combination
Keeping in pace with the latest available codes, Mammut standard load
combinations are compiled taking into consideration all the codes and releases
available at this moment without compromising on strength, serviceability and
economy.
MBMA 2006 remains the basis of the adopted standard load combinations, since
it refers to IBC 2006 and IBC 2006 refers to ASCE 7-05.
The notations used in the standard load combinations are listed below, these
notations are also used for combinations as per different codes in order to avoid
confusion.
D
Co
Cr
Crv
Crh
Lf
Lr
S
T
W
E
Em
Dead Load
Collateral Load
Crane Load (Inclusive of Crane weight and lifted load)
Crane Vertical Load
Crane Horizontal Load
Floor Live Load (Mezzanine Live Load)
Roof Live Load
Snow Load
Temperature Load
Wind Load
Combined effect of Seismic induced forces
E
= Eh Ev
= (r QE) (0.2 SDS D)
Seismic load effect including over-strength
= Emh Ev
= (o QE) (0.2 SDS D)
Em
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
MBMA 2006
Mammut Standard LRFD
MBMA 06
Section 1.3.7
Note:1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
Eqn. 16-1
Eqn. 16-2
Eqn. 16-3
Eqn. 16-4
Eqn. 16-6
Eqn. 16-5
Eqn. 16-7
Eqn. 16-22
Eqn. 16-23
f1 = 0.5
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) <= 4.79 kN/m2
f1 = 1.0
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) > 4.79 kN/m2
for saw tooth configuration roof.
f2 = 0.7
f2 = 0.2
for other roof configurations.
* - Denotes combination for frame connections, bracings, strut tube, eave
strut, strut purlins.
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
MBMA 2006
Mammut Standard ASD
MBMA 06
Section 1.3.7
Eqn. 16-8
Eqn. 16-9
Eqn. 16-10
Eqn. 16-11
Eqn. 16-12
Eqn. 16-13
Eqn. 16-14
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
D
Lr or S
D + Co + (Lr or S)
D + Co + (Lr or S) + Lf
W
E = Eh
Cr
Note:1) The above combinations are for main frames only for individual
members refer chapter on serviceability.
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
Note:1) f1 = 0.0
if Roof Snow load
(pf) <= 0.624 kN/m2
2) f1 = 0.5
if
0.624 <= (pf) < 1.488 kN/m2
3) f2 = 0.0
if Roof Snow load
(pf) < 1.44 kN/m2
4) f2 = 0.2
if Roof Snow load
(pf) >= 1.44 kN/m2
5) f3 = 0.5
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) <= 4.79 kN/m2
6) f3 = 1.0
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) > 4.79 kN/m2
7) Refer AISC Seismic Provision Part III for values of
8) Av - Effective Peak Acceleration (See MBMA 96)
9) E - Seismic Load (Seismic Base Shear)
10) *Stress increase as per section AISC Seismic Provision 1997 Part III Section 4.2
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
Eqn. 12-1
Eqn. 12-2
Eqn. 12-3
Eqn. 12-4
Eqn. 12-6
Eqn. 12-5
Eqn. 12-6
Eqn. 12-17
Eqn. 12-18
Note:1) f1 = 0.5
if Floor Live Load (Lf) <= 4.79 kN/m2
2) f1 = 1.0
if Floor Live Load (Lf) > 4.79 kN/m2
3) f2 = 0.7
for roof configurations (such as saw tooth)
4) f2 = 0.2
for other roof configuration
5) * - Denotes combination for connections, bracings, strut tube, eave strut, strut
purlins.
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
Eqn. 12-12
Eqn. 12-13
Eqn. 12.14
Eqn. 12-15
Eqn. 12-13
Eqn. 12-16
Eqn. 12-16-1
Note:1) f1 = 0.5
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) <= 4.79 kN/m2
2) f1 = 1.0
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) > 4.79 kN/m2
3) f2 = 0.0
if Design Snow Load (Pf) <= 1.44 kN/m2
4) f2 = 0.25
if Design Snow Load (Pf) > 1.44 kN/m2
5) * - Denotes combination for connections, bracings, strut tube, eave strut, strut
purlins.
6) 0.714 is E/1.4 in the code
7) Stress increase as per section 1612.3.3
8) Ev need not be used in ASD
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
10
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
11
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
12
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
13
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
MBMA 2002
MBMA 2002 Section 1.7 States
Load Combinations are covered in IBC 2000, Section 1605. Two alternate sets of
allowable stress combinations are provided and one set of load and resistance
factor combinations is provided
MBMA 02
Section 1.7
14
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
15
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
16
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
IBC 2003
Section
1605.2.1
Eqn. 16-1
Eqn. 16-2
Eqn. 16-3
Eqn. 16-4
Eqn. 16-6
Eqn. 16-5
Eqn. 16-6
Eqn. 16-19
Eqn. 16-20
17
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
IBC 2003
Section
1605.3.1
Eqn. 16-7
Eqn. 16-8
Eqn. 16-9
Eqn. 16-10
Eqn. 16-11
Eqn. 16-10
Eqn. 16-12
Eqn. 16-19
Eqn. 16-20
Exception:
1) f1 is denoted as l1 in code, it is changed for clarity
2) f1 = 0.5
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) <= 4.79 kN/m2
3) f1 = 1.0
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) > 4.79 kN/m2
4) * - Denotes combination for frame connections, bracings, strut tube, eave
strut, strut purlins.
5) Stress increase as per section 1617.1.1.2
18
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
Note:1) f1 = 0.5
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) <= 4.79 kN/m2
2) f1 = 1.0
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) > 4.79 kN/m2
3) The Snow Load S shall be taken as either the flat roof snow load (pf) or the
sloped roof snow load (ps)
4) * - Denotes combination for frame connections, bracings, strut tube, eave
strut, strut purlins.
19
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
Note:1) The Snow Load S shall be taken as either the flat roof snow load (pf) or
the sloped roof snow load (ps)
2) * - Denotes combination for frame connections, bracings, strut tube, eave
strut, strut purlins.
3) Stress increase as per section 12.4.3.3
20
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
Eqn. 16-1
Eqn. 16-2
Eqn. 16-3
Eqn. 16-4
Eqn. 16-6
Eqn. 16-5
Eqn. 16-7
Eqn. 16-22
Eqn. 16-23
Note:1) f1 = 0.5
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) <= 4.79 kN/m2
2) f1 = 1.0
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) > 4.79 kN/m2
3) f2 = 0.7
for saw tooth configuration roof.
for other roof configurations.
4) f2 = 0.2
5) * - Denotes combination for frame connections, bracings, strut tube, eave
strut, strut purlins.
21
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
Eqn. 16-8
Eqn. 16-9
Eqn. 16-10
Eqn. 16-11
Eqn. 16-12
Eqn. 16-13
Eqn. 16-14
Eqn. 16-12
Eqn. 16-13
Eqn. 16-15
Eqn. 16-22
Eqn. 16-23
f1 = 0.5
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) <= 4.79 kN/m2
if Floor Live Load
(Lf) > 4.79 kN/m2
f1 = 1.0
f2 = 0.0
if Roof Snow Load
(pf) < 1.44 kN/m2
f2 = 0.2
if Roof Snow Load
(pf) >= 1.44 kN/m2
* - Denotes combination for frame connections, bracings, strut tube, eave
strut, strut purlins.
6) Crane hook loads need not be combined with (Lr) Roof Live Load or with
more than (0.75 S) Snow Load or (0.5W) Wind Load (Foot note:- IBC 06 1605.3.1)
22
L O A D S
C O M B I N A T I O N S
BS 5950 - LRFD
BS 5950-1
2000
Section 2.4
23
10
Chapter
S E R V I C E A B I L I T Y
AISC
Design Guide
Series 3
Serviceability
Serviceability as defined in the AISC Specification as a state in which the
function of a building, its appearance, mainRRtainability, durability, and comfort
of its occupancies are preserved under normal usage. Although serviceability
issues have always been a design consideration, changes in codes and materials
have added importance to these matters.
The MBMA 2002 / 2006 states that the customer or his or her agent must identify
for the metal building engineer any and all criteria so that the metal building can
be designed to be suitable for its specific conditions of use and compatible with
other materials used in the metal building system. Nevertheless it also points
out the requirement for the active involvement of the customer in the design
stage of a structure and the need for informed discussion of standards and levels
of building performance. Likewise the AISC code of standard practice states that
in those instances where the fabricator has both the responsibility, the owner
must provide the performance criteria for the structural steel frame.
ASCE 7-02 addresses the serviceability issues as follows: Structural systems, and
members thereof, shall be designed to have adequate stiffness to limit
deflections, lateral drift, vibration, or any other deformations that adversely
affect the intended use and performance of buildings and other structures.
Many of the design criteria in the AISC design guide series 3 Serviceability
Design Considerations for Steel Buildings are based on the authors own
judgment and rules of the thumb from their own experience. It should be noted
that when applicable design codes mandate specific deflection limits the code
requirements supersede the recommendations of the Design guide.
S E R V I C E A B I L I T Y
Ponding
ASCE 7-05 section 8.4 states that roofs with a slope of at least 0.25 : 12 ( = 1.19)
need not be investigated for ponding stability.
Standard Deflection Limitations
Unless specified in the Project Information Form, all deflection limitations
prescribed in this chapter shall govern.
All the standard allowable deflection limits are within the provisions of MBMA
2002 / 2006 and are applicable for general cases. For special case with the
approval of manager or supervisor deflection limits in MBMA 2002 / 2006 may
be considered if required.
The wind speed (3 Second Gust) that is to be considered for horizontal deflection
should be based upon 10 year mean recurrence interval and in the absence of
data for a 10 year wind speed map the listed limit values in the tables below for
horizontal sway, deflection due to wind only, can be approximated by
multiplying by an approximate reduction factor =0.70.
This assumption may be disregarded if customer has stated specific deflection
criteria.
Maximum deflection for any members vertical or horizontal should not exceed
200 mm for practical reasons.
S E R V I C E A B I L I T Y
Standard Allowable
Deflection
Rigid Frame and Endwall Rafters Vertical Deflection
With fully sheeted walls
With blockwall and sheeting of equal heights
Span / 180*
With full height blockwall
&
With glazing & sheeting of equal heights
Span / 120
With full height glazing
With pendant operated crane
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Structural Members
Load Case
L or S or W
&
D + (L or S)
W or E or Cr
W or E
Total
W
S E R V I C E A B I L I T Y
1
2
3
Structural Members
Vertical Deflection
Horizontal Deflection
Span / 225
Table 1.3.1(b) from MBMA 2006 is reproduced below for reference, and is
same as Table 1.1(b) in MBMA 2002
S E R V I C E A B I L I T Y
M A T E R I A L
11
Chapter
S P E C I F I C A T I O N S
Material Specifications
Some of the more common materials frequently used in a Metal Building
System comprise of Built-up sections made from hot rolled plates, or hotrolled sections used at specific locations like fascia post, end wall columns &
rafters, crane beam etc. Then there are cold-formed sections, like purlins, girt
and roof & wall panels, connection bolts, fasteners etc.
Unless specified in customer specification or the Project Information Form, all
materials that are used as primary & secondary components of a metal
building shall comply as the table 11.1 below as a standard practice.
For special materails requirement in any job, prior information should be
conveyed to the supervisor or manager and purchasing.
Table 11.1 Material Specification (Click on the link below)
Material Specification.xls
M A T E R I A L
S P E C I F I C A T I O N S
BS EN 10025 : 1993
BS 4360 : 1986
Sr. No.
Grade
Tensile
2
N/mm
Yield
2
N/mm
S185
290-510
185
DIN 17100
ASTM / SAE
Tensile
2
N/mm
Yield
2
N/mm
Grade
Tensile
2
N/mm
Yield
2
N/mm
St 33
290-510
185
SA 516 Gr. 50
414
221
Grade
Grade
Tensile
2
N/mm
Yield
2
N/mm
S235
340-470
235
40A
340-500
235
St 37-1
340-470
235
S235JR
340-470
235
St 37-2
340-470
235
S235JRG1
340-470
235
USt 37-2
340-470
235
S235JRG2
340-470
235
40B
340-500
235
RSt 37-2
340-470
235
S235JO
340-470
235
40C
340-500
235
St 37-3U
S235J2G3
340-470
235
40D
340-500
235
St 37-3N
S235J2G4
340-470
235
40D
340-500
235
10
A36
400
248
11
SA 516 Gr. 70
483
262
12
S275
410-560
275
43A
430-580
275
13
S275JR
410-560
275
43B
430-580
275
St 44-2
410-540
275
14
S275JO
410-560
275
43C
430-580
275
St 44-3U
15
S275J2G3
410-560
275
43D
430-580
275
St 44-3N
16
S275J2G4
410-560
275
43D
430-580
275
290
17
A572 Gr. 42
415
18
E295
470-510
295
St 50-2
470-610
295
19
E335
570-710
335
St 60-2
570-710
335
20
A572 Gr. 50
450
345
21
S355
490-630
355
50A
490-640
355
St 52-3
490-630
355
22
S355JR
490-630
355
50B
490-640
355
23
S355JO
490-630
355
50C
490-640
355
St 52-3U
24
S355J2G3
490-630
355
50D
490-640
355
St 52-3N
25
S355J2G4
490-630
355
50D
490-640
355
26
S355K2G3
490-630
355
50DD
490-640
355
27
S355K2G4
490-630
355
50DD
490-640
355
28
St 70-2
670-830
365
29
E360
670-830
360
A572 Gr. 60
520
415
30
A572 Gr. 65
550
450
B O L T S
A N D
12
Chapter
F A S T E N E R S
AISC 2005
This section will briefly describe the allowable stress / load calculation as per
AISC 2005 LRFD and ASD specification for steel design.
Anchor Bolts / Rods
Anchor bolts are more commonly called Anchor Rods as per AISC and ASTM
F1554 for the sake of consistency with the codes the same terminology is
adopted in this manual. Standard stock anchor rods are grade A36 or 4.6, the
yield strength F y and specified tensile strength F u for both are same. The
standard stock diameters and other dimensions are as listed in Table 12.1
below.
Some customers may request non-stock material such as Grade 8.8 or A325,
such variations should be clearly mentioned in the PIF and all concerned
should be informed in advance of release of anchor rod BOM. As far as design
is concerned appropriate F y and F u values should be used in the equations for
different grade of anchor rod. In the subsequent calculations and examples all
grade of anchor rod is assumed A36 / Gr. 4.6 and concrete is M25 mix. All
anchor rods in stock are hooked type. The calculation for pull out strength of
headed anchor rods is for information only, until it is adopted as a standard
stock item.
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
Anchor Rod
Table 12.1
Diameter
T
(mm) (d) (mm)
16
20
24
30
36
Sr.
No
.
1
2
3
4
5
E
(mm)
L
(mm)
X
(mm)
Lp
(mm)
Wt. (kgs)
275
300
375
550
850
375
450
525
750
1050
120
175
205
265
295
75
100
100
125
150
0.86
1.69
3.07
6.13
11.64
100
150
150
200
200
Dia.
(mm)
Max.
Axial
Tension
(kN)
Max.
Allowab
le Shear
(kN)
(d)
16
20
24
30
36
(T)
26.54
41.47
59.72
93.31
134.36
(Vm)
13.67
21.36
30.76
48.07
69.22
Considering
Maximum Tension
Embedment
Length
(mm) (Le)
420
525
630
890
1195
Considering
Maximum Shear
Allow.
Tension
(kN)
Allow.
Shear
(kN)
Allow.
Tension
(kN)
Allow.
Shear
(kN)
(Ta)
26.54
41.47
59.72
93.31
134.36
(Va)
4.47
6.98
10.05
15.71
22.62
(Ta)
9.97
15.58
22.44
35.06
50.49
(Va)
13.67
21.36
30.76
48.07
69.22
Gross Area
(cm2) (Ag)
2.01
3.14
4.52
7.07
10.18
Bond
Stress
(kN/cm2)
Pull Out
(Bond)
(kN)
(u)
0.138
0.126
0.105
0.084
0.070
(Tb)
29.13
41.73
50.07
70.73
94.97
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
Example
Example :- 12.1 Calculation of above tabulated values
Given Data:Grade of Anchor Rod
Grade of Concrete
1. Allowable Stresses
a. Anchor Rod
= 248 N/mm2
Yield Stress
Fy
= 400 N/mm2
Tensile Strength
Fu
Tensile Stress
F nt
= 0.75 F u
= 0.40 F u
Shear Stress
F nv
b. Concrete
Characteristic Compressive Strength fc for M25 concrete
Allowable bond stress
= [ 0.506 sqrt (fc) ] / d
= 300 N/mm2
= 160 N/mm2
= 25 N/mm2
<= 1.38 N/mm2
mm
N/mm2
u = 1.38,
if u > 1.38
16
20
24
30
36
1.580
1.265
1.054
0.843
0.703
1.380
1.265
1.054
0.843
0.703
B O L T S
Eqn. J3-1
Eqn. J3-1
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
Area A b
mm
mm2
LRFD
ASD
16
201.06
45.24
30.16
20
314.16
70.69
47.12
24
452.39
101.79
67.86
30
706.86
159.04
106.03
36
1017.88
229.02
152.68
Maximum Tension kN
Rod Diameter
Area A b
Tensile Strength kN
mm
mm2
LRFD
ASD
16
20
24
30
36
201.06
314.16
452.39
706.86
1017.88
24.13
37.70
54.29
84.82
122.15
16.08
25.13
36.19
56.55
81.43
The values in Table 12.1 are calculated based on AISC 89, where as the above
values are calculated as per AISC 2005, hence the difference.
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
Rn
= F nt
x Ab
Rn
= F nt x A b
LRFD =
0.75
ASD
= 2.00
Where F nt is the allowable tensile stress with applied shear (Say = 15 kN)
Eqn. J3-3a
Eqn. J3-3b
F nt
F nt
= 1.3 F nt f v (F nt / F nv )
= 1.3 F nt f v ( F nt / F nv )
<= F nt
<= F nt
LRFD = 0.75
ASD = 2.00
Table 12.5
Rod Diameter
Area A b
Shear Stress fv
mm
mm2
N/mm2
ASD
16
201.06
74.60
203.49
20
314.16
47.74
270.63
24
452.39
33.15
307.11
30
706.86
21.22
336.95
36
1017.88
14.73
353.16
Note:- Above value is applicable for a shear force of 15 kN only
110.24
210.95
265.66
310.42
334.74
Surface Area
Em. Length Le
mm
mm2
N/mm2
mm
LRFD
ASD
16
50.27
1.380
420
43.70
29.13
20
62.83
1.265
525
62.59
41.73
24
75.40
1.054
630
75.11
50.07
30
94.25
0.843
890
106.10
70.73
36
113.10
0.703
1195
142.46
94.97
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
Table 12.7
Rod Diameter
Dim X = eh
mm
16
20
24
30
36
mm
120
175
205
265
295
ASD
20.09
36.63
51.49
83.20
111.14
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
LRFD = 0.75
ASD = 2.00
Where,
Np
Y4
A brg
fc
Table 12.8
Diameter
Lp
mm
16
mm
100
mm
275
mm
375
mm
75
Nut Bearing
Area
mm2
380
20
150
300
450
100
615
24
150
375
525
100
900
30
200
550
750
125
1520
36
200
850
1050
150
2120
Table 12.9
Diameter
mm
mm2
LRFD
ASD
16
380
57.00
38.00
20
615
92.25
61.50
24
900
135.00
90.00
30
1520
228.00
152.00
36
2120
318.00
212.00
Appendix D of ACI 318-02 also lists criteria for anchor rods to prevent failure
due to lateral bursting forces at the anchor head. These lateral bursting forces
are associated with tension in the anchor rods. The failure plane or surface in this
case is assumed to be cone shaped and radiating from the anchor head to the
adjacent free edge or side of the concrete element.
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
db
Note:- For use headed anchor rods on concrete pedestal column or thin slabs,
the size of concrete column or slab thickness should be know, in order to
determine the breakout cone overlap and failure conditions. See AISC design
guide series # 1 for more details.
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
Gross Area
(mm2)
Ab
113.10
201.06
314.16
452.39
572.56
706.86
855.30
1017.88
Single Shear
(kN)
R nv
18.10
32.17
50.27
72.38
91.61
113.10
136.85
162.86
Double Shear
(kN)
2 Rn
36.19
64.34
100.53
144.76
183.22
226.19
273.70
325.72
Tension (kN)
R nt
33.93
60.32
94.25
135.72
171.77
212.06
256.59
305.36
All standard stock bolts are fully threaded and hence the shear values for
threads in shear plane should be considered in design.
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
Example
Example :- 12.2 Calculation of above tabulated values
Given Data:Grade of Connection Bolt
= Grade 8.8
1. Allowable Stresses
Yield Stress
Tensile Strength
Tensile Stress
Shear Stress
Fy
Fu
F nt
F nv
= 248 N/mm2
= 400 N/mm2
= 0.75 F u
= 0.40 F u
= 300 N/mm2
= 160 N/mm2
Note:- For A307, A325, A490 bolts refer values for F nt and F nv directly from Table
J3.2 AISC 05, as given in table below
Table 12.11
Bolt Grade
A36
A307
A325
A490
Grade 8.8
Grade 10.9
Fu
F nt
F nv
N/mm2
N/mm2
N/mm2
400
413
826
1040
800
1040
300
310
620
780
600
780
160
165
330
414
320
416
10
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
2. Tensile Strength
Rn
Rn
Rn
Eqn. J3-1
Table 12.12
Allowable Tension in kN (LRFD)
Bolt Grade
F nt
N/mm2
16
20
24
27
30
33
36
Area Ab (mm2)
113.10
201.06
314.16
452.39
572.56
706.86
855.30
1017.88
A36
300
25.45
45.24
70.69
101.79
128.82
159.04
192.44
229.02
A307
310
26.27
46.71
72.98
105.10
133.01
164.21
198.70
236.47
A325
620
52.55
93.42
145.97
210.19
266.02
328.42
397.39
472.93
A490
780
66.16
117.62
183.78
264.65
334.94
413.51
500.35
595.46
Grade 8.8
600
50.89
90.48
141.37
203.58
257.65
318.09
384.88
458.04
Grade 10.9
780
66.16
117.62
183.78
264.65
334.94
413.51
500.35
595.46
F nt
N/mm2
16
20
24
27
30
33
36
Area Ab (mm2)
113.10
201.06
314.16
452.39
572.56
706.86
855.30
1017.88
A36
300
16.96
30.16
47.12
67.86
85.88
106.03
128.29
152.68
A307
310
17.52
31.14
48.66
70.06
88.67
109.47
132.46
157.64
A325
620
35.03
62.28
97.31
140.13
177.35
218.95
264.93
315.29
A490
780
44.11
78.41
122.52
176.43
223.30
275.67
333.57
396.97
Grade 8.8
600
33.93
60.32
94.25
135.72
171.77
212.06
256.59
305.36
Grade 10.9
780
44.11
78.41
122.52
176.43
223.30
275.67
333.57
396.97
11
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
3. Shear Strength
Rn
Rn
Rn
Eqn. J3-1
Table 12.13
Allowable Shear in kN (LRFD)
Bolt Grade
F nv
N/mm2
16
20
24
27
30
33
36
Area Ab (mm2)
113.10
201.06
314.16
452.39
572.56
706.86
855.30
1017.88
A36
160
13.57
24.13
37.70
54.29
68.71
84.82
102.64
122.15
A307
165
14.01
24.91
38.92
56.05
70.94
87.58
105.97
126.11
A325
330
28.03
49.82
77.85
112.10
141.88
175.16
211.94
252.23
A490
414
35.12
62.43
97.55
140.47
177.78
219.48
265.57
316.05
Grade 8.8
320
27.14
48.25
75.40
108.57
137.41
169.65
205.27
244.29
Grade 10.9
416
35.29
62.73
98.02
141.15
178.64
220.54
266.85
317.58
F nt
N/mm2
(mm2)
16
20
24
27
30
33
36
113.10
201.06
314.16
452.39
572.56
706.86
855.30
1017.88
A36
160
9.05
16.08
25.13
36.19
45.80
56.55
68.42
81.43
A307
165
9.34
16.61
25.95
37.37
47.29
58.39
70.65
84.08
A325
330
18.68
33.22
51.90
74.73
94.59
116.77
141.30
168.15
A490
414
23.41
41.62
65.03
93.64
118.52
146.32
177.05
210.70
Grade 8.8
320
18.10
32.17
50.27
72.38
91.61
113.10
136.85
162.86
Grade 10.9
416
23.52
41.82
65.35
94.10
119.09
147.03
177.90
211.72
Note:- For Double Shear simply multiply the values in table 12.13 above by 2
12
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
Rn
= F nt
x Ab
LRFD =
0.75
Rn
= F nt x A b
ASD
Where F nt is the allowable tensile stress with applied shear
Eqn. J3-3a
Eqn. J3-3b
F nt
F nt
= 1.3 F nt f v (F nt / F nv )
= 1.3 F nt f v ( F nt / F nv )
<= F nt
<= F nt
= 2.00
LRFD = 0.75
ASD = 2.00
= 620 N/mm2
= 330 N/mm2
= Shear Force / Area of Bolt
= 45 x 1000 / 706.86
= 63.66 N/mm2
= 1.3 x 620 63.66 (620/0.75 x 330)
LRFD
= 620.0 N/mm2
= 646.53 > 620 N/mm2
= 0.75 x 620 x 706.86/1000
= 328.7 kN
= 1.3 x 620 63.66 (2 x 620/330)
ASD
= 566.8 N/mm2
= 566.79 < 620 N/mm2
= 620 x 706.86/2000
= 219.1 kN
13
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
Allowable shear for a given tension may also be back calculated using the
equation,
f v = (1.3 F nt f t ) / (F nt / F nv )
f v = (1.3 F nt f t ) / ( F nt / F nv )
Using grade 8.8 bolt again,
F nt
F nv
Say the calculated tension
Bolt diameter
Area of Bolt
Therefore,
Calculated tensile stress f t
LRFD
fv
fv
<= f nv
<= f nv
LRFD = 0.75
ASD = 2.00
= 600 N/mm2
= 320 N/mm2
= 165 kN
= 30 mm
= 706.86 mm2
= Tensile Force / Area of Bolt
= 165 x 1000 / 706.86
= 233.43 N/mm2
= (1.3 x 600 233.43) / [600 / (0.75 x 320)]
= 218.63 < 320
= 218.63 N/mm2
= 0.75 x 218.63 x 706.86 / 1000 = 115.9 kN
= (1.3 x 600 233.43) / [600 x 2 / 320]
= 145.75 < 320
= 145.75 N/mm2
= 145.75 x 706.86 / 2000
= 51.51 kN
Now the capacity of bolts in shear can also be calculated for full tension capacity,
in other words how much shear can a bolt take along with full tension? Say for
grade 8.8 bolt
= 600 N/mm2
F nt
= 320 N/mm2
F nv
LRFD
= (1.3 x 600 600) / [600 / (0.75 x 320)]
fv
= 72.0 < 320
= 72.0 N/mm2
Therefore shear capacity
= 0.75 x 72.0 x 706.86 / 1000 = 38.16 kN
ASD
fv
Therefore shear capacity
The values of allowable shear with full tension are as tabulated in table 12.14
14
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
Table 12.14
Allowable Shear with Full Tension in kN (LRFD)
Bolt Grade
F nt
F nv
N/mm2
N/mm2
Area Ab (mm2)
16
20
24
27
30
33
36
113.10
201.06
314.16
452.39
572.56
706.86
855.30
1017.88
A36
300
160
3.05
5.43
8.48
12.21
15.46
19.09
23.09
27.48
A307
310
165
3.15
5.61
8.76
12.61
15.96
19.71
23.84
28.38
A325
620
330
6.31
11.21
17.52
25.22
31.92
39.41
47.69
56.75
A490
780
414
7.90
14.05
21.95
31.61
40.00
49.38
59.75
71.11
Grade 8.8
600
320
6.11
10.86
16.96
24.43
30.92
38.17
46.19
54.97
Grade 10.9
780
416
7.94
14.11
22.05
31.76
40.19
49.62
60.04
71.45
F nt
F nv
N/mm2
N/mm2
Area Ab
(mm2)
16
20
24
27
30
33
36
113.10
201.06
314.16
452.39
572.56
706.86
855.30
1017.88
A36
300
160
1.36
2.41
3.77
5.43
6.87
8.48
10.26
12.21
A307
310
165
1.40
2.49
3.89
5.61
7.09
8.76
10.60
12.61
A325
620
330
2.80
4.98
7.78
11.21
14.19
17.52
21.19
25.22
A490
780
414
3.51
6.24
9.75
14.05
17.78
21.95
26.56
31.61
Grade 8.8
600
320
2.71
4.83
7.54
10.86
13.74
16.96
20.53
24.43
Grade 10.9
780
416
3.53
6.27
9.80
14.11
17.86
22.05
26.69
31.76
15
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
5. Bearing Strength
a) For a bolt in a connection with standard, oversized, and short slotted
holes, independent of the direction of loading, or a long slotted hole
with the slot parallel to the direction of the bearing force.
i. When deformation of the hole at service load is a design
consideration.
Rn
Rn
Eqn. J3-6a
= 1.2 L c t F u
= 1.2 L c t F u /
<= 2.4 d t F u
<= 2.4 d t F u /
LRFD = 0.75
ASD = 2.00
Eqn. J3-6b
= 1.5 L c t F u
= 1.5 L c t F u /
<= 3.0 d t F u
<= 3.0 d t F u /
STANDARD OR SHORT
SLOTTED HOLE
LONG
SLOTTED
HOLE
P
Lc
Lc
LRFD = 0.75
ASD = 2.00
Lc
16
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
b) For a bolt in a connection with long slotted hole with the slots
perpendicular to the direction of the bearing force.
Eqn. J3-6c
Rn
Rn
= 1.0 L c t F u
= 1.0 L c t F u /
<= 2.0 d t F u
<= 2.0 d t F u /
LRFD = 0.75
ASD = 2.00
Where,
d
Fu
Lc
LONG
SLOTTED
HOLE
Lc
Conservatively equations J3-6a is used for all standard and oversized holes and
is tabulated below in Table 12.15, if the specified minimum edge distance and
pitch are maintained the equation L c will generally not govern.
Note that unless low strength bolts are used (A36 and A307), the capacity is
independent of the bolt grade. That means, the tabulated values are applicable
for all grades of bolts with F u >= 450 N/mm2 (A325, A490, Gr. 8.8 & 10.9)
17
B O L T S
A N D
F A S T E N E R S
Table 12.15
Plate
Thickness
mm
1.5
1.8
2.0
2.5
3
4
5
6
8
10
12
15
20
25
30
40
50
12
7.29
8.75
9.72
12.15
14.58
19.44
24.30
29.16
38.88
48.60
58.32
72.90
97.20
121.50
145.80
194.40
243.00
36
21.87
26.24
29.16
36.45
43.74
58.32
72.90
87.48
116.64
145.80
174.96
218.70
291.60
364.50
437.40
583.20
729.00
Plate
Thickness
mm
12
16
20
24
27
30
33
36
1.5
1.8
2.0
2.5
3
4
5
6
8
10
12
15
20
25
30
40
50
4.86
5.83
6.48
8.10
9.72
12.96
16.20
19.44
25.92
32.40
38.88
48.60
64.80
81.00
97.20
129.60
162.00
6.48
7.78
8.64
10.80
12.96
17.28
21.60
25.92
34.56
43.20
51.84
64.80
86.40
108.00
129.60
172.80
216.00
8.10
9.72
10.80
13.50
16.20
21.60
27.00
32.40
43.20
54.00
64.80
81.00
108.00
135.00
162.00
216.00
270.00
9.72
11.66
12.96
16.20
19.44
25.92
32.40
38.88
51.84
64.80
77.76
97.20
129.60
162.00
194.40
259.20
324.00
10.94
13.12
14.58
18.23
21.87
29.16
36.45
43.74
58.32
72.90
87.48
109.35
145.80
182.25
218.70
291.60
364.50
12.15
14.58
16.20
20.25
24.30
32.40
40.50
48.60
64.80
81.00
97.20
121.50
162.00
202.50
243.00
324.00
405.00
13.37
16.04
17.82
22.28
26.73
35.64
44.55
53.46
71.28
89.10
106.92
133.65
178.20
222.75
267.30
356.40
445.50
14.58
17.50
19.44
24.30
29.16
38.88
48.60
58.32
77.76
97.20
116.64
145.80
194.40
243.00
291.60
388.80
486.00
18
13
Chapter
W E L D S
Welds
AISC 2005
This section provides some information on the weld design as per the latest
AISC 2005 structural steel specification.
The provisions of AWS D1.1 apply to all specifications on weld in AISC 2005,
with some exceptions as listed in the table below,
Table 13.1
AISC 2005
Section J1.6
Section J2.2a
Table J2.2
Table J2.5
Appendix 3 Table A-3.1
Section B3.9 & Appendix 3
Section M2.2
AWS D1.1
Section 5.17.1
Section 2.3.2
Table 2.1
Table 2.3
Table 2.4
Section 2 Part C
Section 5.15.4.3 & 5.15.4.3
1. Groove Welds
Effective Area: - The effective area of groove welds shall be considered as the
length of the weld times the effective throat thickness t eff .
i. For a CJP (Complete Joint Penetration) Weld, the effective
throat thickness,
t eff = thickness of thinner part joined
ii. For a PJP (Partial Joint Penetration) Weld, the effective
throat thickness is as per table J2.1
iii. For a flare groove welds the effective throat thickness is as
per table J2.2
W E L D S
Welding Process
Shielded Metal Arc
Gas Metal Arc
Flux Cored Arc
SMAW
GMAW
FCAW
Submerged Arc
SAW
Groove Type
(AWS D1.1 Figure 3.3)
All
Effective Throat
J or U Groove
60 V
All
Depth of Groove
J or U Groove
60 Bevel or V
GMAW
FCAW
F, H
45 Bevel
Depth of Groove
SMAW
All
45 Bevel
Depth of Groove
Minus 3 mm
GMAW
FCAW
V, OH
45 Bevel
Depth of Groove
Minus 3 mm
Welding Positions
F Flat
H Horizontal
V Vertical
OH- Overhead
Flare V Groove
15.8 R
19 R
8R
15.8 R
SAW
8R
12.7 R
[a] For Flare Bevel Groove with R < 10 mm use only reinforcing fillet weld on filled flush joint.
R = radius of joint surface (can be assumed to be 2t for HSS), (mm)
General Note;
W E L D S
2. Fillet Welds
Effective Area: - The effective area of a fillet welds shall be considered as the
effective length multiplied by the effective throat. The effective throat of a fillet
weld shall be the shortest distance from the root to the face of the diagrammatic
weld. An increase in the effective throat weld is permitted if consistent penetration
can be demonstrated by tests using the production process and procedure
available. For fillet welds in holes and slots the effective length shall be the length
of centerline of the weld along the center of the plane through the throat.
In the case of overlapping fillets, the effective area shall not exceed the nominal
cross-sectional area of the hole or slot, in the plane of the faying surface.
The minimum size of fillet welds shall be not less than the size required to transmit
the calculated forces, nor the size as shown in Table J2.4. These do not apply to
fillet weld reinforcements of PJP or CJP groove welds.
Table 13.5 (AISC 2005 Table J2.4)
Minimum Size of Fillet Welds
Material Thickness of
Minimum Effective Throat Thickness, [a] (mm)
Thinner Part Joined, (mm)
To (6) inclusive
3
Over (6) to (13)
5
Over (13) to (19)
6
Over (19)
8
[a] Leg dimension of fillet welds. Single pass welds must be used.
Note: See Section J2.2b for maximum size of fillet welds.
= tp mm
= ( tp 2 ) mm
4 x Nominal Size of weld
W E L D S
a) If longitudinal fillet welds are used alone in end connections of flat-bar tension
members, the length of each fillet weld shall be not less than the perpendicular
distance between the welds. (See figure below)
Minimum
Lw >= d
FLAT BAR
WELDS
b) For end loaded fillet welds with a length up to 100 times the leg dimension, it
is permitted to take the effective length equal to the actual length. When the
length of the end loaded fillet weld exceeds 100 times the weld size, the
effective length shall be determined by multiplying the actual length by the
reduction factor . (See figure above for length of weld)
a. For 100 <= L w < 300
= 0.60
Where,
Lw
w
Where,
L wint
Sw
W E L D S
W E L D S
d) In lap joints, the minimum amount of lap shall be 5 times the thickness of
thinner part joined, but not less than 25 mm.
L wlap
Where,
L wlap
tp
W E L D S
W E L D S
W E L D S
4. Strength of Welds.
The design or allowable strength of welds shall be the lower value of the base
material and the weld metal strength determined according to the limit states
of tensile rupture, shear rupture or yielding as follows,
For base metal
Rn
Rn
Eqn. J2-2
= F BM x A BM
= F BM x A BM /
LRFD
ASD
= Fw x Aw
= Fw x Aw /
LRFD
ASD
Eqn. J2-3
Where,
F BM
- nominal strength of the base metal per unit area in N/mm2
Fw
- nominal strength of the weld metal per unit area in N/mm2
A BM - cross sectional area of the base metal in mm2
- cross sectional area of the base metal in mm2
Aw
The values of , , F BM , F w and the limitations thereon are given in table J2.5
Alternatively, for fillet welds loaded in plane the design strength, R n and the
allowable strength, R n / of welds is permitted to be determined as follows,
LRFD
0.75
ASD
2.00
a) For a linear weld group loaded in plane through the center of gravity,
Rn
Rn
Eqn. J2-4
= Fw x Aw
= Fw x Aw /
LRFD
ASD
Where,
F EXX
Aw
Note:- A linear weld group is one in which all elements are in a line or are
parallel
W E L D S
10
W E L D S
LINEAR WELD
GROUP
11
W E L D S
b) For weld elements within a weld group that are loaded in-plane and
analyzed using an instantaneous center of rotation method, the components
of the nominal strength, R nx and R ny are permitted to determined as follows:
R nx
R nx
Eqn. J2-6
= F wix x A wi
= F wiy x A wi
Where,
A wi
= effective area of weld throat of any ith weld element, in mm2
Eqn. J2-7
Eqn. J2-8
F wi
fp
F wi
F wix
F wiy
p
w
r crit
Di
Dm
Du
12
W E L D S
c)
For filled weld groups concentrically loaded and consisting of elements that
are oriented both longitudinally and transversely to the direction of applied
load, the combined strength, R n , of the fillet weld group shall be determined
as the greater of:
Eqn. J2-9a
Rn
= R wl + R wt
OR
Eqn. J2-9b
Rn
= 0.85 R wl + 1.5 R wt
Where,
= the total nominal strength of longitudinally loaded fillet welds, as
R wl
determined in accordance with table J2.5 in kN
= the total nominal strength of transversely loaded fillet welds, as
R wt
determined in accordance with table J2.5 in kN without the alternate in
equation J2.4 and J2.5 in kN.
5. Combination of Welds.
If two or more general types of welds (groove, fillet, plug, and slot) are
combined in a single joint, the strength of each shall be separately computed
with reference to the axis of the group in order to determine the strength of the
combination.
6. Filler Metal requirements.
The choice of electrode for use with CJP groove welds subject to tension
normal to the effective area shall comply with the requirements for matching
filler metals given in AWS D1.1
Table 13.6
Base Metal
A36 < 19 mm
A36 > 19 mm, A572 (Gr. 50 & 55)
A588*, A992
A1011, A1018
A913 (Gr. 60 & 65)
For corrosion resistance and color similar to the base metal see AWS D1.1 sect 3.7.3
Notes:1.
Electrodes shall meet the requirements of AWS A5.1, A5.5, A5.17, A5.18, A5.20, A5.23, A5.28 & A5.29
2.
In joints with base metals of different strengths use either a filler metal that matches the higher strength
base metal or a filler metal that matches the lower strength and produces a low hydrogen deposit.
13
W E L D S
14
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
14
Chapter
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Clear Span
Clear Span frames are single gable frames providing full-width clear space
inside the building without any interior columns. This type of frame is
generally used when, an unobstructed working area is desired in diverse
applications such as auditoriums, gymnasiums, aircraft hangars, showrooms
and recreation facilities. The deepest part of the frame is the knee (the joint
between the rafter and the column) for small spans, and also at mid span for
large spans. A horizontal knee connection is more popular because it facilitates
erection, the other option being a vertical knee connection that is employed for
flush side-wall construction, parapet fascia, glazing etc. Clear Span rigid
frames are suitable and economical when,
i)
Frame width is in the range 24 m-30 m.
ii)
Headroom at the exterior walls is not critical.
RIDGE DISTANCE
RIDGE LINE
HORIZONTAL
KNEE
CLEAR HT.
CLEAR WIDTH
CENTER TO CENTER
CENTER TO OUT
OUT TO CENTER
OUT TO OUT
CROSS SECTION
Horizontal Knee
Perpendicular Knee
Vertical Knee
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Multi - Span
When clear space inside the building is not the crucial requirement then MultiSpan rigid frames offer greater economy and theoretically unlimited building
size. Buildings wider than around 90m experience a build up of temperature
stresses and require temperature load analysis and design. Multi-span rigid
frames have straight interior columns, generally hot-rolled tube sections pin
connected at the top with the rafter. When lateral sway is critical, the interior
columns may be moment connected at the top with the rafter, and in such a
situation, built-up straight columns are more viable than hot-rolled tube
columns.
The bottom flange of the rafter at ridge should be horizontal when an interior
column is located at ridge to facilitate connection. Multi-Span rigid frames are
one of the more economical solutions, when the required width of the building
is large (width > 24m) and the intended use are as warehouses, logistics,
distribution centers, show rooms and factories. The most economical modular
width in multi-span buildings is in the range 18m-24m.
RIDGE DISTANCE
RIDGE LINE
CLEAR WIDTH
CENTER TO CENTER
CENTER TO OUT
OUT TO CENTER
OUT TO OUT
CROSS SECTION
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
WIDTH
CROSS SECTION
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
WIDTH
CROSS SECTION
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Space Saver
Space Saver framing system utilizes straight columns, keeping the rafter
bottom flange horizontal for accommodation ceiling applications with rigid
knee connection. Selection of Space Saver is appropriate for following,
1. The required frame width is between 6 to 18m and eave height does not
exceed 6m.
2. Straight columns are desired.
3. Roof slope of < 0.5:10 are acceptable.
4. Requirement of minimum air volume inside the building for cold storage
ware houses.
RIDGE DISTANCE
WIDTH
CROSS SECTION
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Roof System
A Roof System framing ideally consists of beam (rafter) resting on top of a
concrete column of a new or an existing substructure. In order to avoid large
horizontal forces on top of these concrete columns and induce huge moments
at base the rafters are designed to induce vertical reactions only. This can be
achieved by prescribing a theoretical roller support condition at one end.
Hence any horizontal thrust is released by movement of the roller support.
The roller supports are provided at one end by means of roller rods. The other
option is to provide slotted holes at one end, in such cases some horizontal
force does exist, the a horizontal reaction H 2 has to be considered for the
design of supporting system. H 2 is calculated as below,
H 2 = mR
Where,
m= Coefficient of friction between steel and steel
R = Vertical reaction at that end.
A Roof System is generally not economical for spans greater than 12m
although it can span as large as 40 m. This is due to fact that the Roof System
as designed as simply supported and the maximum moment occur at the midspan.
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Multi-Gable
Multi-Gable buildings are ideal framing configuration for very wide building
requirement. The advantage for such wide building is high eave heights can be
avoided, hence reduced height of interior columns. and temperature effects
can be controlled by dividing the frame into separate structural segments,
making these more economical when compared to multi-span buildings.
These are not recommended due to high maintenance requirement in valley
region, costly internal drainage and bracing requirement inside the building at
columns located at valley. Multi-Gable framing should is not a good solution,
especially in areas of snowfall.
Multi-Gable frames may be clear span or multi-span, the interior columns at
knee are rigidly connected to the rafters using a vertical connection. When
clear height requirement is a criteria, the clear height at interior columns will
usually govern. Also the stiffeners should be adequately provided at interior
column connection.
10
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
End Walls
The standard end wall are designed as bearing frame. That is all connections
are considered as pinned. The lateral stability is provided by the diaphragm
action in the absence of this shear diaphragm cross bracing are required. Cross
bracings should be provide in areas of high seismic zones.
Main frame ends are used in case it is required to consider provision for,
1. Future extension is intended or if stated clearly in the (P.I.F.), in such an
arrangement only wind columns are required.
2. Crane run length is full length of the building
3. Open for access condition prevails at the end wall such as hangar
buildings
4. X-bracing is required at end wall for stability, but it is not allowed by the
end-user.
11
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Roof Slope
Building roof slopes play a major role in the behavior of a frame. Substantial
reduction in steel rigid frame weight can be achieved by using steeper slopes
for Clear Span frames of large widths. Table below gives a comparison of
frame weights for different slope,
Table 14.1
Sr. No.
Roof Slope
Frame Weight
1
0.5 : 10
3682
2
1.0 : 10
3466
3
1.5 : 10
3328
4
2.0 : 10
3240
For a Clear Span Frame of 42 m width and 6.00 m eave height.
Tips on Roof Slope
1. In case of Multi-Span frame, steep roof slopes may result in heavy frames
due to the fact the larger unbraced lengths of interior columns require
heavy wide flange columns.
2. Steep roof slopes help reduce the deflection in wide span buildings.
3. In the areas of high snowfall steep roof slopes (> 1:10) help reduce
accumulation of snow and the loads if snow load governs the design.
4. Steep roof slope are uneconomical when fascias are required, because the
height of fascia increases if it is required to cover the ridge line. This also
impacts on more horizontal forces at the eave of the frame and
consequently increases the frame weight.
5. Roof slope of 1.5:10 or greater necessitates sag rods provision between
purlins thus adding to the price of the building.
Table 14.2
Sr. No.
1
2
3
4
Roof Slope
Clear Span up to 45 m
Clear Span up to 60 m
Clear Span > 60 m
Multi-Span up to 60 m
12
Slope : 10
1.0 : 10
1.5 : 10
2.0 to 3.0 : 10
0.5 : 10
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Eave Height
Eave height is a function of,
1. Clear height at eave.
2. Mezzanine clear heights below beam and above joist
3. Clearance above Crane beam / Crane hook height requirement.
A designer should minimize eave height to the bare minimum required, no
need to round off the values, say if a calculated eave height of 7396 mm is
required for a given clear height requirement of 6500 mm, provide 7396 mm,
no need to round it off to 7400 mm. Since the eave height affects the price of
the building due to following reasons,
1.
2.
3.
4.
13
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Roof Purlins
Roof purlins should be arranged according to the following guide lines or as
required by design,
1. Provide the first eave purlin at a distance of (+/-)80 mm
2. Standard interior purlin spacing is 1.5 m for M30-252 and 2.0 m for M45250, excluding the areas of local areas such as corners and edge.
3. Higher spacing may be provided for purlins supporting sandwich panels,
not exceeding 3.0 m.
4. Spacing less than 1.5 or 2.0 m may also be used if required by design.
5. If non-standard purlin spacings are used at estimate stage, it should be
specified in the estimate and the PIF.
6. Different lap distance may be used at end bay and interior bays for
optimization.
7. Nesting of purlins is not practical with our profiles and hence should be
avoided.
Table 14.3 Minimum thicknesses of members that are to be used in the design
Minimum Thickness or size used
Members
(other than Dubai jobs)
Z- Sections (200mm depth)
General Notes
1. Z- Sections 250 mm deep of 2.0 mm and 2.5 mm thickness can be rolled.
These are roll formed from 395 mm wide coil which is the same coil that
we use to produce the 200 mm deep C-sections. Thus the price per linear
meter of 250 mm deep Z section is the same as the 200 mm deep C-section.
2. Welding of cold formed galvanized sections should be avoided as far as
possible due to fabrication requirement. Small length of welding in
unavoidable case can be acceptable by factory.
3. We now have a resistance-welding machine for welding cold formed
sections. Welding of cold formed sections up to 2.5 mm thick is possible
with this welding machine.
14
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Wall Girts
Our standard practice is to provide flush Endwall girts, that is flush with end
wall columns (end wall columns spacing is in range of 5m-6m), which
provides a diaphragm action for a bearing frame end wall, thus avoiding any
need for end wall bracing. The Sidewall girts are designed as continuous beam
bypassing the main frame columns this allows lapping of the girts and larger
main frames columns spacing can be used. If there are no special requirements
such as wall openings, block walls, etc. standard wall girt spacing should be
followed as below,
1. The first girt should be provided at 2250mm from finish floor level to allow
for recent or future erection of personal doors.
2. Standard interior purlin spacing is 1.5 m for M30-252 and 2.0 m for M45250, excluding the areas of local areas such as corners and edge.
3. Spacing less than 1.5 or 2.0 m may also be used if required by design.
4. Maximum spacing of girts for sandwich panels should not exceed 3.0 m.
5. If non-standard purlin spacings are used at estimate stage, it should be
specified in the estimate and the PIF.
6. Different lap distance may be used at end bay and interior bays for
optimization.
7. Nesting of girts is not practical with our profiles and hence should be
avoided.
Sag rods
1. A minimum 1 row of 12 mm diameter (min.) sag rods should be provided
for all purlins and girts for all bay spacing between 8.5 m and 9 m up to
and including 1.5:10 roof slopes.
2. For roof slopes greater than 1.5:10 sag rods may be required for all lengths
of bay spacing.
3. Minimum 2 rows of 12 mm diameter (min.) sag rods should be provided
for all purlins and girts for all bay spacing between 9 m and 10 m up to
and including 1.5:10 roof slopes. For roof slopes greater than 1.5:10 sag
rods may be required for all lengths of bay spacing.
4. Sag rods must be provided for 356 deep M-purlins sections (TMCP) for all
bay spacing lengths and all roof slopes. Number of rows of sag rods
required should be as required by design, with a minimum of 2 rows.
5. For JAFZA and other areas 16 mm diameter sag rod is required, see job
requirements for different areas.
15
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Expansion Joints
The maximum length of the building without any expansion joint can be
calculated using following formula,
L = D max / KaD T
Where,
D max = Maximum Allowable Expansion in mm.
L
= Length of building in mm.
a
= Coefficient of linear expansion (0.0000117/ o C)
DT
= Temp. Difference in o C
K
= 1.00 for building without air-conditioning
= 0.70 for building with air-conditioning
= 0.55 for building with heating and air-conditioning
Example:
Calculate the maximum length when expansion joint is required for the
following locations: Abu Dhabi & Dubai. Considering a 30 -mm expansion
slot, which is derived from purlin expansion joint detail
Note: 2mm expansion per purlin connection.
Assuming 15 bays gives: 15 x 2 = 30 mm
Solution: Temperature difference in UAE:
Abu Dhabi
= 35 oC
Based on "Engineer's Guide to Solar Energy" By Yvonne Howell & Justin A.
Bereny
Abu Dhabi Area
1. Building without air-conditioning
L = 30 / ( 1.00 x 35 x 0.0000117)
2. Building with air-conditioning
L = 30 / ( 0.70 x 35 x 0.0000117)
3. Building with air-conditioning
L = 30 / ( 0.55 x 35 x 0.0000117)
(K = 1.0)
= 73260 mm = 73.26 m
(K = 0.70)
= 104657 mm = 104.65 m
(K = 0.55)
= 133199 mm = 133.20 m
Expansion joint should be provided if the length of the building exceeds 120
meters, even if it is not required as per calculation above.
16
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Bay Spacing
Bay Spacing is another important criterion that affects the overall economy of
the building. It is important to achieve a reasonable balance between the total
weight of purlin/girt and main frame. The information provided below are for
standard loads only, for non-standard loads the results may vary depending
upon other criteria.
The standard loads are,
Live Loads Roof
Live Loads Frame
Wind Load
Table 14.4
Cold Formed
Section Type
Z-Section
M-Section
= 0.96 kN/m2
= 0.57 kN/m2
= 1.00 kN/m2
Bay Location
End Bays
Interior Bays
End Bays
Interior Bays
6.50 m
7.50 m
9.00 m
12.0 m
Smaller end bays than interior bays will usually reduce the effect of higher
deflection and bending moment in end bays as compared to interior bays and
help reduce the weights of purlins/girts in the end bays. This will avoid the
need of nested purlins/girts in the end bays and result in uniform size of
purlin/girt sizes.
For non-standard loadings, the economical bay spacing may tend to decrease,
with the increase in the loads.
For buildings with heavy cranes ( > 10 MT) the economical bay spacing ranges
between 6.00 m and 7.50 m.
17
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
18
= 72.0 m
=6
= 12.0 m
= 90.0 m
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Bracing Systems
A building is subjected to lateral forces in many direction due to wind,
seismic, crane and other horizontal loads, for metal buildings these forces are
resolved in two orthogonal directions. The main frame resist these lateral
forces in the plane they are provided. In other direction a Bracings Systems is
provided, these may consist of cross bracing or portal frames. These loads are
eventually transferred to the foundations through a definite load path.
Following guide line should be followed when deciding upon the type of
bracing and their configuration,
Wind and Seismic load Bracing in longitudinal direction
1. A maximum of 5 bays may be provided between braced bays.
2. A braced bay should not be located in the end bay of a building if the end
wall system is a bearing frame end, unless it is required for many other
reasons. In such cases where a bracing cannot be avoided in the end bays,
the corner column may be either rotated or specially connection detail
should be provided. The end wall columns should be checked for loading
in all directions.
3. The bracing in roof and sidewall should be preferably in the same bays. If
due to some reason such as framed openings etc, the sidewall bracing may
be provided in one bay adjacent and proper load transfer should be
designed and detailed to transfer the load through the strut member to the
braced bay.
4. Roof bracing should be broken at the ridge line.
5. Cables / rods braces should preferably not exceed 15 m in length. If a cross
bracing contains pieces longer than 15m, then the bracing may be broken
to two sets of bracings with a strut member between them so that the
rod/cable lengths is not exceeding 15 m.
6. Bracing of any one type or material, such as cable, rod, angle or portal
bracing should be used in one wall. Mixing of different type of bracing, in
one wall should be avoided.
7. It is preferable to use only one type of wall bracing in the whole building
otherwise the lateral loads will have to be distributed as per the bracing
stiffness.
8. Minimum diameter for cable bracing is 12 mm and 20 mm for rod bracing.
9. The maximum length of cable, rod or angle bracing should preferably not
exceed 15 meters in length.
10. Use 75x75x6 double angles up to 12 meter and 100x100x8 double angles up
to 15 meters, unless required otherwise by design.
19
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
20
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Built-Up Sections
Table 14.5 Minimum thicknesses of members that are to be used in the design
Minimum Thickness or size used
Members
(other than Dubai jobs)
Built-up members Web
5 mm thick
6 mm thick
IPEA-200
Flange braces
Angle 40x40x2.5
Sag rods
12 mm diameter
Cable braces
12 mm diameter
Rod braces
22 mm diameter
21
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
150 x 8
175 x 8
200 x 8
200 x 20
250 x 20
-
200 x 25
250 x 25
-
22
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
BALANCE
3000 (MIN)
10 mm
(TYP)
TF1
W1
15 MAX
3000 (MIN)
TF2
TF3
TF4
W2
W3
W4
BUTT WELD
(TYP)
28 MAX
BF1
BF3
BF4
BF2
DEPTH
RAFTER
STRAIGHT LENGTH
CRANE BEAM
CRANE BRACKET
TAPERED
150 (MIN)
23
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
24
Minimum
12 mm
175 mm
10 mm
175 mm
16 mm
2 Nos.
12 mm
10 mm
5 mm
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Description
Symbol
Limits
(dw min )
(dw max )
210 mm
1550 mm
2200 mm
125 mm
500 mm
15 mm
15
(bf max )
(bf min )
(tf max )
Note:The limitations above are for standard jobs and manufacturing on automatic
welding machine, other depth / widths of sections are possible and can be
fabricated offline, if required for any job.
Table 14.9 Design Limitations for Built up members
Sr.
No
Description
Compact
NonCompact
Maximum
AISC 1989
1
Web depth to thickness ratio (dw / tw)
90
138
180
$
2
Flange width to thickness ratio (bf / tf)
18.3
26.8
33
3
Web depth to flange width ratio (dw / bf)
5
4
Flange thk. to web thk. ratio (tf / tw)
2.5
All limits are for grade 50 material (F y = 345 N/mm2)
$ - Using K = 1
c
AISC 2005
1
Web depth to thickness ratio (dw / tw)
90
137
180
2
Flange width to thickness ratio (bf / tf)
18.3
47 $
33
3
Web depth to flange width ratio (dw / bf)
5
4
Flange thk. to web thk. ratio (tf / tw)
2.5
All limits are for grade 50 material (F y = 345 N/mm2)
$ - Using K = 0.76 and F = 0.7 F
c
L
y
All values noted above are for flanges and webs in flexure, see code for axial compression
Refer Table B5.1 from AISC 89 and Table B4.1 from AISC 05
25
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Channels
260x75 @ 27.6
300x90 @ 41.2
380x100 @ 54.5
-
I Beams
IPEA-200 @ 18.4
UB203x133 @ 25.1
-
26
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
27
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Design Considerations
1. It is necessary to have double side weld for built-up members that will be
hot dip galvanized.
2. Thin and slender sections are prone to twisting and buckling because of
high temperature stresses while galvanizing.
3. Proper vent holes should be provided for hollow tube sections.
4. Proper consideration should be given to splice pate faying (contact)
surface. Some consultants prefer these surfaces free of galvanization, with
special friction paints.
5. All lapped joints or welding should be seal welded in order to avoid flow
of cleaning material and zinc into the welds.
6. Proper temporary bracing should be provided for thin members.
7. The limitations on overall size of the member are governed by the size of
the galvanizing tank.
Table 14.11 Design Limitations for Hot Dip Galvanized Built up members
Sr.
Symbol
Description
Limits
No
1
Web depth to thickness ratio
(dw / tw)
130
2
Flange width to thickness ratio
(bf / tf)
25
3
Web depth to flange width ratio
(dw / bf)
5
4
Flange thickness to web thickness ratio
(tf / tw)
2.0
28
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Crane System
Detailed information on the crane system, supplier, capacity, service class,
wheel loads etc, are required to provide a realistic design and estimate at the
first instance. The price impact on the design and estimate due to any variation
is huge, hence proper attention should be paid to all aspects of design and
detailing for building with cranes. Some guidelines are provided below for
design of buildings with cranes.
1. Crane runway beams may be provided with any of the 3 configuration
below,
Cap Channel + Top Flange + Web + Bottom Flange.
Cap Channel + Web + Bottom Flange.
Top Flange + Web + Bottom Flange. (with or with out surge girder
as required by design)
2. The default fatigue stress range is 20.70 kN/cm2. However for paper mills,
foundries and rolling mills a fatigue stress of 12.50 kN/cm2 is often
required for safety reasons. (The fatigue stresses considered in design
should be confirmed with the customer at estimation stage).
3. As a standard welding procedure,
For Crane beams with web thickness less than or equal to 8 mm
double side fillet welds are provided between top / bottom flange
and web.
For web thickness greater than 8 mm, CJP (Complete joint
Penetration) weld is provided between top flange and web only
and double side fillet weld between bottom flange and web, this
should be considered at estimate stage.
4. If crane lifting capacity is equal to or exceeds 20MT the portion of the main
frame column below the crane runway beam should be double side weld.
5. Double side welding should be provided for stepped column below crane
beam and independent crane columns. The double side welding for crane
beams should be included in the estimate.
6. Stepped columns are more economical than separate crane column
especially for larger eave height buildings.
29
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
30
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
31
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Mezzanine
Buildings with mezzanines should be carefully designed and estimated,
various options for the flooring system should be explored depending upon
the loading, use and location of mezzanine. The impact on the overall
percentage of estimate due to any variation is huge. Following guide lines are
to be considered while planning mezzanine floor:1. Most economical mezzanine column spacing is around 6.0 m.
2. Whenever possible mezzanine columns should be aligned with main frame
column and wind column spacing for proper framing and connection.
3. Generally aligning joists along the shorter panel side of a mezzanine plan
will provide an economical framing.
4. Cold formed sections (double C back to back) may be used as joist, if
allowed by consultants / customer. Otherwise hot-rolled or built-up
sections may be used.
5. Preferably use tube columns as mezzanine columns, tube columns may be
filled with concrete to increase the axial capacity.
6. Generally the anchor bolt pattern for tube column is parallel to the plane of
rigid frame, but if required for stability in other direction for minor lateral
loads, it may be rotated 90.
7. In areas of high seismic zones, check with customer if bracings are allowed
below mezzanine.
8. Use hot-rolled or built-up columns if bracing is to be provided for
mezzanine.
9. Clear height above and below mezzanine beam must be maintained,
preferably between 2.5 m-3.0 m, or as required by the customer.
10. Top landing may or may not be required depending on the location of the
staircase with reference to mezzanine plan. If it is not required it should be
avoided.
11. Maximum number of Riser in a single straight flight without mid-landing
should preferably not exceed 15. If exceeded then a mid-landing should be
provided.
32
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
12. The choice of single or double flight stair should be based on mezzanine
layout or as required by customer.
13. A stair Riser ranges from 160 to 200 mm, standard rise of 175 mm should
be used, unless unavoidable.
14. A stair Tread ranges from 220 to 250 mm, standard tread width of 230
mm should be used, unless unavoidable.
Table 14.12 Maximum Allowable Joist Spacing
Slab
Thickness
(mm)
100
125
150
175
200
225
Deck Profile
Panel Thk.
(mm)
45-150
0.50
45-150
0.70
33
Maximum
Spacing (mm)
Number of
Spans
2250
2000
1750
2250
2000
1750
3 or More
3 or More
3 or More
3 or More
3 or More
3 or More
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Hangar Buildings
1. The hangar door is not Mammuts scope of supply.
2. The hangar doors are usually supported at the bottom and laterally
supported at the top, hence the lateral wind load transferred by the door to
the building framing should be considered in design.
3. For hangar buildings the vertical deflection of rigid frame rafters above the
door track area should be limited to 100 mm for live load only. (This
applies to the 2 end frames supporting the hanger door leaves).
4. Camber must be provided for the 2 end frame rafters supporting the door
equal to the dead load deflection only.
5. Estimates must include top track door guides. These door guide members
are vertical and are suspended (welded) from the bottom chord of the
member connecting the 2 end frames rafters. Door guide members are
often made of 300mm deep UB or UC sections.
6. Soffit panels and necessary flashings and purlins above the door, to
conceal the framing above the door, should be quoted as an option.
7. Wall panels and girts (on the inside of the 2nd interior frame), to conceal the
structural members above the door (between the 2 end frames), should be
quoted as an option.
8. Door cladding to be included as an add-on price.
9. Building should be designed as partially enclosed structure.
34
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Optimizing
The following guideline will help in design and estimation for an economical
solution, keeping in consideration detailing ease, fabrication, shipping and
erection limitations.
1. Minimize the number of splice in columns and rafter by providing
maximum possible length of a section.
Example:- Clear Span building width is 28 meters, job is to be shipped in
containers, maximum length of section is limited to 11.8 m
Therefore, number of pieces = 28 / 11.8 = 2.37 ~ 3 pieces
If the ridge portion is flat 3 pieces maximum.
If splice is at ridge then 4 pieces maximum.
Example:- A 2-Multispan building width is 85 meters, job is to be shipped
overland, maximum length of section is limited to 12.0 m
Therefore, number of pieces = 85 / 12 = 7.08 ~ 8 pieces
If the ridge portion is flat, with column at ridge 9 pieces.
If interior column is not at ridge then 8 pieces.
In some cases, say for building width 24 to 26 m try to use vertical knee to
reduce the number of piece to two.
2. If possible try to locate the splices at the locations of minimum bending
moment or at locations of least depth.
3. Try to group frames of similar profile if the only difference is the bay
spacing and the difference in weight does not exceed 5%, also the
difference of weight of total number of frames is not exceeding 1000 kgs.
Example:W1
N1
W2
N2
Equation-1
Equation-2
( W2 / W1 )
( W2 N1 W1 N1 )
35
<= 1.05
<= 1000
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
36
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
16. Both flanges may be considered braced if the section framing is connected
at the center or close to one flange, the distance between the extreme edge
of framing member and far side flange does not exceed 200 mm.
17. In case of joist framing into beams, always consider the top flange braced if
compression is top only. For other cases where the bottom flange may be
in compression , consider both the flanges braced if the joist or framing
member extends beyond half the web depth of beam. Other wise, provide
flange brace for bracing the far side flange.
18. Maintain the maximum stress ratios between 0.95 and 1.00, ensure that all
the sections are fully utilized.
19. If lateral deflection is governs the design
a. Check the Height / Width ratio if greater than 0.75 use fixed base.
b. For clear span frames, increase the depth of the column and then
increase the depth of the rafter.
c. For multi-span frames, try to increase the depth of column and rafter at
knee and interior column location, then try to fix the columns at top,
and then try fixing the base of interior columns. This may need builtup section instead of tube columns.
20. If vertical deflection is governs the design, try increasing the rafter depth at
knee and then column depth at knee, slight increase in the depth at ridge
might help in case of clear span frames for less wide buildings.
21. Provide camber for very large width clear span frames.
22. For buildings with crane, both flanges of the columns can be considered
braced at level of crane beam.
23. Top flange of crane beam can be considered braced at location of
longitudinal bracing to column flange.
24. For independent crane columns, consider brace points at the tie member
connecting the independent crane column to main frame column.
37
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
Insulation
Table 14.15 Quantity of insulation in m2 that can be loaded in one 40 feet
long container:
Density
Size
50
75
100
12 kg/m3
FRK(FSK) WMSK(MB)
3960
3520
3000
2640
1760
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
16 kg/m3
FRK(FSK) WMSK(MB)
2530
2640
1760
1320
20 kg/ m3
FRK(FSK) WMSK(MB)
2530
2640
2090
1760
1320
Fiberglass
Description
Blankets or batts
Expanded
Polystrene
White
"Beadboard"
Extruded
Polystrene
Blueboard or
Pinkboard
R11-R13 = 3.5"
R19 = 6.25"
R4 = 1"
R5 = 1"
R-value
R21 = 5.25"
evaluation in
R6 = 1.5"
R7.5 = 1.5"
R25 = 8.75"
inches
R8 = 2"
R10 = 2"
R30 = 9.50"
R38 = 12
[Where, R is the thermal resistance of the roofing material in ft2 h F/Btu (K m2/W)]
Polyurethene/
Polyisocyanurate
Foil-faced OR
Felt-faced
R6 = 1"
R9 = 1.5"
R12 = 2"
= 1 / (R / 5.678)
= 1 / (20/5.678)
= 0.28 (W/m2 K)
= 1 / (R / 5.678)
= 1 / (30/5.678)
= Thickness (T) / k
K m2/W
=1/R
38
= 0.19 (W/m2 K)
G U I D E L I N E
F O R
D E S I G N
O F
M E T A L
B U I L D I N G
1
2
3
4
5
5
6
8
10
12
2. For roof monitors of throat width exceeding 2.5 meters, provide one
continuous row of strut tube (minimum 150x150x4.5) at the ridge for the
full length of building.
39
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
15
Chapter
D E S I G N
Thickness
(mm)
Aluzinc
Aluminium
0.70
Profiles
Coil Width
M30-252
M45-250
M45-150
1219 mm
Cover
Width
1010 mm
1000 mm
900 mm
Thickness
(mm)
Coil Width
PU Thickness
(mm)
35, 50, 75, 100
0.50
and
0.70
1219 mm
Thickness
(mm)
Coil Width
0.35
and
0.50
1100 mm
Other Materials
Fleece
Al. Foil
Cover Width
(mm)
1000
1000
900
996
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
Panel thickness:
1. All thicknesses of roof and wall panels are TCTP Total Coated Thickness
Painted. They include the thickness of Aluzinc coating and paint. This
means a BMT Base Metal Thickness is lesser than the TCTP. (Refer
table below)
Table 15.3 TCTP and BMT
Sr. No.
Panel Type & Finish
1
Aluzinc Mill Finish (Primer Coated)
2
Aluzinc Painted
3
Galvanized Mill Finish (AL+Zn Coated)
4
Aluminium Mill Finish
5
Aluminium Painted
Assumptions
(Aluminium +Zinc) Coating Thickness =
Primer Thickness =
Paint Thickness =
Deductions
TCTP - 0.044 = BMT
TCTP - 0.064 = BMT
TCTP 0.032 = BMT
TCTP = BMT
TCTP 0.025 = BMT
0.032 mm
0.012 / 0.015 mm
0.020 / 0.010 mm
Base metal thickness varies for different material and finish, For the purpose of
design the actual base metal thickness is used for calculation of section
properties.
2. If a customer specifies a different thickness please consult purchasing for
prices. However, approval of V.P. is required before quoting.
3. For panels requiring PVF2 (Poly Vinyl Fluoride 2) finish
a) V.P. approval is required.
b) Extended delivery time should be informed to the client.
c) When PVF2 panels are used, all fasteners should be Stainless Steel.
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
Exterior
Interior
High Rib
M30-252
M45-250
M45-150
Flat Series
MW - MR
ST- FL
High Rib
M30-252
M45-250
M45-150
High Rib
M30-252
M45-250
M45-150
Flat Series
MW - MR
ST- FL
Flat Series
MW - MR
ST- FL
PU
Core
Thk.
(mm)
No. of
Pallets
per 12m
T or C
No. of Panels
per Pallet in a
12m
Total No. of
Panels in a 12m
Panel
Width
(m)
Average
Length of
Panel (m)
Total No. of
Panels in a 12m
50
13
12
52
48
10.5
546
504
75
10
40
36
10.5
420
378
100
32
28
10.5
336
294
50
11
10
44
40
10.5
462
420
75
36
32
10.5
378
336
100
28
24
10.5
294
252
50
22
19
88
76
10.5
924
798
75
14
13
56
52
10.5
588
546
100
11
44
36
10.5
462
378
The section properties can be calculated manual as per Section 3 of AISI 2001
Manual. The values tabulated in the load table for various panel profiles below
are calculated using RSG Software (CFS Version 4.14).
Based on these properties the allowable loads are calculated for any of the 3
case that is Moment, Shear or Deflection which governs.
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
Example 15.1
Let us consider a panel of 0.50 mm thk Aluzinc material and M45-250 profile.
The base metal thickness is taken as 0.425 mm
We know the equation and location for maximum moment for 1, 2 and 3 spans
beam for a uniform load are as given below,
Moment
Location at mid span
1 Span
M = WL2 / 8
Location at mid span
2 Span
M = 0.07 WL2
Location at support
2 Span
M = WL2 / 8
3 Span
M = 0.08 WL2
Location at midspan
Location at support
3 Span
M = WL2 / 10
Shear
1 Span
2 Span
3 Span
V = WL / 2
V = 5 WL / 8
V = 6 WL / 10
Location at support
Location at support
Location at support
Deflection
1 Span
2 Span
3 Span
D = 0.013 WL4 / EI
D = 0.0054 WL4 / EI
D = 0.0069 WL4 / EI
Location at midspan
Location at midspan
Location at midspan
W=8V/L
W=8V/5L
W = 10 V / 6 L
Location at support
Location at support
Location at support
Deflection
1 Span
2 Span
3 Span
W = 76.9 DEI / L4
W = 185 DEI / L4
W = 145 DEI / L4
Location at midspan
Location at midspan
Location at midspan
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
We know, from panel load chart, the maximum allowable moment, shear and
deflection are as below,
Compression at top
Max. Moment
M atx = 0.74 kNm
Compression at bottom
Max. Moment
M abx = 0.99 kNm
= 4.02 kN
Max. Shear
Va
Max Deflection
D
= L / 60
Substituting the values of Max. Moment = M, Max. Shear = V, Maximum
deflection = L/60 and L = 2.00 m, E = 20000, I tx = 11.49, we get,
Moment
1 Span
2 Span
2 Span
3 Span
3 Span
W = 8 x 0.74 / 22
W = 0.74 / (0.07 x 22)
W = 8 x 0.99 / 22
W = 0.74 / (0.08 x 22)
W = 10 x 0.99 / 22
= 1.48 kN/m2
= 2.64 kN/m2
= 1.98 kN/m2
= 2.31 kN/m2
= 2.48 kN/m2
Shear
1 Span
2 Span
3 Span
W = 8 x 4.02 / 2
W = 8 x 4.02 / (5 x 2)
W = 10 x 4.02 / (6 x 2)
= 16.1 kN/m2
= 3.22 kN/m2
= 3.35 kN/m2
Deflection
1 Span
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
Similarly for Wind Pressure (WP) case, all the equations above remain same.
We see that deflection does not govern; hence we use the same allowable load
for Wind Pressure (WP) as for D+L case.
For wind suction, the equations are re-written with interchanging the values
for M abx instead of M atx , and also I bx is used instead of I tx for deflection, as
shown below,
Moment
1 Span
2 Span
2 Span
3 Span
3 Span
W = 8 x 0.99 / 22
W = 0.99 / (0.07 x 22)
W = 8 x 0.74 / 22
W = 0.99 / (0.08 x 22)
W = 10 x 0.74 / 22
= 1.98 kN/m2
= 3.53 kN/m2
= 1.48 kN/m2
= 3.09 kN/m2
= 1.85 kN/m2
1 Span
= 0.05 kN/m2
= 0.57 kN/ m2
= 0.62 kN/ m2
=2
= 2.5 m
Allowable load as per the table for 0.5 Aluzinc for 2 spans = 1.27 kN/ m2
Hence it is OK to use 2.5 meter span for above panel material, profile and
thickness.
Similarly, it should be checked for Wind Pressure and Wind Suction especially
in the corners and edge strips.
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
The same exercise as above for single skin can be applied to check the
allowable loads in the table for any given panel.
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
E
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
0.50
1000.00
4.315
5.18
15.60
0.70
1000.00
6.228
7.62
22.92
20000.00
20.28
6.80
12.72
1.40
17.71
7.34
8.19
1.52
12.80
1.00
1000.00
9.095
11.27
33.87
20000.00
33.53
11.75
19.13
2.43
28.54
11.16
13.93
2.30
33.33
It x
(kN / cm
2)
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
20000.00
11.49
3.58
8.53
Ibx
S xTop
S xBot
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
0.74
10.99
4.84
4.81
0.99
4.02
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
1.00
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
5.92
3.79
2.63
1.93
1.48
1.17
0.95
0.78
0.66
0.56
0.48
WP
5.92
3.79
2.63
1.93
1.48
1.17
0.94
0.71
0.54
0.43
0.34
WS
7.94
5.08
3.53
2.59
1.76
1.24
0.90
0.68
0.52
0.41
0.33
D+L
6.43
5.08
3.53
2.59
1.99
1.57
1.27
1.05
0.88
0.75
0.65
WP
6.43
5.08
3.53
2.59
1.99
1.57
1.27
1.05
0.88
0.75
0.65
WS
5.92
3.79
2.63
1.93
1.48
1.17
0.95
0.78
0.66
0.56
0.48
D+L
7.31
5.85
4.11
3.02
2.31
1.83
1.48
1.22
1.03
0.88
0.76
WP
7.31
5.85
4.11
3.02
2.31
1.83
1.48
1.22
1.03
0.81
0.65
WS
7.31
4.74
3.29
2.42
1.85
1.46
1.18
0.98
0.82
0.70
0.60
D+L
11.23
7.19
4.99
3.67
2.81
2.22
1.80
1.49
1.25
1.06
0.92
WP
11.23
7.19
4.99
3.67
2.81
2.22
1.66
1.25
0.96
0.76
0.61
WS
12.12
7.76
5.39
3.96
2.83
1.99
1.45
1.09
0.84
0.66
0.53
D+L
12.12
7.76
5.39
3.96
3.03
2.39
1.94
1.60
1.35
1.15
0.99
WP
12.12
7.76
5.39
3.96
3.03
2.39
1.94
1.60
1.35
1.15
0.99
WS
11.23
7.19
4.99
3.67
2.81
2.22
1.80
1.49
1.25
1.06
0.92
D+L
15.15
9.70
6.73
4.95
3.79
2.99
2.42
2.00
1.68
1.43
1.24
WP
15.15
9.70
6.73
4.95
3.79
2.99
2.42
2.00
1.68
1.43
1.14
WS
14.04
8.99
6.24
4.58
3.51
2.77
2.25
1.86
1.56
1.25
1.00
D+L
19.40
12.42
8.62
6.33
4.85
3.83
3.10
2.57
2.16
1.84
1.58
WP
19.40
12.42
8.62
6.33
4.85
3.77
2.75
2.06
1.59
1.25
1.00
WS
18.42
11.79
8.19
6.02
4.57
3.21
2.34
1.76
1.35
1.06
0.85
D+L
18.42
11.79
8.19
6.02
4.61
3.64
2.95
2.44
2.05
1.74
1.50
WP
18.42
11.79
8.19
6.02
4.61
3.64
2.95
2.44
2.05
1.74
1.50
WS
19.40
12.42
8.62
6.33
4.85
3.83
3.10
2.57
2.16
1.84
1.58
D+L
23.03
14.74
10.24
7.52
5.76
4.55
3.68
3.05
2.56
2.18
1.88
WP
23.03
14.74
10.24
7.52
5.76
4.55
3.68
3.05
2.56
2.18
1.88
WS
24.25
15.52
10.78
7.92
6.06
4.79
3.88
3.21
2.55
2.01
1.61
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
0.50
1000.00
1.527
5.71
0.70
1000.00
2.223
1.00
1000.00
3.221
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
It x
S xTop
S xBot
Ibx
(kN / cm
2)
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
17.11
6998.00
12.58
3.91
9.35
0.34
11.85
5.26
5.14
0.45
1.85
8.14
24.42
6998.00
21.28
7.08
13.53
0.61
18.47
7.73
8.43
0.67
5.38
11.80
35.38
6998.00
34.73
12.11
19.92
1.05
29.07
11.52
13.93
1.00
13.89
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
Aluminium
0.70
1.00
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
2.72
1.74
1.21
0.89
0.68
0.54
0.44
0.36
0.30
0.26
0.22
WP
2.72
1.74
1.21
0.89
0.68
0.49
0.36
0.27
0.21
0.16
0.13
WS
3.57
2.28
1.57
0.99
0.66
0.47
0.34
0.26
0.20
0.15
0.12
D+L
2.96
2.28
1.59
1.17
0.89
0.70
0.57
0.47
0.40
0.34
0.29
WP
2.96
2.28
1.59
1.17
0.89
0.70
0.57
0.47
0.40
0.34
0.29
WS
2.72
1.74
1.21
0.89
0.68
0.54
0.44
0.36
0.30
0.26
0.22
D+L
3.36
2.69
1.89
1.39
1.06
0.84
0.68
0.56
0.47
0.40
0.35
WP
3.36
2.69
1.89
1.39
1.06
0.84
0.68
0.51
0.39
0.31
0.25
WS
3.36
2.18
1.51
1.11
0.85
0.67
0.54
0.45
0.37
0.29
0.23
D+L
4.91
3.14
2.18
1.60
1.23
0.97
0.79
0.65
0.55
0.47
0.40
WP
4.91
3.14
2.18
1.60
1.19
0.84
0.61
0.46
0.35
0.28
0.22
WS
5.37
3.44
2.39
1.54
1.03
0.73
0.53
0.40
0.31
0.24
0.19
D+L
5.37
3.44
2.39
1.75
1.34
1.06
0.86
0.71
0.60
0.51
0.44
WP
5.37
3.44
2.39
1.75
1.34
1.06
0.86
0.71
0.60
0.51
0.44
WS
4.91
3.14
2.18
1.60
1.23
0.97
0.79
0.65
0.55
0.47
0.40
D+L
6.71
4.29
2.98
2.19
1.68
1.33
1.07
0.89
0.75
0.64
0.55
WP
6.71
4.29
2.98
2.19
1.68
1.33
1.07
0.86
0.67
0.52
0.42
WS
6.14
3.93
2.73
2.00
1.54
1.21
0.98
0.75
0.58
0.45
0.36
D+L
8.42
5.39
3.74
2.75
2.10
1.66
1.35
1.11
0.94
0.80
0.69
WP
8.42
5.39
3.74
2.75
1.94
1.37
1.00
0.75
0.58
0.45
0.36
WS
8.00
5.12
3.56
2.43
1.63
1.14
0.83
0.63
0.48
0.38
0.30
D+L
8.00
5.12
3.56
2.61
2.00
1.58
1.28
1.06
0.89
0.76
0.65
WP
8.00
5.12
3.56
2.61
2.00
1.58
1.28
1.06
0.89
0.76
0.65
WS
8.42
5.39
3.74
2.75
2.10
1.66
1.35
1.11
0.94
0.80
0.69
D+L
10.00
6.40
4.44
3.27
2.50
1.98
1.60
1.32
1.11
0.95
0.82
WP
10.00
6.40
4.44
3.27
2.50
1.98
1.60
1.32
1.09
0.86
0.68
WS
10.52
6.73
4.68
3.44
2.63
2.08
1.57
1.18
0.91
0.72
0.57
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
10
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T h ic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
E
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
( m m)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
0.50
1000.00
5.028
6.10
18.31
20000.00
14.58
0.70
1000.00
6.942
8.53
25.63
20000.00
23.87
8.19
14.31
1.69
20.30
8.27
9.54
1.71
17.99
1.00
1000.00
9.813
1.22
36.60
20000.00
36.60
12.86
20.72
2.65
31.38
12.12
15.50
2.50
38.95
It x
(kN / cm
2)
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
4.68
10.08
Ibx
S xTop
S xBot
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
0.97
13.48
5.76
6.07
1.19
6.55
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
Galvanized
0.70
1.00
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
7.73
4.95
3.43
2.52
1.93
1.53
1.24
1.02
0.86
0.73
0.63
WP
7.73
4.95
3.43
2.52
1.93
1.53
1.19
0.90
0.69
0.54
0.44
WS
9.50
6.08
4.22
3.10
2.16
1.51
1.10
0.83
0.64
0.50
0.40
D+L
9.50
6.08
4.22
3.10
2.38
1.88
1.52
1.26
1.06
0.90
0.78
WP
9.50
6.08
4.22
3.10
2.38
1.88
1.52
1.26
1.06
0.90
0.78
WS
7.73
4.95
3.43
2.52
1.93
1.53
1.24
1.02
0.86
0.73
0.63
D+L
11.88
7.60
5.28
3.88
2.97
2.35
1.90
1.57
1.32
1.12
0.97
WP
11.88
7.60
5.28
3.88
2.97
2.35
1.90
1.57
1.30
1.03
0.82
WS
9.66
6.18
4.29
3.15
2.42
1.91
1.55
1.28
1.07
0.91
0.76
D+L
13.52
8.65
6.01
4.41
3.38
2.67
2.16
1.79
1.50
1.28
1.10
WP
13.52
8.65
6.01
4.41
3.38
2.67
1.96
1.47
1.13
0.89
0.71
WS
13.66
8.74
6.07
4.46
3.25
2.28
1.66
1.25
0.96
0.76
0.61
D+L
13.66
8.74
6.07
4.46
3.41
2.70
2.18
1.81
1.52
1.29
1.11
WP
13.66
8.74
6.07
4.46
3.41
2.70
2.18
1.81
1.52
1.29
1.11
WS
13.52
8.65
6.01
4.41
3.38
2.67
2.16
1.79
1.50
1.28
1.10
D+L
17.07
10.92
7.59
5.57
4.27
3.37
2.73
2.26
1.90
1.62
1.39
WP
17.07
10.92
7.59
5.57
4.27
3.37
2.73
2.26
1.90
1.62
1.34
WS
16.90
10.82
7.51
5.52
4.23
3.34
2.70
2.23
1.82
1.43
1.14
D+L
21.23
13.59
9.44
6.93
5.31
4.19
3.40
2.81
2.36
2.01
1.73
WP
21.23
13.59
9.44
6.93
5.31
4.11
3.00
2.25
1.74
1.36
1.09
WS
20.02
12.82
8.90
6.54
5.01
3.53
2.57
1.93
1.49
1.17
0.94
D+L
20.02
12.82
8.90
6.54
5.01
3.96
3.20
2.65
2.22
1.90
1.63
WP
20.02
12.82
8.90
6.54
5.01
3.96
3.20
2.65
2.22
1.90
1.63
WS
21.23
13.59
9.44
6.93
5.31
4.19
3.40
2.81
2.36
2.01
1.73
D+L
25.03
16.02
11.12
8.17
6.26
4.94
4.00
3.31
2.78
2.37
2.04
WP
25.03
16.02
11.12
8.17
6.26
4.94
4.00
3.31
2.78
2.37
2.04
WS
26.54
16.99
11.80
8.67
6.64
5.24
4.25
3.51
2.81
2.21
1.77
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
11
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
252.5
252.5
.2
25
15
252.5
31.4
5
30
2.8
4
79
29.5
34.3 37
33
37 34.3
175.6
30
34
37
33
79.5
37
34
173
79.5
173
79.5
173
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
P a nel
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hick ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
( k g/ m )
N o m in
a l A re a
(cm
2)
T o p in C o m pre s sio n
Ix
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
E
It x
( kN / c m
2)
(cm
4)
S xTop
(cm
S xBot
3)
( cm
3)
We b
S hea
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
Ma
tx
(kN m)
Ibx
( cm
4)
(mm)
(mm)
0.50
1010
4.315
5.13
6.70
20000
5.21
2.24
7.29
0.46
3.57
0.70
1010
6.228
7.54
9.84
20000
9.17
4.15
10.80
0.86
5.72
1.00
1010
9.095
11.16
14.57
20000
14.57
6.68
16.08
1.38
9.59
S xTop
S xBot
Ma
bx
(kN m)
2.53
2.09
0.45
8.01
3.81
3.68
0.76
17.33
5.84
6.63
1.21
25.97
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
1.00
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
3.71
2.37
1.65
1.21
0.93
0.73
0.59
0.49
0.41
0.35
0.30
WP
3.71
2.37
1.65
1.21
0.83
0.59
0.43
0.32
0.25
0.19
0.16
WS
3.63
2.32
1.35
0.85
0.57
0.40
0.29
0.22
0.17
0.13
0.11
D+L
3.63
2.32
1.61
1.18
0.91
0.72
0.58
0.48
0.40
0.34
0.30
WP
3.63
2.32
1.61
1.18
0.91
0.72
0.58
0.48
0.40
0.34
0.30
WS
3.71
2.37
1.65
1.21
0.93
0.73
0.59
0.49
0.41
0.32
0.26
D+L
4.53
2.90
2.02
1.48
1.13
0.90
0.73
0.60
0.50
0.43
0.37
WP
4.53
2.90
2.02
1.48
1.13
0.90
0.73
0.60
0.47
0.37
0.29
WS
4.63
2.97
2.06
1.51
1.08
0.76
0.55
0.41
0.32
0.25
0.20
D+L
6.86
4.39
3.05
2.24
1.71
1.35
1.10
0.91
0.76
0.65
0.55
WP
6.86
4.39
3.05
2.19
1.47
1.03
0.75
0.56
0.43
0.34
0.27
WS
6.08
3.75
2.17
1.37
0.92
0.64
0.47
0.35
0.27
0.21
0.17
D+L
6.08
3.89
2.70
1.98
1.52
1.20
0.97
0.80
0.68
0.58
0.50
WP
6.08
3.89
2.70
1.98
1.52
1.20
0.97
0.80
0.68
0.58
0.50
WS
6.86
4.39
3.05
2.24
1.71
1.35
1.10
0.85
0.65
0.51
0.41
D+L
7.59
4.86
3.38
2.48
1.90
1.50
1.22
1.00
0.84
0.72
0.62
WP
7.59
4.86
3.38
2.48
1.90
1.50
1.22
1.00
0.82
0.64
0.52
WS
8.57
5.49
3.81
2.58
1.73
1.21
0.88
0.66
0.51
0.40
0.32
D+L
11.03
7.06
4.90
3.60
2.76
2.18
1.77
1.46
1.23
1.04
0.87
WP
11.03
7.06
4.90
3.48
2.33
1.64
1.19
0.90
0.69
0.54
0.43
WS
9.65
6.17
3.64
2.29
1.53
1.08
0.79
0.59
0.45
0.36
0.29
D+L
9.65
6.17
4.29
3.15
2.41
1.91
1.54
1.28
1.07
0.91
0.79
WP
9.65
6.17
4.29
3.15
2.41
1.91
1.54
1.28
1.07
0.91
0.79
WS
11.03
7.06
4.90
3.60
2.76
2.18
1.77
1.42
1.09
0.86
0.69
D+L
12.06
7.72
5.36
3.94
3.01
2.38
1.93
1.59
1.34
1.14
0.98
WP
12.06
7.72
5.36
3.94
3.01
2.38
1.93
1.59
1.30
1.03
0.82
WS
13.79
8.83
6.13
4.32
2.90
2.03
1.48
1.11
0.86
0.67
0.54
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
12
WS
Va
(cm 3 )
(cm
3)
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
(kN )
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
252.5
252.5
.2
25
15
252.5
31.4
5
30
2.8
4
79
29.5
34.3 37
33
37 34.3
175.6
30
34
37
33
79.5
37
34
173
79.5
173
79.5
173
Aluminium
P a ne l
B ase
M etal
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
0.50
1010
1.527
5.65
0.70
1010
2.223
1.00
1010
3.221
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
It x
S xTop
S xBot
Ibx
(kN / cm
2)
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
7.37
6998
5.73
2.46
8.01
0.21
3.89
2.76
2.38
0.21
5.56
8.06
10.52
6998
9.72
4.39
11.48
0.38
6.01
4.04
3.82
0.33
8.98
11.68
15.25
6998
15.25
6.99
16.79
0.61
9.76
6.05
6.61
0.52
12.95
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
Aluminium
0.70
1.00
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
1.71
1.09
0.76
0.56
0.43
0.34
0.27
0.23
0.19
0.15
0.12
WP
1.71
1.09
0.76
0.48
0.32
0.23
0.16
0.12
0.10
0.07
0.06
WS
1.65
0.89
0.52
0.32
0.22
0.15
0.11
0.08
0.06
0.05
0.04
D+L
1.65
1.05
0.73
0.54
0.41
0.33
0.26
0.22
0.18
0.16
0.13
WP
1.65
1.05
0.73
0.54
0.41
0.33
0.26
0.22
0.18
0.16
0.13
WS
1.71
1.09
0.76
0.56
0.43
0.34
0.27
0.20
0.15
0.12
0.10
D+L
2.06
1.32
0.92
0.67
0.51
0.41
0.33
0.27
0.23
0.19
0.17
WP
2.06
1.32
0.92
0.67
0.51
0.41
0.31
0.23
0.18
0.14
0.11
WS
2.14
1.37
0.95
0.61
0.41
0.29
0.21
0.16
0.12
0.10
0.08
D+L
3.05
1.95
1.36
1.00
0.76
0.60
0.49
0.40
0.32
0.25
0.20
WP
3.05
1.95
1.29
0.81
0.54
0.38
0.28
0.21
0.16
0.13
0.10
WS
2.65
1.38
0.80
0.50
0.34
0.24
0.17
0.13
0.10
0.08
0.06
D+L
2.65
1.70
1.18
0.87
0.66
0.52
0.42
0.35
0.29
0.25
0.22
WP
2.65
1.70
1.18
0.87
0.66
0.52
0.42
0.35
0.29
0.25
0.22
WS
3.05
1.95
1.36
1.00
0.76
0.57
0.41
0.31
0.24
0.19
0.15
D+L
3.32
2.12
1.47
1.08
0.83
0.66
0.53
0.44
0.37
0.31
0.27
WP
3.32
2.12
1.47
1.08
0.83
0.66
0.53
0.40
0.30
0.24
0.19
WS
3.81
2.44
1.51
0.95
0.64
0.45
0.33
0.24
0.19
0.15
0.12
D+L
4.86
3.11
2.16
1.59
1.21
0.96
0.78
0.64
0.51
0.40
0.32
WP
4.86
3.11
2.02
1.27
0.85
0.60
0.44
0.33
0.25
0.20
0.16
WS
4.20
2.24
1.29
0.82
0.55
0.38
0.28
0.21
0.16
0.13
0.10
D+L
4.20
2.69
1.87
1.37
1.05
0.83
0.67
0.56
0.47
0.40
0.34
WP
4.20
2.69
1.87
1.37
1.05
0.83
0.67
0.56
0.47
0.40
0.34
WS
4.86
3.11
2.16
1.59
1.21
0.92
0.67
0.50
0.39
0.31
0.24
D+L
5.25
3.36
2.33
1.71
1.31
1.04
0.84
0.69
0.58
0.50
0.43
WP
5.25
3.36
2.33
1.71
1.31
1.04
0.82
0.62
0.48
0.38
0.30
WS
6.07
3.88
2.44
1.54
1.03
0.72
0.53
0.40
0.31
0.24
0.19
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
13
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
252.5
252.5
.2
25
15
252.5
31.4
5
30
2.8
4
79
29.5
34.3 37
33
37 34.3
175.6
30
34
37
33
79.5
37
34
173
79.5
173
79.5
173
Galvanized
P a ne l
B ase
M etal
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
0.50
1010
5.028
6.04
7.87
20000
6.70
2.96
8.59
0.61
0.70
1010
6.942
8.45
11.02
20000
10.55
4.81
12.15
0.99
6.60
4.30
4.30
0.89
19.91
1.00
1010
9.813
9.72
15.75
20000
15.75
7.21
17.31
1.49
10.67
6.37
7.52
1.31
28.33
It x
(kN / cm
2)
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
Ibx
S xTop
S xBot
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
4.35
3.00
2.72
0.56
11.20
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
Galvanized
0.70
1.00
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
4.89
3.13
2.17
1.60
1.22
0.97
0.78
0.65
0.54
0.46
0.40
WP
4.89
3.13
2.17
1.60
1.07
0.75
0.55
0.41
0.32
0.25
0.20
WS
4.50
2.85
1.65
1.04
0.70
0.49
0.36
0.27
0.21
0.16
0.13
D+L
4.50
2.88
2.00
1.47
1.12
0.89
0.72
0.59
0.50
0.43
0.37
WP
4.50
2.88
2.00
1.47
1.12
0.89
0.72
0.59
0.50
0.43
0.37
WS
4.89
3.13
2.17
1.60
1.22
0.97
0.78
0.64
0.50
0.39
0.31
D+L
5.62
3.60
2.50
1.84
1.41
1.11
0.90
0.74
0.62
0.53
0.46
WP
5.62
3.60
2.50
1.84
1.41
1.11
0.90
0.74
0.60
0.47
0.38
WS
6.11
3.91
2.72
1.96
1.31
0.92
0.67
0.51
0.39
0.31
0.24
D+L
7.94
5.08
3.53
2.59
1.98
1.57
1.27
1.05
0.88
0.75
0.63
WP
7.94
5.08
3.53
2.52
1.69
1.19
0.86
0.65
0.50
0.39
0.32
WS
7.10
4.32
2.50
1.58
1.06
0.74
0.54
0.41
0.31
0.25
0.20
D+L
7.10
4.55
3.16
2.32
1.78
1.40
1.14
0.94
0.79
0.67
0.58
WP
7.10
4.55
3.16
2.32
1.78
1.40
1.14
0.94
0.79
0.67
0.58
WS
7.94
5.08
3.53
2.59
1.98
1.57
1.27
0.98
0.75
0.59
0.47
D+L
8.88
5.68
3.95
2.90
2.22
1.75
1.42
1.17
0.99
0.84
0.72
WP
8.88
5.68
3.95
2.90
2.22
1.75
1.42
1.17
0.94
0.74
0.59
WS
9.92
6.35
4.41
2.97
1.99
1.40
1.02
0.77
0.59
0.46
0.37
D+L
11.90
7.62
5.29
3.89
2.98
2.35
1.90
1.57
1.32
1.13
0.94
WP
11.90
7.62
5.29
3.76
2.52
1.77
1.29
0.97
0.75
0.59
0.47
WS
10.52
6.73
4.04
2.55
1.71
1.20
0.87
0.66
0.51
0.40
0.32
D+L
10.52
6.73
4.68
3.43
2.63
2.08
1.68
1.39
1.17
1.00
0.86
WP
10.52
6.73
4.68
3.43
2.63
2.08
1.68
1.39
1.17
1.00
0.86
WS
11.90
7.62
5.29
3.89
2.98
2.35
1.90
1.57
1.21
0.96
0.76
D+L
13.15
8.42
5.84
4.29
3.29
2.60
2.10
1.74
1.46
1.24
1.07
WP
13.15
8.42
5.84
4.29
3.29
2.60
2.10
1.74
1.41
1.11
0.89
WS
14.88
9.52
6.61
4.81
3.22
2.26
1.65
1.24
0.95
0.75
0.60
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
14
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
100
A luzin c
C o ated
Steel
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
0.50
900.00
4.315
5.76
17.35
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
It x
S xTop
S xBot
Ibx
(kN / cm
2)
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
20000.00
15.78
5.41
7.64
1.12
16.29
6.12
7.03
1.26
7.61
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
0.70
900.00
6.228
8.47
25.51
20000.00
25.15
8.94
11.51
1.84
25.51
9.12
11.58
1.88
24.22
1.00
900.00
9.095
12.53
37.76
20000.00
37.63
13.37
17.00
2.76
37.76
13.43
17.02
2.77
57.10
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
1.00
S p a n
Load
Case
D+L
Va
1.00
8.94
I n
M e t e r s
1.25
5.72
1.50
3.97
1.75
2.92
2.00
2.24
2.25
1.77
2.50
1.43
2.75
1.18
3.00
0.99
3.25
0.85
3.50
0.73
WP
8.94
5.72
3.97
2.92
2.24
1.77
1.29
0.97
0.75
0.59
0.47
WS
10.11
6.47
4.49
3.30
2.53
1.83
1.33
1.00
0.77
0.61
0.49
D+L
10.11
6.47
4.49
3.30
2.53
2.00
1.62
1.34
1.12
0.96
0.83
WP
10.11
6.47
4.49
3.30
2.53
2.00
1.62
1.34
1.12
0.96
0.83
WS
8.94
5.72
3.97
2.92
2.24
1.77
1.43
1.18
0.99
0.85
0.73
D+L
12.63
8.09
5.61
4.13
3.16
2.50
2.02
1.67
1.40
1.20
1.03
WP
12.63
8.09
5.61
4.13
3.16
2.50
2.02
1.67
1.40
1.11
0.89
WS
11.18
7.15
4.97
3.65
2.79
2.21
1.79
1.48
1.24
1.06
0.91
D+L
14.76
9.44
6.56
4.82
3.69
2.91
2.36
1.95
1.64
1.40
1.20
WP
14.76
9.44
6.56
4.82
3.69
2.83
2.06
1.55
1.19
0.94
0.75
WS
15.07
9.64
6.70
4.92
3.77
2.87
2.09
1.57
1.21
0.95
0.76
D+L
15.07
9.64
6.70
4.92
3.77
2.98
2.41
1.99
1.67
1.43
1.23
WP
15.07
9.64
6.70
4.92
3.77
2.98
2.41
1.99
1.67
1.43
1.23
WS
14.76
9.44
6.56
4.82
3.69
2.91
2.36
1.95
1.64
1.40
1.20
D+L
18.83
12.05
8.37
6.15
4.71
3.72
3.01
2.49
2.09
1.78
1.54
WP
18.83
12.05
8.37
6.15
4.71
3.72
3.01
2.49
2.09
1.77
1.42
WS
18.44
11.80
8.20
6.02
4.61
3.64
2.95
2.44
2.05
1.75
1.44
D+L
22.08
14.13
9.81
7.21
5.52
4.36
3.53
2.92
2.45
2.09
1.80
WP
22.08
14.13
9.81
7.21
5.52
4.23
3.08
2.32
1.78
1.40
1.12
WS
22.19
14.20
9.86
7.24
5.55
4.24
3.09
2.32
1.79
1.41
1.13
D+L
22.19
14.20
9.86
7.24
5.55
4.38
3.55
2.93
2.47
2.10
1.81
WP
22.19
14.20
9.86
7.24
5.55
4.38
3.55
2.93
2.47
2.10
1.81
WS
22.08
14.13
9.81
7.21
5.52
4.36
3.53
2.92
2.45
2.09
1.80
D+L
27.73
17.75
12.33
9.06
6.93
5.48
4.44
3.67
3.08
2.63
2.26
WP
27.73
17.75
12.33
9.06
6.93
5.48
4.44
3.67
3.08
2.63
2.12
WS
27.60
17.66
12.27
9.01
6.90
5.45
4.42
3.65
3.07
2.61
2.13
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
15
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
100
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
( k g/ m )
N o m in
a l A re a
(cm
2)
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
S xTop
It x
(kN / cm
2)
4)
S xBot
3)
3)
Ma
tx
Ibx
4)
(mm)
(mm)
0.50
900.00
1.527
6.34
19.11
6998
17.31
5.93
8.40
0.51
17.68
0.70
900.00
2.223
9.05
27.27
6998
26.71
9.46
12.25
0.82
27.26
1.00
900.00
3.221
13.11
39.51
6998
39.33
13.96
17.76
1.21
39.51
(cm
(cm
(cm
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
(kN m)
(cm
S xTop
S xBot
Ma
bx
(kN m)
(kN )
6.70
7.55
0.58
3.49
9.75
12.36
0.85
10.15
14.05
17.80
1.22
23.73
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
Aluminium
0.70
1.00
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
D+L
1.00
4.12
1.25
2.63
1.50
1.83
1.75
1.34
2.00
1.03
2.25
0.81
2.50
0.66
2.75
0.54
3.00
0.46
3.25
0.39
3.50
0.34
WP
4.12
2.63
1.83
1.34
0.97
0.68
0.50
0.37
0.29
0.23
0.18
WS
4.65
2.98
2.07
1.48
0.99
0.70
0.51
0.38
0.29
0.23
0.18
D+L
4.65
2.98
2.07
1.52
1.16
0.92
0.74
0.61
0.52
0.44
0.38
WP
4.65
2.98
2.07
1.52
1.16
0.92
0.74
0.61
0.52
0.44
0.38
WS
4.12
2.63
1.83
1.34
1.03
0.81
0.66
0.54
0.46
0.39
0.34
D+L
5.81
3.72
2.58
1.90
1.45
1.15
0.93
0.77
0.65
0.55
0.47
WP
5.81
3.72
2.58
1.90
1.45
1.15
0.93
0.70
0.54
0.43
0.34
WS
5.14
3.29
2.29
1.68
1.29
1.02
0.82
0.68
0.55
0.44
0.35
D+L
6.57
4.20
2.92
2.14
1.64
1.30
1.05
0.87
0.73
0.62
0.54
WP
6.57
4.20
2.92
2.14
1.50
1.05
0.77
0.58
0.44
0.35
0.28
WS
6.77
4.33
3.01
2.21
1.53
1.07
0.78
0.59
0.45
0.36
0.28
D+L
6.77
4.33
3.01
2.21
1.69
1.34
1.08
0.90
0.75
0.64
0.55
WP
6.77
4.33
3.01
2.21
1.69
1.34
1.08
0.90
0.75
0.64
0.55
WS
6.57
4.20
2.92
2.14
1.64
1.30
1.05
0.87
0.73
0.62
0.54
D+L
8.47
5.42
3.76
2.76
2.12
1.67
1.35
1.12
0.94
0.80
0.69
WP
8.47
5.42
3.76
2.76
2.12
1.67
1.35
1.09
0.84
0.66
0.53
WS
8.21
5.26
3.65
2.68
2.05
1.62
1.31
1.09
0.85
0.67
0.54
D+L
9.70
6.21
4.31
3.17
2.42
1.92
1.55
1.28
1.08
0.92
0.79
WP
9.70
6.21
4.31
3.17
2.20
1.55
1.13
0.85
0.65
0.51
0.41
WS
9.76
6.25
4.34
3.19
2.21
1.55
1.13
0.85
0.66
0.52
0.41
D+L
9.76
6.25
4.34
3.19
2.44
1.93
1.56
1.29
1.08
0.92
0.80
WP
9.76
6.25
4.34
3.19
2.44
1.93
1.56
1.29
1.08
0.92
0.80
WS
9.70
6.21
4.31
3.17
2.42
1.92
1.55
1.28
1.08
0.92
0.79
D+L
12.20
7.81
5.42
3.98
3.05
2.41
1.95
1.61
1.36
1.16
1.00
WP
12.20
7.81
5.42
3.98
3.05
2.41
1.95
1.60
1.23
0.97
0.78
WS
12.12
7.76
5.39
3.96
3.03
2.39
1.94
1.60
1.24
0.97
0.78
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
16
WS
Va
(cm 3 )
(cm
3)
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
100
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
(cm
2)
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
S xTop
It x
(kN / cm
2)
4)
S xBot
3)
3)
Ma
tx
Ibx
4)
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
0.50
900.00
5.028
6.77
20.42
20000.00
19.42
6.82
9.09
1.41
19.90
0.70
900.00
6.942
9.48
28.58
20000.00
28.33
10.08
12.90
2.08
28.58
1.00
900.00
9.813
13.54
40.82
20000.00
40.74
14.46
18.35
2.99
40.82
(cm
(cm
(cm
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
(kN m)
(cm
S xTop
S xBot
Ma
bx
(kN m)
7.27
8.85
1.50
12.35
10.21
12.95
2.11
32.63
14.50
18.37
2.99
66.55
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
Galvanized
0.70
1.00
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
D+L
1.00
11.25
1.25
7.20
1.50
5.00
1.75
3.67
2.00
2.81
2.25
2.22
2.50
1.80
2.75
1.49
3.00
1.25
3.25
1.07
3.50
0.92
WP
11.25
7.20
5.00
3.67
2.81
2.18
1.59
1.20
0.92
0.72
0.58
WS
12.01
7.69
5.34
3.92
3.00
2.24
1.63
1.23
0.94
0.74
0.59
D+L
12.01
7.69
5.34
3.92
3.00
2.37
1.92
1.59
1.33
1.14
0.98
WP
12.01
7.69
5.34
3.92
3.00
2.37
1.92
1.59
1.33
1.14
0.98
WS
11.25
7.20
5.00
3.67
2.81
2.22
1.80
1.49
1.25
1.07
0.92
D+L
15.01
9.61
6.67
4.90
3.75
2.97
2.40
1.98
1.67
1.42
1.23
WP
15.01
9.61
6.67
4.90
3.75
2.97
2.40
1.98
1.67
1.37
1.09
WS
14.07
9.00
6.25
4.59
3.52
2.78
2.25
1.86
1.56
1.33
1.12
D+L
16.65
10.66
7.40
5.44
4.16
3.29
2.66
2.20
1.85
1.58
1.36
WP
16.65
10.66
7.40
5.44
4.16
3.18
2.32
1.74
1.34
1.06
0.85
WS
16.86
10.79
7.49
5.51
4.22
3.21
2.34
1.76
1.35
1.07
0.85
D+L
16.86
10.79
7.49
5.51
4.22
3.33
2.70
2.23
1.87
1.60
1.38
WP
16.86
10.79
7.49
5.51
4.22
3.33
2.70
2.23
1.87
1.60
1.38
WS
16.65
10.66
7.40
5.44
4.16
3.29
2.66
2.20
1.85
1.58
1.36
D+L
21.08
13.49
9.37
6.88
5.27
4.16
3.37
2.79
2.34
2.00
1.72
WP
21.08
13.49
9.37
6.88
5.27
4.16
3.37
2.79
2.34
1.99
1.60
WS
20.81
13.32
9.25
6.80
5.20
4.11
3.33
2.75
2.31
1.97
1.61
D+L
23.88
15.29
10.62
7.80
5.97
4.72
3.82
3.16
2.65
2.26
1.95
WP
23.88
15.29
10.62
7.80
5.97
4.58
3.34
2.51
1.93
1.52
1.22
WS
23.95
15.33
10.64
7.82
5.99
4.59
3.34
2.51
1.93
1.52
1.22
D+L
23.95
15.33
10.64
7.82
5.99
4.73
3.83
3.17
2.66
2.27
1.95
WP
23.95
15.33
10.64
7.82
5.99
4.73
3.83
3.17
2.66
2.27
1.95
WS
23.88
15.29
10.62
7.80
5.97
4.72
3.82
3.16
2.65
2.26
1.95
D+L
29.93
19.16
13.30
9.77
7.48
5.91
4.79
3.96
3.33
2.83
2.44
WP
29.93
19.16
13.30
9.77
7.48
5.91
4.79
3.96
3.33
2.83
2.29
WS
29.86
19.11
13.27
9.75
7.46
5.90
4.78
3.95
3.32
2.83
2.30
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
17
WS
Va
(cm 3 )
(cm
3)
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
(kN )
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
Aluminium
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
( k g/ m )
N o m in
a l A re a
(cm
2)
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
E
It x
(kN / cm
2)
4)
S xTop
S xBot
3)
3)
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
Ma
tx
Ibx
4)
S xTop
3)
S xBot
(cm 3 )
Ma
bx
(mm)
0.50
1000.00
10.160
10.17
70.44
20000.00
48.53
8.66
25.66
1.79
38.78
10.74
9.99
2.06
3.59
0.70
1000.00
13.800
14.95
103.58
20000.00
83.78
15.67
38.67
3.23
70.38
17.32
20.40
3.58
11.43
0.70
1000.00
6.181
14.96
103.95
6998.00
80.86
14.95
38.44
1.30
66.79
16.97
18.66
1.47
3.93
(cm
(cm
(cm
(kN m)
(cm
(cm
(kN m)
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
Va
(mm)
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
7.18
5.74
4.79
4.10
3.58
2.83
2.29
1.89
1.59
1.35
1.17
WP
7.18
5.74
4.79
4.10
3.58
2.83
2.29
1.89
1.59
1.35
1.17
WS
7.18
5.74
4.79
4.10
3.59
3.19
2.64
2.18
1.83
1.45
1.16
D+L
5.74
4.60
3.83
3.28
2.87
2.55
2.30
2.09
1.83
1.56
1.35
WP
5.74
4.60
3.83
3.28
2.87
2.55
2.30
2.09
1.83
1.56
1.35
WS
5.74
4.60
3.83
3.28
2.87
2.55
2.29
1.89
1.59
1.35
1.17
D+L
6.53
5.22
4.35
3.73
3.26
2.90
2.61
2.37
2.18
1.95
1.68
WP
6.53
5.22
4.35
3.73
3.26
2.90
2.61
2.37
2.18
1.95
1.68
WS
6.53
5.22
4.35
3.73
3.26
2.90
2.61
2.36
1.99
1.69
1.46
D+L
22.86
16.56
11.50
8.45
6.47
5.11
4.14
3.42
2.87
2.45
2.11
WP
22.86
16.56
11.50
8.45
6.47
5.11
4.14
3.42
2.87
2.45
2.11
WS
22.86
18.29
12.71
9.34
7.15
5.65
4.58
3.78
3.18
2.62
2.10
D+L
18.29
14.63
12.19
9.34
7.15
5.65
4.58
3.78
3.18
2.71
2.34
WP
18.29
14.63
12.19
9.34
7.15
5.65
4.58
3.78
3.18
2.71
2.34
WS
18.29
14.63
11.50
8.45
6.47
5.11
4.14
3.42
2.87
2.45
2.11
D+L
20.78
16.63
13.85
11.68
8.94
7.06
5.72
4.73
3.97
3.39
2.92
WP
20.78
16.63
13.85
11.68
8.94
7.06
5.72
4.73
3.97
3.39
2.92
WS
20.78
16.63
13.85
10.56
8.09
6.39
5.17
4.28
3.59
3.06
2.64
D+L
7.86
6.29
4.62
3.39
2.60
2.05
1.66
1.37
1.15
0.98
0.85
WP
7.86
6.29
4.62
3.39
2.60
2.05
1.66
1.37
1.15
0.98
0.84
WS
7.86
6.29
5.24
3.85
2.95
2.33
1.89
1.44
1.11
0.87
0.70
D+L
6.29
5.03
4.19
3.59
2.95
2.33
1.89
1.56
1.31
1.12
0.96
WP
6.29
5.03
4.19
3.59
2.95
2.33
1.89
1.56
1.31
1.12
0.96
WS
6.29
5.03
4.19
3.39
2.60
2.05
1.66
1.37
1.15
0.98
0.85
D+L
7.15
5.72
4.76
4.08
3.57
2.91
2.36
1.95
1.64
1.40
1.20
WP
7.15
5.72
4.76
4.08
3.57
2.91
2.36
1.95
1.64
1.40
1.20
WS
7.15
5.72
4.76
4.08
3.25
2.56
2.08
1.72
1.44
1.23
1.06
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
18
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
(kN )
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
Aluminium
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o min
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
(cm
2)
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
E
It x
(kN / cm
2)
4)
S xTop
S xBot
3)
3)
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
Ma
tx
Ibx
4)
S xTop
3)
S xBot
(cm 3 )
Ma
bx
( mm )
( k g/ m )
0.50
1000.00
10.760
10.30
111.34
20000.00
77.23
11.79
31.58
2.44
56.74
14.23
11.33
2.34
3.59
0.70
1000.00
14.400
15.15
163.72
20000.00
132.79
21.47
46.92
4.43
101.88
23.06
22.17
4.58
11.43
0.70
1000.00
6.781
15.15
163.72
6998.00
127.89
20.37
46.78
1.77
96.85
22.46
20.60
1.79
3.93
(cm
(cm
(cm
(kN m)
(cm
(cm
(kN m)
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
Va
( mm )
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
7.18
5.74
4.79
4.10
3.59
3.19
2.87
2.58
2.16
1.84
1.59
WP
7.18
5.74
4.79
4.10
3.59
3.19
2.87
2.58
2.16
1.84
1.59
WS
7.18
5.74
4.79
4.10
3.59
3.19
2.87
2.47
2.08
1.77
1.53
D+L
5.74
4.60
3.83
3.28
2.87
2.55
2.30
2.09
1.91
1.77
1.53
WP
5.74
4.60
3.83
3.28
2.87
2.55
2.30
2.09
1.91
1.77
1.53
WS
5.74
4.60
3.83
3.28
2.87
2.55
2.30
2.09
1.91
1.77
1.59
D+L
6.53
5.22
4.35
3.73
3.26
2.90
2.61
2.37
2.18
2.01
1.86
WP
6.53
5.22
4.35
3.73
3.26
2.90
2.61
2.37
2.18
2.01
1.86
WS
6.53
5.22
4.35
3.73
3.26
2.90
2.61
2.37
2.18
2.01
1.86
D+L
22.86
18.29
15.24
11.58
8.87
7.01
5.67
4.69
3.94
3.36
2.90
WP
22.86
18.29
15.24
11.58
8.87
7.01
5.67
4.69
3.94
3.36
2.90
WS
22.86
18.29
15.24
11.95
9.15
7.23
5.86
4.84
4.07
3.47
2.99
D+L
18.29
14.63
12.19
10.45
9.14
7.23
5.86
4.84
4.07
3.47
2.99
WP
18.29
14.63
12.19
10.45
9.14
7.23
5.86
4.84
4.07
3.47
2.99
WS
18.29
14.63
12.19
10.45
8.87
7.01
5.67
4.69
3.94
3.36
2.90
D+L
20.78
16.63
13.85
11.88
10.39
9.04
7.32
6.05
5.08
4.33
3.74
WP
20.78
16.63
13.85
11.88
10.39
9.04
7.32
6.05
5.08
4.33
3.74
WS
20.78
16.63
13.85
11.88
10.39
8.76
7.09
5.86
4.93
4.20
3.62
D+L
7.86
6.29
5.24
4.49
3.54
2.79
2.26
1.87
1.57
1.34
1.15
WP
7.86
6.29
5.24
4.49
3.54
2.79
2.26
1.87
1.57
1.34
1.15
WS
7.86
6.29
5.24
4.49
3.58
2.83
2.29
1.89
1.59
1.26
1.01
D+L
6.29
5.03
4.19
3.59
3.14
2.79
2.29
1.89
1.59
1.35
1.17
WP
6.29
5.03
4.19
3.59
3.14
2.79
2.29
1.89
1.59
1.35
1.17
WS
6.29
5.03
4.19
3.59
3.14
2.79
2.26
1.87
1.57
1.34
1.15
D+L
7.15
5.72
4.76
4.08
3.57
3.18
2.86
2.36
1.99
1.69
1.46
WP
7.15
5.72
4.76
4.08
3.57
3.18
2.86
2.36
1.99
1.69
1.46
WS
7.15
5.72
4.76
4.08
3.57
3.18
2.83
2.34
1.96
1.67
1.44
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
19
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
(kN )
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
0.50
1000.00
11.760
10.51
0.70
1000.00
15.400
Aluminium
0.70
1000.00
7.781
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
It x
S xTop
S xBot
Ibx
(kN / cm
2)
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
204.51
20000.00
141.53
17.38
42.27
3.59
96.23
21.30
13.80
2.85
3.59
15.45
300.71
20000.00
242.40
31.74
62.54
6.55
177.35
35.03
27.49
5.68
11.43
15.45
300.71
6998.00
233.57
30.05
62.43
2.61
167.49
34.07
25.39
2.20
3.93
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+ L
7.18
5.74
4.79
4.10
3.59
3.19
2.87
2.61
2.39
2.21
2.05
WP
7.18
5.74
4.79
4.10
3.59
3.19
2.87
2.61
2.39
2.21
2.05
WS
7.18
5.74
4.79
4.10
3.59
3.19
2.87
2.61
2.39
2.16
1.86
D+ L
5.74
4.60
3.83
3.28
2.87
2.55
2.30
2.09
1.91
1.77
1.64
WP
5.74
4.60
3.83
3.28
2.87
2.55
2.30
2.09
1.91
1.77
1.64
WS
5.74
4.60
3.83
3.28
2.87
2.55
2.30
2.09
1.91
1.77
1.64
D+ L
6.53
5.22
4.35
3.73
3.26
2.90
2.61
2.37
2.18
2.01
1.86
WP
6.53
5.22
4.35
3.73
3.26
2.90
2.61
2.37
2.18
2.01
1.86
WS
6.53
5.22
4.35
3.73
3.26
2.90
2.61
2.37
2.18
2.01
1.86
D+ L
22.86
18.29
15.24
13.06
11.43
10.16
8.39
6.93
5.82
4.96
4.28
WP
22.86
18.29
15.24
13.06
11.43
10.16
8.39
6.93
5.82
4.96
4.28
WS
22.86
18.29
15.24
13.06
11.35
8.97
7.26
6.00
5.04
4.30
3.71
D+ L
18.29
14.63
12.19
10.45
9.14
8.13
7.26
6.00
5.04
4.30
3.71
WP
18.29
14.63
12.19
10.45
9.14
8.13
7.26
6.00
5.04
4.30
3.71
WS
18.29
14.63
12.19
10.45
9.14
8.13
7.32
6.65
5.82
4.96
4.28
D+ L
20.78
16.63
13.85
11.88
10.39
9.24
8.31
7.50
6.31
5.37
4.63
WP
20.78
16.63
13.85
11.88
10.39
9.24
8.31
7.50
6.31
5.37
4.63
WS
20.78
16.63
13.85
11.88
10.39
9.24
8.31
7.56
6.93
6.20
5.35
D+ L
7.86
6.29
5.24
4.49
3.93
3.49
3.14
2.76
2.32
1.98
1.70
WP
7.86
6.29
5.24
4.49
3.93
3.49
3.14
2.76
2.32
1.98
1.70
WS
7.86
6.29
5.24
4.49
3.93
3.48
2.82
2.33
1.96
1.67
1.44
D+ L
6.29
5.03
4.19
3.59
3.14
2.79
2.52
2.29
1.96
1.67
1.44
WP
6.29
5.03
4.19
3.59
3.14
2.79
2.52
2.29
1.96
1.67
1.44
WS
6.29
5.03
4.19
3.59
3.14
2.79
2.52
2.29
2.10
1.93
1.70
D+ L
7.15
5.72
4.76
4.08
3.57
3.18
2.86
2.60
2.38
2.09
1.80
WP
7.15
5.72
4.76
4.08
3.57
3.18
2.86
2.60
2.38
2.09
1.80
WS
7.15
5.72
4.76
4.08
3.57
3.18
2.86
2.60
2.38
2.20
2.04
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
20
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
0.50
1000.00
12.760
10.73
0.70
1000.00
16.400
Aluminium
0.70
1000.00
8.781
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
It x
S xTop
S xBot
Ibx
S xTop
S xBot
(kN / cm
2)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
330.93
20000.00
226.81
23.21
53.72
4.79
149.20
29.80
16.60
3.43
3.59
15.77
486.60
20000.00
388.27
42.57
79.36
8.79
279.05
48.97
33.56
6.93
11.43
15.77
486.60
6998.00
374.16
40.26
79.26
3.50
262.65
47.66
30.89
2.68
3.93
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
7.18
5.74
4.79
4.10
3.59
3.19
2.87
2.61
2.39
2.21
2.05
WP
7.18
5.74
4.79
4.10
3.59
3.19
2.87
2.61
2.39
2.21
2.05
WS
7.18
5.74
4.79
4.10
3.59
3.19
2.87
2.61
2.39
2.21
2.05
D+L
5.74
4.60
3.83
3.28
2.87
2.55
2.30
2.09
1.91
1.77
1.64
WP
5.74
4.60
3.83
3.28
2.87
2.55
2.30
2.09
1.91
1.77
1.64
WS
5.74
4.60
3.83
3.28
2.87
2.55
2.30
2.09
1.91
1.77
1.64
D+L
6.53
5.22
4.35
3.73
3.26
2.90
2.61
2.37
2.18
2.01
1.86
WP
6.53
5.22
4.35
3.73
3.26
2.90
2.61
2.37
2.18
2.01
1.86
WS
6.53
5.22
4.35
3.73
3.26
2.90
2.61
2.37
2.18
2.01
1.86
D+L
22.86
18.29
15.24
13.06
11.43
10.16
9.14
8.31
7.62
6.66
5.74
WP
22.86
18.29
15.24
13.06
11.43
10.16
9.14
8.31
7.62
6.66
5.74
WS
22.86
18.29
15.24
13.06
11.43
10.16
8.87
7.33
6.16
5.25
4.52
D+L
18.29
14.63
12.19
10.45
9.14
8.13
7.32
6.65
6.10
5.25
4.52
WP
18.29
14.63
12.19
10.45
9.14
8.13
7.32
6.65
6.10
5.25
4.52
WS
18.29
14.63
12.19
10.45
9.14
8.13
7.32
6.65
6.10
5.63
5.23
D+L
20.78
16.63
13.85
11.88
10.39
9.24
8.31
7.56
6.93
6.39
5.66
WP
20.78
16.63
13.85
11.88
10.39
9.24
8.31
7.56
6.93
6.39
5.66
WS
20.78
16.63
13.85
11.88
10.39
9.24
8.31
7.56
6.93
6.39
5.94
D+L
7.86
6.29
5.24
4.49
3.93
3.49
3.14
2.86
2.62
2.42
2.25
WP
7.86
6.29
5.24
4.49
3.93
3.49
3.14
2.86
2.62
2.42
2.25
WS
7.86
6.29
5.24
4.49
3.93
3.49
3.14
2.84
2.38
2.03
1.75
D+L
6.29
5.03
4.19
3.59
3.14
2.79
2.52
2.29
2.10
1.93
1.75
WP
6.29
5.03
4.19
3.59
3.14
2.79
2.52
2.29
2.10
1.93
1.75
WS
6.29
5.03
4.19
3.59
3.14
2.79
2.52
2.29
2.10
1.93
1.80
D+L
7.15
5.72
4.76
4.08
3.57
3.18
2.86
2.60
2.38
2.20
2.04
WP
7.15
5.72
4.76
4.08
3.57
3.18
2.86
2.60
2.38
2.20
2.04
WS
7.15
5.72
4.76
4.08
3.57
3.18
2.86
2.60
2.38
2.20
2.04
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
21
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
E
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
0.50
1000.00
10.21
8.93
53.66
20000.00
0.70
1000.00
13.85
13.13
78.90
20000.00
8.15
1.70
19.71
0.35
11.83
21.79
2.53
0.52
5.76
Aluminium
0.70
1000.00
6.23
13.13
78.90
6998.00
7.45
1.55
19.30
0.13
10.88
21.43
2.31
0.20
2.19
It x
(kN / cm
2)
S xTop
S xBot
Ibx
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
4.10
0.84
12.88
0.17
5.97
14.29
1.25
0.26
2.64
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
1.39
0.89
0.62
0.45
0.35
0.27
0.22
0.18
0.15
0.13
0.11
WP
1.39
0.89
0.62
0.45
0.35
0.27
0.22
0.18
0.15
0.13
0.11
WS
2.07
1.32
0.92
0.67
0.52
0.41
0.33
0.27
0.23
0.20
0.17
D+L
2.07
1.32
0.92
0.67
0.52
0.41
0.33
0.27
0.23
0.20
0.17
WP
2.07
1.32
0.92
0.67
0.52
0.41
0.33
0.27
0.23
0.20
0.17
WS
1.39
0.89
0.62
0.45
0.35
0.27
0.22
0.18
0.15
0.13
0.11
D+L
2.17
1.39
0.96
0.71
0.54
0.43
0.35
0.29
0.24
0.21
0.18
WP
2.17
1.39
0.96
0.71
0.54
0.43
0.35
0.29
0.24
0.21
0.18
WS
1.74
1.11
0.77
0.57
0.43
0.34
0.28
0.23
0.19
0.16
0.14
D+L
2.80
1.79
1.24
0.91
0.70
0.55
0.45
0.37
0.31
0.27
0.23
WP
2.80
1.79
1.24
0.91
0.70
0.55
0.45
0.37
0.31
0.27
0.23
WS
4.18
2.68
1.86
1.37
1.05
0.83
0.67
0.55
0.46
0.40
0.34
D+L
4.18
2.68
1.86
1.37
1.05
0.83
0.67
0.55
0.46
0.40
0.34
WP
4.18
2.68
1.86
1.37
1.05
0.83
0.67
0.55
0.46
0.40
0.34
WS
2.80
1.79
1.24
0.91
0.70
0.55
0.45
0.37
0.31
0.27
0.23
D+L
4.38
2.80
1.94
1.43
1.09
0.86
0.70
0.58
0.49
0.41
0.36
WP
4.38
2.80
1.94
1.43
1.09
0.86
0.70
0.58
0.49
0.41
0.36
WS
3.50
2.24
1.56
1.14
0.88
0.69
0.56
0.46
0.39
0.33
0.29
D+L
1.07
0.69
0.48
0.35
0.27
0.21
0.17
0.14
0.12
0.10
0.09
WP
1.07
0.69
0.48
0.35
0.27
0.21
0.17
0.14
0.12
0.10
0.08
WS
1.61
1.03
0.71
0.52
0.40
0.32
0.26
0.21
0.18
0.14
0.11
D+L
1.61
1.03
0.71
0.52
0.40
0.32
0.26
0.21
0.18
0.15
0.13
WP
1.61
1.03
0.71
0.52
0.40
0.32
0.26
0.21
0.18
0.15
0.13
WS
1.07
0.69
0.48
0.35
0.27
0.21
0.17
0.14
0.12
0.10
0.09
D+L
1.68
1.07
0.75
0.55
0.42
0.33
0.27
0.22
0.19
0.16
0.14
WP
1.68
1.07
0.75
0.55
0.42
0.33
0.27
0.22
0.19
0.16
0.14
WS
1.34
0.86
0.60
0.44
0.34
0.26
0.21
0.18
0.15
0.13
0.11
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
22
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
Aluminium
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
( k g/ m )
N o m in
a l A re a
(cm
2)
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
( F ull
S e c tio
n)
(cm 4 )
E
It x
(kN / cm
2)
( cm
4)
S xTop
(cm
3)
S xBot
( cm
3)
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
Ma
tx
(kN m)
Ibx
(c m
4)
(mm)
(mm)
0.50
1000.00
11.210
9.14
121.99
20000.00
9.33
1.28
22.04
0.26
13.58
0.70
1000.00
14.850
13.44
179.36
20000.00
18.59
2.60
33.07
0.54
26.90
0.70
1000.00
7.229
13.44
179.36
6998.00
17.01
2.37
32.66
0.21
24.75
S xTop
S xBot
Ma
bx
(kN m)
(kN )
23.94
1.91
0.39
2.64
35.85
3.86
0.80
5.76
35.51
3.53
0.31
2.19
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
2.12
1.36
0.94
0.69
0.53
0.42
0.34
0.28
0.24
0.20
0.17
WP
2.12
1.36
0.94
0.69
0.53
0.42
0.34
0.28
0.24
0.20
0.17
WS
3.15
2.02
1.40
1.03
0.79
0.62
0.50
0.42
0.35
0.30
0.26
D+L
3.15
2.02
1.40
1.03
0.79
0.62
0.50
0.42
0.35
0.30
0.26
WP
3.15
2.02
1.40
1.03
0.79
0.62
0.50
0.42
0.35
0.30
0.26
WS
2.12
1.36
0.94
0.69
0.53
0.42
0.34
0.28
0.24
0.20
0.17
D+L
3.31
2.12
1.47
1.08
0.83
0.65
0.53
0.44
0.37
0.31
0.27
WP
3.31
2.12
1.47
1.08
0.83
0.65
0.53
0.44
0.37
0.31
0.27
WS
2.65
1.69
1.18
0.86
0.66
0.52
0.42
0.35
0.29
0.25
0.22
D+L
4.30
2.75
1.91
1.40
1.07
0.85
0.69
0.57
0.48
0.41
0.35
WP
4.30
2.75
1.91
1.40
1.07
0.85
0.69
0.57
0.48
0.41
0.35
WS
6.38
4.08
2.83
2.08
1.59
1.26
1.02
0.84
0.71
0.60
0.52
D+L
6.38
4.08
2.83
2.08
1.59
1.26
1.02
0.84
0.71
0.60
0.52
WP
6.38
4.08
2.83
2.08
1.59
1.26
1.02
0.84
0.71
0.60
0.52
WS
4.30
2.75
1.91
1.40
1.07
0.85
0.69
0.57
0.48
0.41
0.35
D+L
6.71
4.30
2.98
2.19
1.68
1.33
1.07
0.89
0.75
0.64
0.55
WP
6.71
4.30
2.98
2.19
1.68
1.33
1.07
0.89
0.75
0.64
0.55
WS
5.37
3.44
2.39
1.75
1.34
1.06
0.86
0.71
0.60
0.51
0.44
D+L
1.64
1.05
0.73
0.54
0.41
0.32
0.26
0.22
0.18
0.16
0.13
WP
1.64
1.05
0.73
0.54
0.41
0.32
0.26
0.22
0.18
0.16
0.13
WS
2.45
1.57
1.09
0.80
0.61
0.48
0.39
0.32
0.27
0.23
0.20
D+L
2.45
1.57
1.09
0.80
0.61
0.48
0.39
0.32
0.27
0.23
0.20
WP
2.45
1.57
1.09
0.80
0.61
0.48
0.39
0.32
0.27
0.23
0.20
WS
1.64
1.05
0.73
0.54
0.41
0.32
0.26
0.22
0.18
0.16
0.13
D+L
2.57
1.64
1.14
0.84
0.64
0.51
0.41
0.34
0.29
0.24
0.21
WP
2.57
1.64
1.14
0.84
0.64
0.51
0.41
0.34
0.29
0.24
0.21
WS
2.05
1.31
0.91
0.67
0.51
0.41
0.33
0.27
0.23
0.19
0.17
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
23
WS
Va
(cm 3 )
(cm
3)
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
0.50
1000.00
12.208
9.35
0.70
1000.00
15.848
Aluminium
0.70
1000.00
8.229
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
It x
S xTop
S xBot
Ibx
S xTop
S xBot
(kN / cm
2)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
218.89
20000.00
16.74
1.73
31.77
0.36
24.35
34.03
2.57
0.53
2.64
13.75
321.82
20000.00
33.43
3.52
47.27
0.73
48.24
50.59
5.21
1.08
5.76
13.75
321.82
6998.00
30.59
3.20
46.87
0.28
44.41
50.28
4.76
0.41
2.19
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
2.86
1.83
1.27
0.93
0.72
0.56
0.46
0.38
0.32
0.27
0.23
WP
2.86
1.83
1.27
0.93
0.72
0.56
0.46
0.38
0.32
0.27
0.23
WS
4.24
2.72
1.89
1.39
1.06
0.84
0.68
0.56
0.47
0.40
0.35
D+L
4.22
2.72
1.89
1.39
1.06
0.84
0.68
0.56
0.47
0.40
0.35
WP
4.22
2.72
1.89
1.39
1.06
0.84
0.68
0.56
0.47
0.40
0.35
WS
2.86
1.83
1.27
0.93
0.72
0.56
0.46
0.38
0.32
0.27
0.23
D+L
4.47
2.86
1.99
1.46
1.12
0.88
0.72
0.59
0.50
0.42
0.36
WP
4.47
2.86
1.99
1.46
1.12
0.88
0.72
0.59
0.50
0.42
0.36
WS
3.58
2.29
1.59
1.17
0.89
0.71
0.57
0.47
0.40
0.34
0.29
D+L
5.81
3.72
2.58
1.90
1.45
1.15
0.93
0.77
0.65
0.55
0.47
WP
5.81
3.72
2.58
1.90
1.45
1.15
0.93
0.77
0.65
0.55
0.47
WS
8.61
5.51
3.83
2.81
2.15
1.70
1.38
1.14
0.96
0.81
0.70
D+L
8.61
5.51
3.83
2.81
2.15
1.70
1.38
1.14
0.96
0.81
0.70
WP
8.61
5.51
3.83
2.81
2.15
1.70
1.38
1.14
0.96
0.81
0.70
WS
5.81
3.72
2.58
1.90
1.45
1.15
0.93
0.77
0.65
0.55
0.47
D+L
9.08
5.81
4.03
2.96
2.27
1.79
1.45
1.20
1.01
0.86
0.74
WP
9.08
5.81
4.03
2.96
2.27
1.79
1.45
1.20
1.01
0.86
0.74
WS
7.26
4.65
3.23
2.37
1.82
1.43
1.16
0.96
0.81
0.69
0.59
D+L
2.22
1.42
0.99
0.73
0.56
0.44
0.36
0.29
0.25
0.21
0.18
WP
2.22
1.42
0.99
0.73
0.56
0.44
0.36
0.29
0.25
0.21
0.18
WS
3.31
2.12
1.47
1.08
0.83
0.65
0.53
0.44
0.37
0.31
0.27
D+L
3.31
2.12
1.47
1.08
0.83
0.65
0.53
0.44
0.37
0.31
0.27
WP
3.31
2.12
1.47
1.08
0.83
0.65
0.53
0.44
0.37
0.31
0.27
WS
2.22
1.42
0.99
0.73
0.56
0.44
0.36
0.29
0.25
0.21
0.18
D+L
3.47
2.22
1.54
1.13
0.87
0.69
0.56
0.46
0.39
0.33
0.28
WP
3.47
2.22
1.54
1.13
0.87
0.69
0.56
0.46
0.39
0.33
0.28
WS
2.78
1.78
1.23
0.91
0.69
0.55
0.44
0.37
0.31
0.26
0.23
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
24
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
E
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
0.50
1000.00
9.848
10.09
52.72
20000.00
0.70
1000.00
13.488
14.83
77.53
20000.00
49.91
9.69
36.70
2.00
49.08
14.71
15.47
3.04
17.88
Aluminium
0.70
1000.00
5.869
14.83
77.53
6998.00
47.65
9.13
36.96
0.79
46.16
14.20
14.16
1.23
6.80
It x
(kN / cm
2)
S xTop
S xBot
Ibx
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
29.35
5.50
25.48
1.14
26.23
8.71
7.54
1.56
7.77
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
9.08
5.81
4.04
2.96
2.27
1.79
1.45
1.20
1.01
0.86
0.74
WP
9.08
5.81
4.04
2.96
2.27
1.79
1.45
1.20
1.01
0.86
0.74
WS
12.46
7.97
5.54
4.07
3.11
2.46
1.99
1.61
1.24
0.98
0.78
D+L
12.43
7.97
5.54
4.07
3.11
2.46
1.99
1.65
1.38
1.18
1.02
WP
12.43
7.97
5.54
4.07
3.11
2.46
1.99
1.65
1.38
1.18
1.02
WS
9.08
5.81
4.04
2.96
2.27
1.79
1.45
1.20
1.01
0.86
0.74
D+L
14.13
9.08
6.31
4.63
3.55
2.80
2.27
1.88
1.58
1.34
1.16
WP
14.13
9.08
6.31
4.63
3.55
2.80
2.27
1.88
1.58
1.34
1.16
WS
11.35
7.26
5.04
3.71
2.84
2.24
1.82
1.50
1.26
1.07
0.93
D+L
16.01
10.25
7.11
5.23
4.00
3.16
2.56
2.12
1.78
1.52
1.31
WP
16.01
10.25
7.11
5.23
4.00
3.16
2.56
2.12
1.78
1.52
1.31
WS
24.30
15.55
10.80
7.93
6.07
4.80
3.89
3.02
2.33
1.83
1.47
D+L
24.30
15.55
10.80
7.93
6.07
4.80
3.89
3.21
2.70
2.30
1.98
WP
24.30
15.55
10.80
7.93
6.07
4.80
3.89
3.21
2.70
2.30
1.98
WS
16.01
10.25
7.11
5.23
4.00
3.16
2.56
2.12
1.78
1.52
1.31
D+L
25.01
16.01
11.12
8.17
6.25
4.94
4.00
3.31
2.78
2.37
2.04
WP
25.01
16.01
11.12
8.17
6.25
4.94
4.00
3.31
2.78
2.37
2.04
WS
20.01
12.81
8.89
6.53
5.00
3.95
3.20
2.65
2.22
1.89
1.63
D+L
6.34
4.06
2.82
2.07
1.59
1.25
1.02
0.84
0.70
0.60
0.52
WP
6.34
4.06
2.82
2.07
1.59
1.25
1.02
0.84
0.70
0.60
0.50
WS
9.84
6.30
4.37
3.21
2.46
1.81
1.32
0.99
0.77
0.60
0.48
D+L
9.84
6.30
4.37
3.21
2.46
1.94
1.57
1.30
1.09
0.93
0.80
WP
9.84
6.30
4.37
3.21
2.46
1.94
1.57
1.30
1.09
0.93
0.80
WS
6.34
4.06
2.82
2.07
1.59
1.25
1.02
0.84
0.70
0.60
0.52
D+L
9.91
6.34
4.41
3.24
2.48
1.96
1.59
1.31
1.10
0.94
0.81
WP
9.91
6.34
4.41
3.24
2.48
1.96
1.59
1.31
1.10
0.94
0.81
WS
7.93
5.08
3.52
2.59
1.98
1.57
1.27
1.05
0.88
0.75
0.65
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
25
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
0.50
1000.00
10.450
10.22
0.70
1000.00
14.090
Aluminium
0.70
1000.00
6.470
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
It x
S xTop
S xBot
Ibx
S xTop
S xBot
(kN / cm
2)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
92.03
20000.00
46.31
7.04
31.65
1.45
42.92
12.92
9.10
1.88
7.77
15.02
135.32
20000.00
79.66
12.61
45.71
2.60
81.66
21.79
18.93
3.91
17.88
15.02
135.32
6998.00
75.72
11.80
45.97
1.03
77.17
21.16
17.48
1.52
6.80
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+ L
11.62
7.44
5.17
3.80
2.91
2.30
1.86
1.54
1.29
1.10
0.95
WP
11.62
7.44
5.17
3.80
2.91
2.30
1.86
1.54
1.29
1.10
0.95
WS
15.02
9.62
6.68
4.91
3.76
2.97
2.40
1.99
1.67
1.42
1.23
D+ L
12.43
9.62
6.68
4.91
3.76
2.97
2.40
1.99
1.67
1.42
1.23
WP
12.43
9.62
6.68
4.91
3.76
2.97
2.40
1.99
1.67
1.42
1.23
WS
11.62
7.44
5.17
3.80
2.91
2.30
1.86
1.54
1.29
1.10
0.95
D+ L
14.13
11.30
8.07
5.93
4.54
3.59
2.91
2.40
2.02
1.72
1.48
WP
14.13
11.30
8.07
5.93
4.54
3.59
2.91
2.40
2.02
1.72
1.48
WS
14.13
9.30
6.46
4.74
3.63
2.87
2.32
1.92
1.61
1.38
1.19
D+ L
20.82
13.32
9.25
6.80
5.20
4.11
3.33
2.75
2.31
1.97
1.70
WP
20.82
13.32
9.25
6.80
5.20
4.11
3.33
2.75
2.31
1.97
1.70
WS
31.26
20.00
13.89
10.21
7.81
6.17
5.00
4.13
3.47
2.96
2.44
D+ L
28.61
20.00
13.89
10.21
7.81
6.17
5.00
4.13
3.47
2.96
2.55
WP
28.61
20.00
13.89
10.21
7.81
6.17
5.00
4.13
3.47
2.96
2.55
WS
20.82
13.32
9.25
6.80
5.20
4.11
3.33
2.75
2.31
1.97
1.70
D+ L
32.51
20.82
14.46
10.62
8.13
6.42
5.20
4.30
3.61
3.08
2.66
WP
32.51
20.82
14.46
10.62
8.13
6.42
5.20
4.30
3.61
3.08
2.66
WS
26.02
16.65
11.56
8.50
6.51
5.14
4.16
3.44
2.89
2.46
2.12
D+ L
8.20
5.25
3.64
2.68
2.05
1.62
1.31
1.08
0.91
0.78
0.67
WP
8.20
5.25
3.64
2.68
2.05
1.62
1.31
1.08
0.91
0.78
0.67
WS
12.14
7.77
5.40
3.97
3.04
2.40
1.94
1.61
1.28
1.01
0.81
D+ L
10.88
7.77
5.40
3.97
3.04
2.40
1.94
1.61
1.35
1.15
0.99
WP
10.88
7.77
5.40
3.97
3.04
2.40
1.94
1.61
1.35
1.15
0.99
WS
8.20
5.25
3.64
2.68
2.05
1.62
1.31
1.08
0.91
0.78
0.67
D+ L
12.36
8.20
5.69
4.18
3.20
2.53
2.05
1.69
1.42
1.21
1.05
WP
12.36
8.20
5.69
4.18
3.20
2.53
2.05
1.69
1.42
1.21
1.05
WS
10.25
6.56
4.56
3.35
2.56
2.02
1.64
1.36
1.14
0.97
0.84
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
26
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
Aluminium
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
E
(kN / cm
2)
It x
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
82.97
9.67
42.34
2.00
80.67
21.03
12.01
2.48
7.77
143.68
17.46
61.53
3.61
156.24
35.34
25.47
5.26
17.88
16.30
61.76
1.42
147.20
34.38
23.44
2.04
6.80
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
1000.00
11.448
10.43
181.20
20000.00
1000.00
15.088
15.34
266.43
20000.00
1000.00
7.469
15.34
266.43
6998.00
136.18
(mm)
(mm)
0.50
0.70
0.70
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
Ma
tx
Ibx
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
Ma
bx
(kN m)
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
15.54
10.22
7.10
5.21
3.99
3.15
2.55
2.11
1.77
1.51
1.30
WP
15.54
10.22
7.10
5.21
3.99
3.15
2.55
2.11
1.77
1.51
1.30
WS
15.54
12.43
8.82
6.48
4.96
3.92
3.17
2.62
2.20
1.88
1.62
D+L
12.43
9.95
8.29
6.48
4.96
3.92
3.17
2.62
2.20
1.88
1.62
WP
12.43
9.95
8.29
6.48
4.96
3.92
3.17
2.62
2.20
1.88
1.62
WS
12.43
9.95
7.10
5.21
3.99
3.15
2.55
2.11
1.77
1.51
1.30
D+L
14.13
11.30
9.42
8.07
6.20
4.90
3.97
3.28
2.76
2.35
2.02
WP
14.13
11.30
9.42
8.07
6.20
4.90
3.97
3.28
2.76
2.35
2.02
WS
14.13
11.30
8.87
6.52
4.99
3.94
3.19
2.64
2.22
1.89
1.63
D+L
28.84
18.46
12.82
9.42
7.21
5.70
4.61
3.81
3.20
2.73
2.35
WP
28.84
18.46
12.82
9.42
7.21
5.70
4.61
3.81
3.20
2.73
2.35
WS
35.76
26.92
18.70
13.74
10.52
8.31
6.73
5.56
4.67
3.98
3.43
D+L
28.61
22.89
18.70
13.74
10.52
8.31
6.73
5.56
4.67
3.98
3.43
WP
28.61
22.89
18.70
13.74
10.52
8.31
6.73
5.56
4.67
3.98
3.43
WS
28.61
18.46
12.82
9.42
7.21
5.70
4.61
3.81
3.20
2.73
2.35
D+L
32.51
26.01
20.03
14.71
11.27
8.90
7.21
5.96
5.01
4.27
3.68
WP
32.51
26.01
20.03
14.71
11.27
8.90
7.21
5.96
5.01
4.27
3.68
WS
32.51
23.07
16.02
11.77
9.01
7.12
5.77
4.77
4.01
3.41
2.94
D+L
11.32
7.24
5.03
3.70
2.83
2.24
1.81
1.50
1.26
1.07
0.92
WP
11.32
7.24
5.03
3.70
2.83
2.24
1.81
1.50
1.26
1.07
0.92
WS
13.60
10.42
7.24
5.32
4.07
3.22
2.60
2.15
1.81
1.54
1.33
D+L
10.88
8.70
7.24
5.32
4.07
3.22
2.60
2.15
1.81
1.54
1.33
WP
10.88
8.70
7.24
5.32
4.07
3.22
2.60
2.15
1.81
1.54
1.33
WS
10.88
7.24
5.03
3.70
2.83
2.24
1.81
1.50
1.26
1.07
0.92
D+L
12.36
9.89
7.86
5.78
4.42
3.49
2.83
2.34
1.97
1.67
1.44
WP
12.36
9.89
7.86
5.78
4.42
3.49
2.83
2.34
1.97
1.67
1.44
WS
12.36
9.06
6.29
4.62
3.54
2.80
2.26
1.87
1.57
1.34
1.16
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
27
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
(kN )
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
Aluminium
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
(cm
2)
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
E
It x
(kN / cm
2)
4)
S xTop
S xBot
3)
3)
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
Ma
tx
Ibx
4)
S xTop
3)
S xBot
(cm 3 )
Ma
bx
(mm)
( k g/ m )
0.50
1000.00
12.490
10.60
275.89
20000.00
120.63
11.84
51.26
2.44
120.48
28.50
14.49
2.99
7.77
0.70
1000.00
16.090
15.59
405.67
20000.00
209.52
21.47
74.73
4.43
235.16
47.41
30.39
6.39
17.88
0.70
1000.00
8.470
15.59
405.67
6998.00
198.35
20.00
74.93
1.74
221.09
46.21
28.43
2.47
6.80
(cm
(cm
(cm
(kN m)
(cm
(cm
(kN m)
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
Va
(mm)
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
15.54
12.43
8.69
6.38
4.89
3.86
3.13
2.59
2.17
1.85
1.60
WP
15.54
12.43
8.69
6.38
4.89
3.86
3.13
2.59
2.17
1.85
1.60
WS
15.54
12.43
10.36
7.81
5.98
4.73
3.83
3.16
2.66
2.27
1.95
D+L
12.43
9.95
8.29
7.10
5.98
4.73
3.83
3.16
2.66
2.27
1.95
WP
12.43
9.95
8.29
7.10
5.98
4.73
3.83
3.16
2.66
2.27
1.95
WS
12.43
9.95
8.29
6.38
4.89
3.86
3.13
2.59
2.17
1.85
1.60
D+L
14.13
11.30
9.42
8.07
7.06
5.91
4.79
3.96
3.32
2.83
2.44
WP
14.13
11.30
9.42
8.07
7.06
5.91
4.79
3.96
3.32
2.83
2.44
WS
14.13
11.30
9.42
7.98
6.11
4.83
3.91
3.23
2.72
2.31
2.00
D+L
35.46
22.69
15.76
11.58
8.86
7.00
5.67
4.69
3.94
3.36
2.89
WP
35.46
22.69
15.76
11.58
8.86
7.00
5.67
4.69
3.94
3.36
2.89
WS
35.76
28.61
22.71
16.68
12.77
10.09
8.17
6.76
5.68
4.84
4.17
D+L
28.61
22.89
19.07
16.35
12.77
10.09
8.17
6.76
5.68
4.84
4.17
WP
28.61
22.89
19.07
16.35
12.77
10.09
8.17
6.76
5.68
4.84
4.17
WS
28.61
22.69
15.76
11.58
8.86
7.00
5.67
4.69
3.94
3.36
2.89
D+L
32.51
26.01
21.67
18.09
13.85
10.94
8.86
7.33
6.16
5.24
4.52
WP
32.51
26.01
21.67
18.09
13.85
10.94
8.86
7.33
6.16
5.24
4.52
WS
32.51
26.01
19.70
14.47
11.08
8.75
7.09
5.86
4.92
4.20
3.62
D+L
13.60
8.89
6.18
4.54
3.47
2.74
2.22
1.84
1.54
1.32
1.13
WP
13.60
8.89
6.18
4.54
3.47
2.74
2.22
1.84
1.54
1.32
1.13
WS
13.60
10.88
8.78
6.45
4.94
3.90
3.16
2.61
2.19
1.87
1.61
D+L
10.88
8.70
7.25
6.22
4.94
3.90
3.16
2.61
2.19
1.87
1.61
WP
10.88
8.70
7.25
6.22
4.94
3.90
3.16
2.61
2.19
1.87
1.61
WS
10.88
8.70
6.18
4.54
3.47
2.74
2.22
1.84
1.54
1.32
1.13
D+L
12.36
9.89
8.24
7.06
5.43
4.29
3.47
2.87
2.41
2.06
1.77
WP
12.36
9.89
8.24
7.06
5.43
4.29
3.47
2.87
2.41
2.06
1.77
WS
12.36
9.89
7.72
5.67
4.34
3.43
2.78
2.30
1.93
1.64
1.42
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
28
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
(kN )
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
0.50
900.00
10.099
10.73
89.07
20000.00
66.67
12.19
28.42
2.52
0.70
900.00
13.739
15.76
130.67
20000.00
112.48
21.70
42.45
4.48
84.19
22.06
20.96
4.33
26.16
Aluminium
0.70
900.00
6.120
15.88
132.27
6998.00
110.37
21.01
42.76
1.82
80.88
21.76
19.65
1.71
9.00
It x
(kN / cm
2)
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
Ibx
S xTop
S xBot
(kN m)
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
46.92
13.55
10.78
2.23
8.21
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
16.42
12.89
8.95
6.57
5.03
3.98
3.22
2.66
2.24
1.91
1.64
WP
16.42
12.89
8.95
6.57
5.03
3.98
3.22
2.66
2.24
1.91
1.64
WS
16.42
11.39
7.91
5.81
4.45
3.52
2.85
2.35
1.98
1.69
1.40
D+L
13.14
10.51
7.91
5.81
4.45
3.52
2.85
2.35
1.98
1.69
1.45
WP
13.14
10.51
7.91
5.81
4.45
3.52
2.85
2.35
1.98
1.69
1.45
WS
13.14
10.51
8.76
6.57
5.03
3.98
3.22
2.66
2.24
1.91
1.64
D+L
14.93
11.94
9.89
7.27
5.56
4.40
3.56
2.94
2.47
2.11
1.82
WP
14.93
11.94
9.89
7.27
5.56
4.40
3.56
2.94
2.47
2.11
1.82
WS
14.93
11.94
9.95
8.22
6.29
4.97
4.03
3.33
2.80
2.38
2.05
D+L
35.83
22.93
15.92
11.70
8.96
7.08
5.73
4.74
3.98
3.39
2.92
WP
35.83
22.93
15.92
11.70
8.96
7.08
5.73
4.74
3.98
3.39
2.92
WS
34.61
22.15
15.38
11.30
8.65
6.84
5.54
4.58
3.85
3.14
2.51
D+L
34.61
22.15
15.38
11.30
8.65
6.84
5.54
4.58
3.85
3.28
2.83
WP
34.61
22.15
15.38
11.30
8.65
6.84
5.54
4.58
3.85
3.28
2.83
WS
35.83
22.93
15.92
11.70
8.96
7.08
5.73
4.74
3.98
3.39
2.92
D+L
43.27
27.69
19.23
14.13
10.82
8.55
6.92
5.72
4.81
4.10
3.53
WP
43.27
27.69
19.23
14.13
10.82
8.55
6.92
5.72
4.81
4.10
3.53
WS
44.79
28.66
19.91
14.62
11.20
8.85
7.17
5.92
4.98
4.24
3.66
D+L
14.60
9.34
6.49
4.77
3.65
2.88
2.34
1.93
1.62
1.38
1.19
WP
14.60
9.34
6.49
4.77
3.65
2.88
2.34
1.93
1.62
1.38
1.15
WS
13.64
8.73
6.06
4.46
3.41
2.70
2.18
1.74
1.34
1.06
0.84
D+L
13.64
8.73
6.06
4.46
3.41
2.70
2.18
1.80
1.52
1.29
1.11
WP
13.64
8.73
6.06
4.46
3.41
2.70
2.18
1.80
1.52
1.29
1.11
WS
14.40
9.34
6.49
4.77
3.65
2.88
2.34
1.93
1.62
1.38
1.19
D+L
16.36
10.92
7.58
5.57
4.26
3.37
2.73
2.26
1.90
1.61
1.39
WP
16.36
10.92
7.58
5.57
4.26
3.37
2.73
2.26
1.90
1.61
1.39
WS
16.36
11.68
8.11
5.96
4.56
3.60
2.92
2.41
2.03
1.73
1.49
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
29
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
Aluminium
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
(cm
2)
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
E
It x
(kN / cm
2)
(cm
4)
S xTop
(cm
S xBot
3)
(cm
3)
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
Ma
tx
(kN m)
Ibx
(cm
4)
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
0.50
900.00
10.639
10.87
136.09
20000.00
102.55
16.27
34.05
3.36
66.37
0.70
900.00
14.279
15.96
199.73
20000.00
171.49
28.80
50.75
5.95
122.62
0.70
900.00
6.660
16.08
201.75
6998.00
167.97
27.78
51.10
2.41
116.72
S xTop
S xBot
Ma
bx
(kN m)
17.75
11.90
2.46
8.21
29.28
23.83
4.92
26.16
28.73
22.15
1.92
9.00
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+ L
16.42
13.14
10.95
8.77
6.72
5.31
4.30
3.55
2.99
2.54
2.19
WP
16.42
13.14
10.95
8.77
6.72
5.31
4.30
3.55
2.99
2.54
2.19
WS
16.42
12.58
8.74
6.42
4.92
3.88
3.15
2.60
2.18
1.86
1.61
D+ L
13.14
10.51
8.74
6.42
4.92
3.88
3.15
2.60
2.18
1.86
1.61
WP
13.14
10.51
8.74
6.42
4.92
3.88
3.15
2.60
2.18
1.86
1.61
WS
13.14
10.51
8.76
7.51
6.57
5.31
4.30
3.55
2.99
2.54
2.19
D+ L
14.93
11.94
9.95
8.03
6.14
4.85
3.93
3.25
2.73
2.33
2.01
WP
14.93
11.94
9.95
8.03
6.14
4.85
3.93
3.25
2.73
2.33
2.01
WS
14.93
11.94
9.95
8.53
7.46
6.09
4.94
4.08
3.43
2.92
2.52
D+ L
47.56
30.44
21.14
15.53
11.89
9.40
7.61
6.29
5.28
4.50
3.88
WP
47.56
30.44
21.14
15.53
11.89
9.40
7.61
6.29
5.28
4.50
3.88
WS
39.35
25.18
17.49
12.85
9.84
7.77
6.30
5.20
4.37
3.73
3.21
D+ L
39.35
25.18
17.49
12.85
9.84
7.77
6.30
5.20
4.37
3.73
3.21
WP
39.35
25.18
17.49
12.85
9.84
7.77
6.30
5.20
4.37
3.73
3.21
WS
41.85
30.44
21.14
15.53
11.89
9.40
7.61
6.29
5.28
4.50
3.88
D+ L
47.56
31.48
21.86
16.06
12.30
9.72
7.87
6.50
5.47
4.66
4.02
WP
47.56
31.48
21.86
16.06
12.30
9.72
7.87
6.50
5.47
4.66
4.02
WS
47.56
38.04
26.42
19.41
14.86
11.74
9.51
7.86
6.61
5.63
4.85
D+ L
18.00
12.35
8.58
6.30
4.82
3.81
3.09
2.55
2.14
1.83
1.58
WP
18.00
12.35
8.58
6.30
4.82
3.81
3.09
2.55
2.14
1.83
1.58
WS
15.38
9.84
6.83
5.02
3.84
3.04
2.46
2.03
1.71
1.46
1.22
D+ L
14.40
9.84
6.83
5.02
3.84
3.04
2.46
2.03
1.71
1.46
1.26
WP
14.40
9.84
6.83
5.02
3.84
3.04
2.46
2.03
1.71
1.46
1.26
WS
14.40
11.52
8.58
6.30
4.82
3.81
3.09
2.55
2.14
1.83
1.58
D+ L
16.36
12.30
8.54
6.28
4.81
3.80
3.08
2.54
2.14
1.82
1.57
WP
16.36
12.30
8.54
6.28
4.81
3.80
3.08
2.54
2.14
1.82
1.57
WS
16.36
13.09
10.72
7.88
6.03
4.76
3.86
3.19
2.68
2.28
1.97
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
30
WS
Va
(cm 3 )
(cm
3)
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
(kN )
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
Aluminium
P a ne l
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hic k ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
(cm
2)
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
E
It x
(kN / cm
2)
4)
S xTop
S xBot
3)
3)
Ma
tx
Ibx
4)
S xTop
3)
14.77
3.05
8.21
29.65
6.12
26.16
27.35
2.37
9.00
900.00
11.540
11.11
241.53
20000.00
182.36
23.60
44.64
4.87
111.94
0.70
900.00
15.180
16.42
357.91
20000.00
305.68
42.03
67.02
8.68
209.02
0.70
900.00
7.560
16.42
357.91
6998.00
296.49
40.09
66.81
3.48
196.97
42.52
(cm
(cm
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
16.42
13.14
10.95
9.38
8.21
7.30
6.24
5.15
4.33
3.69
3.18
WP
16.42
13.14
10.95
9.38
8.21
7.30
6.24
5.15
4.33
3.69
3.18
WS
16.42
13.14
10.84
7.96
6.10
4.82
3.90
3.22
2.71
2.31
1.99
D+L
13.14
10.51
8.76
7.51
6.10
4.82
3.90
3.22
2.71
2.31
1.99
WP
13.14
10.51
8.76
7.51
6.10
4.82
3.90
3.22
2.71
2.31
1.99
WS
13.14
10.51
8.76
7.51
6.57
5.84
5.26
4.78
4.33
3.69
3.18
D+L
14.93
11.94
9.95
8.53
7.46
6.02
4.88
4.03
3.39
2.89
2.49
WP
14.93
11.94
9.95
8.53
7.46
6.02
4.88
4.03
3.39
2.89
2.49
WS
14.93
11.94
9.95
8.53
7.46
6.64
5.97
5.06
4.25
3.62
3.12
D+L
52.31
41.85
30.85
22.67
17.35
13.71
11.11
9.18
7.71
6.57
5.67
WP
52.31
41.85
30.85
22.67
17.35
13.71
11.11
9.18
7.71
6.57
5.67
WS
48.97
31.34
21.76
15.99
12.24
9.67
7.84
6.48
5.44
4.64
4.00
D+L
41.85
31.34
21.76
15.99
12.24
9.67
7.84
6.48
5.44
4.64
4.00
WP
41.85
31.34
21.76
15.99
12.24
9.67
7.84
6.48
5.44
4.64
4.00
WS
41.85
33.48
27.90
22.67
17.35
13.71
11.11
9.18
7.71
6.57
5.67
D+L
47.56
38.04
27.20
19.99
15.30
12.09
9.79
8.09
6.80
5.80
5.00
WP
47.56
38.04
27.20
19.99
15.30
12.09
9.79
8.09
6.80
5.80
5.00
WS
47.56
38.04
31.70
25.08
19.20
15.17
12.29
10.16
8.54
7.27
6.27
D+L
18.00
14.40
12.00
9.09
6.96
5.50
4.46
3.68
3.09
2.64
2.27
WP
18.00
14.40
12.00
9.09
6.96
5.50
4.46
3.68
3.09
2.64
2.27
WS
18.00
12.16
8.44
6.20
4.75
3.75
3.04
2.51
2.11
1.80
1.55
D+L
14.40
11.52
8.44
6.20
4.75
3.75
3.04
2.51
2.11
1.80
1.55
WP
14.40
11.52
8.44
6.20
4.75
3.75
3.04
2.51
2.11
1.80
1.55
WS
14.40
11.52
9.60
8.23
6.96
5.50
4.46
3.68
3.09
2.64
2.27
D+L
16.36
13.09
10.55
7.75
5.94
4.69
3.80
3.14
2.64
2.25
1.94
WP
16.36
13.09
10.55
7.75
5.94
4.69
3.80
3.14
2.64
2.25
1.94
WS
16.36
13.09
10.91
9.35
7.45
5.89
4.77
3.94
3.31
2.82
2.43
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
31
WS
Va
26.44
0.50
(kN m)
bx
43.69
( k g/ m )
(cm
Ma
(kN m)
(mm)
(cm
S xBot
(cm 3 )
(mm)
(cm
We b
S he a
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
T o p in C o m pre s s io n
Ix
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
(kN )
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
P a nel
N o m ina l C o v e rin
T hick ne s g Widt h
s
N o m in
al
We ight
N o m in
a l A re a
T o p in C o m pre s sio n
Ix
(mm)
(mm)
( k g/ m )
(cm 2 )
( F ull
S e c t io
n)
(cm 4 )
A luzinc
C o ated
Steel
0.50
900.00
12.439
11.37
0.70
900.00
16.079
Aluminium
0.70
900.00
8.460
We b
S hea
r
B o t t o m in C o m pre s s io n
It x
S xTop
S xBot
Ibx
( kN / c m
2)
S xTop
S xBot
(cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
( cm 3 )
(kN m)
( cm 4 )
(cm 3 )
(cm 3 )
(kN m)
(kN )
382.26
20000.00
288.23
31.40
56.13
6.48
170.45
36.31
17.72
3.66
8.21
16.77
564.76
20000.00
479.49
55.65
83.86
11.49
321.77
59.71
35.97
7.43
26.16
16.77
564.76
6998.00
465.52
53.09
83.64
4.61
302.35
58.17
33.10
2.87
9.00
Ma
tx
Ma
bx
Panel
Nom inal
Thickne
(m m )
No. of
Spans
0.50
0.70
Aluminium
0.70
S p a n
Load
Case
I n
M e t e r s
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
16.42
13.14
10.95
9.38
8.21
7.30
6.57
5.97
5.47
4.91
4.23
WP
16.42
13.14
10.95
9.38
8.21
7.30
6.57
5.97
5.47
4.91
4.23
WS
16.42
13.14
10.95
9.38
7.32
5.78
4.68
3.87
3.25
2.77
2.39
D+L
13.14
10.51
8.76
7.51
6.57
5.78
4.68
3.87
3.25
2.77
2.39
WP
13.14
10.51
8.76
7.51
6.57
5.78
4.68
3.87
3.25
2.77
2.39
WS
13.14
10.51
8.76
7.51
6.57
5.84
5.26
4.78
4.38
4.04
3.75
D+L
14.93
11.94
9.95
8.53
7.46
6.64
5.85
4.84
4.06
3.46
2.99
WP
14.93
11.94
9.95
8.53
7.46
6.64
5.85
4.84
4.06
3.46
2.99
WS
14.93
11.94
9.95
8.53
7.46
6.64
5.97
5.43
4.98
4.35
3.75
D+L
52.31
41.85
34.87
29.89
22.98
18.15
14.70
12.15
10.21
8.70
7.50
WP
52.31
41.85
34.87
29.89
22.98
18.15
14.70
12.15
10.21
8.70
7.50
WS
52.31
38.02
26.40
19.40
14.85
11.73
9.50
7.86
6.60
5.62
4.85
D+L
41.85
33.48
26.40
19.40
14.85
11.73
9.50
7.86
6.60
5.62
4.85
WP
41.85
33.48
26.40
19.40
14.85
11.73
9.50
7.86
6.60
5.62
4.85
WS
41.85
33.48
27.90
23.91
20.92
18.15
14.70
12.15
10.21
8.70
7.50
D+L
47.56
38.04
31.70
24.25
18.56
14.67
11.88
9.82
8.25
7.03
6.06
WP
47.56
38.04
31.70
24.25
18.56
14.67
11.88
9.82
8.25
7.03
6.06
WS
47.56
38.04
31.70
27.17
23.30
18.41
14.91
12.32
10.35
8.82
7.61
D+L
18.00
14.40
12.00
10.28
9.00
7.28
5.90
4.88
4.10
3.49
3.01
WP
18.00
14.40
12.00
10.28
9.00
7.28
5.90
4.88
4.10
3.49
3.01
WS
18.00
14.40
10.22
7.51
5.75
4.54
3.68
3.04
2.55
2.18
1.88
D+L
14.40
11.52
9.60
7.51
5.75
4.54
3.68
3.04
2.55
2.18
1.88
WP
14.40
11.52
9.60
7.51
5.75
4.54
3.68
3.04
2.55
2.18
1.88
WS
14.40
11.52
9.60
8.23
7.20
6.40
5.76
4.88
4.10
3.49
3.01
D+L
16.36
13.09
10.91
9.35
7.18
5.68
4.60
3.80
3.19
2.72
2.35
WP
16.36
13.09
10.91
9.35
7.18
5.68
4.60
3.80
3.19
2.72
2.35
WS
16.36
13.09
10.91
9.35
8.18
7.12
5.77
4.77
4.01
3.41
2.94
WP
= W in d Pr essu r e Loa d
32
WS
= W in d Su ct ion Loa d
Va
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
Sheeting Screws
The strength calculations for sheeting screws /fasteners are governed by
AISIs North American Specification for the Design of Cold Formed Structural
Members 2001 edition section E4.
Sheeting Screws and Fasteners include Self Drilling, Self Tapping screws.
The provisions of section E4 of AISI are applicable for all screws of diameter
more than 2.03 mm, but not greater than 6.35 mm.
Standard stock screws are of 4.8, 5.5, and 6.3 mm diameters. Generally the
length of the screw does not influence the design strength as long as 3 threads
project beyond the holding material, but it does affect the driving torque.
Longer the screws more torque required and hence more strength or diameter
of screw is required.
The screws are stocked in two material, carbon steel and stainless steel (BiMetal). Stainless steel is used with aluminum panels. The drill bit of stainless
screw is made of carbon steel; hence these are also called bi-metal screws.
These screws are drawn from wire rods of various grades of steel; the threads
are either cut or rolled.
Table 15.7
Material
Grade
F u (N/mm2)
Carbon Steel
A510
625
A304
540
Table 15.8
Screw Number
Diameter in mm
# 10
4.8
# 12
5.5
# 14
6.3
The following factor of safety or resistance factor is applicable for this section
Table 15.9
LRFD
0.50
ASD
3.00
33
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
General
1. As a standard for Single Skin Sheeting fasteners are always provided at the
valleys only (i.e. trough), not at the peak (crown). Unless specified in the
PIF.
2. If the fasteners are required at the crown for Single Skin Sheeting, these
should always be provided with saddle washers, this should be
accordingly priced in the estimate.
3. As a standard for Sandwich panel, fasteners are provided at crown
without saddle washers at roof only, in the walls fasteners are provided at
the valley.
a) Shear
1. Shear Strength Limited by Tilting and Bearing
a. For t 2 / t 1 <= 1.00
Eqn. E 4.3.1-1
Eqn. E 4.3.1-2
Eqn. E 4.3.1-3
P ns
P ns
P ns
P ns
P ns
= 2.7 t 1 d F u1
= 2.7 t 2 d F u2
Where,
d
= nominal screw diameter in mm
t1
= thickness of material in contact with screw head, (panel)
= thickness of material not in contact with screw head, (purlin/girt)
t2
= Tensile strength of the material in contact with screw head, (panel)
F u1
= Tensile strength of the material not in contact with screw head,
F u2
(purlin/girt)
34
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
= 2.7 t e F u
Where,
t
= thickness of the connected part
e
= edge distance from center of hole to nearest end of connected part
Fu
= Tensile strength of the connected material. (panel)
3. Shear Strength of Screws
P ns
= 0.80 P ss
Where,
= Shear strength or resistance of screw reported by the manufacturer.
P ss
The values for all cases above are tabulated in Table 12.18 for common screws
diameters, purlins and panel thickness.
35
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
b) Tension
For screws which carry tension, the head of the screw or washer, if a washer is
provided, shall be a diameter d w not less than 7.94 mm and at least 1.27 mm
thick. 3 modes of failure govern the design, Pull-Out, Pull-Over and Tension in
screws.
1. Pull-Out (of Screw from Purlin or Girt)
P not
= 0.85 t c d F u2
= 1.5 t 1 d w F u1
3. Tension in Screws
P not
= 0.80 P ts
Where,
d
= nominal screw diameter in mm
= washer diameter, should not be greater than 12.7 mm
dw
= thickness of material in contact with screw head, (panel)
t1
tc
= lesser of depth of penetration or t 2 (t c = t 2 )
= Tensile strength of the material in contact with screw head, (panel)
F u1
= Tensile strength of the material not in contact with screw head,
F u2
(purlin/girt)
= Tensile strength or resistance of screw reported by the manufacturer.
P ts
The values for all cases above are tabulated in Table 12.19 for common screws
diameters,
purlins
and
panel
thickness.
36
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
Table 15.10
Pull-Out
Screw Diameter
mm
4.8
1.10
1.38
1.65
1.84
2.30
5.5
1.26
1.58
1.89
2.10
2.63
6.3
1.45
1.81
2.17
2.41
3.01
0.30
0.40
0.50
0.70
1.00
1.29
1.71
2.14
3.00
4.29
0.49
0.65
0.81
1.13
1.62
P not = 1.5 t 1 d w F u1
Panel Thickness in mm
Steel Panel
Pull-Over
Aluminium Panel
Pull-Over
4.8
5.5
6.3
4.8
5.5
6.3
P ns = 0.80 P ts
Carbon Steel Screws
Tension
4.8
P ts =
11.41
kN
4.56
kN
5.5
P ts =
18.50
kN
7.40
kN
6.3
P ts =
20.10
kN
8.04
kN
4.8
P ts =
7.05
kN
2.82
kN
5.5
P ts =
13.90
kN
5.56
kN
P ts =
16.10
kN
6.44
kN
6.3
F u2 = 450
N/mm2
N/mm2
37
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
Table 15.11
Tensile Strength (ASD)
Failure Mode
Pull-Out
P not = 0.85 t c d F u2 /
Purlin Thickness in mm (F u2 = 450
Screw Diameter
N/mm2)
mm
1.20
1.50
1.80
2.00
2.50
4.8
1.10
1.38
1.65
1.84
2.30
5.5
1.26
1.58
1.89
2.10
2.63
6.3
1.45
1.81
2.17
2.41
3.01
0.30
0.40
0.50
0.70
1.00
1.29
1.71
2.14
3.00
4.29
0.49
0.65
0.81
1.13
1.62
P not = 1.5 t 1 d w F u1 /
Panel Thickness in mm
Steel Panel
Pull-Over
Aluminium Panel
Pull-Over
4.8
5.5
6.3
4.8
5.5
6.3
P ns = 0.80 P ts /
Carbon Steel Screws
Tension
4.8
P ts =
11.41
kN
4.56
kN
5.5
P ts =
18.50
kN
7.40
kN
6.3
P ts =
20.10
kN
8.04
kN
4.8
P ts =
7.05
kN
2.82
kN
5.5
P ts =
13.90
kN
5.56
kN
P ts =
16.10
kN
6.44
kN
6.3
F u2 = 450
N/mm2
N/mm2
38
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
Table 15.12
Purlin Thk.
1.2
1.5
1.8
2.0
2.5
4.8
2.72
3.80
5.00
5.86
8.18
5.5
2.91
4.07
5.35
6.27
8.76
6.3
3.12
4.36
5.73
6.71
9.38
Screw Diameter
P ns = 2.7 t 1 d F u1
Panel Thk.
0.30
0.40
0.50
0.70
1.00
4.8
0.87
1.17
1.46
2.04
2.92
5.5
1.00
1.34
1.67
2.34
3.34
6.3
1.15
1.53
1.91
2.68
3.83
Screw Diameter
P ns = 2.7 t 2 d F u2
Purlin Thk.
1.2
1.5
1.8
2.0
2.5
4.8
3.50
4.37
5.25
5.83
7.29
5.5
4.01
5.01
6.01
6.68
8.35
6.3
4.59
5.74
6.89
7.65
9.57
Screw Diameter
P ns = 2.7 t e F u
Panel Thk.
0.30
0.40
0.50
0.70
1.00
4.8
1.31
1.75
2.19
3.06
4.37
5.5
1.50
2.00
2.51
3.51
5.01
6.3
1.72
2.30
2.87
4.02
5.74
P ns = 0.80 P ss
Carbon Steel Screws
Shear
4.8
P ss =
5.98
2.39
kN
5.5
P ss =
10.80
4.32
kN
6.3
P ss =
12.15
4.86
kN
4.8
P ss =
5.10
2.04
kN
5.5
P ss =
8.40
3.36
kN
6.3
P ss =
11.20
4.48
kN
39
P A N E L
&
F A S T E N E R S
D E S I G N
Table 15.13
Shear Strength (ASD)
Screw Diameter
Purlin Thk.
1.2
1.5
1.8
2.0
2.5
4.8
1.81
2.54
3.33
3.90
5.46
5.5
1.94
2.71
3.57
4.18
5.84
6.3
2.08
2.90
3.82
4.47
6.25
Panel Thk.
0.30
0.40
0.50
0.70
1.00
4.8
0.58
0.78
0.97
1.36
1.94
5.5
0.67
0.89
1.11
1.56
2.23
6.3
0.77
1.02
1.28
1.79
2.55
Screw Diameter
P ns = 2.7 t 1 d F u1 /
Screw Diameter
P ns = 2.7 t 2 d F u2 /
Purlin Thk.
1.2
1.5
1.8
2.0
2.5
4.8
2.33
2.92
3.50
3.89
4.86
5.5
2.67
3.34
4.01
4.45
5.57
6.3
3.06
3.83
4.59
5.10
6.38
Screw Diameter
P ns = 2.7 t e F u /
Panel Thk.
0.30
0.40
0.50
0.70
1.00
4.8
0.87
1.17
1.46
2.04
2.92
5.5
1.00
1.34
1.67
2.34
3.34
6.3
1.15
1.53
1.91
2.68
3.83
P ns = 0.80 P ss /
Carbon Steel Screws
Shear
4.8
P ss =
5.98
1.59
kN
5.5
P ss =
10.80
2.88
kN
6.3
P ss =
12.15
3.24
kN
4.8
P ss =
5.10
1.36
kN
5.5
P ss =
8.40
2.24
kN
6.3
P ss =
11.20
2.99
kN
40
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
16
Chapter
D E S I G N
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Thus,
Cross section area A = L x t
Moment of inertia of the section I = I x t
Section Modulus of the section S = I / y
Where,
L
I
y
Most sections can be divided into straight lines and circular arcs. The moments
of inertia and centroid location of such elements are defined by equations from
fundamental theory as presented below.
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
The design of cold-formed steel differs from hot rolled or built-up sections in
that the, elements of cold formed members typically have large width-tothickness (w/t) ratios and are thus subject to local buckling. Figure above
illustrates local buckling in beams and columns. Flat elements in compression
that have both edges parallel to the direction of stress stiffened by a web,
flange, lip or stiffener are referred to as stiffened elements.
In order to account for the effect of local buckling in design, the concept of
effective width is employed for elements in compression. The background for
this concept can be explained as follows.
Unlike a column, a plate does not usually attain its maximum load carrying
capacity at the buckling load, but usually shows significant post buckling
strength. This behavior is illustrated in figure below, where longitudinal and
transverse bars represent a plate that is simply supported along all edges. As
the uniformly distributed end load is gradually increased, the longitudinal
bars are equally stressed and reach their buckling load simultaneously.
However, as the longitudinal bars buckle, the transverse bars develop tension
in restraining the lateral deflection of the longitudinal bars. Thus, the
longitudinal bars do not collapse when they reach their buckling load but are
able to carry additional load because of the transverse restraint.
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
The longitudinal bars nearest the center can deflect more than the bars near
the edge, and therefore, the edge bars carry higher loads after buckling than
do the center bars. The post buckling behavior of a simply supported plate is
similar to that of the grid model. However, the ability of a plate to resist shear
strains that develop during buckling also contributes to its post buckling
strength. Although the grid shown in Fig. a buckled into only one
longitudinal half-wave, a longer plate may buckle into several waves as
illustrated in Fig. b. For long plates, the half-wave length approaches the
width b.
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
After a simply supported plate buckles, the compressive stress will vary from
a maximum near the supported edges to a minimum at the mid-width of the
plate as shown by line 1 of Fig. c. As the load is increased the edge stresses
will increase, but the stress in the mid- width of the plate may decrease
slightly. The maximum load is reached and collapse is initiated when the edge
stress reaches the yield stressa condition indicated by line 2 of Fig. c.
The post buckling strength of a plate element can be considered by assuming
that after buckling, the total load is carried by strips adjacent to the supported
edges which are at a uniform stress equal to the actual maximum edge stress.
These strips are indicated by the dashed lines in Fig. c. The total width of the
strips, which represents the effective width of the element b, is defined so
that the product of b and the maximum edge stress equals the actual stresses
integrated over the entire width. The effective width decreases as the applied
stress increases. At maximum load, the stress on the effective width is the
yield stress.
Thus, an element with a small enough (w/t) will be able to reach the yield
point and will be fully effective. Elements with larger ratios will have an
effective width that is less than the full width, and that reduced width will be
used in section property calculations.
The behavior of elements with other edge-support conditions is generally
similar to that discussed above. However, an element supported along only
one edge will develop only one effective strip.
Equations for calculating effective widths of elements are given in AISI
Specification. These equations are based on theoretical elastic buckling theory
but modified to reflect the results of extensive physical testing. See AISI 2001
Specification for more details.
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
(ASD)
(LRFD)
Eq. C3.1.3-1
b = 1.67
b = 0.90
Where,
= Nominal Flexural Strength (Resistance)
Mn
Se
= Elastic Section Modulus of effective section at extreme fiber.
Fy
= Yield Stress
For continuous spans,
R
= 0.60 for C-sections,
R
= 0.70 for Z-sections.
For simple spans, R is given in Table below,
Depth (mm)
Profile
R
<= 165
C or Z
0.70
165 < D <= 216
C or Z
0.65
216 < D <= 292
Z
0.50
216 < D <= 292
C
0.40
There are 15 conditions that should be satisfied in order to apply the above
clause, See AISI Specification section C3.1.3 for more information.
Beams (C or Z Section) Having One Flange Fastened to a Standing Seam
Roof System
If the flange of a supporting beam is fastened to a standing seam roof system,
the bending strength generally lies between that for a fully braced member
and an unbraced member. The strength depends on the details of the system,
as well as whether the loading is gravity or uplift, and cannot be readily
calculated. Therefore, the AISI 2001Specification allows the nominal strength
to be calculated by Eq. C3.1.3-1, but with the reduction factor R shall be
determined by representative tests of the system. Test specimens and
procedures are detailed in the Base Test Method given in the AISI Manual.
Alternatively, the strength may be determined using the discrete point bracing
and the provisions of section C3.1.2.1
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
2-12 mm
HSB
D E S I G N
4-12 mm
HSB
TIE MEMBER
WITH SDS
PURLIN
6 mm THK. PL.
RAFTER
TOP FLANGE
3 mm WELD
144 mm LG.
200
DETAIL # 01
DETAIL # 02
DETAIL # 03
CAPACITY = 19 kN
CAPACITY = 38 kN
CAPACITY = 77 kN
= Grade 8.8
= 12 mm
= 2 for Detail 01
= 4 for Detail 02 & 03
= 3 mm
= 144.69 N/mm2
= 150 mm
= 6 mm
= 150 3 x 2 = 144 mm
Capacity of 2 x 12 mm in shear
Capacity of 4 x 12 mm in shear
= 2 x 18.10
= 4 x 18.10
Capacity of 3 mm Weld
= 36.20 kN
= 72.40 kN
= 19.44 kN
= 38.88 kN
= 77.76 kN
10
= 19.44 kN
= 38.88 kN
= 155.5 kN
for Detail # 01
for Detail # 02
for Detail # 03
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Framing Type
Continuous Bypass, can be simply supported Flush
Continuous Bypass, can be simply supported Flush
Simply supported Flush, can be Continuous Bypass
Type
1
2
3
Short
Continuous
Long
Lap on each
Design
Total Lap
side
Lap*
(mm)
(mm)
(mm)
95 mm
190 mm
100 mm
375 mm
750 mm
660 mm
705 mm
1410 mm
1320 mm
Design Lap* = Total Lap 2 x 45
Bay
Spacing
Range (m)
<6
6 to 8
>8
Connection Bolts
All bolts used for connection of purlin at the lap and to welded plate on the
rafter / column are 12 mm diameter HSB Gr. 8.8. Grade of bolt is subject to
change based on availability and management decision.
11
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
DETAIL # 01
DETAIL # 03
DETAIL # 02
12
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
In braced bays the eave purlin also acts as strut member in bracing
truss for accumulated roof bracing loads and transfer these to sidewall
bracing.
Eave purlin may be considered laterally restraint and fully supported by roof
sheeting, and partially restrained by the wall sheeting through the eave angle
connection. The wall sheeting is considered to provide full support for eave
purlin against vertical deflections in the following cases,
Fully sheeted walls, where the wall sheeting is resting on ground slab
or beam
Partially sheeted walls with block wall underneath where the bottom
girt or base angle is resting on the block wall.
For portion of framed opening width, not exceed half the bay spacing, in fully
sheeted walls, eave purlin may be considered as supported.
For other cases where the walls are partially sheeted from eave to some height
above ground and open for access, adequate proper sag rod arrangement shall
be provide with flayed sag rods at the top to carry the weight of the sheeting.
Section Properties and Capacities
The section properties and capacities of all available cold formed Sections are
tabulated in the following tables. These may be calculated manually as per
AISI Manual 2001 Section 3, the properties and capacities in the tables are
calculated using RSG Software (CFS Version 4.14).
13
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Z Section Properties
ASD
Design Mode =
v =
1.60
c =
1.80
b =
1.67
t =
1.67
15
Depth
Section
thickness
Depth
mm
WTp=WBt
mm
Thk
mm
Lip
mm
Rad
mm
Angle
deg
cm 2
Wt
kg/m
Yd
mm
Coil Width
mm
200Z15
200
60
1.5
18.494
60
5.175
4.06
100
345
200Z18
200
60
1.8
19.048
60
6.210
4.87
100
345
200Z20
200
60
2.0
19.417
60
6.900
5.42
100
345
200Z25
200
60
2.5
20.340
60
8.625
6.77
100
345
250Z20
250
60
2.0
18.917
60
7.880
6.19
125
394
250Z25
250
60
2.5
19.840
60
9.850
7.73
125
394
Section
Ixx
Rxx
mm
IycTop=Bot
Ryy
mm
Cw
Section Data
Section
SxTop=Bot
4
mm
Area
Syy
mm
Torsional Constants
mm
mm 4
Ro
mm
200Z15
3.06E+06
30598
76.89
2.07E+05
6035
28.26
3.02E+09
388.14
81.92
200Z18
3.66E+06
36591
76.76
2.49E+05
7268
28.34
3.64E+09
670.70
81.83
200Z20
4.06E+06
40562
76.67
2.78E+05
8095
28.39
4.05E+09
920.03
81.76
200Z25
5.04E+06
50403
76.45
3.51E+05
10178
28.52
5.11E+09
1796.94
81.59
250Z20
6.89E+06
55109
93.50
2.74E+05
7991
26.35
6.51E+09
1050.70
97.14
250Z25
8.57E+06
68587
93.30
3.45E+05
10049
26.47
8.20E+09
2052.14
96.98
Section
Vay
Vax
Maxo
Maxo1*
Maxo2
Mayo
Pao
Ta
200Z15
11.19
18.68
5.68
3.98
3.70
1.10
55.83
106.83
200Z18
19.40
22.20
7.25
5.07
4.71
1.50
76.41
128.20
200Z20
26.68
24.50
8.23
5.76
5.35
1.67
90.66
142.44
200Z25
45.35
30.12
10.41
7.28
6.76
2.10
125.18
178.05
250Z20
20.98
24.50
10.33
7.23
5.17
1.65
90.36
162.67
250Z25
41.14
30.12
13.80
9.66
6.90
2.08
126.34
203.34
14
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
M-Sections (TMCP)
M-Sections are latest addition to Mammut range of cold formed sections.
These sections are basically C shaped 356 mm deep, with large stiffened
openings in the webs along the length of the sections and longitudinal ribs in
the web and flanges for stiffening. These are referred as 360M section in
order to keep the steel line as a rounded value of 360 mm from outside flange
face. These may be used as purlins or girts for long bay spacings (more than 10
meters). Coil width of 540 mm is required to roll these M sections.
Table 16.5 Framing
Sr. No.
Location
Framing Type
1
Roof
Continuous# Bypass, can be simply supported Flush
2
Sidewall
Continuous# Bypass, can be simply supported Flush
Currently we are unable to fabricate TMCP Section, Hence this sections is not3
Endwall*
Simply supported Flush, can be Continuous Bypass
applicable
* - Not used at end walls very often, Z-sections are used instead.
# - Continuity is achieved by using a connector section back to back.
Table 16.6 Type of Laps
Sr.
No.
Type
1
2
3
Continuous
Long
Big
Lap on each
Design
Total Lap
side
Lap*
(mm)
(mm)
(mm)
405 mm
810 mm
720 mm
710 mm
1420 mm
1330 mm
1015 mm
2030 mm
1940 mm
Design Lap* = Total Lap 2 x 45
Bay
Spacing
Range (m)
<= 10
10 to 12
> 12
15
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
The punching pattern of the M-Purlin is so programmed that the first 3 oval
holes are always spaced at a distance of 305 mm from either ends, and the
balance is equally divided depending upon the length.
Example:If,
L = is the bay spacing between which M purlin will span.
Then,
No. of spacing of holes
= (L 2 x 965) / 305 (Rounded to lower side)
Where, 965 is the sum of (5 + 45 + 3 x 305)
5 = the distance of purlin end from bay center line
45 = the distance of first 18 dia hole from purlin edge.
305 = the spacing between the first 3 holes.
Currently we are unable to fabricate TMCP Section, Hence this sections is notHence the minimum length = 965 x 2 = 1930 mm.
applicable
Say bay spacing L = 11890 mm
Then no. of holes
= (11890 2 x 965) / 305
= 32.65 ~ 32
Spacing of holes
= (11890 2 x 965) / 32
= 311.25 mm
Therefore,
Total number of holes = 32 + 3 x 2
= 38 Oval holes
Spacing of holes
= 45 + 3 @ 305 + 32 @ 311.25 + 3 @ 305 + 45
= 11880 + 5 + 5
= 11890 mm
16
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Connection Bolts
All bolts used for connection of purlin at the lap and to welded plate on the
rafter / column are 16 mm diameter HSB Gr. 8.8. Grade of bolt is subject to
change based on availability and management decision.
Currently we are unable to fabricate TMCP Section, Hence this sections is notapplicable
General
M sections of any dimension can be produced on the TMCP machine, with
following limitations, but these will require coils of different widths.
Table 16.4 Section Profile on TMCP Machine
Dimension
Minimum (mm)
Maximum (mm)
Web depth
92
356
Flange width
41
76
Lip length
NA
25
Thickness
0.8
3.0
Minimum Length = 1930 mm
NA - Denotes that the sections may be without lip (Open C or Stud)
M Sections when used as Jambs and Headers for framed opening can be
rolled with out the large holes.
17
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
200
TIE MEMBER
WITH SDS
PURLIN
2-16 mm
HSB
2-16 mm
HSB
6 mm THK. PL.
RAFTER
TOP FLANGE
3 mm WELD
169 mm LG.
DETAIL # 01
DETAIL # 02
DETAIL # 03
CAPACITY = 31 kN
CAPACITY = 51 kN
CAPACITY = 82 kN
Currently we are unable to fabricate TMCP Section, Hence this sections is notCheck Connection Capacity
applicable
Bolt Grade
Bolt Size
No. of Bolts
Weld Size
Allowable Stress in weld E70XX
Length of plate
Thickness of Plate
Length of Weld
= Grade 8.8
= 16 mm
= 2 for Detail 01 (Single Shear)
= 2 for Detail 02 (Double Shear)
= 3 mm
= 144.69 N/mm2
= 175 mm
= 6 mm
= 175 3 x 2 = 169 mm
Capacity of 2 x 16 mm in shear
Capacity of 2 x 16 mm in shear
= 2 x 32.17
= 2 x 32.17 x 2
Capacity of 3 mm Weld
= 31.10 kN
for Detail # 01
= 51.86 kN
for Detail # 02
Capacity for Detail 03 is sum of Detail 01 and 02, hence
31.10 + 51.86 = 82.96 kN
for Detail # 03
18
= 64.36 kN
= 128.7 kN
= 31.10 kN
= 62.20 kN
= 103.68 kN
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Design Mode =
ASD
v =
1.60
c =
1.80
b =
1.67
t =
1.67
Lip
Rad
Yd
Depth
18
Depth
X
S.C
X
C.G
Thk.
Lip
Y
WBp
Section thickness
Section Data
Section
Depth
mm
WTp=WBt
mm
Thk
mm
Lip
mm
Rad
mm
Angle
deg
360M18
356
76
1.8
22.429
2.39
360M20
356
76
2.0
22.915
2.39
Section
Ixx
SxTop=Bot
IycTop=Bot
Syy
mm 4
mm 3
Rxx
mm
mm 4
Area
cm 2
Wt
kg/m
Yd
mm
Coil Width
mm
90
9.720
7.63
178
540
90
10.800
8.48
178
540
Cw
mm 3
Ryy
mm
mm 6
mm 4
Ro
mm
Torsional Constants
360M18
1.70E+07
95647
131.76
3.03E+05
10073
24.88
1.47E+10
1058
140.47
360M20
1.93E+07
108548
153.14
3.26E+05
10330
28.14
1.83E+10
1440
141.31
Section
Vay
Vax
Maxo
Maxo1*
Maxo2
Mayo
Pao
Ta
360M18
15.46
17.82
16.83
10.10
6.73
1.73
73.99
217.17
360M20
21.21
19.64
19.33
11.60
7.73
1.94
87.10
242.14
19
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Example 1
Consider a building with 8 bays; spaced at 6500 + 6 @ 7500 + 6500
Loads are as listed below,
Dead Load
Live Load
Wind pressure
Purlin Spacing
= 0.10 kN/m2
= 0.60 kN/m2
= 0.90 kN/m2
= 2.00 meters.
Hence the uniformly distributed load due to Dead + Live (DL+LL) is,
= Purlin Spacing x (Dead Load + Live Load)
For ASD
= 2.00 x (0.10 + 0.60)
= 1.40 kN/m
Currently For
we LRFD
are unable to fabricate
this sections
not= 2.00TMCP
x (1.20Section,
x 0.10 + Hence
1.6 x 0.60)
= 2.16iskN/m
applicable
Similarly, the uniformly distributed load due to Dead + Wind (DL+WL) is,
= Purlin Spacing x (Dead Load - Wind Load)
Where, wind load
= wind pressure x coefficient,
As per MBMA 2002 the coefficients are as below,
End Zone
= 1.28
Interior Zone
= 1.08
Therefore the loads are,
End Zone or spans
For ASD
= 2.00 x (0.60 x 0.10 - 0.90 x 1.28)
= -2.18 kN/m
For LRFD
= 2.00 x (0.90 x 0.10 1.6 x 0.9 x 1.28) = -3.51 kN/m
Interior Zone or spans
For ASD
= 2.00 x (0.60 x 0.10 - 0.90 x 1.08)
= -1.82 kN/m
For LRFD
= 2.00 x (0.90 x 0.10 1.6 x 0.9 x 1.08) = -2.93 kN/m
The spans, lap length, loading, shear force, shear at lap location, bending
moments at mid span and lap location and reactions for both gravity and wind
load is as shown below, note that only ASD loading and forces are shown.
Let us use a trail section 200Z25 at end bays and 200Z18 in interior bays.
Only the first and last laps are long laps, other laps are continuous.
20
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
1.40 kN/m
DL+LL
LAP LENGTH
SPANS
705
(TYPICAL)
375
375
375
6500
7500
5.31
7500
5.23
7500
5.26
375
7500
5.24
7500
5.27
705
7500
6500
5.19
5.61
3.49
SHEAR FORCE
DIAGRAM
3.49
4.31
4.33
4.32
4.34
5.31
4.69
4.27
0.00
SHEAR FORCE
AT LAP LOCATION
0.00
-4.69
-4.34
-4.27
-4.32
-4.33
-4.31
-4.39
REACTIONS
3.49
10.92
10.42
10.52
10.49
10.52
10.42
10.92
-6.91
-6.47
-6.59
-6.55
-6.47
-6.91
-6.91
3.49
SUPPORT MOMENT
BENDING MOMENT
DIAGRAM
4.34
3.15
3.31
3.27
3.27
3.31
3.15
4.34
MIDSPAN MOMENT
-3.71
-3.51
-3.35
-3.32
-3.42
-3.43
-3.39
-3.43
-3.39
21
-3.42
-3.32
-3.35
-3.71
-3.51
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Section Capacities.
Referring the properties table for Z section,
Sections
200Z18
200Z25
Shear (kN)
19.40
45.35
Moment (kNm)
7.25
10.41
I xx (mm4)
3.66 x 106
5.04 x 106
= 0.08
at midto
span
= 4.340Hence
kNm this sections is notCurrently Moment
we are unable
fabricate TMCP Section,
Moment Capacity for Z25applicable = 10.41 kNm
(Compression flange fully braced)
Stress Ratio
= 4.34 / 10.41 = 0.417
= 0.42
Shear at right lap
Shear capacity for Z25
Stress Ratio
Moment at right lap
Moment capacity for Z25
Stress Ratio
= 4.690 kN
= 45.35 kN
= 4.69 / 45.35 = 0.103
= 3.510 kNm
= 10.41 kNm
= 3.51 / 10.41 = 0.337
= 0.10
= 0.34
= 5.610 kN
= 45.35 + 19.40
= 5.610 / 64.75 = 0.0866
= 6.910 kNm
= 10.41 + 7.25
= 6.91 / 17.60 = 0.391
= 64.75 kN
= 0.09
= 17.6 kNm
= 0.39
= 0.16
22
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
23
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Second Span
Shear at right of left support
Shear capacity for Z25+Z18
Stress Ratio
Moment at left support
Moment capacity for Z25+Z18
Stress Ratio
= 5.310 kN
= 45.35 + 19.40
= 5.310 / 64.75 = 0.0866
= 6.910 kNm
= 10.41 + 7.25
= 6.91 / 17.60 = 0.391
= 64.75 kN
= 0.08
= 17.6 kNm
= 0.39
= 0.16
= 0.31
= 3.150 kNm
= 7.250 kNm
= 4.27 kN
= 19.40 kN
= 4.27 / 19.40 = 0.220
= 3.35 kNm
= 7.25 kNm
= 3.35 / 7.25 = 0.462
= 3.15 / 7.25
= 0.434
= 0.43
= 0.22
= 0.46
= 0.26
24
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
LAP LENGTH
SPANS
705
-1.82 kN/m
(TYPICAL)
375
375
375
6500
-2.18 kN/m
7500
7500
8.59
7500
6.61
375
7500
6.88
6.81
7500
6.84
705
7500
6500
7.04
6.77
5.58
SHEAR FORCE
DIAGRAM
-5.58
Currently we are unable to fabricate TMCP Section, Hence this sections is not-7.04applicable
-6.77
-6.84
-6.81
-6.88
-6.61
7.15
6.01
6.28
6.24
6.21
-8.59
6.17
5.84
5.58
SHEAR FORCE
AT LAP LOCATION
-5.58
-5.84
-6.17
-6.24
-6.28
-6.21
-7.15
-6.01
REACTIONS
-5.58
-15.63
-13.73
-13.38
-13.61
-13.38
-13.73
-15.63
-5.58
MIDSPAN MOMENT
BENDING MOMENT
DIAGRAM
-7.14
-3.82
9.79
-4.39
-4.24
-4.24
8.63
8.19
8.48
-4.39
-3.82
8.19
8.63
-7.14
9.79
SUPPORT MOMENT
MOMENTS AT
LOCATIONS
4.59
6.11
5.54
6.46
6.06
6.34
6.47
6.47
6.34
25
6.06
6.46
5.54
6.11
4.59
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
= 0.12
= 0.16
= 0.44
= 8.59 kN
= 45.35 + 19.40
= 8.59 / 64.75 = 0.133
= 9.790 kNm
= 10.41 + 7.25
= 9.79 / 17.60 = 0.556
= 64.75 kN
= 0.13
= 17.6 kNm
= 0.55
= 0.32
26
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Second Span
Shear at right of left support
Shear capacity for Z25+Z18
Stress Ratio
Moment at left support
Moment capacity for Z25+Z18
Stress Ratio
= 7.04 kN
= 45.35 + 19.40
= 7.04 / 64.75 = 0.108
= 9.790 kNm
= 10.41 + 7.25
= 9.79 / 17.60 = 0.522
= 64.75 kN
= 0.10
= 17.6 kNm
= 0.55
= 0.31
= 0.66
= 6.01 kN
= 19.40 kN
= 6.01 / 19.40 = 0.309
= 6.11 kNm
= 7.25 kNm
= 6.11 / 7.25 = 0.843
= 0.31
= 0.84
= 0.74
27
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Note:- If sag rods are used and the allowable un braced length of a given
section is more than the actual un braced length, then full section capacity is
used. Otherwise the reduction factor as below are used,
If,
Where,
Lc
0.75
Lc
<=
<
>
0.75
Lc
1.00
Lc
Lu
=
=
<=
1.00
R = 0.70
R = 0.85
R = 1.00
Section
200Z15
200Z18
200Z20
200Z25
250Z20
250Z25
Deflections
First Span
DL+LL
DL+WL
Second Span
DL+LL
= Span / 180 = 7500 / 180
DL+WL
28
= 36.11 mm
Actual
= 54.16 mm
Actual
= 3.61 cm
= 1.38 cm
= 5.42 cm
= 2.39 cm
= 41.67 mm
Actual
= 62.50 mm
Actual
= 4.17 cm
= 1.41 cm
= 6.25 cm
= 1.56 cm
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Sag Rods
Welded Plate
No
3
Yes
Liner
Design
12
No
ASD
Total Weight
Deflection Limit (Gravity Loads)
Deflection Limit (Wind Load)
342.14
180
120
Kgs.
DL+ LL
DL+WL
kN/m
kN/m
Purlin Sizes
Purlin Lap
Wind Increase
6.50
7.50
6.50
1.40
1.40
1.40
1.40
1.40
1.40
1.40
-2.18
-1.82
-1.82
-1.82
-1.82
-1.82
-1.82
The above values are calculated by adding the loads and multiplying by the purlin spacing.
1.40
-2.18
200Z25
L
7.50
200Z18
C
7.50
7.50
7.50
7.50
1
1
1
1
1
1
200Z18
200Z18
200Z18
200Z18
200Z18
200Z25
C
C
C
C
L
C= Continous lap 375 mm each side. L= Long lap 705 mm each side.
1.00
By Structrural analysis using Stiffness Matrix Analysis the following Internal Forces are obtained
** DL+LL
Moment-Left Support
Moment-Left Lap
Moment-Mid Span
Moment-Right Lap
Shear-Left Lap
Shear-Right Lap
** DL+WL
Moment-Left Support
Moment-Left Lap
Moment-Mid Span
Moment-Right Lap
Shear-Left Lap
Shear-Right Lap
kN.m
kN.m
kN.m
kN.m
0.00
0.00
4.34
-3.51
-6.91
-3.71
3.15
-4.83
-6.47
-4.82
3.31
-4.93
-6.59
-4.93
3.27
-4.89
-6.55
-4.89
3.27
-4.93
-6.59
-4.93
3.31
-4.82
-6.47
-4.83
3.15
-3.71
-6.91
-3.51
4.34
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
kN
kN
3.49
-4.69
4.39
-4.73
4.77
-4.80
4.79
-4.78
4.78
-4.79
4.80
-4.77
4.73
-4.39
4.69
-3.49
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
kN.m
kN.m
kN.m
kN.m
0.00
0.00
-7.14
4.59
9.79
5.54
-3.82
6.11
8.19
6.06
-4.39
6.46
8.63
6.47
-4.24
6.34
8.48
6.34
-4.24
6.47
8.63
6.46
-4.39
6.06
8.19
6.11
-3.82
5.54
9.79
4.59
-7.14
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
kN
kN
-5.58
7.15
-5.84
6.01
-6.17
6.28
-6.24
6.21
-6.21
6.24
-6.28
6.17
-6.01
5.84
-7.15
5.58
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
** DL+LL
Left Support
Left Lap
Mid Span
Right Lap
0.08
0.08
0.42
0.34
0.39
0.51
0.43
0.67
0.45
0.66
0.46
0.68
0.45
0.68
0.45
0.67
0.45
0.67
0.45
0.68
0.45
0.68
0.46
0.66
0.45
0.67
0.43
0.51
0.39
0.34
0.42
0.08
0.08
Deflection Cm
Allowable Cm
1.38
3.61
1.41
4.17
1.56
4.17
1.52
4.17
1.52
4.17
1.56
4.17
1.41
4.17
1.38
3.61
0.00
0.12
0.12
0.98
0.44
0.00
2.39
5.42
0.55
0.76
0.75
0.84
0.00
1.56
6.25
0.56
0.83
0.86
0.90
0.00
2.10
6.25
0.59
0.90
0.83
0.87
0.00
1.97
6.25
0.58
0.87
0.83
0.90
0.00
1.97
6.25
0.59
0.90
0.86
0.83
0.00
2.10
6.25
0.56
0.84
0.75
0.76
0.00
1.56
6.25
0.55
0.44
0.98
0.12
0.00
2.39
5.42
0.12
** DL+WL
Left Support
Left Lap
Mid Span
Right Lap
Deflection Cm
Allowable Cm
-Ve
-Ve
All Stress Ratios as per above are less than 1.0 - Use Sizes as given above.
Last Revised on 29-Jul-2007
29
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
0
1.4
os
xc
26
1.4
N/ m
6k
2
.
1
s
0x
in 2
.6 1
=0
26
kN
/m
The UDL due to DL+LL is resolved parallel purlin web and along the slope as
shown above. The value parallel to purlin web should be entered in the purlin
design sheet. (See purlin design sheet on the following page).
Since there are no sag rods, minor axis bending is applicable for full span.
Maximum Mid span moment due to vertical (major axis load)
End Span
= 3.91 kNm
Interior Span = 2.98 kNm
Hence the moments due to minor axis load can be calculated as below,
End Span
= 3.91 x 0.61 / 1.26
= 1.89 kNm
Interior Span = 2.98 x 0.61 / 1.26
= 1.44 kNm
30
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
Sag Rods
D E S I G N
Welded Plate
No
3
Yes
6.50
7.50
Liner
Design
12
No
ASD
Total Weight
Deflection Limit (Gravity Loads)
Deflection Limit (Wind Load)
342.14
180
120
Kgs.
DL+LL
DL+WL
kN/m
kN/m
Purlin Sizes
Purlin Lap
Wind Increase
7.50
6.50
1.26
1.26
1.26
1.26
1.26
1.26
1.26
-2.01
-1.74
-1.74
-1.74
-1.74
-1.74
-1.74
The above values are calculated by adding the loads and multiplying by the purlin spacing.
1.26
-2.01
200Z25
L
200Z18
C
7.50
7.50
7.50
7.50
1
1
1
1
1
1
200Z18
200Z18
200Z18
200Z18
200Z25
200Z18
C
C
C
C
L
C= Continous lap 375 mm each side. L= Long lap 705 mm each side.
1.00
By Structrural analysis using Stiffness Matrix Analysis the following Internal Forces are obtained
** DL+LL
Moment-Left Support
Moment-Left Lap
Moment-Mid Span
Moment-Right Lap
Shear-Left Lap
Shear-Right Lap
** DL+WL
Moment-Left Support
Moment-Left Lap
Moment-Mid Span
Moment-Right Lap
Shear-Left Lap
Shear-Right Lap
kN.m
kN.m
kN.m
kN.m
0.00
0.00
3.91
-3.16
-6.22
-3.34
2.84
-4.35
-5.82
-4.34
2.98
-4.44
-5.93
-4.44
2.95
-4.41
-5.89
-4.41
2.95
-4.44
-5.93
-4.44
2.98
-4.34
-5.82
-4.35
2.84
-3.34
-6.22
-3.16
3.91
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
kN
kN
3.14
-4.22
3.95
-4.26
4.29
-4.32
4.31
-4.30
4.30
-4.31
4.32
-4.29
4.26
-3.95
4.22
-3.14
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
kN.m
kN.m
kN.m
kN.m
0.00
0.00
-6.52
4.38
9.19
5.15
-3.71
5.88
7.88
5.83
-4.18
6.16
8.24
6.17
-4.06
6.06
8.12
6.06
-4.06
6.17
8.24
6.16
-4.18
5.83
7.88
5.88
-3.71
5.15
9.19
4.38
-6.52
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
kN
kN
-5.12
6.62
-5.55
5.78
-5.90
6.00
-5.97
5.93
-5.93
5.97
-6.00
5.90
-5.78
5.55
-6.62
5.12
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
** DL+LL
Left Support
Left Lap
Mid Span
Right Lap
0.07
0.07
0.37
0.30
0.35
0.46
0.39
0.60
0.40
0.60
0.41
0.61
0.41
0.61
0.41
0.61
0.41
0.61
0.41
0.61
0.41
0.61
0.41
0.60
0.40
0.60
0.39
0.46
0.35
0.30
0.37
0.07
0.07
Deflection Cm
Allowable Cm
1.24
3.61
1.27
4.17
1.41
4.17
1.37
4.17
1.37
4.17
1.41
4.17
1.27
4.17
1.24
3.61
0.00
0.11
0.11
0.89
0.42
0.00
2.16
5.42
0.52
0.71
0.73
0.81
0.00
1.55
6.25
0.54
0.80
0.82
0.85
0.00
1.99
6.25
0.57
0.85
0.80
0.84
0.00
1.88
6.25
0.56
0.84
0.80
0.85
0.00
1.88
6.25
0.57
0.85
0.82
0.80
0.00
1.99
6.25
0.54
0.81
0.73
0.71
0.00
1.55
6.25
0.52
0.42
0.89
0.11
0.00
2.16
5.42
0.11
** DL+WL
Left Support
Left Lap
Mid Span
Right Lap
Deflection Cm
Allowable Cm
-Ve
-Ve
All Stress Ratios as per above are less than 1.0 - Use Sizes as given above.
Last Revised on 29-Jul-2007
31
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Since the top flange is attached to sheeting at every +/- 250 mm or so, it can be
considered as fully braced and use the full section capacity for minor axis
bending.
Referring to property table for Z Section we can see the allowable moment
capacities in minor axis direction are,
200Z18
= 1.50 kNm
200Z25
= 2.10 kNm
Therefore, the stress ratios are,
End Span
= 1.89 / 2.10
Interior Span = 1.44 / 1.50
= 0.90
= 0.96
Referring the major axis stress ratios from purlin design sheet we know,
End Span
= 0.37
Interior Span = 0.39
Hence the combined stress ratio is,
End Span
= 0.90 + 0.37
Interior Span = 0.96 + 0.39
Since the combined ratios are exceeding unity, the following alternatives can
be checked with,
1. Reduced purlin spacing.
2. Increase purlin section.
3. Add sag rod.
We will add 2 rows of sag rods in each bay, conservatively assuming minor
axis moment as (wl2/10), where, l is the span of purlin between the sag rods,
therefore the minor axis moment,
End Span
= 0.61 x (6.5/3)2 / 10 = 0.286
Interior Span = 0.61 x (7.5/3)2 / 10 = 0.381
Therefore, the stress ratios are,
End Span
= 0.286 / 2.10 = 0.136
Interior Span = 0.381 / 1.50 = 0.254
Hence the combined stress ratio is,
End Span
= 0.14 + 0.37
Interior Span = 0.25 + 0.39
32
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
RAFTER
SUPPORT
RAFTER
SUPPORT
MINOR AXIS BENDING
WITHOUT SAG ROD
RAFTER
SUPPORT
SAGROD
SUPPORT
(TYP)
RAFTER
SUPPORT
The sagrod is acting as support for minor axis bending; hence there is a
reaction force in the sag rod. In the example above the reaction can be
conservatively calculated as below,
End Span
= 0.61 x (6.50 / 3)
= 1.32 kN
Interior Span = 0.61 x (7.50 / 3)
= 1.52 kN
Say if we have 8 rows of purlins, and assuming each sag rod reaction force as
above, although it will vary with the tributary load.
Then the total force in the sag rod at ridge,
End Span
T
= 1.32 x 8
= 10.56 kN
Interior Span T
= 1.52 x 8
= 12.48 kN
If the roof is symmetrical about the ridge, the total force T is taken as tension
in the ridge sag rod. Say if we are using 12 mm diameter sag rod A36 material
the capacity of this sag rod is calculated as,
= 0.75 F u A g /
= 0.75 x 400 x (122 x p / 4) / 2
= 16.96 kN
>
12.48 kN
33
Hence OK
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
If the number of purlins is large or in other words the total force in sag rod T
is greater than the sag rod capacity, flayed or bent sag rod may be provided up
to the location where the sag rod capacity is less than or equal to T. Similarly
for mono slope buildings flayed or bent sag rods may be provided to transfer
the force in sag rod to main frame rafter.
RIDGE LINE
T
T7
T7
T6
T6
T5
T5
T4
T4
T3
T3
T2
T2
T1
T1
PURLINS
(TYP)
SAG RODS
(TYP)
RAFTER
SUPPORT
RAFTER
SUPPORT
EAVE LINE
PURLINS
(TYP)
RAFTER
SUPPORT
RAFTER
SUPPORT
SAG RODS
(TYP)
EAVE LINE
34
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
After deciding the purlin section, the next step is to design the connections.
Connection Design.
Example:- 1
DL+LL
Maximum Reaction at support
= 10.92 kN
DL+WL (V u )
Maximum Reaction at support
= 15.63 kN
The gravity loads are transferred by bolts bearing on the welded plate, we
know that there are 2 sections at the support (Z18+Z18), hence the total
bearing thickness available = 1.8 + 1.8 = 3.6 mm
Strength in Bearing (ASD)
= n ( 2.4 F u d b t p / )
Where,
n
Fu
db
tp
= number of bolts = 2
= Ultimate tensile stress of the purlin material = 450 N/mm2
= Diameter of the connection bolts = 12 mm
= total purlin thickness = 3.6 mm
= 2 x [ 2.4 x 450 x 12 x 3.6 / ( 2 x 1000 ) ]
= 46.66 kN
> 10.92 and 15.63 kN
Vu
R
Va
WELD
PURLIN / GIRT
RAFTER / COLUMN
35
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
= n ( Fv p db2 / 4 )
Where,
Fv
Check one side weld between rafter flange and welded plate (SWC001)
Length of weld L w
Size of weld S w
= length of plate
= 150 mm
= 3 mm
= 0.707 S w x F w x L w x 1.5*
= 0.707 x 3 x 144.69 x 150 x 1.5* / 1000
= 46.03 kN
> 10.92 and 15.63 kN
If axial load (V a ) is present, then the shear and welds should be checked for
the resultant force.
Say, Axial Load (V a )
Therefore, Resultant
= 35 kN
= sqrt (V u 2 + V a 2)
= sqrt (15.632 + 352)
= 38.33 kN
Inclination of Resultant ()
= 24.06
Strength of weld
Hence we see that the welds are ok, but the shear capacity of 2 bolts is
insufficient, therefore we should provide a 4 bolt connection using SWC002
plate.
Note:- * - Directional Increase with = 90, See equation J2-5 of AISC 05
36
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
= 10.47 kN
= 14.83 kN
(Governs)
LEVER ARM
Vb
Vb
WELD
Mu
PURLIN / GIRT
RAFTER / COLUMN
37
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Example 2
Consider a building with 8 bays; spaced at 9000 + 6 @ 12000 + 9000
Loads are as listed below,
Dead Load
Live Load
Wind pressure
Purlin Spacing
= 0.10 kN/m2
= 0.60 kN/m2
= 0.90 kN/m2
= 2.00 meters.
Hence the uniformly distributed load due to Dead + Live (DL+LL) is,
= Purlin Spacing x (Dead Load + Live Load)
For ASD
= 2.00 x (0.10 + 0.60)
= 1.40 kN/m
For LRFD
= 2.00 x (1.20 x 0.10 + 1.6 x 0.60)
= 2.16 kN/m
Similarly, the uniformly distributed load due to Dead + Wind (DL+WL) is,
= Purlin Spacing x (Dead Load - Wind Load)
Where, wind load
= wind pressure x coefficient,
As per MBMA 2002 the coefficients are as below,
End Zone
= 1.28
Interior Zone
= 1.08
Therefore the loads are,
End Zone or spans
For ASD
= 2.00 x (0.60 x 0.10 - 0.90 x 1.28)
= -2.18 kN/m
For LRFD
= 2.00 x (0.90 x 0.10 1.6 x 0.9 x 1.28) = -3.51 kN/m
Interior Zone or spans
For ASD
= 2.00 x (0.60 x 0.10 - 0.90 x 1.08)
= -1.82 kN/m
For LRFD
= 2.00 x (0.90 x 0.10 1.6 x 0.9 x 1.08) = -2.93 kN/m
The spans, lap length, loading, shear force, shear at lap location, bending
moments at mid span and lap location and reactions for both gravity and wind
load is as shown below, note that only ASD loading and forces are shown.
Let us use a trail section 360M20 at end bays and 360M18 in interior bays.
All laps are long lap 710 mm.
38
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
1.40 kN/m
DL+LL
LAP LENGTH
SPANS
(TYPICAL)
710
710
9000
12000
12000
12000
12000
12000
12000
9000
8.28
8.43
8.39
8.41
8.37
8.52
8.04
8.04
8.52
8.37
8.41
8.39
8.43
8.28
4.56
SHEAR FORCE
DIAGRAM
4.56
7.51
7.35
7.46
7.44
7.49
7.60
7.11
0.00
SHEAR FORCE
AT LAP LOCATION
0.00
-7.11
-7.60
-7.44
-7.49
-7.46
-7.51
-7.35
REACTIONS
4.56
16.33
16.95
16.76
16.82
16.76
16.95
16.33
-15.65
-17.10
-16.71
-16.84
-16.71
-17.10
-15.65
4.56
SUPPORT MOMENT
BENDING MOMENT
DIAGRAM
7.43
8.83
8.29
8.42
8.42
8.29
8.83
-10.49
-11.85
-11.48
-11.60
-11.49
-11.79
7.43
MIDSPAN MOMENT
MOMENTS AT
LOCATIONS
-10.65
-11.79
-11.49
-11.60
-11.48
39
-11.85
-10.49
-10.65
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Section Capacities.
Referring the properties table for M section,
Sections
360M18
360M20
Shear (kN)
22.42
28.96
Moment (kNm)
18.53
21.48
I xx (mm4)
17.45 x 106
19.30 x 106
= 0.16
at mid
span TMCP Section,
= 7.430
kNm
Currently we Moment
are unable
to fabricate
Hence
this sections is notMoment Capacity forapplicable
M20
= 21.48 kNm
(Compression flange fully braced)
= 0.35
Stress Ratio
= 7.43 / 21.48 = 0.346
Shear at right lap
Shear capacity for M20
Stress Ratio
Moment at right lap
Moment capacity for M20
Stress Ratio
= 7.11 kN
= 28.96 kN
= 7.11 / 28.96 = 0.245
= 10.65 kNm
= 21.48 kNm
= 10.65 /21.48 = 0.496
= 0.25
= 0.50
= 8.04 kN
= 28.96+22.42
= 8.04 / 51.38 = 0.156
= 15.65 kNm
= 21.48+18.53
= 15.65 / 40.01 = 0.391
= 51.38 kN
= 0.16
= 40.01kNm
= 0.39
= 0.18
40
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
41
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Second Span
Shear at right of left support
Shear capacity for M20+M18
Stress Ratio
Moment at right support
Moment capacity for M20+M18
Stress Ratio
= 5.310 kN
= 28.96+22.42
= 8.04 / 51.38 = 0.156
= 15.65 kNm
= 21.48+18.53
= 15.65 / 40.01 = 0.391
= 51.38 kN
= 0.16
= 40.01kNm
= 0.39
= 0.18
= 0.43
= 8.83 kNm
= 18.53 kNm
= 7.60 kN
= 22.42 kN
= 7.60 / 22.42 = 0.338
= 11.79 kNm
= 18.53 kNm
= 11.79 /18.53 = 0.636
= 0.48
= 0.34
= 0.64
= 0.52
42
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
-1.82 kN/m
-2.18 kN/m
(TYPICAL)
710
710
LAP LENGTH
9000
SPANS
12000
12.26
12000
11.04
12000
11.04
12000
12000
11.04
11.04
12000
-11.04
11.04
7.36
FORCE
Currently we are uSHEAR
nable
to fabricate TMCP Section, Hence this sections is notDIAGRAM
-7.36
applicable
-11.04
-11.04
10.82
9.83
-11.04
-11.04
9.83
-11.04
-11.04
9.83
9.83
9000
-12.26
9.83
9.83
7.36
SHEAR FORCE
AT LAP LOCATION
-7.36
-9.83
-9.83
-9.83
-9.83
-9.83
-9.83
-10.82
REACTIONS
-7.36
-23.30
-22.08
-22.08
-22.08
-22.08
-22.08
-23.30
-7.36
MIDSPAN MOMENT
BENDING MOMENT
DIAGRAM
-12.41
-11.04
22.08
-11.04
-11.04
22.08
22.08
-11.04
22.08
-11.04
-11.04
22.08
22.08
-12.41
22.08
SUPPORT MOMENT
MOMENTS AT
LOCATIONS
14.46
15.20
15.19
15.19
15.20
15.19
15.19
15.19
15.19
43
15.20
15.19
15.19
15.20
14.46
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
= 0.25
UNBRACED
COMPRESSION FLANGE
POINT OF
CONTRAFLEXURE
Ms
9000
Ra
Rb
Taking moments about point of contra-flexure, since we know the net moment
at this point = 0
Rb x d + Ms = 2.18 d2 / 2
-2.18 d2 / 2 + 12.26 d + 22.08 = 0
+1.09 d2 + 12.26 d + 22.08 = 0
Solving the above quadratic equation, we get, d
Therefore the unbraced length Lb
44
= 2.25 m
= 2250 mm
= 9000 2250 = 6750 mm
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Since there are 2 rows of sag rods, the un braced length is divided into 3
segments, by the 2 sag rods L u
= 6750 / 3
= 2250 mm
The allowable un braced length Lu as per table below for 360M20= 2250 mm
Therefore L c = L u / L b
Lc
0.75
Lc
If,
<=
<
>
0.75
Lc
1.00
<=
1.00
R = 0.60
R = 0.75
R = 1.00
=
L u / Sag Rod Spacing
Where,
Lc
Currently we are unable toLfabricate
P Section,un
Hence
thislength
sections is not= TMC
Allowable
braced
u
applicable
Calculation of L u (AISI 2001 Manual page II-19)
For members bent about the centrodial axis perpendicular to the web,
calculation of lateral buckling strength is unnecessary when the un braced
length is less than 'L u , which results in a critical elastic flexural stress F e , that is
2.78 F y . L u may be calculated as below,
1. For singly, doubly and point symmetric sections:
L u = { G J / 2 C 1 + [ C 2 / C 1 + ( G J / 2 C 1 ) 2 ] 0.5} 0.5
C 1 = 7.72 [ K y F y S f / C b r y ] 2 / AE
C 2 = 2 E C w / k t 2
C b = 1.67 , K t = 0.70
Sr. No.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Section
360M10
360M12
360M15
360M18
360M20
360M25
45
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
= 0.37
= 0.67
= 12.26 kN
= 28.96 + 22.42
= 12.26 / 51.38 = 0.238
= 22.08 kNm
= 21.48 + 18.53
= 22.08 / 40.0 = 0.552
= 51.38 kN
= 0.23
= 40.0 kNm
= 0.55
= 0.35
= 11.04 kN
= 28.96 + 22.42
= 11.03 / 51.38 = 0.215
= 22.08 kNm
= 21.48 + 18.53
= 22.08 / 40.0 = 0.552
= 51.38 kN
= 0.21
= 40.0 kNm
= 0.55
= 0.34
46
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
= 9.83 kN
= 22.42 kN
= 9.83/ 22.42 = 0.438
= 15.19 kNm
= 18.53 kNm
= 0.44
= 0.82
= 0.86
= 9.83 kN
= 22.42 kN
= 9.83 / 22.42 = 0.438
= 15.20 kNm
= 18.53 kNm
= 15.20 / 18.53 = 0.820
= 0.43
= 0.82
= 0.86
DL+WL
= 50.00 mm
Actual
= 75.00 mm
Actual
= 5.00 cm
= 1.02 cm
= 7.50 cm
= 1.87 cm
Second Span
DL+LL
= Span / 180 = 12000 / 180 = 66.67 mm
Actual
DL+WL
= Span / 120 = 12000 / 120 = 100.0 mm
Actual
= 6.67 cm
= 2.31 cm
= 10.0 cm
= 2.76 cm
47
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
Sag Rods
No. of Rows
Welded Plate
Yes
2
Yes
D E S I G N
Diameter
Liner
12
No
ASD
Design
mm
Total Weight
Deflection Limit (Gravity Loads)
Deflection Limit (Wind Load)
779.47
180
120
Kgs.
9.00
12.00
DL+LL
DL+WL
kN/m
kN/m
1.40
-2.18
1.40
1.40
1.40
1.40
1.40
1.40
1.40
-1.84
-1.84
-1.84
-1.84
-1.84
-1.84
-2.18
The above values are calculated by adding the loads and multiplying by the purlin spacing.
Purlin Sizes
Purlin Lap
Wind Increase
360M20
L
360M18
L
12.00
360M18
L
12.00
1.00
12.00
12.00
12.00
1
1
1
1
360M18
360M18
360M18
360M18
L
L
L
L
L= Long lap 710 mm each side.
9.00
360M20
L
By Structrural analysis using Stiffness Matrix Analysis the following Internal Forces are obtained
** DL+LL
Moment-Left Support
Moment-Left Lap
Moment-Mid Span
Moment-Right Lap
kN.m
kN.m
kN.m
kN.m
** DL+ WL
Moment-Left Support
Moment-Left Lap
Moment-Mid Sp an
Moment-Right Lap
7.43
-10.65
-15.65
-10.49
8.83
-11.79
-17.11
-11.85
8.29
-11.49
-16.71
-11.48
8.42
-11.60
-16.84
-11.60
8.42
-11.48
-16.71
-11.49
8.29
-11.85
-17.11
-11.79
8.83
-10.49
-15.65
-10.65
7.43
kN.m
kN.m
kN.m
kN.m
-12.41
14.46
22.08
15.19
-11.04
15.20
22.08
15.20
-11.04
15.19
22.08
15.19
-11.04
15.19
22.08
15.19
-11.04
15.19
22.08
15.19
-11.04
15.20
22.08
15.20
-11.04
15.19
22.08
14.46
-12.41
kN
kN
-7.36
10.82
-9.83
9.83
-9.83
9.83
-9.83
9.83
-9.83
9.83
-9.83
9.83
-9.83
9.83
-10.82
7.36
Currently
we are
unable
to7.35fabricate
TMCP
Section,
Hence
this7.11sections is notShear-Left Lap
kN
4.56
7.51
7.46
7.49
7.44
7.60
Shear-Right Lap
kN
-7.11
-7.60
-7.44applicable
-7.49
-7.46
-7.51
-7.35
-4.56
Shear-Left Lap
Shear-Right Lap
** DL+LL
Left Support
Left Lap
Mid Span
Right Lap
0.16
0.16
0.35
0.50
0.39
0.57
0.48
0.64
0.46
0.64
0.45
0.62
0.45
0.62
0.45
0.63
0.45
0.63
0.45
0.62
0.45
0.62
0.45
0.64
0.46
0.64
0.48
0.57
0.39
0.50
0.35
0.16
Deflection Cm
Allowable Cm
1.02
5.00
2.31
6.67
2.05
6.67
2.11
6.67
2.11
6.67
2.05
6.67
2.31
6.67
1.02
5.00
** DL+WL
Left Support
Left Lap
Mid Span
Right Lap
0.25
0.25
0.77
0.67
0.55
0.86
0.79
0.86
0.60
0.86
0.79
0.86
0.60
0.86
0.79
0.86
0.60
0.86
0.79
0.86
0.60
0.86
0.79
0.86
0.60
0.86
0.79
0.86
0.55
0.67
0.77
0.25
1.87
7.50
2.76
10.00
2.76
10.00
2.76
10.00
2.76
10.00
2.76
10.00
2.76
10.00
1.87
7.50
Deflection Cm
Allowable Cm
-Ve
-Ve
All Stress Ratios as per above are less than 1.0 - Use Size s as given abo ve.
Last Revised on 21-Jan-2007
48
0.16
0.25
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
= 16.95 kN
DL+WL (V u )
Maximum Reaction at support
= 23.30 kN
Currently we are unable to fabricate TMCP Section, Hence this sections is notThe gravity loads are transferred
by bolts bearing on the welded plate, we
applicable
know that there are 2 sections at the support (M18+M18), hence the total
bearing thickness available = 1.8 + 1.8 = 3.6 mm
Strength in Bearing (ASD)
= n ( 2.4 F u d b t p / )
Where,
n
Fu
db
tp
= number of bolts = 4
= Ultimate tensile stress of the purlin material = 450 N/mm2
= Diameter of the connection bolts = 16 mm
= total purlin thickness = 3.6 mm
= 4 x [ 2.4 x 450 x 16 x 3.6 / ( 2 x 1000 ) ]
= 124.42 kN > 16.95 and 23.30 kN
= n ( Fv p db2 / 4 )
Where,
Fv
49
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Vu
R
Va
WELD
PURLIN / GIRT
RAFTER / COLUMN
Currently we are unable to fabricate TMCP Section, Hence this sections is notapplicable
Check one side weld between rafter flange and welded plate (SWC008)
Length of weld L w
Size of weld S w
= length of plate
= 175 mm
= 3 mm
= 0.707 S w x F w x L w x 1.5*
= 0.707 x 3 x 144.69 x 175 x 1.5* / 1000
= 80.55 kN
> 16.95 and 23.30kN
If axial load (V a ) is present, then the shear and welds should be checked for
the resultant force.
Say, Axial Load (V a )
Therefore, Resultant
= 50 kN
= sqrt (V u 2 + V a 2)
= sqrt (22.242 + 502)
= 54.72 kN
Inclination of Resultant ()
= 23.98
Strength of weld
50
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
LEVER ARM
Vb
Vb
WELD
Mu
PURLIN / GIRT
RAFTER / COLUMN
51
(Governs)
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
C-Sections
These sections are generally used as framed opening jambs and headers. As
required by design single or double C back to back may be used. These are
also used as top and bottom girt in secondary framing of fascias. Single or
double C-sections can also be used as end wall rafters and columns, but at
MBS these are not used due to various municipality requirements of minimum
thickness of primary framing members. 120 mm deep sections are used as
framing members of sliding doors.
Framing
Most commonly simply supported flush connection.
Connection Bolts
All bolts used for connection are 12 mm diameter HSB Gr. 8.8. Grade of bolt is
subject to change based on availability and management decision.
General
1. We are now using the TMCP roll forming machine to produce 200 & 250
mm deep C sections. We are using 2 coil widths for fabricating C-sections,
345 mm coil for 200C15, and 394 mm coil for 200C20, 200C25, 250C20 &
250C25. The flanges and webs of this C section are stiffened with
longitudinal ribs. 200C15 may be used for small framed openings for
windows, louvers etc up to a maximum of 3000 mm long.
2. 250 mm deep C-Sections may be used for framed openings for jambs and
header, when the purlin or girt sections are 250 mm deep. A 394 mm coil is
also used to produce 250 mm deep Z-Sections.
3. C sections of any profile can be produced on the TMCP machine, with
following limitations, but these will require stocks of different coil widths.
Table 16.4 Section Profile on TMCP Machine
Dimension
Minimum (mm)
Maximum (mm)
Web depth
92
356
Flange width
41
76
Lip length
NA
25
Thickness
0.8
2.5
Minimum length = 900 mm
NA - Denotes that sections may be without lip (Open C or Stud)
52
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
ASD
v =
1.60
c =
1.80
b =
1.67
t =
1.67
Depth
Section
thickness
Depth
mm
WTp=WBt
mm
Thk
mm
Lip
mm
Rad
mm
Angle
deg
C.G
S.C
20
Y
Section Data
Section
cm 2
Area
Wt
kg/m
Yd
mm
Coil Width
mm
120C20
120
60
2.0
16.379
2.390
90
5.10
4.00
60
255
200C15
200
65
1.5
13.479
2.390
90
5.18
4.06
100
345
200C20
200
80
2.0
23.059
2.390
90
7.88
6.19
100
394
200C25
200
80
2.5
24.920
2.390
90
9.85
7.73
100
394
250C20
250
60
2.0
18.060
2.390
90
7.88
6.19
125
394
250C25
250
60
2.5
19.919
2.390
90
9.85
7.73
125
394
Section
Ixx
Rxx
mm
IycTop=Bot
Ryy
mm
Cw
SxTop=Bot
4
mm
Syy
mm
Torsional Constants
mm
mm 4
Ro
mm
69.98
120C20
1.19E+06
19816
48.28
1.20E+05
5902
21.65
6.65E+08
680.00
200C15
3.08E+06
30768
77.11
1.21E+05
4885
21.59
1.76E+09
388.00
89.03
200C20
4.95E+06
49523
79.27
3.25E+05
11493
28.71
5.00E+09
1050.70
101.58
200C25
6.15E+06
61487
79.01
4.08E+05
14556
28.79
6.35E+09
2052.00
101.68
250C20
6.87E+06
54942
93.36
1.51E+05
6457
19.56
3.48E+09
1050.07
101.09
250C25
8.55E+06
68373
93.15
1.90E+05
8226
19.66
4.42E+09
2052.00
101.06
Section
Vay
Vax
Maxo
Maxo1*
Maxo2
Mayo
Pao
Ta
120C20
28.78
17.47
4.54
2.72
3.18
1.20
84.04
112.98
200C15
22.01
11.10
5.51
3.30
3.58
0.88
46.59
112.98
200C20
37.77
22.78
9.00
5.40
5.85
2.11
85.44
177.30
200C25
46.59
27.91
11.93
7.16
7.75
2.75
122.29
221.62
250C20
35.88
12.43
11.08
6.65
4.43
1.19
78.17
177.30
250C25
55.97
14.97
16.09
9.65
6.44
1.57
108.29
221.62
53
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Example 3
Design of Framed Opening Header and Jambs
Given:- (Refer sketch below)
Bay Spacing
= 8000 mm
Eave Height
= 9000 mm
Framed Opening Size
= 6000 x 6000
Wind Pressure
= 1.00 kN/m2
Solution:Design of Header
Calculate the effective wind load area, is the greater of,
= 0.5 x 6.0
tributary area of Header
Span x Span / 3
= 6.0 x 6.0 / 3
Hence effective wind load area
= 12.0 m2
= 3.00 m2
= 12.0 m2
Considering an enclosed building and roof slope less than 10, referring table
1.4.6 (a) of MBMA 02, GCp for interior zone is given by,
Inward Pressure ( Pressure) = -0.159 Log A + 1.08
= -0.159 Log 12 + 1.08 = 0.91
Outward Pressure (Suction) = 0.159 Log A - 1.16
= 0.159 Log 12 1.16 = -0.99
Wind Load Pressure
Wind Load Suction
Moment Pressure
Shear Pressure
Moment Suction
Shear Suction
= 0.46 kN/m
= -0.50 kN/m
= 2.07 kNm
= 1.38 kN
= 2.25 kNm
= 1.50 kN
54
(Pressure)
(Suction)
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
M / Maxo2
V / Vay
OK
OK
Suction
M / Maxo
V / Vay
OK
OK
Check Deflection,
Ixx
= 3.08 x 106
mm4
Calculated deflection, suction
= 5 x 0.50 x 1000 x 60004 /(384 x 205000 x 3.08 x 106 x 1000)
= 13.36 mm
= span / 90
= 66.67 mm
= 6000 / 90
OK
500
Allowable deflection
2500
1500
FRAMED OPENING
6000 X 6000
500
6000
500
500
500
8000
55
9000
1500
1500
500
1500
BAY SPACING
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Design of Jambs
For the design of jambs it is important to note the connection detail of the
opening purpose, such as roll up door, sliding door or open for access.
The tributary width in all cases will be different,
Tributary width for Roll Up Door
= (Framed Opening Width / 2 + 0.5)
= (6 / 2 + 0.5)
= 3.5 m
Tributary width for Sliding Door or open for access = 0.5 m
a) Considering, the opening for a Roll-Up Door
Effective wind load area is the greater of,
Tributary area
= 3.5 x 7
Span x Span / 3
=7x7/3
Hence effective wind load area
= 24.5 m2
= 16.3 m2
= 24.5 m2
Considering an enclosed building and roof slope less than 10, referring table
1.4.6 (a) of MBMA 02, GCp for interior zone is given by,
Inward Pressure ( Pressure) = -0.159 Log A + 1.08
= -0.159 Log 24.5 + 1.08 = 0.86
Outward Pressure (Suction) = 0.159 Log A - 1.16
= 0.159 Log 24.5 1.16 = -0.94
Wind Load Pressure
Wind Load Suction
= 3.01 kN/m
= -3.29 kN/m
Jamb is also supporting the header hence we need to consider the reactions
from the header
= 1.38
Pressure
= 1.50
Suction
Loading diagram is as below,
SUCTION
3.29 kN/m
1.50 kN
1.38 kN
500
Rb 11.82 kN
7000
Ra 11.63 kN
Rb 12.91 kN
56
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
2x200C25 are,
= 23.86 kNm (Pressure)
= 15.50 kNm (Suction)
= 93.18 kN
We see the capacities are much below required, even for double C section,
hence hot-rolled or built-up section may be used as jambs for above case.
b) Considering, the opening for a Sliding Door
Designing the door leaf members of size 3 x 6
1) DSD Inner Stile, Span = 1.50 m, Width = 1.50 m
Effective wind load area is the greater of,
Tributary area
= 1.50 x 1.50
= 2.25 m2
= 1.5 x 1.5 / 3
= 0.75 m2
Span x Span / 3
Hence effective wind load area
= 2.25 m2
Considering an enclosed building and roof slope less than 10, referring table
1.4.6 (a) of MBMA 02, GCp for interior zone is given by,
Inward Pressure ( Pressure) = -0.159 Log A + 1.08
= -0.159 Log 2.25 + 1.08 = 1.02
Outward Pressure (Suction) = 0.159 Log A - 1.16
= 0.159 Log 2.25 1.16 = -1.10
Wind Load Pressure
= 1.00 x 1.02 x 1.5
= 1.53 kN/m
Wind Load Suction
= 1.00 x -1.10 x 1.5
= -1.65 kN/m
= 0.43 kNm
Moment Pressure
= 1.53 x 1.52 / 8
= 1.53 x 1.5 / 2
= 1.15 kN
Shear Pressure
2
= 0.46 kNm
Moment Suction
= 1.65 x 1.5 / 8
Shear Suction
= 1.65 x 1.5 / 2
= 1.24 kN
The compression flange is considered laterally braced by the sheeting under
wind pressure loading, hence full moment capacity can be used. Where are for
wind suction loading, the full moment capacity is reduced by applying the
reduction factor R = 0.70
57
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
(Pressure)
(Suction)
M / Maxo2
V / Vay
OK
OK
Suction
M / Maxo
V / Vay
OK
OK
Check Deflection,
mm4
Ixx
= 1.19 x 106
Calculated deflection, suction
= 5 x 1.65 x 1000 x 15004 /(384 x 205000 x 1.19 x 106 x 1000)
= 0.45 mm
Allowable deflection
= span / 90
= 16.67 mm
= 1500 / 90
OK
SUCTION 2.48 kN
2.48 kN
2.48 kN
PRESSURE 2.30 kN
2.30 kN
2.30 kN
Ra 3.45 kN
1500
1500
1500
1500
Rb 3.45 kN
6000
Ra 3.72 kN
Rb 3.72 kN
58
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
Moment Pressure
Shear Pressure
Moment Suction
Shear Suction
= 6.90 kNm
= 3.45 kN
= 7.44 kNm
= 3.72 kN
M / Maxo2
V / Vay
OK
OK
Suction
M / Maxo
V / Vay
OK
OK
Check Deflection,
Ixx
= 2 x 1.19 x 106 mm4
Calculated deflection, suction
= 0.0495 x 2.48 x 1000 x 60003 /( 205000 x 2 x 1.19 x 106)
= 54.34 mm
Allowable deflection
= span / 90
= 66.67 mm
= 6000 / 90
OK
Edge Stile will be similarly designed for half the load of center stile.
59
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
SUCTION 3.72 kN
0.81 kN/m
PRESSURE 3.45 kN
0.75 kN/m
Ra 2.85 kN
1500
Rb 2.85 kN
1500
3000
Ra 3.08 kN
Rb 3.08 kN
60
P U R L I N S
&
G I R T S
D E S I G N
M / Maxo2
V / Vay
OK
OK
Suction
M / Maxo
V / Vay
OK
OK
Check Deflection,
Ixx
= 1.19 x 106
mm4
Calculated deflection, suction
= 5 x 0.81 x 1000 x 30004 /(384 x 205000 x 1.19 x 106 x 1000)
+ 3.72 x 1000 x 30003 /(48 x 205000 x 1.19 x 106)
= 3.50 + 8.58
= 12.08 mm
P
Allowable deflection
= span / 90
= 33.33 mm
= 3000 / 90
OK
Similar check can be made for 250C20 and 250C25 when the girts are 250 mm
deep. And 360M20 for 360 deep girts, note that the jambs and header for 360
deep sections are without the large oval holes.
61
17
Chapter
M E Z Z A N I N E
Mezzanine
Mezzanine literally means an intermediate floor between main floors of a
building. These may be built in steel or concrete or a combination of both.
Generally, joists are cold formed or hot rolled sections, unless built-up sections
are required for heavy loading. The direction of framing (Joist & beams) is
selected based on the most economical solution, usually, the joist span the
shortest direction and beam the other. The beams or joist are connected to the
main frame columns for lateral stability.
If the beams are in the same plane as the main frame, the beams may be rigidly
connected to the main frames for sway control and economical frame. The
beams and joist are designed as simply supported for single story. In case of a
multi-story building the rigidly connected beam is a better and economical
option.
The mezzanine columns may be square tube, hot rolled or built-up section, hot
rolled tube columns are better in all direction and preferred due to
architectural reasons. Tube columns may also be filled with concrete to
increase the axial load bearing capacity.
The floor may consist of metal decking panels filled with concrete or hollow
core slabs or Mammut planks. Joists are not required when Mammut planks
are used. The metal deck panels are galvanized and not designed to carry any
live loads, except the dead weight of concrete during pouring and a working
load of 50 kg/m2. The concrete slab must be designed to carry the service live
loads. Grating and Chequered plates are also used as flooring in industrial
applications.
The clearances above and below the mezzanine should be checked
accurately during estimation stage and end-user informed. It is very
important since any alteration after the final design may affect the overall
economy of the structure compared to quote price.
M E Z Z A N I N E
Some of the possible analytical models are as shown in the sketch below.
Weight ( kN/m2)
0.050
0.069
0.098
Weight (kN/m2)
2.04
2.66
3.29
3.91
4.54
5.16
5.79
M E Z Z A N I N E
Deck Panel
The total load on the deck panel includes the self weight of the panel, weight
of concrete slab plus 50 kg/m2 working load.
M E Z Z A N I N E
Example
Given Data:Mezzanine Deck Panel
Concrete Slab
Floor Finish
Spacing of Joist
Therefore,
Total Dead Load on Joist
= 0.15 + 2.779
= 2.929 kN/m2
Therefore,
UDL on Joist
M E Z Z A N I N E
Table 17.3 Allowable Loads in kN/m2 for 45-150 Galvanized Deck Panel
Panel
Base
Metal
Panel
Nominal
Thickness
Galvanized
Load
Case
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
D+L
11.25
7.20
5.00
3.67
2.81
2.18
1.59
1.20
0.92
0.72
0.58
D+L
12.01
7.69
5.34
3.92
3.00
2.37
1.92
1.59
1.33
1.14
0.98
D+L
15.01
9.61
6.67
4.90
3.75
2.97
2.40
1.98
1.67
1.37
1.09
D+L
16.65
10.66
7.40
5.44
4.16
3.18
2.32
1.74
1.34
1.06
0.85
D+L
16.86
10.79
7.49
5.51
4.22
3.33
2.70
2.23
1.87
1.60
1.38
D+L
21.08
13.49
9.37
6.88
5.27
4.16
3.37
2.79
2.34
1.99
1.60
D+L
23.88
15.29
10.62
7.80
5.97
4.58
3.34
2.51
1.93
1.52
1.22
D+L
23.95
15.33
10.64
7.82
5.99
4.73
3.83
3.17
2.66
2.27
1.95
D+L
29.93
19.16
13.30
9.77
7.48
5.91
4.79
3.96
3.33
2.83
2.29
(mm)
0.50
0.70
1.00
S p a n I n M e t e r s
(Based on Allowable Deflection of Span / 120)
No. of
Spans
Deck Profile
Panel Thk.
(mm)
45-150
0.50
45-150
0.70
Maximum
Spacing (mm)
Number of
Spans
2250
2000
1750
2250
2000
1750
3 or More
3 or More
3 or More
3 or More
3 or More
3 or More
M E Z Z A N I N E
Chequered Plates
Chequered plates are available in various thicknesses and pattern in the
market; only 5.0 mm thick Chequered plates are a standard stock item; other
thicknesses are procured on a job to job basis. Commonly used thicknesses are
5.0, 6.0, and 8.0 mm and tear drop pattern. The grades are A36 or S275JR. Table
below provides allowable loads in various thicknesses for A36 grade.
Table 17.5 Allowable loads on Chequered plate
Allowable loads in kN/m2
Thickness
(mm)
5.00
Weight
(kg/m2)
39.25
No. of
Spans
Span (mm)
500
600
700
800
900
1000
1100
1200
1300
1400
1500
7.09
4.10
2.58
1.73
1.22
0.89
0.67
0.51
0.40
0.32
0.26
13.15
9.13
6.21
4.16
2.92
2.13
1.60
1.23
0.97
0.78
0.63
13.37
7.74
4.87
3.27
2.29
1.67
1.26
0.97
0.76
0.61
0.50
The loads are based on extreme fiber allowable stress of 0.45 F y and deflection
of Span / 150.
Example:- (Validating the above table)
We know the maximum values for single span as below,
Bending moment
Shear
Deflection
= wl2 / 8
= wl / 2
= 5 wl4 / 384 EI
= 0.125 wl2
= 0.50 wl
= 0.013 wl4/EI
The thickness includes the pattern; hence the effective thickness as verified for
5.0 mm thk is 4.7 mm, properties are calculated as below,
Grade
Fy
t
A
I xx
S xx
= A36
= 248 N/mm2
= 4.70 mm
= 4.70 mm2
= bd3/12
= 1.00 x 4.73 / 12
= 2 I xx / t
= 2 x 8.65 / 4.70
= 8.65 mm4 / mm
= 3.68 mm3 / mm
M E Z Z A N I N E
= M / S xx
Therefore,
w
w
= 0.0131 N/mm2
= 13.14 kN/m2
=V/A
0.5 wl / 4.70
Therefore,
w
w
= 1.865 N/mm2
= 1865 kN/m2
= 0.013 wl4/EI =
Therefore,
w
= 7.09 kN/m2
Similarly, the allowable loads are calculated for different span and number of
spans.
M E Z Z A N I N E
Grating
Standard stock size of grating is 30 x 3 @ 41 mm c/c. Which denotes 30 x 3 mm
serrated flat bars spaced at 41 mm c/c and tied along the length by 5.0 mm
square twisted rods at a spacing of 100 mm c/c. The available grades are
S275JR or A36 material.
Table 17.6 Allowable loads on Grating
Weight
(kg/m)
No. of
Spans
Span (mm)
500
30 x 3
17.66
44.55
44.55
55.69
The loads are based on extreme fiber allowable stress of 0.45 F y and deflection
of Span / 150.
Example:- (Validating the above table)
We know the maximum values for single span as below,
Bending moment
Shear
Deflection
= wl2 / 8
= wl / 2
= 5 wl4 / 384 EI
= 0.125 wl2
= 0.50 wl
= 0.013 wl4/EI
The thickness includes the pattern; hence the effective thickness as verified for
5.0 mm thk is 4.7 mm, properties are calculated as below,
Grade
Fy
b
n
A
I xx
S xx
= S275JR
= 275 N/mm2
= 3 mm
d = 30 mm
= number of bars / per meter width = 987 / 41 = 24.07~25
= nbd
= 25 x 30 x 3
= 2250 mm2 / m
= nbd3/12
= 25 x 3.0 x 303 / 12 = 1.68 x 105 mm4 / m
= 2 I xx / d
= 2 x 1.68 x 105 / 30 = 1.12 x 104 mm3 / m
M E Z Z A N I N E
= M / S xx
Therefore,
w
= 44.35 kN/m2
=V/A
0.5 wl / 2250
Therefore,
w
= 990 kN/m2
= 0.013 wl4/EI =
Therefore,
w
= 44.35 kN/m2
Similarly, the allowable loads are calculated for different span and number of
spans.
M E Z Z A N I N E
Mammut Planks
Mammut Planks may be used as alternative flooring for mezzanines; the
characteristic are as below,
1. These are 65 mm thick precast slabs with truss type reinforcement in the
direction of the span.
2. These are always spanning in one direction.
3. The width is up to 2.4 m, and these planks need one prop at every 3.5 m,
until the balance concrete and reinforcement are cast in situ to provide
total thickness of slab.
4. Minimum bearing length of 50 mm is required.
5. Provide standard fin plate SWC-110 at 1200 mm c/c spacing in direction
parallel to the web of the beam. The plate is welded on the top flange of
the beam.
6. The top flange can be considered braced at 1200 mm spacing due the clips,
after the balance concrete is set.
7. Two rods of 10 mm diameter are inserted through the holes of the clip and
may tack welded to hold in position (by erector).
8. The mezzanine beam should be checked for strength with maximum
unbraced length between the strut tube spacing with dead load of 65 mm
thick planks (1.8 kN/m2)
9. The mezzanine beams and joist may also be designed as composite beams
if shear studs are used. This is an economical solution for large loads and
long spans. This may not be advantageous for beams rigidly connected to
main frame columns where negative moment controls the design.
10. The standard shear studs are 2 types, 12 mm dia. x 50 mm long and 19 mm
dia. and 100 mm long.
10
M E Z Z A N I N E
WIDTH AS REQUIRED
WELDED CLIP
@ 1200 mm c/c
1200
150
65
1200
MEZZANINE BEAM
ELEVATION
GROUT
WELDED CLIP
@ 1200 mm c/c
MAMMUT PLANKS
10 mm ROD
MEZZANINE BEAM
GROUT
WELDED CLIP
@ 1200 mm c/c
MAMMUT PLANKS
EDGE ANGLE
MEZZANINE BEAM
11
MAMMUT PLANKS
M E Z Z A N I N E
Span * (mm)
Mammut Plank
Thickness (mm)
1
L<= 3500
2
4000
3
4500
4
5000
5
5500
6
6000
65
7
6500
8
7000
9
7500
10
8000
11
8500
12
9000
* - For a Maximum Live Load = 5.00 kN/m2
Total Slab
thickness
(mm)
130
160
160
180
200
220
220
240
260
280
300
300
Weight
(kN/m2)
3.25
4.00
4.00
4.50
5.00
5.50
6.00
6.00
6.50
7.00
7.50
7.50
Example:Given:Building Width
Bay Spacing
Mezzanine Col. Spacing
Live Load
= 35000 mm
= 6 @ 7500 mm
= 4 @ 8750 mm
= 5.00 kN/m2
Solution:- Alternative 1
Let us span the planks in the shorter direction
i.e. bay spacing
= 7500 mm
Hence the total slab thickness required
= 260 mm
Hence Dead Load of the slab = 6.50 kN/m2
Working load of 50 kg/m2 = 0.50 kN/m2
Therefore, Total Dead Load
= 7.00 kN/m2
Live Load
= 5.00 kN/m2
DL+LL
= 12.0 kN/m2
Total UDL on interior beam = Bay Spacing x Total Load
= 7.50 x 12.0
= 90.0 kN/m
12
M E Z Z A N I N E
13
M E Z Z A N I N E
Thickness (mm)
Weight * (kN/m2)
1
150
2
200
3
265
4
320
5
400
6
500
* - Data from UPC product manual
2.36
3.06
3.94
4.27
4.95
7.07
14
M E Z Z A N I N E
WELDED CLIP
@ 1200 mm c/c
1200
150
1200
MEZZANINE BEAM
ELEVATION
GROUT
WELDED CLIP
@ 1200 mm c/c
10 mm ROD
MEZZANINE BEAM
STRUT TUBE
125 X 125 X 3.2
GROUT
WELDED CLIP
@ 1200 mm c/c
EDGE ANGLE
MEZZANINE BEAM
STRUT TUBE
125 X 125 X 3.2
15
M E Z Z A N I N E
16
M E Z Z A N I N E
Example:Given:Building Width
Bay Spacing
Mezzanine Col. Spacing
Live Load
= 35000 mm
= 6 @ 7500 mm
= 4 @ 8750 mm
= 5.00 kN/m2
17
M E Z Z A N I N E
Design of Joist
Mezzanine Joist are designed as simply supported beams with the
compression flange assumed to fully braced by screws attached to the decking
panel at 300 mm spacing c/c. The connections mainly consist of a fin plate
connection for light loads and clip connections for heavy loads. All bolts are
High Strength Bolts (HSB) grade 8.8. Refer excel sheet for allowable loads on
different cold formed sections, for hot rolled and built-up joist refer table
below. The table below may also be used for mezzanine beams if the spacing
of joist is not going to exceed 1.50 meters.
Table 17.9 Allowable loads in kN/m for Mezzanine Beams and Joist.
Section (mm)
Web x Thk.
+ Flg. Thk.
IPEA-200
UB203x133
250
250
250
250
250
250
250
250
250
4
5
4
6
5
6
4
5
6
125
125
150
125
150
150
150
150
150
6
6
6
6
6
6
8
8
8
7.5
8.5
10.99
16.18
Length (m)
5.5
6
6.5
7
Allowable Loads in kN/m
7.96
5.94
4.53
3.52
2.78
11.73
8.75
6.68
5.20
4.12
2.23
3.30
1.80
2.67
1.47
2.19
1.21
1.80
16.54
17.25
19.28
17.96
19.99
20.70
24.72
25.42
26.13
13.36
13.93
15.57
14.51
16.15
16.72
19.98
20.54
21.10
4.32
4.50
5.05
4.68
5.22
5.40
6.58
6.76
6.94
3.53
3.67
4.12
3.81
4.26
4.40
5.38
5.52
5.66
2.91
3.02
3.40
3.14
3.51
3.63
4.44
4.56
4.67
2.42
2.51
2.83
2.61
2.92
3.02
3.70
3.79
3.89
Weight
kg/m
4.5
18.40
25.10
26.58
37.89
14.87
21.20
19.63
21.59
21.98
23.55
23.94
25.91
26.69
28.65
30.62
37.46
39.09
43.65
40.71
45.28
46.90
55.96
57.56
59.17
20.99
21.89
24.46
22.80
25.36
26.27
31.36
32.25
33.15
11.01
11.48
12.83
11.95
13.30
13.77
16.46
16.93
17.39
8.63
9.00
10.06
9.36
10.43
10.80
13.11
13.48
13.85
18
6.75
7.03
7.87
7.31
8.15
8.44
10.26
10.54
10.82
5.36
5.59
6.26
5.81
6.48
6.70
8.16
8.38
8.61
M E Z Z A N I N E
Section (mm)
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
4
5
4
6
5
6
4
5
6
125
125
150
125
150
150
150
150
150
6
6
6
6
6
6
8
8
8
21.20
23.55
23.55
25.91
25.91
28.26
28.26
30.62
32.97
46.62
48.99
54.05
51.35
56.42
58.78
68.82
71.15
73.49
26.13
27.45
30.30
28.77
31.62
32.94
38.59
39.89
41.19
20.60
21.64
23.89
22.68
24.93
25.97
30.43
31.45
32.48
16.65
17.48
19.31
18.32
20.14
20.98
24.59
25.42
26.25
Length (m)
5.5
6
6.5
7
Allowable Loads in kN/m
13.72 11.50
9.76
8.02
14.41 12.07 10.25
8.42
15.92 13.34 11.33
9.31
15.10 12.64 10.73
8.81
16.60 13.91 11.81
9.70
17.29 14.48 12.30 10.10
20.28 16.99 14.44 12.02
20.95 17.56 14.92 12.42
21.63 18.13 15.40 12.81
350
350
350
350
350
350
350
350
350
4
4
5
5
6
4
6
5
6
125
150
125
150
125
150
150
150
150
6
6
6
6
6
8
6
8
8
22.77
25.12
25.51
27.87
28.26
29.83
30.62
32.58
35.33
56.33
65.01
59.58
68.25
62.82
68.04
71.49
85.44
88.64
31.59
36.46
33.40
38.27
35.21
46.13
40.08
47.92
49.71
24.91
28.75
26.34
30.18
27.76
36.38
31.60
37.79
39.20
20.13
23.24
21.28
24.39
22.43
29.41
25.54
30.55
31.69
16.60
19.16
17.55
20.11
18.49
24.26
21.06
25.19
26.13
13.91
16.06
14.70
16.85
15.49
20.33
17.64
21.12
21.90
11.82
13.65
12.49
14.32
13.16
17.28
14.99
17.94
18.60
10.16
11.74
10.73
12.31
11.31
14.86
12.88
15.43
15.99
8.82
10.19
9.32
10.69
9.81
12.91
11.18
13.40
13.89
7.50
8.66
7.92
9.08
8.34
11.10
9.50
11.52
11.94
6.22
7.18
6.56
7.53
6.90
9.21
7.87
9.55
9.90
5.20
6.01
5.49
6.30
5.77
7.71
6.58
7.99
8.28
400
400
400
400
400
400
400
400
400
400
400
400
400
400
400
400
4
4
5
4
5
6
4
5
6
5
5
6
6
5
6
6
125
150
125
175
150
125
150
175
150
150
200
175
150
175
200
175
6
6
6
6
6
6
8
6
6
8
6
6
8
8
6
8
24.34
26.69
27.48
29.05
29.83
30.62
31.40
32.19
32.97
34.54
34.54
35.33
37.68
37.68
37.68
40.82
59.55
59.53
70.86
59.50
80.77
75.11
59.48
90.69
85.03
100.41
100.60
94.94
104.63
113.64
104.86
117.85
37.36
42.92
39.74
44.55
45.30
42.12
44.53
50.87
47.68
56.33
56.44
53.25
58.69
63.76
58.82
66.11
29.47
33.86
31.34
38.25
35.73
33.21
39.55
40.13
37.61
44.44
44.52
42.00
46.29
50.30
46.39
52.15
23.82
27.37
25.33
30.93
28.89
26.84
34.43
32.44
30.40
35.93
36.00
33.95
37.43
40.67
37.51
42.17
19.64
22.58
20.89
25.51
23.82
22.13
28.40
26.76
25.07
29.63
29.69
28.00
30.86
33.54
30.93
34.78
16.47
18.93
17.51
21.39
19.97
18.55
23.81
22.43
21.01
24.84
24.89
23.47
25.87
28.13
25.93
29.16
14.00
16.09
14.88
18.18
16.97
15.76
20.25
19.06
17.85
21.12
21.16
19.95
21.99
23.91
22.04
24.78
12.03
13.84
12.79
15.64
14.59
13.55
17.41
16.39
15.35
18.16
18.20
17.15
18.91
20.56
18.95
21.31
10.45
12.02
11.11
13.59
12.67
11.76
15.13
14.24
13.33
15.78
15.81
14.89
16.42
17.87
16.46
18.51
9.16
10.53
9.73
11.90
11.10
10.30
13.26
12.48
11.67
13.82
13.85
13.05
14.39
15.66
14.42
16.22
8.08
9.30
8.59
10.51
9.80
9.09
11.71
11.01
10.30
12.21
12.23
11.52
12.70
13.83
12.73
14.32
7.06
8.12
7.49
9.18
8.56
7.93
10.33
9.62
8.99
10.77
10.68
10.05
11.20
12.20
11.12
12.63
Web x Thk.
+ Flg. Thk.
Weight
kg/m
4.5
19
7.5
8.5
6.48
6.80
7.52
7.12
7.84
8.16
9.72
10.04
10.35
5.30
5.56
6.16
5.82
6.41
6.67
7.96
8.22
8.47
4.39
4.60
5.09
4.81
5.31
5.52
6.59
6.80
7.01
3.66
3.84
4.25
4.01
4.43
4.60
5.51
5.68
5.85
M E Z Z A N I N E
Section (mm)
Web x Thk.
Weight
Flg. Thk.
Length (meters)
6
6.5
kg/m
7.5
8.5
9.5
10
10.5
11
11.5
12
2.84
400
125
24.34
16.47
14.00
12.03
10.45
9.16
8.08
7.06
5.96
5.08
4.35
3.75
3.26
400
150
26.69
18.93
16.09
13.84
12.02
10.53
9.30
8.12
6.86
5.85
5.01
4.33
3.75
3.27
400
125
27.48
17.51
14.88
12.79
11.11
9.73
8.59
7.49
6.33
5.39
4.62
3.98
3.45
3.00
400
175
29.05
21.39
18.18
15.64
13.59
11.90
10.51
9.18
7.76
6.61
5.67
4.90
4.25
3.71
400
150
29.83
19.97
16.97
14.59
12.67
11.10
9.80
8.56
7.23
6.16
5.28
4.55
3.95
3.44
400
125
30.62
18.55
15.76
13.55
11.76
10.30
9.09
7.93
6.70
5.70
4.88
4.21
3.64
3.17
400
150
31.40
23.81
20.25
17.41
15.13
13.26
11.71
10.33
8.73
7.44
6.39
5.51
4.79
4.18
400
175
32.19
22.43
19.06
16.39
14.24
12.48
11.01
9.62
8.13
6.92
5.94
5.12
4.44
3.87
400
150
32.97
21.01
17.85
15.35
13.33
11.67
10.30
8.99
7.60
6.47
5.54
4.78
4.14
3.60
400
150
34.54
24.84
21.12
18.16
15.78
13.82
12.21
10.77
9.10
7.75
6.65
5.74
4.98
4.34
400
200
34.54
24.89
21.16
18.20
15.81
13.85
12.23
10.68
9.03
7.69
6.60
5.69
4.94
4.31
400
175
35.33
23.47
19.95
17.15
14.89
13.05
11.52
10.05
8.50
7.23
6.20
5.35
4.64
4.04
400
150
37.68
25.87
21.99
18.91
16.42
14.39
12.70
11.20
9.47
8.06
6.91
5.97
5.17
4.51
400
175
37.68
28.13
23.91
20.56
17.87
15.66
13.83
12.20
10.31
8.79
7.54
6.51
5.65
4.93
400
200
37.68
25.93
22.04
18.95
16.46
14.42
12.73
11.12
9.40
8.00
6.86
5.92
5.13
4.47
400
175
40.82
29.16
24.78
21.31
18.51
16.22
14.32
12.63
10.68
9.10
7.80
6.73
5.84
5.09
450
175
30.62
24.70
21.00
18.07
15.70
13.76
12.16
10.81
9.67
8.62
7.41
6.40
5.57
4.86
450
150
31.79
23.26
19.77
17.00
14.77
12.94
11.43
10.16
9.09
8.10
6.95
6.01
5.22
4.55
450
175
34.15
26.03
22.13
19.03
16.54
14.49
12.80
11.38
10.18
9.08
7.79
6.73
5.85
5.11
450
150
35.33
24.58
20.89
17.97
15.61
13.67
12.07
10.73
9.59
8.55
7.34
6.34
5.50
4.80
450
150
36.50
28.75
24.44
21.02
18.27
16.01
14.14
12.57
11.25
10.12
8.69
7.51
6.53
5.70
450
200
36.50
28.80
24.49
21.06
18.30
16.04
14.17
12.60
11.27
10.05
8.63
7.46
6.48
5.66
450
175
37.68
27.35
23.25
20.00
17.37
15.22
13.44
11.95
10.69
9.53
8.18
7.06
6.13
5.35
450
175
39.64
32.44
27.58
23.73
20.62
18.08
15.97
14.20
12.70
11.43
9.82
8.49
7.38
6.45
450
150
40.04
30.06
25.55
21.98
19.09
16.73
14.78
13.14
11.75
10.57
9.08
7.84
6.81
5.95
450
200
40.04
30.13
25.61
22.03
19.14
16.77
14.81
13.17
11.78
10.50
9.02
7.79
6.77
5.91
450
175
43.18
33.76
28.70
24.69
21.45
18.80
16.60
14.76
13.21
11.88
10.21
8.82
7.67
6.69
20
M E Z Z A N I N E
Section (mm)
Web x
Thk.
Weight
Flg. Thk.
kg/m
Length (meters)
6
6.5
7.5
8.5
9.5
10
10.5
11
11.5
12
500
175
32.19
23.60
21.76
20.18
17.90
15.70
13.87
12.33
11.04
9.93
8.98
8.15
7.09
6.20
500
150
33.76
26.72
22.72
19.54
16.98
14.88
13.14
11.69
10.46
9.40
8.50
7.71
6.70
5.86
500
175
36.11
29.80
25.34
21.80
18.94
16.60
14.67
13.04
11.67
10.50
9.49
8.61
7.49
6.55
500
150
37.68
28.36
24.11
20.74
18.02
15.79
13.94
12.40
11.09
9.97
9.01
8.17
7.10
6.21
500
150
38.47
32.82
27.91
24.01
20.87
18.29
16.16
14.37
12.86
11.57
10.46
9.49
8.32
7.28
500
200
38.47
32.88
27.96
24.06
20.91
18.33
16.19
14.40
12.89
11.59
10.48
9.51
8.27
7.23
500
175
40.04
31.45
26.74
23.00
19.98
17.51
15.47
13.75
12.30
11.06
10.00
9.07
7.89
6.89
500
175
41.61
36.93
31.41
27.02
23.49
20.59
18.19
16.18
14.48
13.03
11.78
10.70
9.38
8.20
500
150
42.39
34.45
29.29
25.20
21.90
19.19
16.95
15.08
13.49
12.13
10.96
9.95
8.72
7.63
500
200
42.39
34.53
29.36
25.26
21.95
19.24
16.99
15.11
13.52
12.16
10.99
9.97
8.67
7.58
500
175
45.53
38.56
32.79
28.21
24.52
21.49
18.99
16.89
15.11
13.59
12.29
11.15
9.78
8.55
500
200
48.67
42.67
36.29
31.22
27.14
23.79
21.02
18.70
16.73
15.05
13.61
12.35
10.83
9.48
500
200
10
54.95
50.82
43.22
37.19
32.33
28.35
25.05
22.28
19.94
17.94
16.23
14.74
13.03
11.40
500
220
10
58.09
54.93
46.72
40.21
34.95
30.65
27.08
24.09
21.56
19.40
17.55
15.94
14.09
12.33
500
200
12
61.23
58.98
50.16
43.17
37.53
32.91
29.08
25.87
23.16
20.84
18.85
17.12
15.26
13.36
500
250
10
62.80
61.10
51.97
44.72
38.88
34.09
30.13
26.81
23.99
21.59
19.53
17.74
15.69
13.73
500
220
12
65.00
63.91
54.36
46.78
40.67
35.67
31.52
28.05
25.10
22.59
20.43
18.56
16.54
14.48
500
250
12
70.65
71.31
60.66
52.21
45.39
39.81
35.18
31.30
28.02
25.22
22.81
20.72
18.47
16.17
500
200
16
73.79
75.31
64.06
55.14
47.94
42.04
37.16
33.06
29.60
26.64
24.10
21.89
19.82
17.36
500
220
16
78.81
79.93
69.67
59.96
52.13
45.72
40.41
35.96
32.19
28.98
26.21
23.81
21.57
18.89
500
250
16
86.35
79.86
73.65
67.19
58.42
51.24
45.29
40.31
36.09
32.48
29.38
26.70
24.18
21.18
550
175
33.76
21.41
19.73
18.30
17.06
15.97
15.01
13.92
12.46
11.21
10.14
9.21
8.40
7.68
550
175
38.07
33.74
28.70
24.69
21.46
18.81
16.62
14.79
13.23
11.90
10.76
9.77
8.91
8.15
550
200
40.43
37.14
31.58
27.18
23.62
20.71
18.30
16.28
14.57
13.11
11.85
10.77
9.82
8.98
550
175
42.39
35.74
30.39
26.15
22.72
19.92
17.60
15.65
14.00
12.60
11.39
10.34
9.42
8.62
550
175
43.57
41.59
35.38
30.44
26.46
23.21
20.51
18.24
16.33
14.69
13.29
12.07
11.00
10.07
550
200
44.75
39.14
33.28
28.63
24.89
21.82
19.28
17.15
15.34
13.80
12.48
11.33
10.33
9.45
550
175
47.89
43.58
37.06
31.89
27.72
24.30
21.47
19.10
17.09
15.38
13.91
12.63
11.51
10.54
550
200
51.03
48.10
40.91
35.20
30.60
26.83
23.71
21.09
18.88
16.99
15.36
13.95
12.72
11.64
550
200
10
57.31
57.07
48.54
41.78
36.32
31.85
28.15
25.05
22.42
20.18
18.25
16.58
15.12
13.84
550
220
10
60.45
61.59
52.39
45.09
39.20
34.38
30.39
27.04
24.21
21.79
19.71
17.90
16.33
14.95
550
200
12
63.59
66.05
56.18
48.35
42.04
36.87
32.59
29.00
25.96
23.37
21.14
19.20
17.52
16.03
550
250
10
65.16
68.38
58.17
50.07
43.53
38.18
33.75
30.03
26.89
24.20
21.89
19.89
18.14
16.61
550
220
12
67.35
71.48
60.80
52.33
45.50
39.91
35.28
31.39
28.11
25.30
22.89
20.79
18.97
17.36
550
250
12
73.01
72.65
67.01
58.30
50.69
44.47
39.31
34.98
31.32
28.20
25.51
23.18
21.14
19.36
550
200
16
76.15
72.62
66.98
61.52
53.50
46.93
41.48
36.92
33.06
29.76
26.92
24.46
22.32
20.43
550
220
16
81.17
72.57
66.93
62.09
57.89
50.98
45.06
40.11
35.91
32.33
29.25
26.58
24.25
22.21
550
250
16
88.71
72.49
66.85
62.01
57.82
54.15
50.44
44.90
40.20
36.20
32.75
29.76
27.15
24.87
21
M E Z Z A N I N E
Section (mm)
Web x Thk.
Weight
Length (meters)
6
6.5
7.5
8.5
9.5
10
10.5
11
11.5
12
8.60
Flg. Thk.
kg/m
600
175
35.33
19.58
18.04
16.73
15.59
13.72
12.93
12.23
11.61
11.04
10.31
9.40
600
175
40.04
37.86
32.20
27.71
24.09
21.12
18.66
16.60
14.86
13.37
12.09
10.98
10.01
9.17
600
200
42.39
38.50
35.35
30.42
26.45
23.19
20.50
18.24
16.32
14.69
13.29
12.07
11.01
10.07
600
175
44.75
40.25
34.23
29.45
25.60
22.44
19.83
17.64
15.79
14.20
12.84
11.66
10.63
9.73
600
175
45.53
38.47
35.48
32.91
29.55
25.92
22.90
20.38
18.25
16.42
14.85
13.49
12.31
11.27
600
200
47.10
43.95
37.38
32.17
27.96
24.52
21.66
19.27
17.25
15.52
14.03
12.75
11.62
10.63
600
175
50.24
48.80
41.51
35.72
31.05
27.23
24.06
21.41
19.16
17.25
15.60
14.17
12.92
11.82
600
200
53.38
53.74
45.71
39.34
34.20
29.99
26.51
23.59
21.11
19.00
17.19
15.61
14.24
13.03
600
200
10
59.66
63.52
54.04
46.51
40.44
35.47
31.35
27.90
24.98
22.49
20.34
18.48
16.86
15.43
600
220
10
62.80
66.64
58.24
50.13
43.59
38.24
33.80
30.08
26.93
24.24
21.93
19.93
18.18
16.64
600
200
12
65.94
66.61
61.43
53.69
46.69
40.95
36.20
32.22
28.85
25.97
23.50
21.35
19.48
17.83
600
250
10
67.51
66.59
61.42
55.56
48.31
42.38
37.47
33.35
29.86
26.88
24.32
22.10
20.16
18.46
600
220
12
69.71
66.57
61.40
56.96
50.47
44.27
39.14
34.83
31.19
28.08
25.41
23.09
21.06
19.29
600
220
10
72.22
73.18
62.24
53.57
46.57
40.85
36.10
32.12
28.76
25.88
23.41
21.26
19.39
17.75
600
200
12
75.36
78.00
66.35
57.11
49.65
43.55
38.49
34.25
30.66
27.60
24.96
22.68
20.68
18.93
600
250
12
75.36
66.51
61.34
56.90
53.06
49.25
43.54
38.75
34.70
31.25
28.27
25.69
23.44
21.47
600
250
10
76.93
80.58
68.55
59.00
51.30
44.99
39.77
35.39
31.68
28.52
25.80
23.43
21.38
19.57
600
200
16
78.50
66.48
61.31
56.87
53.03
49.66
45.91
40.86
36.59
32.95
29.81
27.10
24.72
22.64
600
220
12
79.13
83.93
71.40
61.45
53.43
46.86
41.42
36.86
33.00
29.71
26.87
24.41
22.27
20.39
600
220
16
83.52
66.43
61.26
56.82
52.98
49.61
46.65
44.01
39.72
35.76
32.36
29.41
26.84
24.58
600
250
12
84.78
92.82
78.96
67.97
59.10
51.84
45.82
40.78
36.51
32.87
29.74
27.02
24.65
22.57
600
200
16
87.92
97.55
82.99
71.43
62.11
54.49
48.16
42.87
38.38
34.55
31.26
28.40
25.91
23.73
600
250
16
91.06
66.36
61.18
56.75
52.90
49.54
46.57
43.93
41.57
39.45
36.18
32.89
30.01
27.49
600
220
16
92.94
105.45
89.72
77.23
67.15
58.91
52.08
46.35
41.51
37.37
33.81
30.72
28.03
25.67
600
250
16
100.48
117.31
99.81
85.92
74.72
65.55
57.95
51.58
46.19
41.59
37.63
34.20
31.20
28.57
22
M E Z Z A N I N E
Section (mm)
Web x Thk.
Weight
Flg. Thk.
Length (meters)
6
6.5
kg/m
7.5
8.5
9.5
10
10.5
11
11.5
12
650
200
55.74
59.58
50.68
43.62
37.93 33.27 29.41 26.17 23.43 21.09 19.08 17.33 15.81 14.48
650
200
10
62.02
61.47
56.70
51.40
44.70 39.21 34.66 30.85 27.62 24.87 22.50 20.45 18.65 17.08
650
220
10
65.16
61.44
56.66
52.57
48.11 42.21 37.31 33.21 29.74 26.78 24.23 22.02 20.09 18.40
650
200
12
68.30
61.41
56.63
52.54
48.99 45.15 39.92 35.53 31.82 28.65 25.92 23.56 21.50 19.69
650
250
10
69.87
61.39
56.62
52.52
48.98 45.87 41.29 36.75 32.91 29.64 26.82 24.37 22.24 20.37
650
220
12
72.06
61.37
56.60
52.50
48.95 45.85 43.10 38.36 34.36 30.94 28.00 25.44 23.22 21.26
650
220
10
75.36
81.09
68.98
59.38
51.63 45.28 40.03 35.62 31.89 28.71 25.97 23.60 21.53 19.71
650
250
12
77.72
61.31
56.54
52.44
48.90 45.79 43.05 40.62 38.17 34.37 31.10 28.27 25.80 23.63
650
200
12
78.50
86.32
73.43
63.21
54.96 48.21 42.62 37.93 33.96 30.57 27.66 25.13 22.93 20.99
650
250
10
80.07
89.12
75.82
65.26
56.75 49.78 44.00 39.16 35.07 31.57 28.56 25.95 23.68 21.68
650
200
16
80.86
61.28
56.51
52.41
48.87 45.76 43.02 40.59 38.41 36.22 32.77 29.79 27.19 24.90
650
220
12
82.27
92.74
78.90
67.92
59.06 51.81 45.80 40.76 36.50 32.86 29.73 27.01 24.65 22.57
650
220
16
85.88
61.23
56.46
52.36
48.81 45.71 42.97 40.54 38.36 36.40 34.62 32.30 29.48 27.01
650
250
12
87.92
102.38
87.10
74.98
65.21 57.20 50.57 45.01 40.31 36.29 32.84 29.84 27.23 24.94
650
200
16
91.06
107.50
91.46
78.73
68.47 60.07 53.10 47.27 42.33 38.12 34.49 31.34 28.60 26.19
650
250
16
93.42
61.16
56.38
52.29
48.74 45.63 42.90 40.46 38.28 36.32 34.55 32.93 31.46 30.11
650
220
16
96.08
116.06
98.75
85.02
73.93 64.87 57.35 51.05 45.72 41.17 37.25 33.86 30.89 28.30
650
250
16
103.62
128.91
109.69
94.44
82.13 72.06 63.71 56.72 50.80 45.75 41.40 37.63 34.34 31.45
700
200
58.09
57.08
52.64
48.06
41.79 36.66 32.41 28.85 25.83 23.25 21.04 19.12 17.44 15.97
700
200
10
64.37
57.01
52.58
48.78
45.48 42.60 38.07 33.89 30.35 27.33 24.73 22.47 20.51 18.78
700
220
10
67.51
56.98
52.55
48.75
45.45 42.57 40.02 36.43 32.63 29.38 26.59 24.17 22.05 20.20
700
200
12
70.65
56.95
52.52
48.71
45.42 42.54 39.99 37.73 34.87 31.40 28.42 25.83 23.57 21.59
700
250
10
72.22
56.93
52.50
48.70
45.40 42.52 39.98 37.72 35.69 32.47 29.38 26.71 24.37 22.33
700
220
12
74.42
56.91
52.48
48.68
45.38 42.50 39.95 37.69 35.67 33.85 30.65 27.86 25.43 23.29
700
220
10
78.50
89.28
75.96
65.39
56.86 49.88 44.09 39.25 35.14 31.64 28.63 26.01 23.73 21.73
700
250
12
80.07
56.86
52.42
48.62
45.32 42.44 39.90 37.64 35.61 33.79 32.15 30.65 28.21 25.85
700
200
12
81.64
94.91
80.75
69.52
60.45 53.03 46.88 41.73 37.37 33.65 30.44 27.67 25.24 23.12
700
200
16
83.21
56.82
52.39
48.59
45.29 42.41 39.87 37.61 35.58 33.76 32.11 30.62 29.25 27.22
700
250
10
83.21
97.93
83.32
71.73
62.38 54.72 48.38 43.06 38.56 34.72 31.42 28.55 26.05 23.86
700
220
12
85.41
101.83
86.64
74.59
64.87 56.91 50.31 44.78 40.11 36.11 32.68 29.70 27.10 24.82
700
220
16
88.23
56.77
52.34
48.54
45.24 42.36 39.82 37.56 35.53 33.71 32.06 30.57 29.20 27.95
700
250
12
91.06
112.21
95.48
82.20
71.49 62.72 55.46 49.37 44.21 39.81 36.03 32.75 29.88 27.37
700
200
16
94.20
117.72
100.17
86.24
75.00 65.81 58.18 51.80 46.39 41.78 37.81 34.36 31.36 28.72
700
250
16
95.77
56.70
52.26
48.46
45.17 42.29 39.74 37.48 35.46 33.64 31.99 30.49 29.12 27.87
700
220
16
99.22
126.95
108.02
93.01
80.89 70.98 62.76 55.87 50.04 45.07 40.79 37.07 33.84 30.99
700
250
16
106.76
135.60
119.81
103.16
89.72 78.73 69.62 61.98 55.52 50.00 45.25 41.14 37.55 34.40
23
M E Z Z A N I N E
Section (mm)
Web x Thk.
Weight
Flg. Thk.
kg/m
Length (meters)
6
6.5
7.5
8.5
9.5
10
10.5
11
11.5
12
750
200
60.45
53.21
49.07
45.52
42.45
39.76
35.51
31.61
28.31
25.49
23.07
20.96
19.13
17.52
750
200
10
66.73
53.15
49.01
45.46
42.38
39.69
37.32
35.21
33.16
29.86
27.02
24.56
22.42
20.53
750
220
10
69.87
53.11
48.98
45.43
42.35
39.66
37.29
35.18
33.29
31.59
29.02
26.38
24.07
22.05
750
200
12
73.01
53.08
48.94
45.40
42.32
39.63
37.26
35.15
33.26
31.56
30.02
28.16
25.70
23.55
750
250
10
74.58
53.07
48.93
45.38
42.30
39.61
37.24
35.13
33.24
31.54
30.00
28.61
26.56
24.34
750
220
12
76.77
53.05
48.91
45.36
42.28
39.59
37.22
35.11
33.22
31.52
29.98
28.58
27.31
25.37
750
220
10
81.64
97.75
83.17
71.60
62.27
54.63
48.30
42.99
38.50
34.67
31.37
28.51
26.02
23.83
750
250
12
82.43
52.99
48.85
45.30
42.23
39.54
37.16
35.05
33.16
31.46
29.93
28.53
27.25
26.08
750
200
12
84.78
103.78
88.31
76.02
66.12
58.01
51.29
45.66
40.89
36.82
33.32
30.28
27.63
25.31
750
200
16
85.57
52.96
48.82
45.27
42.19
39.50
37.13
35.02
33.13
31.43
29.89
28.50
27.22
26.05
750
220
12
88.55
111.20
94.62
81.46
70.85
62.16
54.96
48.93
43.82
39.47
35.71
32.46
29.63
27.14
750
250
10
86.35
107.02
91.06
78.40
68.18
59.82
52.89
47.09
42.17
37.98
34.36
31.23
28.50
26.11
750
220
16
90.59
52.91
48.77
45.22
42.14
39.45
37.08
34.97
33.08
31.38
29.84
28.45
27.17
26.00
750
250
12
94.20
122.33
104.09
89.62
77.95
68.40
60.48
53.84
48.23
43.43
39.31
35.73
32.61
29.88
750
200
16
97.34
126.58
109.11
93.95
81.71
71.70
63.40
56.45
50.56
45.54
41.21
37.47
34.20
31.33
750
250
16
98.13
52.83
48.69
45.14
42.07
39.38
37.00
34.89
33.01
31.31
29.77
28.37
27.10
25.93
750
220
16
102.36
126.53
116.72
101.20
88.03
77.24
68.31
60.82
54.48
49.07
44.41
40.37
36.85
33.76
750
250
16
109.90
126.46
116.65
108.24
97.49
85.56
75.66
67.37
60.35
54.36
49.20
44.73
40.84
37.41
800
200
12
75.36
49.70
45.82
42.49
39.61
37.08
34.86
32.88
31.11
29.52
28.07
26.76
25.57
24.47
800
220
12
79.13
49.66
45.78
42.45
39.57
37.05
34.82
32.84
31.07
29.48
28.04
26.73
25.53
24.43
800
220
10
84.78
106.50
90.62
78.02
67.85
59.53
52.64
46.86
41.97
37.80
34.20
31.09
28.37
25.99
800
250
12
84.78
49.60
45.72
42.39
39.51
36.99
34.76
32.79
31.02
29.42
27.98
26.67
25.47
24.38
800
200
16
87.92
49.57
45.69
42.36
39.48
36.96
34.73
32.75
30.98
29.39
27.95
26.64
25.44
24.35
800
200
12
87.92
112.93
96.10
82.74
71.96
63.14
55.83
49.70
44.52
40.09
36.28
32.98
30.10
27.57
800
220
12
91.69
118.67
102.83
88.54
77.01
67.57
59.75
53.20
47.65
42.92
38.84
35.31
32.23
29.52
800
220
16
92.94
49.52
45.64
42.31
39.43
36.91
34.68
32.70
30.93
29.34
27.90
26.59
25.39
24.30
800
250
12
97.34
118.61
109.41
97.25
84.59
74.23
65.64
58.44
52.35
47.15
42.68
38.80
35.42
32.45
800
250
16
100.48
49.45
45.56
42.24
39.36
36.83
34.61
32.63
30.86
29.27
27.82
26.51
25.32
24.22
800
200
16
100.48
118.58
109.38
101.50
88.60
77.75
68.76
61.22
54.84
49.40
44.71
40.65
37.11
34.00
800
220
16
105.50
118.53
109.33
101.45
94.61
83.66
73.99
65.88
59.02
53.17
48.12
43.75
39.94
36.60
800
250
16
113.04
118.45
109.26
101.37
94.54
88.56
81.84
72.88
65.29
58.82
53.24
48.41
44.20
40.50
24
M E Z Z A N I N E
Section (mm)
Web x
Thk.
Weight
Flg. Thk.
kg/m
850
200
12
77.72
850
220
12
850
220
10
850
200
16
90.28
850
200
12
91.06
850
220
12
94.83
850
220
16
95.30
850
250
12
87.14
850
250
12
100.48
850
250
16
102.84
850
200
16
103.62
850
220
16
108.64
850
250
16
116.18
Length (meters)
6
6.5
7.5
8.5
9.5
10
10.5
11
11.5
12
43.05
39.92
37.21
34.83
32.74
30.88
29.21
27.71
26.36
25.12
24.00
22.96
81.48
46.67
43.01
39.88
37.17
34.80
32.70
30.84
29.17
27.67
26.32
25.08
23.96
22.93
87.92
111.67
98.30
84.64
73.61
64.59
57.12
50.85
45.55
41.02
37.13
33.75
30.81
28.22
46.58
42.93
39.80
37.08
34.71
32.61
30.75
29.09
27.59
26.23
25.00
23.87
22.84
111.64
102.98
89.65
77.98
68.43
60.51
53.87
48.26
43.46
39.34
35.76
32.64
29.91
111.60
102.94
95.52
83.35
73.14
64.68
57.59
51.59
46.47
42.06
38.24
34.91
31.98
46.53
42.88
39.75
37.03
34.66
32.56
30.70
29.04
27.54
26.18
24.95
23.82
22.79
46.61
42.96
39.83
37.11
34.74
32.65
30.78
29.12
27.62
26.26
25.03
23.90
22.87
111.55
102.89
95.47
89.04
80.21
70.94
63.17
56.59
50.97
46.14
41.95
38.30
35.09
46.45
42.80
39.67
36.96
34.58
32.49
30.63
28.96
27.46
26.10
24.87
23.74
22.71
111.51
102.86
95.44
89.00
83.38
74.25
66.12
59.23
53.36
48.30
43.92
40.09
36.74
111.46
102.81
95.39
88.95
83.33
78.36
71.07
63.68
57.36
51.93
47.22
43.11
39.50
111.39
102.73
95.31
88.88
83.25
78.29
73.87
69.92
63.37
57.37
52.17
47.63
43.65
Notes for Table 17.5:1. Compression Flange of Beams or joist are considered to be fully braced.
2. Maximum Allowable Deflection considered is Span / 240.
3. The allowable uniformly distributed loads are inclusive of self weight.
4. Material Grade is A572 Gr. 50 (Fu=450 N/mm2 and Fy=345 N/mm2)
25
M E Z Z A N I N E
Table 17.10 Allowable loads in kN for Standard Joist and Beam Connection.
Connection
Code
Min.
Web
Depth
(mm)
MZC-J01
MZC-J02
183
MZC-J03
175
MZC-J04
MZC-J05
MZC-J06
MZC-J07
MZC-J08
MZC-J09
250
MZC-J10
220
MZC-J11
MZC-J12
MZC-J13
MZC-J14
Min.
Web Thk.
(mm)
Supporting
Flange or
Web
Thk. (mm)
4
4
5
6
4
4
4
4
180
263
4
4
5
6
4
5
6
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
265
343
4
4
5
6
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
MZC-J15
300
MZC-J16
MZC-J17
MZC-J18
MZC-J19
MZC-J20
345
180
265
345
Capacity (kN)
ASD
Bolt
Pattern
Type
96
93
117
140
2-16
Fin Plate
4-16
End Plate
96
2-16
Coped
145
133
167
200
155
193
193
3-16
Fin Plate
6-16
End Plate
7-16
Clip
Conn.
145
3-16
Coped
193
207
259
289
4-16
Fin Plate
10-16
Clip
Conn.
4-16
2-16
3-16
4-16
Coped
Tube
Tube
Tube
LRFD
N/A
64
62
77
93
N/A
N/A
64
N/A
96
89
111
133
103
128
128
N/A
96
N/A
128
138
172
193
N/A
128
64
96
128
193
96
145
193
26
M E Z Z A N I N E
Connection
Code
Min.
Web
Depth
(mm)
MZC-B01
250
MZC-B02
300
MZC-B03
380
MZC-B04
460
Min.
Web Thk.
(mm)
Supporting
Flange or
Web
Thk. (mm)
ASD
LRFD
4
5
6
8
8
8
10
10
10
4
5
6
8
8
8
10
10
10
4
5
6
8
8
8
10
10
10
4
5
6
8
8
8
10
10
10
4
4
4
4
5
6
4
5
6
4
4
4
4
5
6
4
5
6
4
4
4
4
5
6
4
5
6
4
4
4
4
5
6
4
5
6
89
111
133
153
178
178
153
192
201
99
133
160
213
213
213
230
267
267
91
155
203
270
270
270
307
338
338
75
147
224
327
327
327
384
409
409
133
167
200
230
267
267
230
288
301
149
200
241
321
321
321
345
401
401
137
233
305
407
407
407
460
508
508
113
221
336
492
492
492
576
616
616
Capacity (kN)
27
Bolt
Pattern
Type
4-20
End Plate
6-20
End Plate
8-20
End Plate
10-20
End Plate
M E Z Z A N I N E
Connection
Code
Min.
Web
Depth
(mm)
MZC-B05
475
MZC-B06
575
MZC-B07
230
Min.
Web Thk.
(mm)
Supporting
Flange or
Web
Thk. (mm)
ASD
LRFD
4
5
6
8
8
8
10
10
10
12
12
12
4
5
6
8
8
8
10
10
10
12
12
12
4
5
6
8
8
8
10
10
10
4
4
4
4
5
6
4
5
6
5
6
8
4
4
4
4
5
6
4
5
6
5
6
8
4
4
4
4
5
6
4
5
6
73
142
224
338
338
338
368
423
423
460
476
476
60
117
203
398
398
398
460
512
512
576
578
578
129
162
172
172
201
201
172
201
201
109
214
336
508
508
508
552
636
636
691
714
714
90
177
306
598
598
598
691
770
770
864
867
867
194
243
259
259
301
301
259
301
301
Capacity (kN)
28
Bolt
Pattern
Type
8-24
End Plate
10-24
End Plate
7-20
Clip Conn.
M E Z Z A N I N E
Connection
Code
Min.
Web
Depth
(mm)
MZC-B08
310
MZC-B09
390
MZC-B10
470
MZC-B11
490
Min.
Web Thk.
(mm)
Supporting
Flange or
Web
Thk. (mm)
ASD
LRFD
4
5
6
8
8
8
10
10
10
4
5
6
8
8
8
10
10
10
4
5
6
8
8
8
10
10
10
4
5
6
8
8
4
4
4
4
5
6
4
5
6
4
4
4
4
5
6
4
5
6
4
4
4
4
5
6
4
5
6
4
4
4
4
5
172
216
259
259
301
301
259
301
301
216
270
324
345
402
402
345
402
402
259
324
388
432
502
502
432
502
502
259
324
388
414
518
259
324
388
388
452
452
388
452
452
324
405
486
518
603
603
518
603
603
388
486
583
648
753
753
648
753
753
388
486
583
622
777
8
10
10
10
6
4
5
6
518
414
518
579
777
622
777
868
Capacity (kN)
29
Bolt
Pattern
Type
10-20
Clip Conn.
13-20
Clip Conn.
16-20
Clip Conn.
13-24
Clip Conn.
M E Z Z A N I N E
Connection
Code
Min.
Web
Depth
(mm)
MZC-B12
590
MZC-B13
265
MZC-B14
380
MZC-B15
460
MZC-B16
540
MZC-B17
570
MZC-B18
670
Min.
Web Thk.
(mm)
Supporting
Flange or
Web
Thk. (mm)
ASD
LRFD
4
5
6
8
8
8
10
10
10
4
5
6
4
5
6
4
5
6
8
4
5
6
8
4
5
6
8
5
6
8
4
4
4
4
5
6
4
5
6
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
311
388
466
518
622
622
518
648
723
107
134
150
157
197
201
189
236
251
251
220
275
301
301
237
297
356
361
346
416
434
466
583
699
777
933
933
777
972
1085
161
201
226
236
295
301
283
354
376
376
330
413
452
452
356
445
534
542
520
624
651
Capacity (kN)
30
Bolt
Pattern
16-24
Type
Clip Conn.
3-20
Tube
4-20
Tube
5-20
Tube
6-20
Tube
Tube
6-24
Tube
18
Chapter
B R A C I N G
Bracing
Buildings are subjected to lateral forces in all directions, metal buildings
simplify the design approach by resolving the force into two orthogonal
directions. One along the main frames and the other normal to the main
frames. The main frames offer no lateral resistance normal to their plane in the
longitudinal direction, unless the columns are fixed at the base, which is not a
practical and economical solution. Thus stability in longitudinal direction is
achieved by providing bracing at roof and sidewall provided in some bays of
the building. The lateral forces are subsequently transferred to column bases
and then to the foundations. The main purpose of a bracing system is the
transfer the lateral forces due to following,
1. Longitudinal Wind Load Bracing
The wind load acting on the end wall is transmitted to the wind columns by
sheeting and girts. This force is transferred equally to the column base and the
top end of the column. The force transmitted to building roof is assumed to
travel in the roof through diaphragm action and the nearest purlins,
instantaneously gets divided equally in the braced bays, and is eventually
transferred to the sidewall bracing of the building and down into the
foundations. A simple roof bracing system with load path is shown in the
sketch below for illustration,
In the sketch below, the cable/rods shown in heavy lines are in tension,
resisting the wind acting in the direction shown, the other cable/rod is in
compression and is hence inactive. When the wind load is in other direction
the other cable/rods, shown dashed, will be in tension and the heavy lines will
be in compression and hence inactive. Note the cable/rods between grid line C
& D are assumed to take no load for whichever direction the wind is acting in.
These cable/rods would have been active if there was a column at ridge.
B R A C I N G
All strut (compression) members and their connections, in the end bays and
braced bays, shall be designed for the axial load as shown. The first option is
to check if the purlin alone with standard connection is capable of taking the
combined bending and axial loads, next a strut purlin may be added and then
a strut tube or beam
1
LENGTH
BAY SPACING
BAY SPACING
BAY SPACING
P1+P2
P1
P1
WIDTH
P2
P3
P1+P2
P2
P1
P1
P1
P1
P1+P2
P2
P1+P2+P3
P3
P1+P2+P3
P3
BAY SPACING
BAY SPACING
BAY SPACING
BAY SPACING
P1
P1
P2
P1+P2
P3
P1+P2+P3
P1+P2+P3
RIDGE LINE
P1+P2+P3
P1+P2+P3
EAVE HT.
A building should have the following minimum quantity of bays based on the
required number of braced bays from Table below..
Minimum Number of Braced Bays
1
2
3
4
5
B R A C I N G
RIDGE LINE
5. crane,
P
6. seismic, etc.
WIDTH
T
H
Where,
V=PH/S
T = [ P x sqrt ( H2 S2 ) ] / S
The dashed line are inactive cable/rod/ flat bars in compression
B R A C I N G
For buildings with mezzanine, seismic forces at mezzanine floor levels should
be added. Strut members may not be required due to the presence of
mezzanine beam/joist, provided these are designed for additional axial loads.
Cross bracings, is also be required at interior mezzanine column locations in
some bays to resist the seismic forces for influencing tributary area of that
mezzanine column in longitudinal direction.
P
P1
P1
T1
h1
P2
P2
P1+P2
P2
h2
H
h2
T
T2
Hr
T2
Hr
Hr
S
V
Hr = P1 + P2
V = [ P 1 x ( h 1 +h 2 ) + P 2 x h 2 ] / S
T 1 = P 1 x Cable Length / S
T 2 = ( P 1 + P 2 ) x Cable Length / S
B R A C I N G
P1
h1
P1+P2
Hr
Hr
h2
Hr
Hr
S
V
h2
P2
Hr
Hr
S
V
S
V
B R A C I N G
B R A C I N G
In case a portal bracing is required below the crane beam level, the inside of
the top flange of the portal rafter should be at the same level as the crane
beam for proper transfer of longitudinal load to vertical bracing system. These
longitudinal angles are provided at every rigid frame column to prevent
buckling of column at these locations.
If the distance from eave to top of crane beam is less than or equal to 1000 mm
provide kicker angle otherwise cross bracing may be provided above the crane
level.
In case of crane beam supported on a separate crane column or stepped
column, angles should be provide in the plane of the runway beam thus
avoiding eccentric load transfer and eliminating the need of the diagonal angle
mentioned above. The wind bracing below the crane beam can be in the same
plane as the bracing above the crane level.
B R A C I N G
B R A C I N G
B R A C I N G
Diagonal-bracing
This is the most common and simple bracing system commonly used in metal
buildings at roof and sidewalls. The commonly used materials are galvanized
cable strands, rods, and angles. Flat bars are generally used at end walls.
1. Cable Bracing
Cable bracings are made from Zinc Coated Extra High Strength Grade Cables
conforming to ASTM A 475 Class A.
The Maximum Breaking Strength
The Factor of Safety
P ult = 119 kN
= 0.60
= 2.50
R n = P ult
LRFD
R n = 0.60 x 119 = 71.4 kN
R n = P ult / ASD
R n = 119 / 2.50 = 47.6 kN
LRFD
ASD
2. Rod Bracing
Rod bracings can be ASTM A36, Din 933 Grade 4.6 or ASTM A307 material.
For all the 3 grades,
Yield strength,
Tensile strength,
F y = 248 N/mm2
F u = 400 N/mm2
10
B R A C I N G
Table 18.1
Capacity (kN)
Diameter (mm)
AISC 89
12
16
20
22
25
30
32
36
ASD
14.93
26.54
41.47
50.18
64.80
93.31
106.16
134.36
AISC 05
ASD
16.96
30.16
47.12
57.02
73.63
106.03
120.64
152.68
LRFD
30.54
54.29
84.82
102.64
132.54
190.85
217.15
274.83
F y = 345 N/mm2
F u = 450 N/mm2
= 250 mm2
Hence gross area A g = 50 x 5
Net area A n , assuming (1) 12 mm HSB
= 250 15 x 5 = 175 mm2
Hence capacity in tension
= 0.6 F y A g
= 0.6 x 345 x 250 / 1000
= 51.75 kN
Or
= 0.5 F u A n
= 0.5 x 450 x 175 / 1000
= 39.37 kN
Shear strength of (1) 12 mm HSB = 18.10 kN
Hence use (2) bolts on either side of the flange in order to fully utilize the
section capacity, therefore capacity = 18.10 x 2
= 36.2 kN
11
B R A C I N G
4. Angle Bracing
Angle bracings are generally used at side walls. The standard section are as
listed in the table below, and the material is A572 Grade 50.
F y = 345 N/mm2
F u = 450 N/mm2
Yield strength,
Tensile strength,
Section
75x75x6
100x100x8
Bolt (mm)
20
24
Hole (mm)
22
26
Capacity (kN)
200.07
267.30
= 1746 mm2
= 1482 mm2
= 200.07 kN
12
B R A C I N G
= 1250 mm2
= 1030 mm2
The strength of the gusset plate and weld will depend upon the angle of
bracing with the horizontal, the net effective width in the direction
perpendicular to the angle bracing and the size of weld.
The width of the plate at this section, and the size of weld should be adjusted
so that the capacity of the plate is not less than the minimum capacity.
Hence minimum of all capacities
= 200.07 kN
13
B R A C I N G
= 3102 mm2
= 2686 mm2
= 318.96 kN
14
B R A C I N G
= 1500 mm2
= 1188 mm2
= 267.30 kN
Note that the excel sheet for angle design does not check for center connection
plates SBP-103 and SBP-111 used in angle bracing.
15
A P P E N D I X
Appendix
- A
Reference
This section compiles some reference materials from various books on structural steel design,
and codes. The intention is provide a one source reference material.
Any other reference material that can be thought of being useful and needs to be included can
be sent to PRD department for inclusion.
A P P E N D I X
- A
A P P E N D I X
- A
A P P E N D I X
- A
A P P E N D I X
- A
Imperial Gauge
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
-
Metric Sheet mm
3.00
2.80
2.50
2.30
2.00
1.80
1.50
1.40
1.20
1.00
0.90
-
Imperial Gauge
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
33
35
38
42
Metric Sheet mm
0.80
0.70
0.60
0.55
0.50
0.45
0.42
0.37
0.35
0.30
0.25
0.20
0.15
0.10
A P P E N D I X
- A
A P P E N D I X
- A
A P P E N D I X
- A
A P P E N D I X
- A
A P P E N D I X
- A
10
A P P E N D I X
- A
11
A P P E N D I X
- A
12
A P P E N D I X
- A
13
A P P E N D I X
- A
14
A P P E N D I X
- A
15
A P P E N D I X
- A
16
A P P E N D I X
- A
17
A P P E N D I X
- A
18
A P P E N D I X
- A
19
A P P E N D I X
- A
20
A P P E N D I X
- A
21
A P P E N D I X
- A
22
A P P E N D I X
- A
23
A P P E N D I X
- A
24
A P P E N D I X
- A
25
A P P E N D I X
- A
26
A P P E N D I X
- A
27
A P P E N D I X
- A
28
A P P E N D I X
- A
29
A P P E N D I X
- A
30
A P P E N D I X
- A
31
A P P E N D I X
- A
32
A P P E N D I X
- A
33
A P P E N D I X
- A
34
A P P E N D I X
- A
35
A P P E N D I X
- A
36
A P P E N D I X
- A
37
A P P E N D I X
- A
38
A P P E N D I X
- A
39
A P P E N D I X
- A
40
A P P E N D I X
- A
41
A P P E N D I X
- A
42
A P P E N D I X
- A
43
A P P E N D I X
- A
44
A P P E N D I X
- A
45
A P P E N D I X
- A
46
A P P E N D I X
- A
47
A P P E N D I X
- A
48
A P P E N D I X
- A
49
A P P E N D I X
- A
50
A P P E N D I X
- A
51
A P P E N D I X
- A
52
A P P E N D I X
- A
Buckling may sometimes occur in the form of wrinkles in thin elements such as webs, flanges,
cover plates, and other parts that make up a section. This phenomenon is called Local
Buckling. The critical buckling stress Fcr in rectangular plates with various types of edge
support and edge loading in the plane of plates is given by,
Fcr
k
E
Where,
forces,
53
A P P E N D I X
- A
54
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
Appendix
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
Geometry
Hole Location
Dimensions
D&B
D
1
2
E1 E2 E3
S1 S2
F&P
Length L
Camber C
Minimum Thickness t
Tolerances (mm)
+
4.762
9.525
3
5
3.175
1.587
3.175
3.175
4.762
9.525
3
5
3.175
1.587
3.175
3.175
2.08 x 10-3 x L
0.95 Design t
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
Built-Up Sections
Refer table B1.2 for values of fabrication tolerance in figure below,
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
Dimensions
a
b
d
e
c
f
E1 E2 E3
S1 S2
F
Geometry
Hole Location
Length L
Sweep S
Camber C
Splice Plates
H
N1
N2
G1
G2
Up to 609 mm
609 to 1219 mm
Over 1219 mm
J
Tolerances (mm)
+
3 - 6.35 Max
3 - 6.35 Max
6.35
6.35
4.762
4.762
3.175
3.175
D / 72
D / 72
3.175
3.175
1.587
1.587
3.175
3.175
3.175
3.175
-3
Runway Beams ( 1.04 x 10 x L )
All other beams ( 2.08 x 10-3 x L )
2.08 x 10-3 x L
3.175
3.175
4.762
4.762
1.587
1.587
1.587
1.587
3.175
3.175
4.762
4.762
6.35
6.35
6.35
6.35
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
10
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
11
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
12
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
13
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
14
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
15
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
16
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
17
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
18
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
19
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
20
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
21
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
22
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
23
F A B R I C A T I O N
&
E R E C T I O N
T O L E R A N C E S
24
A R E A
J O B
Appendix
R E Q U I R E M E N T
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
Abu Dhabi
GENERAL:
1. Primary members to have standard cleaning and to be painted with one
coat of Red Oxide Primer. (UNO in PIF)
2. Secondary members to be of Aluzinc or/and Galvanized materials.
3. Use of Metric system of units in Drawings and Calculations.
4. No Material substitution allowed without prior clearance from area
office.
5. Consistency in design calculation & drawing must be maintained since
most of the jobs are similar.
6. All Approval Drawings & Design Calculations must show PLOT
NUMBER.
DESIGN:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
DMW
GENERAL:
1. Primary members to be Shot blasted to SA 2.5 and painted with the
following: (UNO Otherwise in PIF)
a. Berger, Epimastic 5500M:
A2-component high solids high build epoxy mastic primer/finish
coating. Volume solids 82%, 125 microns DFT.
b. Berger, Epimastic 6000:
A2-component high solids high build surface tolerant epoxy
finish coating. Volume solids 82%, 125 microns DFT.
c. Total of 250 micron DFT.
2. Secondary members to be of Aluzinc or/and Galvanized materials.
3. Use of Metric system of units in Drawings and Calculations.
4. No Material substitution is allowed without prior clearance from area
office.
5. Consistency in design calculation & drawing must be maintained for
similar jobs in a project.
6. All Approval drawings & Design Calculations must show DMW
PROJECT NUMBER and LOCATION.
DESIGN:
1. Minimum 6 mm webs and 8 mm flanges are required for Main Frames
including internal columns, Wind columns, End wall rafter, Canopy
rafter, Mezzanine beams, Joists and columns and Portal Frames.
2. Minimum 2.5 mm thick for Cold formed sections required for use as
Purlins, Eave struts and Girts. These should be fixed to supporting
members with cleats.
3. Anchor bolts shall be Grade 8.8 Hot dip Galvanized, with a minimum of
4 Nos. for all columns.
4. Electro Galvanized connection bolts to be used of Grade 8.8. Minimum 2
Nos. in any point.
5. Sandwich panel profile to be 45/150 with 0.7mm thk. Aluminum as
exterior sheet and 0.5mm Aluminum as interior skin-color is non std.
6. Live Load
: 0.75 kN/m2 (on Purlins & Frames) (UNO in PIF)
7. Wind Speed
: 160 Kmph
8. Collateral Load : 0.25 kN/m2 (on Purlins & Frames) (UNO in PIF)
9. Minimum diameter of Rod bracing at roof is 20 mm .
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
10. Square tube strut beam to be used at roof & wall brace intersection.
(Minimum 2 Braced bays in any building). No pipes to be used.
11. Minimum 6 mm thick Angle bracing to be used at Side walls & End
walls.
12. Galvanized Sag rod 16mm to be used for Purlins, Side wall and End
wall Girts for bays of more than 4.5 m. Use One row every max 3.80 m of
bay size: (i.e. .1 row for bays < 7.60 m , 2 rows for bays >= 7.60 m).
13. Minimum thickness of Gusset plate, splice plate to be 10 mm.
14. Design calculation to include Main Frame: Geometry, Members
Properties and Loading Diagrams.
DRAFTING:
1. All built-up, Hot rolled and cold formed sections to have the sizes and
thickness of the Flanges and Webs shown Clearly (Readable Big font)
on all the Approval Drawings.
2. Irrelevant informations to be excluded from drawings or stamped with
"VOID".
3. Use of Metric system for standard anchor bolt details (No imperial units
are allowed).
4. Show sizes of sidewall Angle bracing on drawings.
5. Tube Struts to be shown in Roof and Sidewall drawings.
6. Show the size and location of Sag Rods on cross section and roof
framing plan - write "GALVANIZED" on drawings.
7. Show Size of Flange Braces/Stays on cross section drawings. (4mm
minimum thickness).
8. No 40mm notch to be shown on drawings.
9. No Ramp or Block work to be shown on Anchor Bolt Plan F1.
10. Grid Enumeration shown on Order Sketch to be adhered to.
11. Column sections to be shown on all Anchor Bolt details ( I , C , ][ ).
12. C/C distance of sidewall and end wall Columns as well as framed
opening jambs following the grid enumeration, to be shown on Anchor
Bolt Plan F1.
13. SKYLIGHTS Locations to be shown on Roof Sheeting Plan according to
the locations in the ORDER SKETCH.
14. All drawings should have the NOTE ABOUT PAINT as follows: All
steel framings members (except bolts and fasteners) shall be Shot
Blasted to Swedish Standard SA 2 and shall be shop painted with:
a. 1st Coat: PenGuard EPOXY Primer
- 50 micron DFT
b. 2nd Coat: PenGuard H.B. EPOXY Under Coat - 70 micron DFT
c. 3rd Coat: PenGuard H.B. EPOXY Under Coat - 70 micron DFT
d. 4th Coat: PenGuard H.B. EPOXY Top Coat
- 50 micron DFT
Total
- 240 micron DFT
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
Dubai
GENERAL:
1. Primary members to have standard cleaning and to be painted with one
coat of Red Oxide Primer. (UNO in PIF)
2. Secondary members to be of Aluzinc Or/And Galvanized materials.
3. Use of Metric system of units in Drawings and Calculations.
4. No Material substitution allowed without prior clearance from area
office.
5. Consistency in design calculation & drawing must be maintained since
most of the jobs are similar.
6. All Approval Drawings & Design Calculations must show PLOT
NUMBER.
DESIGN:
1. Minimum 6 mm thick material is required for Main frame and
Mezzanine beams. Multi-span internal column can be of 150x150x4.5
square tube. Wind columns and end wall rafters, mezzanine joists can be
of Cold Formed or I. Sections of any thickness.
2. Live Load
: 0.60 kN/m2 (on Purlins & Frames) (UNO in PIF)
3. Wind Speed
: 160 KMPH
4. Cable bracing may be used at roof and sidewall.
5. Sag rods to be provided for purlins at bays of size (8.0 MET) and above (1
row per bay).
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
DRAFTING:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Built-up sections flange and web sizes and interior column sizes to be
shown clearly on cross section of the main frame.
Irrelevant informations to be excluded from drawings or stamped with
"VOID".
Use of Metric system for standard anchor bolt details (No imperial
units are allowed).
No 40mm Notch to be shown on drawing.
No Ramp or Block work to be shown on Anchor Bolt Sheet F1.
Grid Enumeration shown on Order Sketch to be adhered to.
Column Sections to be shown on all Anchor Bolt details ( I , C , ][ ).
C/C distances of sidewall and end wall Columns as well as framed
opening jambs following the grid enumeration, to be shown on Anchor
Bolts Plan F1.
SKYLIGHTS Locations to be shown on Roof Sheeting Plan according to
the locations in the ORDER SKETCH.
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
Sharjah
GENERAL:
1. All Primary members should go through standard cleaning and should
be painted with one coat of Red Oxide Primer.
2. All Secondary members shall be of either Aluzinc or/and Galvanized
materials.
3. Metric system of units should be used in all Drawings and Calculations.
4. No Material substitution allowed without prior clearance from area
office.
5. Consistency in design calculation & drawing must be maintained since
most of the jobs are similar.
6. All Approval Drawings & Design Calculations must show PLOT
NUMBER.
DESIGN:
1. Minimum thickness of built-up section of Main frame and Mezzanine
beams to be 4 mm web and 6 mm flanges.
2. Multi-span internal column can be 150x150x4.5mm square tube.
3. Wind columns and end wall rafters, mezzanine joists can be Cold Formed
or built-up of any thickness.
4. Live Load
: 0.60 kN/m2 (on Purlins & Frames) (UNO in PIF)
5. Wind Load
: 1.00 kN/m2 (Up to 10.0 m Mean Height)
6. Cable bracing may be used at roof and sidewall.
7. Provide Galvanized Sag rod 12 mm for Purlins and Side wall Girts for
bay spacing more than 6.00 m. (Use 1 row for bays < 7.60 m , 2 rows for
bays >= 7.60 m).
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
DRAFTING:
1. Built-up sections flange and web sizes and interior column sizes to be
shown clearly on cross section of the main frame.
2. Details of Bolts Connections of Main Frames to be shown on Frame cross
section.
3. Irrelevant informations to be excluded from drawings or stamped with
"VOID".
4. Use of Metric system for standard anchor bolt details (No imperial units
are allowed).
5. No 40 mm Notch to be shown on drawing.
6. No Ramp or Block work to be shown on Anchor Bolt Plan.
7. Grid Enumeration shown on ORDER SKETCH should be adhered to.
8. Column Section profile to be shown on all Anchor Bolt details (I , C ,
Double C ).
9. C/C distances of side wall and end wall columns as well as framed
opening jambs following the grid enumeration, to be shown on Anchor
Bolt Plan.
10. Location of Skylights should be shown on Roof Sheeting Plan according
to the locations shown in the ORDER SKETCH.
11. Show Size of Flange Braces/Stays on cross section drawings. (4 mm Min.
thickness).
12. Flange brace should be provided on both sides of the rafter / column.
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
Northern Emirates
(AJMAN, RAK, UAQ, Fujairah)
GENERAL:
1. Primary members to have standard cleaning and to be painted with one
coat of Red Oxide Primer. (UNO in PIF)
2. Secondary members to be of Aluzinc Or/And Galvanized materials.
3. Use of Metric system of units in Drawings and Calculations.
4. No Material substitution allowed without prior clearance from area
office.
5. Consistency in design calculation & drawing must be maintained since
most of the jobs are similar.
6. All Approval Drawings & Design Calculations must show PLOT
NUMBER.
DESIGN:
1. Minimum 4 mm thick material is required for Main frame and
Mezzanine beams.
2. Multi-span internal column can be of 150x150x4.5 square tube.
3. Wind columns and end wall rafters, mezzanine joists can be of Cold
Formed or I-Sections of any thickness.
4. Live Load
: 0.57 kN/m2 (on Purlins & Frames) (UNO in PIF)
5. Wind Speed
: 160 KMPH
6. Cable bracing may be used at roof and sidewall.
7. Sag rods to be provided for purlins at bays of size (8.0 m) and above (1
row per bay).
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
DRAFTING:
1. Built-up sections flange and web sizes and interior column sizes to be
shown clearly on cross section of the main frame.
2. Irrelevant informations to be excluded from drawings or stamped with
"VOID".
3. Use of Metric system for standard anchor bolt details (No imperial units
are allowed).
4. No 40mm Notch to be shown on drawing.
5. No Ramp or Block work to be shown on Anchor Bolt Sheet F1.
6. Grid Enumeration shown on Order Sketch to be adhered to.
7. Column Sections to be shown on all Anchor Bolt details ( I , C , ][ ).
8. C/C distances of sidewall and end wall Columns as well as framed
opening jambs following the grid enumeration, to be shown on Anchor
Bolts Plan F1.
9. SKYLIGHTS Locations to be shown on Roof Sheeting Plan according to
the locations in the ORDER SKETCH.
10
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
JAFZA
GENERAL:
1. Primary members to be Shot blasted to SA 2 and painted with the
following: (UNO in PIF)
a. Berger, Epimastic 5500M:
A 2-component high solids high build epoxy mastic primer/finish
coating. Volume solids 82%, 125 microns DFT.
b. Berger, Epimastic 6000:
A 2-component high solids high build surface tolerant epoxy finish
coating. Volume solids 82%, 125 microns DFT.
Total of 250 micron DFT.
2. Secondary members to be of Aluzinc or/And Galvanized materials.
3. Galvanized Anchor Bolts and connection bolts to be used, Minimum 4
Nos. required for all columns.
4. Use of Metric system of units in Drawings and Calculations.
5. No Material substitution is allowed without prior clearance from area
office.
6. Consistency in design calculation & drawing must be maintained since
most of the jobs are similar
7. All Approval drawings & Design Calculations must show PLOT
NUMBER.
DESIGN:
1. Minimum 6 mm thick material is required for Main Frames including
internal columns, Wind columns, End wall rafter, Canopy rafter
Mezzanine beams, Joists and columns and Portal Frames. Only Purlins,
Eave struts and Girts can be cold form sections.
2. Live Load
: 0.60 kN/m2 (on Purlins & Frames)
3. Wind Speed
: 162 KMPH or 45 m/sec
4. Purlins at roof to be designed for Pattern Loading.
5. Rod bracing @ roof to be minimum of 20mm Tube strut beam to be
used at roof & wall brace intersection (Minimum 2 Braced bays in any
building).
6. Angle bracing to be used at Sidewalls, and Flat Bar bracing above B/W at
End walls.(4mm Min. thickness for both).
7. Galvanized Sag rod 16mm to be used for Purlins, SIDE WALL and
END WALL Girts for bays of more than 4.5MET. Use One row every
3.80M of bay size: (i.e .1 row for bays < 7.60M , 2 rows for bays >= 7.60M)
8. Design Calculation book must have calculations substantiating Gutter
size and Downspout used.
11
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
12
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
HFZ
GENERAL:
1. Primary members to have standard cleaning and to be painted with one
coat of Red Oxide Primer. (UNO in PIF).
2. Secondary members to be of Aluzinc OR /AND Galvanized materials.
3. Use of Metric system of units in Drawings and Calculations.
4. No Material substitution allowed without prior clearance from area
office.
5. Consistency in design calculation & drawing must be maintained since
most of the jobs are similar.
6. All Approval Drawings & Design Calculations must show PLOT
NUMBER.
DESIGN:
1. Minimum thickness of built-up section of Main frame and Mezzanine
beams to be 4 mm web and 6 mm flanges.
2. Multi-span internal column can be of 150x150x4.5 mm square tube.
3. Wind columns and end wall rafters, mezzanine joists can be of Cold
Formed or built-up of any thickness.
4. Live Load
: 0.60 kN/m2 (on Purlins & Frames) (UNO in PIF)
5. Wind Speed
: 160 KMPH
6. Cable bracing may be used at roof and sidewall.
7. Galvanized Sag rod 12 mm to be used for Purlins and Sidewall Girts as
per HFZ requirements.
13
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
DRAFTING:
1. Built-up sections flange and web sizes and interior column sizes to be
shown clearly on cross section of the main frame.
2. Details of Bolts Connections of Main Frames to be shown on Frame cross
section.
3. Irrelevant informations to be excluded from drawings or stamped with
"VOID".
4. Use of Metric system for standard anchor bolt details (No imperial units
are allowed).
5. No 40mm Notch to be shown on drawing.
6. No Ramp or Block work to be shown on Anchor Bolt Sheet F1.
7. Grid Enumeration shown on Order Sketch to be adhered to.
8. Column Section profile to be shown on all Anchor Bolt details ( I , C ,
Double C ).
9. C/C distances of sidewall and end wall Columns as well as framed
opening jambs following the grid enumeration, to be shown on Anchor
Bolt Plan F1.
10. SKYLIGHTS Locations to be shown on Roof Sheeting Plan according to
the locations in the ORDER SKETCH.
11. Show Size of Flange Braces/Stays on cross section drawings. (4mm Min.
thickness).
12. Flange brace should be provided on both sides of the rafter / column.
14
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
SAIF Zone
GENERAL:
1. Primary members to have standard cleaning and to be painted with one
coat of Gray Oxide Primer. (UNO in PIF).
2. Secondary members to be of Aluzinc or/And Galvanized materials.
3. Use of Metric system of units in Drawings and Calculations.
4. No Material substitution allowed without prior clearance from area
office.
5. Consistency in design calculation & drawing must be maintained since
most of the jobs are similar.
6. All Approval Drawings & Design Calculations must show PLOT
NUMBER.
DESIGN:
15
A R E A
R E Q U I R E M E N T S
DRAFTING:
1. Built-up sections flange and web sizes and interior column sizes to be
shown clearly on cross section of the main frame.
2. Details of Bolts Connections of Main Frames to be shown on Frame cross
section.
3. Irrelevant informations to be excluded from drawings or stamped with
"VOID".
4. Use of Metric system for standard anchor bolt details (No imperial units
are allowed).
5. No 40mm Notch to be shown on drawing.
6. No Ramp or Block work to be shown on Anchor Bolt Sheet F1.
7. Grid Enumeration shown on Order Sketch to be adhered to.
8. Column Sections to be shown on all Anchor Bolt details ( I , C , ][ ).
9. C/C distances of sidewall and end wall Columns as well as framed
opening jambs following the grid enumeration, to be shown on Anchor
Bolt Plan F1.
10. SKYLIGHTS Locations to be shown on Roof Sheeting Plan according to
the locations in the ORDER SKETCH.
11. Base plate thickness to be shown on Anchor Bolts details.
12. All drawings must include details of connections and splices as
distinguished between shop and field welds and showing the length and
type of each weld. (If field welding is indicated)
16